341 81 446MB
English Pages [1095] Year David A. Bell
O19 ep
5lectronic Devices and Circuits Fifth Edition
DAVID A. BELL
OXFORD UNIVERSITY
PRESS
OXFORD UNIVERSITY
PRESS
Oxford University Press is a department of the University of Oxford. It furthers the University’s objective of excellence in research, scholarship,
and, education by publishing worldwide. Oxford is a registered trademark of Oxford University Press in the UK and in certain other countries. Published in India by Oxford University Press
Ground Floor, 2/11, Ansari Road, Daryaganj, New Delhi, 110 002, India
Original fifth edition published by and © Oxford University Press, 70 Wynford Drive, Don Mills, Ontario, Canada.
Previous editions published by Prentice-Hall, Inc. This adapted edition first published in 2008 by Oxford University Press, India © Oxford University Press 2008 The moral rights of the author/s have been asserted. First published 2008
23™ impression 2017 All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted, in any form or by any means, without the prior permission in writing of Oxford University Press, or as expressly permitted by law, by licence, or under terms agreed with the appropriate reprographics rights organization. Enquiries concerning reproduction outside the scope of the above should be sent to the Rights Department, Oxford University Press, at the address above. You must not circulate this book in any other form
and you must impose this same condition on any acquirer.
—g
an a)
s
>
ie
gq
Onis
eS
ON
00 }
PRE
OO;
(
we &O
SS
!
co £ Q}
3 ey
“a
asd E00) ceoed
xs Fo
s
5
ie
e) Oo
zeze § me
6
¢
¥
=
S
a
&
Fr
a A
ISBN-10: 0-19-569340-X
&
Typeset in Palatino Linotype
d
5
& GS
by Archetype, New Delhi 110063 Printed in India by Gopsons Papers Ltd, Noida 201301
c.
4
te
ISBN-13: 978-0-19-569340-9
a)
v &
“\
For Sale in India, Bangladesh, Nepal, Bhutan, Sri Lanka, om. Myanmar, and Malaysia only and not for export therefr
&
6G
PREFACE An
understanding
of electronic
achieved by learning how
devices
and
circuits can most
easily be
to design circuits. Practical circuit design is
usually quite simple, much simpler than some methods of circuit analysis.
The objectives of this book, therefore, are to provide clear explanations of the operation of all the important electronic devices generally available today, to show how each device is used in appropriate circuits, and to demonstrate
_ how such circuits are designed. About the Book
This fifth edition is intended for undergraduate
engineering courses in
electrical and electronics, instrumentation and control, and electronics and
instrumentation as well as a reference text for practising professionals. Beginning with basic semiconductor and pn junction theory, the book explains how each device operates, discusses device characteristics and parameters, and presents appropriate circuit applications. Circuit design and
analysis methods are extensively treated, using currently available devices, standard-value components, and parameters from device manufacturers’ data sheets. The text includes many practical examples. The circuit design procedure mostly involves determining appropriate current and voltage levels, and then applying Ohm’s law and the capacitor
impedance equation. All circuits can be laboratory tested (and/or computer analyzed) to check the authenticity of the design process. Conventional current direction is used because it is the direction normally employed by device
and
integrated
graphic symbol direction.
circuit
manufacturers;
uses an arrowhead
also,
because
every
that indicates conventional
device
current
To reinforce application-based learning and help students assimilate the
concepts, each chapter contains numerous section-wise practice problems, review questions, and problems. The book also provides answers to all practice problems and selected end-chapter problems. New to the Fifth Edition
The text has been revised based on the syllabuses of various universities throughout the world, including those in India. A major addition is a new chapter on active filters, treating low-pass and high-pass, band-pass, notch,
all-pass, state variable, and switched capacitor filters. The chapter covers filter types, circuits, and characteristics as well as filter design examples.
iv
Preface
This edition also covers BJT switching time improvements, the 555 timer as a pulse generator, circuit testing and troubleshooting methods, RC and LC power supply filters, tuned circuit amplifiers, photomultiplier tube, and the laser diode.
class
C
amplifiers,
the
Coverage and Organization | The text has been organized into 22 chapters. Chapter 1 presents the basic semiconductor and pn-junction theory necessary for an understanding of the operation of electronic devices. Chapter 2 covers the operation, characteristics, parameters, and specifi-
cations of semiconductor diodes. Diode load line analysis, ac models, power
dissipation derating, and testing methods are also treated. The Zener diode
is introduced, explained.
and
its operation,
characteristics,
and
parameters
are
Chapter 3 presents diode applications such as half-wave and full-wave
rectification, RC and LC filters and L-input filters for dc power supplies, Zener diode voltage regulators, clipping and clamping
circuits, voltage
multipliers, and diode logic circuits. The calculation of the required filter
capacitor ‘and inductor values for a given rectifier power supply output voltage, load, and ripple is demonstrated with practical design examples. The chapter also includes examples to show how to determine component values for basic voltage regulators, clipping circuits, etc. DC power supply performance and testing are also covered. Chapter 4 introduces the bipolar junction transistor (BJT), and treats BJT
operation, currents, voltages, current amplification, voltage amplification, switching, and testing. Common base, common emitter, and common collector characteristics are also explained.
Chapter 5 completely demystifies practical BJT bias circuit design and
analysis. The chapter includes bias circuit design (for linear and switching circuits), dc load line analysis, thermal stability, and troubleshooting. _ Chapter 6 explains coupling. and bypass capacitors and ac load line analysis for BJT circuits. The three basic BJT circuit configurations are analyzed using h-parameters to derive equations for voltage gain, input impedance, and output impedance. The Ebers-Moll model is also treated in
this chapter. Chapter 7 explains manufacturing methods for diodes, transistors, and integrated circuits, and the effect of the fabrication method on device performance (frequency, switching, power
dissipation). Device packaging
and terminal identifications are also treated. Chapter 8 covers BJT data sheets, decibels and half-power points, device and circuit frequency response, switching times, circuit noise, device power
dissipation, and heat sink selection.
Preface
v
Chapter 9 explains the operation and construction of JFETs and MOSFETs. FET characteristics and parameters for n-channel and p-channel devices are
also covered, as well as FET amplification and switching. Chapter 10 demonstrates practical JFET and MOSFET bias circuit design and analysis, using graphical and calculation methods
and the universal
transfer characteristic. DC load line analysis and FET bias circuit troubleshooting are also treated. Chapter 11 commences with coverage of coupling and bypass capacitors and ac load line analysis for FET circuits, then treats FET models and parameters. The three basic FET circuits are analyzed for voltage gain, input
impedance, and output impedance. Chapter
12
offers
a
thorough
treatment
of
small-signal
amplifiers.
Complete design and analysis examples are presented, including the determination of all resistor and capacitor values and the selection of standard-value components. The circuits studied include the single-stage common-emitter BJT amplifier, single-stage common-source FET amplifier,
two-stage capacitor-coupled and direct-coupled BJT and BIFET amplifiers, differential amplifier, BJT cascode amplifier, and tuned circuit amplifiers. Chapter 13 explains the use of series voltage negative feedback (NFB), emitter current NFB, and parallel current NFB. The effects of NFB on amplifier gain, input and output impedance, bandwidth, etc., are all treated. The application of NFB in a variety of amplifier circuits is demonstrated in many practical circuit examples. Chapter 14 explains op-amp basics, parameters, and biasing considerations for both bipolar and BIFET op-amps. The voltage follower, noninverting amplifier, and inverting amplifier are all thoroughly covered as well as: summing amplifier, difference amplifier, instrumentation amplifier, voltage level detector, and Schmitt trigger. Chapter 15 covers op-amp circuit instability due to feedback, and discusses op-amp gain/frequency and phase/frequency responses and compensation methods. Also treated are: gain/bandwidth product, full
power bandwidth, slew rate, and the effects of stray and load capacitance.
Chapter 16 explains (op-amp and BJT) phase-shift, Colpitts, Hartley, and Wein bridge oscillators, and demonstrates how to design oscillator circuits for a given frequency. Oscillator amplitude stabilization methods are also treated as well as the use of crystals for frequency stabilization. Square wave
and triangular wave generators and the use of the 555 timer as a pulse generator are covered. Chapter 17 treats filter types and characteristics and design methods for
the following op-amp active filters: first-order, second-order and third-order low-pass
and
high-pass,
switched-capacitor.
band-pass,
notch,
allpass,
state-variable,
and
vi
Preface
yChapter
18 explains
the
operation
and
design
of BJT
series
voltage
regulators using a simple circuit with two transistors and a Zener diode through
highly
stable
adjustable
output
circuits
with
pre-regulators,
overload protection, and output current limiting. The operation and advantages of step-up, step-down, and inverting switching regulators are also covered. Chapter
19 treats class A, class B, class AB,
and
class
C
transformer-
coupled, capacitor-coupled, and direct-coupled (BJT and MOSFET) power amplifiers, and shows how to analyze and design such circuits. The chapter also explains the application of a variety of integrated circuit power amplifiers. >,Chapter 20 covers important thyristor devices and their circuit applications including the SCR, DIAC, TRIAC, SUS, SBS, GTO, UJT, and PUT. The operation, characteristics, parameters, and circuit applications of each device are explained. Chapter 21 covers light-emitting diodes, photoconductive cells, photo-
diodes, solar cells, phototransistors, optocouplers, photomultiplier tube, and laser diodes. Chapter 22 covers the VVC diode, thermistor, tunnel diode, Schottky diode, PIN diode, and current limiting diode. Appendix A covers device data sheets, Appendix B gives standard-value components, and Appendix C provides answers to odd-numbered problems.
Iam always grateful for suggestions that might improve my presentation of the material, or for additional topics that should be treated. Comments concerning this book would be very welcome. DAVID
BELL
CONTENTS Preface Chapter 1 1-1 1-2
Basic Semiconductor and pn-Junction Theory
Atomic Theory The Atom 2; Electron Orbits and Energy Levels 3; Conduction in Solids Electron Motion and Hole Transfer 5;
Energy Bands 5
Conventional Current and
Electron Flow 7 1-3
Conductors, Semiconductors, and Insulators
Bonding Forces between Atoms 8; 1-4
Energy Bands in Different Materials 9 10
n-Type and p-Type Semiconductors
Doping 10; n-Type Material 11; p-Type Material 11; Majority and Minority Charge Carriers 12; Effects of Heat and Light 13; Charge Carrier Density 14 1-5 Semiconductor Conductivity Drift Current 16;
Diffusion Current 17;
16
Charge Carrier Velocity 17;
Conductivity 18 20
The pn-Junction
Junction of p-Type and n-Type 20; 1-7
Barrier Voltage 21;
Depletion
Region 21; Summary 22 Biased Junctions Reverse-Biased Junction 23;
23 Forward-Biased Junction 24;
Junction
Temperature Effects 25 Junction Currents and voltages
Shockley Equation 27; Chapter 2 2-1 2-2 2-3
27
Junction Current 28;
29 33
Semiconductor Diodes
pn-Junction Diode
34
Characteristics and Parameters Forward and Reverse Characteristics 35;
35 Diode Parameters 37
Diode Approximations
39
Ideal Diodes and Practical Diodes 39; DC Equivalent Circuits 41 2-4
Junction Voltage
Piecewise Linear Characteristic 40;
DC Load Line Analysis DC Load Line 42;
Q-Point 44;
42. Calculating Load Resistance and
Supply Voltage 44 2-5
Temperature Effects Diode Power Dissipation 47; Resistance 49
47
Forward Voltage Drop 48;
Dynamic
vill_Contents 2-6
Diode AC Models
i
Junction Capacitances 50;
_ Forward-Biased) 51;
50
AC Equivalent Circuits (Reverse-Biased and
Reverse Recovery Time 52
2-7 Diode Specifications
53
Diode Data Sheets 53;
Low-Power Diodes 55;
‘2-8 Diode Testing
Ohmmeter Tests 56;
Use of a Digital Meter 57;
Characteristics 57 , 2-9
tics and Parameters 61;
59
Circuit Symbol and Package 60;
Data Sheet 62;
Characteris-
Equivalent Circuit 64
Diode Applications
3-1 Half-Wave Rectification Positive Half-Wave Rectifier 72; 3-2
56
Plotting Diode
a?
Zener Diodes Junction Breakdown 59;
Chapter 3
Rectifier Diodes 55
Full-Wave Rectification Two-Diode Full-Wave Rectifier 75; Rectifier Circuits 79
71 72 Negative Half-Wave Rectifier 74 Bridge Rectifier 77;
More Bridge
3-3 Half-Wave Rectifier Power Supply Capacitor Filter Circuit 80; Ripple Amplitude and Capacitance 81; Approximate Calculations 82; Capacitor Selection 83; Capacitor Polarity 84;
Diode Specification 86;
~ 3-4 Full-Wave Rectifier Power Supply
75
80
Transformer Selection 88
90
Transformer Selection 94 3-5
3-6
RC AND LC POWER SUPPLY FILTERS RC 7 FILTER 95; LC 7 Filter 97; L-Input Filter 99;
95 Advantages and
Disadvantages 102 Power Supply Performance and Testing Source Effect 103;
Load Effect 104;
Circuits and Open Circuits 105;
Test Procedure 104;
103 Short
Possible Faults and Remedies 106;
Using an Oscilloscope 106 3-7
108
Zener Diode Voltage Regulators
Regulator Circuit with No Load 108; Loaded Regulator 109; Regulator Performance 110 3-8 Series Clipping Circuits Series Clipper 113; Current Level Selection 115; Series Noise Clipper 115 . . 3-9 Shunt Clipping Circuits Shunt Clipper 116; Shunt Noise Clipper 117; Biased Shunt Clipper 118; Zener Diode Shunt Clipper 119 . 3-10 Clamping Circuits Negative and Positive Voltage Clamping Circuits 121; Output Slope 122; Component Determination 123;
Biased Clamping Circuit 125;
Diode Clamping Circuit 127 3-11
DC Voltage Multipliers Voltage Doubler 128; Multi-Stage Voltage Multipliers 131
113 116
121
Zener
128
Contents
3-12
Diode Logic Circuits AND
Gate 132;
Chapter 4 4-1
ix
132
OR Gate 133
Bipolar Junction Transistors
143
4-2
BJT Operation pnp and npn Transistors 144; npn Transistor Operation 145; pnp Transistor Operation 148; Bipolar Devices 148; Summary 149 BJT Voltages and Currents
150
4-3
Terminal Voltages 150; BJT Amplification
154
Transistor Currents 151
Current Amplification 154;
Voltage Amplification 155
4-4
BJT Switching
4-5
Diode-Connected BJT 158; BJT Saturation 159 Common-Base Characteristics Common-Base Circuit 161; Common-Base Input Characteristics 162;
158
Common-Base Output Characteristics 162; Gain Characteristics 164 4-6
144
; 161
Common-Base Current
Common-Emitter Characteristics
166
Common-Emitter Circuit 166; Common-Emitter Input Characteristics 166; Common-Emitter Output Characteristics 167; Common-Emitter 4-7
4-8
Current Gain Characteristics 169 Common-Collector Characteristics Output and Current Gain Characteristics 170;
170 Common-Collector
Circuit 171; Common-Collector Input Characteristics 171 Transistor Testing
172
In-Circuit Testing 172; Ohmmeter and Digital Multimeter Tests 172; Characteristic Plotting 173 Chapter 5
5-1
181 Selection of Q-point
Effect of Emitter Resistor 187
188
Base Bias
Circuit Operation and Analysis 188; 5-3
180
DC Load Line and Bias Point DC Load Line 181; DC Bias Point (Q-Point) 183; 185;
5-2
BJT Biasing
Base Bias Using a Collector-to-Base Circuit Operation Collector-to-Base
Effect of Apg(max) and hpE(min) 189;
pnp Transistor 190 Bias and Analysis 192; Effect of hpgamaxy) and MFE(min) 193; Bias Using a pnp Transistor 195
5-4 Voltage-Divider Bias Circuit Operation 196;
Circuit Analysis 198; 5-5 Comparison of Basic 5-6 Troubleshooting BJT Voltage Measurement
Approximate Circuit Analysis 197;
196
Precise
Voltage-Divider Bias Using a pnp Transistor 202 Bias Circuits Bias Circuits 205; Common Errors 205; Open-Circuited and
Short-Circuited Components 205; Base Bias 206; Bias 206; Voltage-Divider Bias 207
192
Collector-to-Base
203 205
x,
Contents
5-7
Bias-Circuit Design
207
Base Bias Circuit Design 207; Collector-to-Base Bias Circuit Design 209; Voltage-Divider Bias Circuit Design 210; Designing with Standard Resistor Values 212: 5-8
More Bias Circuits Base Bias and Collector-to-Base Bias with Emitter Resistors 213;
Voltage-Divider and Collector-to-Base Combination 213; Current Bias 215 Thermal Stability of Bias Circuits Vee and Icgo Variations 218; Stability Factor 219;
213
Emitter218
Effect of Vg
Changes 222; Diode Compensation 223 5-10 Biasing BJT Switching Circuits _ Direct-Coupled Switching Circuit 224; Capacitor-Coupled Switching Circuit 227; Switching Circuit Design 228 Chapter 6 6-1
AC Analysis of BUT Circuits
238
Coupling and Bypassing Capacitors Coupling Capacitors 239; AC Degeneration 241; Capacitor Polarity 242
239
Emitter Bypassing 241;
AC Load Lines
243
AC Equivalent Circuits 243; AC Load Lines 243; Swing 246 Transistor Models and Parameters T-Equivalent Circuit 246; 247;
6-4
224
h-Parameters 248;
r-Parameters 247;
The Output Voltage 246
Determination of re
Tp Equivalent Circuit 249;
Definition of
h-Parameters 249;
Common-Base and Common-Collector
h-Parameters 252;
Parameter Relationships 252 254
Common-Emitter Circuit Analysis Common-Emitter Circuit 254;
h-Parameter Equivalent Circuit 254;
Input Impedance 255; Output Impedance 256; Voltage Gain 256; Current Gain 257; Power Gain 258; Summary of Typical CE Circuit Performance 258 CE Circuit with Unbypassed Emitter Resistor
h-Parameter Equivalent Circuit 259; Impedance 261; Voltage Gain 261;
259
Input Impedance 260; Output Performance Summary for CE
Circuit with Unbypassed Rx 261 6-6
263
Common-Collector Circuit Analysis
Common-Collector Circuit 263; Input Impedance 264;
f-Parameter Equivalent Circuit 264;
Output Impedance 265;
Voltage Gain 266;
Summary of CC Circuit Performance 266 6-7
Common-Base Circuit Analysis Common-Base Circuit 268; h-Parameter Equivalent Circuit 269;
Impedance 270;
Output Impedance 270;
Effect of Unbypassed Base Resistors 271;
Performance 271
Voltage Gain 270
Summary of CB Circuit
268
Input
Contents
6-8
Comparison of CE, CC, and CB Circuits
xi
274
Impedance at the Transistor Base 275; Impedance at the Transistor Emitter 275; Impedance at the Transistor Collector 276; Voltage gain 276 6-9
Ebers-Moll BJT MODEL
Chapter 7 7-1
278
Fabrication of Semiconductor Devices andiCs
Processing of Semiconductor Materials
288 289
Preparation of Silicon and Germanium 289;
Diffusion 289;
Epitaxial
Growth 290
7-2 Diode Fabrication and Packaging 7-3
Alloy and Diffused Diodes 290; Diode Packaging 291 Transistor Construction and Performance Current Gain 292;
High Power 293;
Switching Transistors 293; 7-4
290
Frequency Response 293;
Breakdown and Punch-Through 293
Transistor Fabrication
294
Alloy Transistors 294;
Microalloy Transistors 295;
Diffused Transistors 295;
Diffused Mesa 296;
Diffused Planar Transistor 297;
Microalloy-
Epitaxial Mesa 296;
Annular Transistor 297
7-5 Integrated Circuits IC Types 298; Monolithic Integrated Circuits 298; 7-6
292
298 Thin Film 298;
Thick Film 299; Hybrid 300 IC Components and Circuits Transistors and Diodes 300;
300
Circuits 301;
Resistors 302;
Capacitors 302
7-7 Transistor and IC Packaging
303
Discrete Transistor Packaging 303; Chapter 8
IC Packages 304
BJT Specifications and Performance
307
8-1
Transistor Data Sheets
308
8-2
Decibels and Half-Power Points
311
Power Measurement in Decibels 311;
8-3
BJT Cutoff Frequency and Capacitances Device Cutoff Frequency 314;
8-4
Half-Power Points 313;
Junction Capacitances 314;
on CE and CB Circuits 318;
Follower 320;
317
Input-Capacitance Effect
Input-Capacitance Effects on Emitter
Stray Capacitance 320 322
Transistor Switching Times Turn-On Times 322;
Frequency 324; 8-6 8-7
Miller Effect 316
BJT Circuit Frequency Response
Coupling and Bypass Capacitor Effects 317;
8-5
314
Turn-Off Times 323;
Rise Time and Cutoff
Switching Time Improvement 324 327 332
Transistor Circuit Noise Transistor Power Dissipation
Maximum Power Dissipation 332;
Maximum Power Dissipation
Curve 334 8-8
Heat Sinking
336
xii_
Contents
Chapter 9 9-1
Field Effect Transistors
Junction Field Effect Transistors n-Channel JFET 346; p-Channel JFET 347;
Packaging 348 9-2, JFET Characteristics ~~ Depletion regions 349;
345 346 JFET Fabrication and 349
Drain Characteristics with Vos = 0 350;
Characteristics with External Bias 351; p-Channel JFET Characteristics 355
Drain
Transfer Characteristics 354;
9-3 JFET Data Sheets and Parameters Maximum Ratings 356; Saturation Current and Pinch-off Voltage 357; Forward Transfer Admittance 360; Output Admittance 362; DrainSource on Resistance 363; Gate Cutoff Current and Input Resistance 363;
Breakdown Voltage 363;
Noise Figure 363
Capacitances 364
9-4 FET Amplification and Switching Amplification 364; FET Switching 366
9-5 MOSFETs
356
364
|
367
Enhancement MOSFET 367; Depletion-Enhancement MOSFET 369; VMOSFET 371; Comparison of n-Channel and p-Channel FETs 374;
Handling MOSFETs 375 Chapter 10 10-1 10-2
380
FET Biasing
DC Load Line and Bias Point DC Load Line 381; Bias Point (Q-Point) 382; Gate Bias Circuit Operation 385;
Effect of Source Resistor 384
Circuit Analysis 386
Gate Bias for a p-Channel JFET 388 10-3 Self-bias Circuit Operation 388; Circuit Analysis 389;
Self-Bias for a p-Channel
JFET 391
10-4
Voltage-Divider Bias Circuit Operation 392;
Circuit Analysis 392;
Voltage-Divider Bias for
a p-Channel JFET 395 10-5 Comparison of Basic JFET Bias Circuits 10-6 Troubleshooting JFET Bias Circuits Common Voltage Measurement 397; Voltage-Divider Bias 398 Bias 398;
10-7
Errors 397;
395 397 Gate Bias 397;
399
JFET Bias Circuit Design
Circuit Design Approach 399; Gate Bias Circuit Design 400; Self-Bias with Design 402; Voltage-Divider Bias Circuit Design 404; Designing Standard-Value Resistors 407
10-8
10-9
Self-
More JFET Bias Circuits Use of Plus/Minus Supplies 408; Current Bias 410
408 Drain Feedback 408;
Constant-
Use of Universal Transfer Characteristic Universal Transfer Characteristic 413; Circuit Analysis 414
413
Contents
xiii
10-10 MOSFET Biasing
417
DMOS Bias Circuits 417; EMOS Bias Circuits 418 10-11 Biasing FET Switching Circuits
421
JFET Switching 421;
Direct-Coupled JFET Switching Circuit 421;
Capacitor-Coupled JFET Switching Circuits 422;
MOSFET
Switching 423 Chapter 11
=AC Analysis of FET Circuits
435
11-1
Coupling, Bypassing, and AC Load Lines Coupling Capacitors 436; Bypassing Capacitors 436; AC Load Lines 436 11-2 FET Models and Parameters FET Equivalent Circuit 438; Equivalent Circuit Parameters 439 11-3 Common-Source Circuit Analysis Common-Source Circuit 439; Common-Source Equivalent Circuit 440; Input Impedance 440; Output Impedance 441; Voltage Gain 442; Summary of Typical CS Circuit Performance 442 11-4 CS Circuit with Unbypassed Source Resistor Equivalent Circuit 444; 445; Voltage Gain 446;
436 438 439
444
Input Impedance 444; Output Impedance Summary of Performance of CS Circuit with
Unbypassed Rs 447 11-5
Common-Drain Circuit Analysis
Common-Drain Circuit 448; Input Impedance 450;
448
Common-Drain Equivalent Circuit 449;
Output Impedance 450;
Voltage Gain 451;
Summary of CD Circuit Performance 451 11-6
Common-Gate Circuit Analysis Common-Gate Circuit 452;
452
Common-Gate Equivalent Circuit 453;
Input Impedance 454; Output Impedance 454; Voltage Gain 454; Effect of Unbypassed Gate Resistors 455; Summary of CG Circuit Performance 456
.
11-7 Comparison of FET and BJT Circuits CS, CD, and CG Circuit Comparison 457; Gate 457; Drain 458;
11-8
457 Impedance at the FET
Impedance at the FET Source 458; Impedance at the FET Voltage Gain 458; FET-BJT Circuit Comparison 460
Frequency Response of FET Circuits Low-Frequency Response 460; High-Frequency Response 461
Chapter 12
469
=Small-Signal Amplifiers
470
12-1 Single-Stage Common-Emitter Amplifier Specification 470;
Selection of Ic, Rc, and Rg 470;
Bypass Capacitor 472; Coupling Capacitors 475; 476; Design Calculations 476 12-2 Single-Stage Common-Source Amplifier Specification 479;
Capacitors 481;
Selection of Ip, Rp, and Rg 479;
Design Calculations 483
460
Bias Resistors 471;
Shunting Capacitors 479 Bias Resistors 481;
xiv_
12-3 12-4
Contents.
.Capacitor-Coupled Two-Stage CE Amplifier Circuit 485; Circuit Design 486; | Circuit Analysis 487
485
Direct-Coupled Two-Stage Circuits
490
Direct-Coupled Circuit 490; Circuit Design 490; 493;. Use of Complementary Transistors 495 12-5
Circuit Analysis
Two-Stage Circuit with Emitter Follower Output Circuit 496
496
12-6 DC Feedback Pair DC Feedback Pair with Two Amplification Stages 500; DC Feedback ~ Pair with Emitter Follower Output 502 12-7 BIFET Circuits BJT-FET Considerations 505; Capacitor-Coupled BIFET Amplifier 505; Direct-Coupled BIFET Amplifier 506; Design Calculations 507 12-8 Differential Amplifier Differential Amplifier Circuit 510; AC Operation 512; Voltage Gain 512; Input and Output Impedances 514; DC Amplification 514; Design Calculations 515 12-9 Small-Signal High-Frequency Amplifiers Common-Base Amplifier 518;
Cascode Amplifier 519;
505
510
518
Design
Calculations 520; Differential Amplifier as a High-Frequency Amplifier 523 12-10 TUNED CIRCUIT AMPLIFIERS Tuned Amplifiers 524; Tuned Amplifier with a Capacitor-Coupled Load 524; Tank Circuit Component Selection 527; Inductively Coupled. Load with Tuned Primary 527; Amplifier with Tuned Primary and Tuned Secondary 529 12-11 Amplifier Testing Preparation 532; Instability 532; DC Voltage Measurements 533, AC Testing 534; Input and Output Impedances 535 Chapter 13
500
524
532
544
Amplifiers with Negative Feedback
Series Voltage Negative Feedback Negative Feedback Concept 545; Voltage Gain 546; Input Impedance 548; Input Impedance with Bias Resistors 549, Output Impedance 550;
545
Two-Stage CE Amplifier with Series Voltage Negative Feedback Negative Feedback Amplifier Circuit 553; Negative Feedback Amplifier Design 556 ack a. 3 More Amplifiers with Series Voltage Negative Feedb 559; DC — ack Complementary Direct-Coupled Circuit with Feedb tage Circuit Feedback Pair Using Negative Feedback 561; BIFET Two-S Cutoff wita Negative Feedback 561; Setting the Circuit Upper
553
13-1
Output Impedance with a Collector Resistor 551
13-2
requency 562
4
Differential Amplifier with Negative Feedback ‘lwo-Stage Differential Amplifier 563; Operation 564;
Circuit Design 565;
DC Bias Conditions 563;
aso
2
5 AC
Modification for Reduced Zout 567
Contents
13-5
Emitter Current Feedback Emitter Current Feedback Circuit 569;
xv
569 Circuit Design 571;
Two-Stage
Circuit with Emitter Current Feedback 572
13-6 Parallel Current Negative Feedback Current Feedback Circuit 576;
Impedances 578; 13-7
576
Current Gain 577;
Output and Input
Circuit Design 579
Additional Effects of Negative Feedback Decibels of Feedback 581; Attenuation Distortion 584;
Bandwidth 581; Phase Shift 584;
581 Harmonic Distortion 583; Noise 586;
Circuit
Stability 586
Chapter 14
‘IC Operational Amplifiers and Basic
592
Op-Amp Circuits 14-1 Integrated Circuit Operational Amplifiers Circuit Symbol and Packages 593; Basic Internal Circuit 593; Important Parameters 594
593
14-2 Biasing Operational Amplifiers Biasing Bipolar Op-amps 595; Biasing BIFET Op-amps 599
595
14-3
600
14-4
Voltage Follower Circuits Direct-Coupled Voltage Follower 600; Follower 602 Non-inverting Amplifiers
Capacitor-Coupled Voltage
Direct-Coupled Non-Inverting Amplifier 604; 14-5
14-6 14-7
14-8
Capacitor-Coupled
Non-Inverting Amplifier 607 Inverting Amplifiers Direct-Coupled Inverting Amplifier 608; Capacitor-Coupled Inverting Amplifier 610 Summing Amplifier Difference Amplifier Circuit Operation 613; Input Resistances 614; Common-Mode Voltages 616 Instrumentation Amplifier
Circuit Operation 617; 14-9
604
608
611 613
617
Voltage Gain 618
Voltage Level Detectors
621
Op-amps in Switching Applications 621; Zero Crossing Detector 622 14-10 Schmitt Trigger Circuits Inverting Schmitt Trigger 624; Triggering Points 625; Input/Output
624
Characteristic 625; Circuit Design 626; Adjusting the Trigger Points 627; Non-Inverting Schmitt Trigger 628
14-11 Testing and Troubleshooting Op-amp Circuits DC Voltages 631; AC Gain and Frequency Response 632; Circuits 632
631 Switching
xvi
Contents
Chapter 15 15-1
15-2
15-3
Operational Amplifier Frequency Response and Compensation
Operational Amplifier Circuit Stability Loop Gain and Loop Phase Shift 640; Uncompensated Gain and Phase Response 641; Compensated Op-amp Gain and Phase Response 642; Amplifier Stability and Gain 643 Frequency Compensation Methods Phase-Lag and Phase-Lead Compensation 646; Manufacturer’s Recommended Compensation 647; Miller-Effect Compensation 648 Op-amp Circuit Bandwidth and Slew Rate Low Cutoff Frequency 649; High Cutoff Frequency 650; Gain-Bandwidth Product 651; Full-Power Bandwidth and Slew Rate 653 Stray Capacitance Effects Load Capacitance Effects
15-4 15-5 15-6 Circuit Stability Precautions Power Supply Decoupling 660; Chapter 16 16-1
16-3
BJT Phase Shift Oscillator 670
Op-Amp Colpitts Oscillator Design 675
BJT Hartley Oscillator 677
Oscillator Amplitude Stabilization
684;
657
Op-Amp Phase Shift Oscillator
Wein Bridge Oscillator
Oscillator 681;
655
666
Hartley Oscillators
Output Amplitude 681;
649
665
BJT Phase Shift Oscillator 669;
Op-Amp Hartley Oscillator 675; 16-4 16-5
646
660
Phase Shift Oscillators Op-Amp Phase Shift Oscillator 666;
Design 670 16-2 Colpitts Oscillators Op-Amp Colpitts Oscillator 670; 672; BJT Colpitts Oscillator 674
640
Stability Precautions 660
Signal Generators
Design 667;
639
678 681
Diode Stabilization Circuit for a Phase Shift
Diode Stabilization Circuit for a Wein Bridge Oscillator
FET Stabilization Circuit for a Wein Bridge Oscillator 684;
Design of a FET Stabilization Circuit 686 16-6 Square Wave Generator 16-7 555 Pulse Generator
688 690
Component Values Pulse Generator 692; Timer Block Diagram 690; Voltage-Controlled Square Wave Generator 694; 693; Duty Cycle 694;
Oscillator 696 16-8
Triangular Wave Generator Integrator 697;
Integrator Combined with Schmitt Trigger 698;
Circuit Design 699 16-9
697
Oscillator Frequency Stabilization Frequency Stability 701; Piezoelectric Crystals 701; Crystal Equivalent Circuit 702; Crystals Control of Oscillators 703
701
Contents
Chapter 17 17-1
17-2
711
= Active Filters
712
Filter Types and Characteristics
Low-Pass 712;
xvii
High-Pass 713;
Band-Pass 713;
Notch 713;
Filter
Characteristics 714 First-Order Active Filters
717
First-Order Low-Pass Filter 717; First-Order High-Pass Filter 718 17-3 Higher-Order Active Filters Falloff Rate 720; Filter Design Categories 721; Second-Order Low-
720
Pass Active Filter 722 17-4 17-5
Second-Order High-Pass Active Filters Third-Order Active Filters
Third-Order Low-Pass filter 728; 17-6
125 728
Third-Order High-Pass Filters 729 731
Band-Pass Filters Multi-Stage Band-Pass Filter 731; Single-Stage Band-Pass Filter 731; Bandwidth 735; Narrow-Band Single-Stage Band-Pass Filter 736
17-8
Notch Filters All-Pass Filters
17-9
Phase-Lag Circuit 740; State-Variable Filters
17-7
738 740 Phase-Lead Circuit 743 744
17-10 IC Switched-Capacitor Filters
746
Switched-Capacitor Resistor Simulation 746; 17-11 Filter Testing and Troubleshooting Chapter 18 18-1
18-2
Transistor Series Regulator Basic Circuit 758; Regulator with Error Amplifier 759; Regulator Performance 760; Regulator Design 762
7357 758
Series
Improving Regulator Performance
Error Amplifier Gain 764;
18-4
751
Linear and Switching Voltage Regulators
764
Output Voltage Adjustment 764;
Output-Current Circuit 766; 18-3
IC Filter Circuits 748
Preregulation 767;
High-
Constant-Current
Source 769; Differential Amplifier 770 Current Limiting Short-Circuit Protection 772; Fold-Back Current Limiting 774 Op-amp Voltage Regulators Voltage-Follower Regulator 776;
772 776
Adjustable Output Regulator 777;
Current Limiting with an Op-amp Regulator 779 18-5
IC Linear Voltage Regulators
723 IC Regulator 780; 18-6
LM340
Regulators 785 Switching Regulator Basics
Switching Regulator Operation 786; Switching Regulators 787 18-7
780
LM317 and LM337 IC Regulators 784;
786
Comparison of Linear and
Step-Down, Step-Up, and Inverting Converters
Step-Down Converter 790; Step-Down Converter Equations 791; Step-Up Converter 793; Inverting Converter 795
790
xwiii
18-8
Contents
IC Controller for Switching Regulators
796
Function Block Diagram 796; Step-Down Converter Using an MC35063 797; Variable Off-Time Modulator 798; Catch Diode Selection 800; Diode Snubber 800; High-Power Converters 800
Chapter 19 19-1
Power Amplifiers
807
Transformer-Coupled Class A Amplifier
808
Class A Circuit 808;
DC and AC Loads 809; 811; Efficiency of a Class A Amplifier 812
19-2
19-3
Collector Voltage Swing
Transformer-Coupled Class B and Class AB Amplifiers Class B Amplifiers 815; Cross-Over Distortion 818; Class AB Amplifier 818; Efficiency of Class B and Class AB Amplifiers 819 Transformer-Coupled Amplifier Design
815
822
19-4 Capacitor-Coupled and Direct-Coupled Output Stages
825
Complementary Emitter Follower 825; Capacitor-Coupled Class AB Output Stage 826; Class AB Capacitor-Coupled Amplifier Design 827; Direct-Coupled Class AB Output Stage 832 19-5 Modifications to Improve Power Amplifier Performance Darlington-Connected Output Transistors 833 Quasi-Complementary Output Stage 835; Output Current Limiting 836; Vgz Multiplier 837; Power Supply Decoupling 839; Increased Voltage Gain and Negative Feedback 840; Load Compensation 840 19-6 BJT Power Amplifier with Differential Input Stage Amplifier Circuit 841; Amplifier Design 842 19-7 Complementary MOSFET Common-Source Power Amplifier Advantages of MOSFETs 846; Power Amplifier with MOSFET Output Stage 847; MOSFET Power Amplifier Design 848 19-8
BJT Power Amplifier with Op-Amp Driver
Circuit Operation 851; 19-9
250 mW
Bridge-Tied Load Amplifier 873;
846
Design
Procedure 855 MOSFET Power Amplifier with OP-Amp Driver Stage
IC Power Amplifier Driver 869;
841
851
Use of Bootstrapping Capacitors 852;
Basic Circuit Operation 858; Bias Control 861; 863; Complete Amplifier Circuit 866 19-10 Integrated Circuit Power Amplifiers
833
858
Output Voltage Swing 869
IC Power Amplifier 872;
7 W IC Power Amplifier 875;
68 W IC Power Amplifier 876 19-11 Class C Amplifier Class C Circuit and Waveforms 877;
877 Efficiency 879;
Bandwidth 881;
Component Selection 882 Chapter 20 20-1
893
= Thyristors
Silicon-Controlled Rectifier (SCR) SCR Operation 894; Specification 899
SCR Characteristics and Parameters 896;
894 SCR
Contents
20-2
SCR Control Circuits Pulse Control 900; 90° Phase Control 903;
900 180° Phase Control 907
More SCR Applications SCR Circuit Stability 908; Zero-Point Triggering 909; Crowbar Circuit 910; Heater Control Circuit 911 20-4 TRIAC and DIAC TRIAC Operation and Characteristics 912; TRIAC Triggering 914; The DIAC 915 20-5 TRIAC Control Circuits
20-3
TRIAC Phase Control Circuit 916;
917;
xix
908
912
916
TRIAC Zero-Point Switching Circuit
The IC Zero Voltage Switch 919
20-6
SUS, SBS, GTO, and SIDAC The SUS 920; TheSBS921; The GTO 925 The SIDAC 925
920
20-7
Unijunction Transistor (UJT)
927
UJT Operation 927; UJT Characteristics 928; UJT Packages 930; UJT Parameters 930; UJT Relaxation Oscillator 932; UJT Control of an SCR 934 20-8 Programmable Unijunction Transistor (PUT) PUT Operation 935; PUT Characteristics 935; PUT Parameters 936; PUT Applications 937
Chapter 21 21-1
Optoelectronic Devices
945
Light Units
946
21-2 Light-Emitting Diodes (LED)
21-3
21-4
935
948
LED Operation and Construction 948; Characteristics and Parameters 949; LED Circuits 950 Seven-Segment Displays LED Seven-Segment Display 952; Liquid Crystal Cells 953; LCD Seven-Segment Displays 954 Photoconductive Cells Cell Construction 955;
952
955
Characteristics and Parameters 956;
Applications 957 21-5
960
Photodiodes and Solar Cells
Photodiode Operation 960;
Characteristics 961;
Photodiode Applications 963;
21-6
Construction 963; Phototransistors Phototransistor (BJT) 967; Applications 969;
Specification 962; Solar Cells 964 967
Characteristics and Specification 968;
Photo-Darlingtons 970;
Photo-FET 970 971
21-7 Optocouplers
Operation and Construction 971;
973; 21-8
Specification 972;
Applications
Other Optocouplers 974
975
Photomultiplier Tube Operation 975; Divider 978
Characteristics 976;
Circuit Diagrams 976;
Voltage
xx.
Contents
21-9
Laser Diode
981
Operation 981; 983;
Chapter 22 22-1
Characteristics and. Parameters 982;
Modulation 984
Drive Circuits
:
Miscellaneous Devices
Voltage-Variable Capacitor Diodes Equivalent Circuit 995; VVC Operation 994;
993 994 Specification and
Characteristics 995; Applications 996 22-2 Thermistors Thermistor Operation 998; Characteristics and Specifications 999; Applications 1000 22-3
Tunnel Diodes
Tunnel Diode Operation 1002; Characteristics and Parameters 1003; Parallel Amplifier 1006 22-4 Schottky, PIN, and Current-Limiting Diodes The Schottky Diode 1009; PIN Diode 1011; Current-Limiting Diode 1012 Appendices Appendix A Appendix B Appendix C
Index
998
1002
1009
1018 Device Data Sheets = Standard-Value Components Answers to Odd-Numbered Problems
1018 1050 1053
‘1060
CHAPTER 1 = asic Semiconductor and pn-Junction Theory Objectives You will be able to:
diagram to show its compo-
Explain how n-type and p-type semiconductor materials are cre-
nents.
ated, and discuss the differences
Explain energy levels and energy bands relating to electrons,
between the two types. Sketch a pn-junction, and explain the origin of the junction
1 Describe an atom, and sketch a
and define valence band and
depletion region.
conduction band.
Draw diagrams to show the effects of forward biasing and
Describe how electric current
flow occurs by electron motion and by hole transfer. Explain conventional current direction and direction of electron flow. Sketch a diagram to show the
relationship between covalently bonded atoms. Discuss the differences between conductors, insulators, and semiconductors.
reverse biasing a pn-junction. 10
Sketch the current/voltage characteristics for forward-bi-
ased and reverse-biased pnjunctions. 11 Discuss temperature effects on conductors, insulators, semiconductors, and
pn-junctions. IZ Calculate current and voltage
levels at a pn-junction.
INTRODUCTION An electronic device controls the movement of electrons. The study of electronic devices requires a basic understanding of the relationship between electrons and the other components of an atom. The movement of electrons within
a solid and the bonding forces between atoms can then be investigated. This leads to a knowledge of the differences between conductors, insulators, and
semiconductors, and to an understanding of p-type and n-type semiconductor material.
2
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Junctions of p-type and n-type material (pn-junctions) are basic to all but a very few semiconductor devices. Forces act upon electrons that are adjacent to a pn-junction, and these forces are altered by the presence of an external
bias voltage.
1-1 ATOMIC THEORY The Atom The atom can be thought of as consisting of a central nucleus surrounded by orbiting electrons (see Fig. 1-1). It may be compared to a planet with orbiting
satellites. Just as satellites are held in orbit by the attractive force of gravity due to the mass of the planet, so each electron is held in orbit by an electrostatic force of attraction between it and the nucleus.
os Electron
f
Nucleus (positively charged)
7
(negatively
e
charged)
Nf
Figure 1-1 The atom consists of a central nucleus
surrounded by orbiting Ne
electrons. The electrons have a negative charge,
&
and the nucleus contains protons that are positively charged.
Eachelectronhasa negative electrical charge of 1.602 X 107~!? Coulombs (C), and some particles within the nucleus have a positive charge of the same magnitude. Because opposite charges attract, a force of attraction exists between the oppositely charged electron and nucleus. Compared to the mass of the nucleus, electrons are relatively tiny particles of almost negligible mass. In fact, they can be considered to be little particles of negative electricity having no mass at all.
The nucleus of an atom (Fig. 1-2) is largely a clus-
Protons
ter of two types of particles, protons and neutrons. Protons have a positive electrical charge, equal in magni-
O° es
tude (but opposite in polarity) to the negative charge :
on an electron. A neutron has no charge at all. Protons and neutrons each have masses about 1800 times the mass of an electron. For a given atom, the number of
Neutrons
Figure 1-2 The nucleus chanson te lagiand cluster of protons neutrons.
protons in the nucleus normally equals the number
of orbiting electrons. Because ’
the
equal in number
protons and
and
equal
orbital
and
electrons
opposite
are
in charge,
Chapter 1
Basic Semiconductor and pn-Junction Theory
3
they neutralize each other electrically. For this reason, all atoms are normally
electrically neutral. If an atom loses an electron, it has lost some negative charge. Consequently, it becomes positively charged and is referred to as a positive ion (see Fig. 1-3a). Similarly, if an atom gains an additional electron, it
becomes negatively charged and is termed a negative ion (Fig. 1-3b). The differences between atoms consist largely of dissimilar numbers and arrangements of the three basic types of particle. However, all electrons are Additional electron Hole
"
> Na, n >> p
From Eq. 1-6,
n= Np-Na = 3X 104-0.5 x 104 = 2.5 x 10"
and, from Eq. 1-3,
p=nz/n= (1.5 X 10!%/(2.5 x 10) = 0.9 X 10° holes /cm?
Section 1-4 Review 1-4.1 Draw a sketch
to illustrate donor doping.
1-4.2 Draw a sketch to illustrate acceptor doping. 1-4.3 Define n-type material, p-type material, minority charge carriers, major-
_.. “>
ity charge carriers, positive temperature coefficient, negative temperature coefficient, and dark resistance.
‘ice2 Problems , Determine the number of free alkene and holes in a sample of silicon
h is doped. with aX in donor:mitered em? and 3.3 x 10" accepatoms. / cm?
Bite
‘
j
at Problem 1-4.1 fora germanium sample if the electron density in
intrinsic germanium is.2.5 x 10. 1-5 SEMICONDUCTOR CONDUCTIVITY Drift Current In free space, an electric field will accelerate electrons in a straight line from
the negative terminal to the positive terminal of the applied voltage. In a conductor or semiconductor at 25°C, a free electron under the influence of an
electric field will move toward the positive terminal of the applied voltage, but will continually collide with atoms along the way. The situation is illustrated in Fig. 1-17. Each time the electron strikes an atom, it rebounds in —
a random direction. The presence of the electric field does not stop the collisions and random motion, but it does cause the electrons to drift in the direction of the positive terminal. Consequently, current produced in this way is termed as drift current, and it is the usual kind of current flow that occurs in conductors and semiconductors.
Chapter ‘1
Basic Semiconductor and pn-Junction Theory
17
Electron path when no electric field is present |
Electron path when the electric field is present
o
+
———
Electron drift due to electric field
d 7
_
Conductor or
We
semiconductor
Figure
1-17
e
toms
Drift current is the type of current flow that occurs in conductors and
semiconductors when a voltage is applied. Electrons cannot travel in a straight line, but instead drift along, bouncing from one atom to another.
Diffusion Current Figure 1-18 illustrates another type of current that occurs in semiconductors. Suppose a concentration of one type of charge carriers appears at one end of a piece of semiconductor material, as the result of a charge carrier injection
from an external source. Because the charge carriers are either all electrons or all holes they have the same polarity, and thus there is a force of repulsion between them. This produces a tendency for the electrons to move gradually, or diffuse, away from the locality of high concentration toward one of low concentration until they are eventually distributed throughout the material.
The movement of charge carriers constitutes an electric current, and so this type of current is known as a diffusion current. Diffusion current
Charge
he
i carrier
—WH-————_»
aes
6.
o-
e
e
concentration ————>-
e*
@
eon eo eG @
e-
»6-
ee , . @Ore
e'= >
gi Bi aoa,
ee
Figure
1-18
Diffusion
current
-
occurs
o-
when
eeo.
-
oe ;
charge
carriers
diffuse
from
a point
of
concentration to spread uniformly throughout the material.
Charge Carrier Velocity Recall from Section 1-2 that electrons have greater mobility than holes. The mobility constants (see Table 1-1) determine the electron and hole (drift
18
Electronic Devices and Circuits
current) velocities under the influence of an electric field. For electron velocity (0,) and hole velocity (Up)
and
: Up = Up 6
(1-8)
where fn and pp are the electron and hole mobility constants, and © is the electric field strength. The minus sign in Eq. 1-7 indicates that the electrons move from negative to positive, opposite to conventional current direction.
Example 1-2 Calculate the drift current velocity for electrons and for holes in a 1 mm length of silicon at 27°C when the terminal voltage is 10 V. Solution
Eq. 1-7:
Un = —UnE/1 =-1500 cm? X 10 V/1 mm = -1500 m/s
Eq. 1-8:
Up= MpE/1 = 500 cm? X 10 V/1 mm = 500 m/s
Conductivity Recall from basic electrical studies that the resistance of a conductor is given by the equation R= pl/a
(1-9)
where p is the resistivity of the material (in 0.m), ! is the length, and a is the cross-sectional area. This can be rewritten as
R= 1/(oa)
(1-10)
where ois the material conductivity (the reciprocal of resistivity) (Q.m)7!.
For doped semiconductor having n free electrons and p holes, the conducti-
vity is given by
o= q(npn + Pp) where q is the electronic charge (1.602 x 10°" C).
(1-11)
Chapter 1
Basic Semiconductor and pn-Junction Theory
Example 1-3 A cylindrically shaped section of n-type silicon has a 1 mm 0.1 mm?
cross-sectional
area. Calculate
its conductivity
and
19
length and resistance
(a) when it is purely intrinsic material, and (b) when it has a free electron
density of n = 8 X 10'3/cm’. Solution
1=1mm=0.1
cmanda=0.1 mm? = 107° cm?
(a) From Table 1-1, the electron and hole density for intrinsic silicon is n; = 1.5 X 10!°/cm?3 and the mobility constants are
Un = 1500 cm2/V.s
Eq. 1-11:
and pp =500cm’/Vs
= G(NUn + Pep) = (1.6 X 107)[(1.5 X 10" x 1500) + (1.5 x 10! x 500)] = 48 X 10-°(Q.cm)7!
From Eg. 1-10, R =1/(o a) = 0.1/(4.8 X 107° (Q.cm)~! x 107% cm’) = 20.8 MQ. (b) For doped material
Eq. 1-3:
p=nz?/n= (1.5 X 10)?/(8 x 10%) = 2.8 x 10°
Eq. 1-11:
o = q(Nn + Pp)
= (1.6 X 107!)[(8 x 10% x 1500) + (2.8 X 10° x 500)]
= 0.019 (Q.cm)7! From Eq. 1-10, R =1/(oa) = 0.1 cm/(0.019 Q/cm X 107 cm?) = 5.26 kD
20 Eledtronic Davices and’Gircuits
e Pr oblems
es
7
Iculate the free electron density i ina 1 mm cube of n-type silicon if its ssurcd resistance iis 35 Dei
1-6 THE pn-JUNCTION Junction of p-Type and n-Type Two blocks of semiconductor material are represented in Fig. 1-19: one block
is p-type material, and the other is n-type. The small circles in the p-type material represent holes, which are the major-
Electrons
Holes
ity charge carriers in p-type. The dots in the
n-type material represent the majority charge carrier free electrons within that material. Normally, the holes are uniformly distributed throughout the volume of the p-type semiconductor and the electrons are uniformly distribFigure 1-19 p-typeandn-type —_ uted in the n-type.
salable
lcama
Electrons cross from
haw-side to fill holes
In
Fig.
1-20,
p-type
and
re
‘
;
5
a pn-junction. Minority
ee
charge carriers
92085 0.
0
Oe Oo.
Or O° o 2
o
O
00
Layer of
negative
positive ions
ions
+
barrier
barrier voltage
voltage
Figure 1-20
ae
Junction
Junction =
h Majority Cc.
; Atapn-junction,
arge
carriers
The barrier Figure 1-21 voltage at a pn-junction
electrons cross from the
assists the flow of minority
on the p-side close to the
opposes the flow of majority
n-side to fill holes in a layer
junction.
semi-
conductor materials are shown side by side, representing
in the p-side
Fr
n-type
charge carriers and
charge carriers.
‘
Since
holes
and
Chapter 1
Basic Semiconductor and pn-Junction Theory
21
electrons are close together at the junction, some free electrons from the n-
side are attracted across the junction to fill adjacent holes on the p-side. They are said to diffuse across the junction from a region of high carrier concentration to one of low concentration. The free electrons crossing the
junction create negative ions on the p-side by giving some atoms one more electron than their total number of protons. The electrons also leave positive
ions (atoms with one fewer electron than the number of protons) behind them on the n-side.
Barrier Voltage The n-type and p-type materials are both electrically neutral before the charge carriers diffuse across the junction. When negative ions are created on the p-side, the portion of the p-side close to the junction acquires a negative voltage (Fig. 1-20). Similarly, the positive ions created on the n-side give the n-side a positive voltage close to the junction. The negative voltage on the p-side tends to repel additional electrons crossing from the n-side. Also (thinking of the holes as positive particles), the positive voltage on the n-side tends to repel any movement of holes from the p-side. So, the initial diffusion of charge carriers creates a barrier voltage at the junction, which is negative on the p-side and positive on the n-side. The transfer of charge carriers and the
resultant creation of the barrier voltage occur when the pn-junctions are formed during the manufacturing process (see Chapter 7). The magnitude of the barrier voltage at a pn-junction can be calculated from a knowledge of the doping densities, electronic charge, and junction temperature. Typical barrier voltages at 25°C are 0.3 V for germanium junctions and 0.7 V for silicon. It has been explained that the barrier voltage at the junction opposes both
the flow of electrons from the n-side and the flow of holes from the p-side. Because electrons are the majority charge carriers in the n-type material, and
holes are the majority charge carriers in the p-type, it is seen that the barrier voltage opposes the flow of majority carriers across the pn-junction (see Fig. 1-21). Any free electrons generated by thermal energy on the p-side of the junction are attracted across the positive barrier to the n-side. Similarly, thermally generated holes on the n-side are attracted to the p-side through the negative barrier presented to them at the junction. Electrons on the p-side and holes on the n-side are minority charge carriers. Therefore, the barrier voltage assists the
flow of minority carriers across the junction (Fig. 1-21).
Depletion Region The movement of charge carriers across the junction leaves a layer on each side that is depleted of charge carriers. This is the depletion region shown in
Fig. 1-22a. ‘On the n-side, the depletion region consists of donor impurity
atoms ‘that, having. lost ‘the free electron associated with them, have become
22
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Depletion region wider
Depletion region
p-type
n-type
"00 6 0le Oi
puis
lio
29
°
0
‘
Diyas of A negative ions
n-type
00,0" .0..6
Sle
0.0
Os: 9 9
p-type
1.0 On)
0'e, D Je a
on lightly doped side
9,0
006
40" 0.
OF
Layer of positive
Layer of i negative
ions
ions
Equal number of ions on each side
(a) Equal doping densities
ee
\ ayer of positive ions
Equal number of ions on each side
(b) Unequal doping densities
Figure 1-22 Charge carrier diffusion across a pn-junction creates a region that is depleted of charge carriers and that penetrates deepest into the more lightly doped side.
positively charged. The depletion region on the p-side is made up of acceptor impurity atoms that have become negatively charged by losing the hole associated with them. (The hole has been filled by an electron.)
On each side of the junction, equal numbers of impurity atoms are involved in the depletion region. If the two blocks of semiconductor material have equal doping densities, the depletion layers on each side have equal - widths (Fig. 1-22a). If the p-side is more heavily doped than the n-side, as illustrated in Fig. 1-22b, the depletion region penetrates more deeply into the n-side in order to include an equal number of impurity atoms on each side of the junction. Conversely, when the n-side is more heavily doped, the depletion region penetrates deeper into the p-type material. Summary e
A region depleted of charge carriers spreads across both pn-junction, penetrating farther into the less doped side.
sides
of a
¢ The depletion region contains an equal number of ionized atoms on opposite sides of the junction. e A barrier voltage is created by the charge carrier depletion effect, positive on the n-side and negative on the p-side. e
The barrier voltage opposes majority charge carrier flow and assists the
flow of minority charge carriers across the junction.
Section 1-6 Review
1-6.1 Sketch a pn-junction showing the depletion region. Briefly explain how "2 the depletion region is created. 1-6.2 Explain the origin of the barrier voltage at a pn-junction. Discuss the _ effect of the barrier voltage on minority and majority charge carriers.
Chapter 1
1-7
Basic Semiconductor and pn-Junction Theory
23
BIASED JUNCTIONS
Reverse-Biased Junction When an external bias voltage is applied to a pn-junction, positive to the n-side and negative to the p-side, electrons from the n-side are attracted to the positive terminal, and holes from the p-side are attracted to the negative terminal. As shown in Fig. 1-23, holes on the p-side of the junction are attracted away from the junction and electrons are attracted away from the junction on the n-side. This causes the depletion region to be widened and the barrier voltage to be increased, as illustrated. With the barrier voltage increase, there is no possibility of a majority charge carrier current flow across the junction, and the junction is said to be reverse biased. Because there is only a very small reverse current, a reverse-biased pn-junction can be said to have a high resistance. Reverse bias
c_ _
a Depletion region is widened by the
— +
reverse bias
ptype
te
0.
0.0.0. 920 10 “0. 6 aO Oa ale 0°20
_
—| _
Ons:
° oO
077°
so
OB
oO
Oo
02
°. OCO°
00
5
~rO
Le
O
Unbiased junction
barri rrier voltag' ltage
as
4.M4+
junetion baxtiee ; voltage is increased by
"
Reverse biased
junction barrier — voltage \ ~
NX
|
reverse bias
Figure 1-23 A reverse bias applied i toa pn -j junction i (positive iti on the n-side, negative on the p-side) causes the depletion
region to widen and increases
the barrier voltage. Only a very small reverse current flows across the junction.
Although there is no possibility that a majority charge carrier current can
flow across a reverse-biased junction, minority carriers generated on each side can still cross the junction. Electrons in the p-side are attracted across the junction to the positive voltage on the n-side. Holes on the n-side may flow
across to the negative voltage on the p-side. This is shown by the junction reverse characteristic, or the graph of reverse current (Ip) versus reverse voltage (Vp) (Fig. 1-24). Since only a very small reverse-bias voltage is
necessary to direct all available minority carriers across the junction, further increases in bias voltage do not increase the current level. This current is referred to as a reverse saturation current.
24
Electronic Devices and Circuits
VR (Vv)
-5 -4
-3 -2
0
-1
0 1 =2
IR
—3 —4
Figure 1-24
~
tic for a reverse-biased pn-junction.
(yA)
'
Forward bias
;
A
0
Depletion region is
+
p-type
barrier voltage Forward-biased
junction barrier
”
narrowed by the forward bias
Unbiased junction
Current-versus-voltage characteris-
n-type
Junction ‘unction
mt
Forward biasing a Figure 1-25 pn-junction (positive on the p-side, negative on the n-side) narrows
bart Darrier ed
aoe aoe bias Tplge by forward
voltage
.
.
depletion region, the R reduces the barrier voltage, and 7
causes a relatively large current to flow
across the junction.
» The reverse saturation current is normally a very small quantity, ranging from nanoamps to microamps, depending on the junction area, temperature,
and semiconductor material.
Forward-Biased Junction Consider the effect of an external bias voltage applied with the polarity shown in Fig. 1-25: positive on the p-side and negative on the n-side. The
holes on the p-side, being positively charged particles, are repelled from the positive terminal and driven toward the junction. Similarly, the electrons on
the n-side are repelled from the negative terminal toward the junction. The
result is that the width of the depletion region and the barrier potential are
both reduced. When the applied bias voltage is progressively increased from zero, the barrier voltage gets smaller until it effectively disappears and charge carriers easily flow across the junction. Electrons from the n-side are now attracted across to the positive bias terminal on the p-side, and holes from the p-side
Chapter 1
Basic Semiconductor and pn-Junction Theory
25
flow across to the negative terminal on the n-side (thinking of holes as positively charged particles). A majority carrier current flows, and the junction is said to be forward biased.
The graph in Fig. 1-26 shows the forward current (Ip) plotted against forward voltage (Vf) for typical germanium and silicon pn-junctions. In each
case, the graph is known as the forward characteristic of the junction. It is seen that there is very little forward current until Vp exceeds the junction barrier voltage (0.3 V for germanium, 0.7 V for silicon). When Vx is increased from zero toward the knee of the characteristic, the barrier voltage is progressively overcome, allowing more majority charge carriers to flow across the junction. Above the knee of the characteristic, Ip increases almost linearly with increase in Vp. The level of current that can be made to flow across a forward-
biased pn-junction largely depends on the area of the junction. (mA) 5 4 Ge
heh
Silicon
3
Ip
Figure 1-26 2 | y
1 0
0
O01
02
7
ance 03
forward characteristics. Germanium junctions are forward biased
|
4 a
04
| 05
pn-junction
at approximately 0.3 V. A
06
07
silicon junction requires
08
Ve
approximately 0.7 V for forward bias.
Junction Temperature Effects As already discussed,
the reverse
consists
charge
of
minority
saturation
carriers.
When
current
the
semiconductor material is raised, increasing numbers
(I,) at a pn-junction
temperature
of
the
of electrons break
away from their atoms. This generates additional minority charge carriers, causing I, to increase as the junction temperature rises. When I, is known for a given temperature (Tj), it can be calculated for another temperature level (T2) from the following equation: MS,
Seo
(1-12)
Example 1-4 demonstrates that I, approximately doubles for each 10°C rise in temperature (Fig. 1-27a).
Example 1-4 Determine the levels of reverse saturation current at temperatures of 35°C and 45°C for a junction which has I, = 30 nA at 25°C.
26
Electronic Devices and Circuits.
Solution Eq. 1-12:
ora) © Tory (272 ~ 7/10)
ol”. Aras":
Tease)
© 30 nA X (25
_
25)/10)
~ 60 nA oc. At 45°C:
Iyasic) © ' 30 nA X (245 ~= 25)/10) ~120nA
“5B -4
(Vv) >
Vr =38 =2
=1
mA
9
es
0 ont
IR at 25°C
-2
Tp at 35°C
Ip=3mA
Ip
| ais
p at 25°C
-4
Tp at 45°C
'
—5
(vA)
(a) Reverse current approximately doubles with each 10°C
0
01 02 03 04 05 06 0.7 08 V.
(V)
F
(b) Forward voltage-drop changes by approximately —2 mV/°C
temperature increase Figure 1-27
Junction reverse current and forward voltage drop are affected by tempera-
ture change.
The junction forward voltage drop (Vr) is also affected by temperature. The horizontal line (at 3 mA) on Fig. 1-27b shows that, if Iz is held constant
while the junction temperature is changing, the forward voltage decreases with rising junction temperature. This means that Vz has a negative temperature coefficient. It is found that the temperature coefficient for the forward voltage of a pn-junction is approximately —1.8 mV/°C for a silicon junction and —2.02 mV/°C for germanium. A figure of —-2 mV/°C is normally used as an approximation.
Summary ¢
A pn-junction is reverse-biased when a voltage is applied positive to the
n-side and negative to the p-side.
Chapter 1
Basic Semiconductor and pn-Junction Theory
27
e Areverse-biased junction has a wide depletion region. e
Avery small minority charge carrier current (Ip) flows across a reverse-bi-
e
ased junction. The junction reverse characteristic is the graph of I, versus Vp.
e
The reverse saturation current (Ij) tends to be constant regardless of the
reverse bias voltage (Va). e The reverse current approximately doubles with every 10°C rise in junction temperature.
¢ A pn-junction is forward-biased when a voltage is applied positive to the p-side and negative to the n-side. e A forward-biased junction has a narrow depletion region. e A majority charge carrier current (Ip) flows across a forward-biased junction. e
The junction forward characteristic is the graph of Ip versus Vr.
e
The forward current (Ip) depends on the level of forward bias voltage (Vp).
¢ Typical junction forward voltage drops are 0.3 V for germanium and 0.7 V for silicon. e The junction forward voltage drop changes by approximately —2 mV/°C as the junction temperature increases.
Section 1-7 Review 1-7.1 Sketch typical voltage/current characteristics for a forward-biased silicon pn-junction: Briefly explain. 1-7.2 Sketch typical voltage/current characteristics for a reverse-biased
pn-junction. Briefly explain. 1-7.3 Discuss the effects of temperature change on forward- and reversebiased pn-junctions.
Practice Problem 1-7.1
The reverse current for a semiconductor diode is measured as 25 nA at
25°C, and as 75 nA at a temperature T2. Calculate T».
1-8
JUNCTION CURRENTS AND VOLTAGES
Shockley Equation The equation relating pn-junction current and voltage levels is called the
Shockley equation. Ip =1, [evo /"Vr —1]
(1-13)
28
Electronic Devices and Circuits
where Ip is the junction current, I, is the reverse saturation current (see Sec-
tion 1-7), Vp is the junction voltage, and n is a constant which is usually taken
as 1 for germanium and 2 for silicon. Vr depends upon temperature “A
By
{
(1.4
(4-14)
where k is Boltzman's constant (1.38 X 10~*), T is absolute temperature, and
q is the electronic charge (1.6 x 10719). When T = 300 K (or 27°C), Eq. 1-14 gives Vr = 26mV
Junction Current The current level at a forward-biased junction can be calculated from Eq, 1-13 for a given applied voltage and temperature. A table of corresponding current and voltage levels could be determined for plotting the junction
forward characteristic. However, the characteristics will not be completely accurate because the Shockley equation does not allow for the resistance of the semiconductor material, and for the surface leakage current that adds to the ‘reverse saturation current. At a reverse-biased junction, the current always equals the reverse saturation current.
Example 1-5 A silicon pn-junction has a reverse saturation current of I, = 30 nA ata temperature of 300 K. Calculate the junction current when the applied voltage is (a) 0.7 V forward bias, (b) 10 V reverse bias. Solution
(a) Forward bias Vp/(n Vz) = 0.7 V/(2 X 26 mV) = 13.46 Ip = 4, [e"D/"Vr ~1]=30 nA
Eq. 4-13:
=21mA
(b) Reverse bias
Vp/(nV>z) = -10 V/(2 X 26 mV) =~192
= —30nA
[e346 - 1]
Chapter 1
Basic Semiconductor.and pn-Junction Theory
29
Junction Voltage Equation 1-13 can be rewritten to give an equation for the junction voltage for a given forward current. Here again it should be remembered that the equation is not completely accurate.
Vp=(@ Va) In Ub/Ie)
(1-15)
Example 1-6 For the silicon pn-junction in Ex. 1-5, calculate the junction forward-bias voltage required to produce a current of (a) 0.1 mA, (b) 10 mA. Solution (a) Ip=0.1mA Eg. 1-15:
Vp = (n V5) In (Ip/Io) = 2X 26mV X In (0.1 mA/30 nA) = 422 mV
(b) b=10mA Eq. 1-15:
Vp = (n Vz) In (Ip /Io)
= 2X26 mV X In(10 mA/30 nA) = 661 mV
‘Practice Problems -4-8.1 A silicon pn-junction has a reverse saturation current of 20 nA at 25°C - and 80 nAcat 45°C. Calculate the current at both temperatures when the
forward bias voltage is'0.69.V. - 4-8.2 Calculate the reverse saturation current for a silicon pn-junction which sc ‘passes a current of 15 mA at 27°C when the forward bias voltage is
680 mV. Review Questions . ‘Section 1-1 1-1
‘Describe'the atom, and draw a two-dimensional diagram to illustrate your de-
scription. Compare the atom to a planet with orbiting satellites. 1-2 1-3
Define nucleus, electron, electronic charge, proton, neutron, shell, positive ion, and negative ion. Sketch two-dimensional diagrams of silicon and germanium atoms. Describe
the valence shell of each atom.
30
Electronic Devices and Circuits
1-4
Explain atomic number
1-5
atomic weight for silicon. Explain what is meant by energy levels and energy bands. Sketch an energy
and atomic weight. State the atomic number
and
band diagram, and define conduction band, valence band, and forbidden gap.
Section 1-2 1-6
Draw a sketch to show the process of current flow by electron motion. Briefly
1-7
explain. Draw sketches to show the process of current flow by hole transfer. Which have greater mobility, electrons or holes? Explain why.
1-8
Define conventional current direction and direction of electron flow. State why
each is important.
Section 1-3 1-9
Name the three kinds of bonds that hold atoms together in a solid. What kind
of
bonding
might
be
found
in
(a) conductors,
(b)
insulators,
and
(c) semiconductors?
1-10
Draw sketches to illustrate metallic bonding and ionic bonding. Explain what
1-11
happens in each case. Draw a sketch to illustrate covalent bonding. Explain the bonding process.
1-12
Draw energy band diagrams for conductors, insulators, and semiconductors. Explain the reasons for the differences between the diagrams.
Section 1-4 1-13 Define acceptor doping, and draw a sketch to illustrate the process. Explain. 1-14 Define donor doping, and draw a sketch to illustrate the process. Explain. 1-15 State the names given to acceptor-doped material and donor-doped material. 1-16
Explain. What is meant by majority charge carriers and
minority
charge
carriers?
1-18
Which are majority carriers and why in (a) donor-doped material, and (b) acceptor-doped material? Explain what happens to resistance with increasing temperature in the case of (a) a conductor, (b) a semiconductor, and (c) a heavily doped semiconductor. What do you think would happen to the resistance of an insulator with increasing temperature? Why? Explain hole-electron pair generation and recombination.
1-19 1-20
Discuss the effects that light can produce on semiconductor materials. Define n-type material, p-type material, majority charge carriers, minority
1-17
charge
positive temperatiire resistance. dark and coefficient,
1-21
carriers,
coefficient,
negative
temperature
Discuss the relationship between the density of holes and electrons in doped and undoped semiconductor material.
Section 1-5 1-22
Draw a diagram to illustrate drift current in a semiconductor material. Briefly
explain.
Chapter 1
Basic Semiconductor and pn-Junction Theory
31
1-23
Draw a diagram to illustrate diffusion current in a semiconductor material.
1-24
Briefly explain. Define resistivity and conductivity.
Section 1-6 1-25
Using illustrations, explain how the depletion region and barrier voltage are produced ata pn-junction. List the characteristics of the depletion region.
1-26
Draw a sketch to show the depletion region and barrier voltage pn-junction with unequal doping of each side. Briefly explain.
at a
Section 1-7 1-27 Abias is applied toa pn-junction, positive to the p-side, negative to the n-side.
Show, by a series of sketches, the effect of this bias on depletion region width, barrier voltage, minority carriers, and majority carriers. Briefly explain the
effect in each case. 1-28 1-29
Repeat Question 1-27 for a bias applied negative to the p-side and positive to the n-side. Sketch the voltage/current characteristics for a pn-junction (a) with forward bias
and
(b) with
reverse bias. Show
how
temperature
change
affects
th:
characteristics.
1-30 1-31
State typical values of barrier voltage for silicon and germanium junctions. Discuss the resistances of forward-biased and reverse-biased pn-junctions. State typical reverse saturation current levels for pn-junctions. Explain the origin of reverse saturation current.
Section 1-8 1-32 1-33
Write the Shockley equation for junction current in terms of junction voltage and other quantities. Define each quantity in the equation. From the Shockley equation for junction current (for Question 1-32), derive the junction voltage equation.
Problems Section 1-4 1-1
Determine
1-2. 1-3.
0.6 X 10!5 donor atoms/cm? and 10'° acceptor atoms/cm‘. Repeat Problem 1-1 for germanium. A sample of silicon is doped with 3 X 10'° acceptor atoms/cm® and 4 X 10'5 donor atoms/cm’. Determine the density of free electrons and holes
1-4
the
density
of
free
electrons
in
silicon
when
doped
with
in the sample. Asilicon sample is to have a free electron density of 5 X 10'° per cm? and a much smaller hole density. Calculate the required doping density for electrons if the material is already doped with 10'° acceptor atoms per cm’.
92
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Section 1-5 1-5
The drift current velocity in a germanium sample is estimated as 12.9 cm/s, and the terminal voltage is 14.5 V, Calculate the length of the sample.
1-6
Determine the conductivity and resistance of a 3 mm cube of germanium, (a) when it is purely intrinsic, and (b) when it has a hole density of p = 5 x 10'4 / cm’,
1-7
A-sample of n-type silicon is 1.5 mm long with a cross-sectional area of 0.02 mm?. Determine the free electron density if its resistance is measured as 28 k{),
1-8
Calculate the resistance of a5 mm cube of silicon described in Problem 1-1.
1-9
Determine the resistivity of the silicon described in Problem 1-3.
Section 1-7 1-10
The reverse saturation current (I,) for a pn-junction is 25 nA at 25°C. Calculate I, at temperatures of 30°C, 33°C, and 37°C,
1-11
The level of I, for a pn-junction is measured as 60 nA at 30°C. Calculate I, at
1-12
ao hs A pn-junction has I, = 35 nA at 25°C. Determine the junction temperature that will produce I, = 55 nA.
Section 1-8 1-13
1-14 1-15 1-16
A forward-biased silicon junction has its current held constant at 33 mA. Calculate the junction voltage at 25°C and 50°C if the reverse saturation current is 50 nA at 25°C. Calculate the forward current for a silicon pn-junction which has 0.65 V forward bias. The reverse saturation current is 100 nA at 25°C. Determine the voltage change required to double the forward current for the junction in Problem 1-14. Repeat Problem 1-14 for a silicon junction with 0.29 V forward bias.
Practice Problem Answers 1-41
0.7 X
10!4,3.2 x 10°
1-4.2 15.1
3.93 X 105, 1.59 x 10% 12x10"
1-7.1
40.85°C
1-8.1
13.2 mA, 23.7 mA
CHAPTER 2 Semiconductor
Diodes
Objectives You will be able to: 1 Sketch a diode circuit symbol, identify the terminals, and discuss diode circuit behavior. 2 Explain diode forward and reverse characteristics. 3 List important diode parameters and determine parameter values from the characteristics. 4 Sketch approximate diode characteristics and dc equivalent circuits, and apply them to circuit analysis.
7 Sketch diode ac equivalent circuits and calculate junction capacitance and switching times. 8 Determine diode parameter values from device data sheets. 9 Test diodes, and plot the forward and reverse characteristics. 10 Sketch a Zener diode circuit symbol, identify the terminals, and explain the characteristics. 11 Determine Zener diode parameter values from device
5 Draw dc load lines on diode
characteristics and from data
characteristics to precisely analyze diode circuits. 6 Determine maximum diode
sheets. 12 Analyze basic Zener diode circuits.
power dissipations and forward voltages at various temperatures.
INTRODUCTION The term diode refers to a two-electrode, or two-terminal, device. A semiconductor diode is simply a pn-junction with a connecting lead on each
side. A diode is a one-way device, offering a low resistance when forward-biased, and behaving almost as an open switch when reverse-biased. An approximately constant voltage drop occurs across a forward-biased diode, and this
simplifies diode circuit analysis. Diode forward and reverse characteristics are graphs of corresponding current and voltage levels. For precise circuit
analysis, dc load lines are drawn on the diode forward characteristic. Some diodes are low-current devices for use in switching circuits. Highcurrent diodes are most often used as rectifiers for ac to dc conversion. Zener
34
Electronic Devices and Circuits
diodes are operated in reverse breakdown because they have a very stable
breakdown voltage.
2-1 pn-JUNCTION DIODE As explained in Sections 1-5 and 1-6, a pn-junction permits substantial current flow when forward biased, and blocks current when reverse-biased, Thus, it can be used as a switch: on when forward-biased and off when biased in reverse. A pn-junction provided with copper wire connecting leads
becomes an electronic device known as a diode (see Fig. 2-1).
The circuit symbol (or graphic symbol) for a
diode is an arrowhead and bar (Fig. 2-2). The
ptype
arrowhead indicates the conventional direction of current flow when the diode is forward-biased (from the positive terminal through the device to the negative terminal). The p-side of the diode is always the positive
!
n-type
§ —— \
_—_—_ Ve
Conductor Figure 2-1 A semiconductor
terminal for forward bias and is termed the ; ‘ anode. The n-side, called the cathode, is the
a is a pn-junction with the junction for connecting
negative terminal when the device is forward-
the device to a circuit.
conductors on each side of
biased.
A pn-junction diode can be destroyed if a high level of forward current overheats the device. It can also be destroyed if a large reverse voltage causes
the junction to break down. The maximum forward current and reverse voltage for diodes are specified on the manufacturer’s data sheets (see Section 2-
7). In general, physically large diodes pass the largest currents and survive the largest reverse voltages. Small diodes are limited to low current levels and low reverse voltages. Figure 2-3 shows
the appearance
of low-, medium-,
and
high-current
diodes. Since the body of the low-current device in Fig. 2-3a may be only 0.3 cm long, the cathode is usually identified by a coloured band. This type of Positive terminal
for forward bias
Ip ee
N
Anode
(p-type)
Negative terminal
for forward bias
|
fe
Cathode
(n-type) Arrowhead indicates conventional current direction
Figure 2-2
Diode circuit symbol. Current flows in the arrowhead direction when the diode
is forward-biased: positive (+) on the anode and negative (—) on the cathode.
Chapter 2
Cathode | lant (a) Low-current diode
35
diode is usually capable of passing a maximum forward current of approximately 100 mA. It can also survive about 75 V reverse bias without breaking
Cathode
Semiconductor Diodes
down,
and
its reverse
cur-
rent is usually less than 1 wA at 25°C.
The medium-current diode shown in Fig. 23b can usually pass a forward current of about (b) Medium-current diode
Cathode J
(c) High-current diode
Figure 2-3 The size and appecsamsotetinda depen upon the level of forward current that the device is
designed to pass.
400 mA and survive over 200 V reverse bias.
The anode and cathode terminals may be indicated by a diode symbol on the side of the device.
Low-current and medium-current diodes are usually mounted by soldering the connecting leads to terminals. Power dissipated in the device is then carried away by air convection aad by heat conduction along the connecting5 leads.
High-current
diodes,
or power
diodes
(see
Fig. 2-3c), generate a lot of heat. So air convec-
tion would be completely inadequate. Such devices are designed to be connected mechanically to a metal heat sink. Power diodes can pass forward currents of many amperes and can survive several hundred volts of reverse bias.
2-2 CHARACTERISTICS AND PARAMETERS Forward and Reverse Characteristics The semiconductor diode is essentially a pn-junction, and its characteristics
are those discussed in Chapter 1. Figures 2-4 and 2-5 show typical forward
and reverse characteristics for low-current silicon and germanium diodes. From the silicon diode characteristics in Fig. 2-4, it is seen that the forward current (Ip) remains very low (less than 100 A) until the diode forward-bias
voltage (Vp) exceeds approximately 0.7 V. At Vr levels greater than 0.7 VTr increases almost linearly. Because the diode reverse current (Ip) is very much smaller than its for-
ward current, the reverse characteristics are plotted with expanded current scales. For a silicon diode, Ip is normally less than 100 nA, and it is almost
completely independent of the reverse-bias voltage. As already explained in Chapter 1, Ip is largely a minority charge carrier reverse saturation current. A small increase in Ip can occur with increasing reverse-bias voltage, as a result
of minority charge carriers leaking along the junction surface. For a diode
with the characteristics in Fig. 2-4, the reverse current is usually less than
36
Electnonic'Devices and Cirauits
(mA)
(nA) Figure 2-4 Typical forward and reverse characteristics for a silicon diode. There is a sub‘stantial forward current (I-) when the forward voltage (Vr) exceeds approximately 0.7 V.
LOW
|
Qn.
Reverse breakdown!
I .
voltage
~ +.
saad xe
!
iV)
F
—50
j
AD
VR
he
'
AS
+
(V) 02
03
O04
2
y
0.1
;
F
1A £0
1
4: LW
(A) ‘Figure 2-5
‘Typical forward and reverse characteristics
fora germanium diode. Substantial forward current (Ir)
“flows when ‘the ‘forward voltage (V-) exceeds approxi‘mately: 0.3 V.
11/10.000 of ‘the ‘lowest normal forward current level. Therefore, Ip is quite negligible‘when compared to Jp, and a reverse-biased diode may be treated almost.as:an open switch. This is investigated further in Ex. '2-1.
Chapter2
Semiconductor Diodes
37
Example 2-1 Calculate the forward and reverse resistances offered by a silicon diode with
the characteristics in Fig. 2.4 at Ip = 100 mA and at Vp = 50 V. Solution
At Ip = 100 mA, Vp ¥ 0.75 V
0.75V Rs Ve = —P= 7 viens , Pee =750, At Vg = 50V, Ip*100nA Ve = 50V Rp= R= 7 = Goona (See = 500 MO
Fig. 2-6 Bee)
Fig.Fig: 2-6b 2-60)
When the diode reverse voltage (Vg) is sufficiently increased, the device goes into reverse breakdown. For the characteristics shown in Fig. 2-4, this “ : occurs where Vp = 75 V. Reverse breakdown can S Rp= iz
ly
Ky ~
(a) Forward resistance I
x’ }y n|
_f
_ Vp
down is usefully applied in Zener diodes, which are introduced in Section 2-9. The characteristics of a germanium diode
R''Tgp
are similar to those of a silicon diode but with
Se ®
(b) Reverse resistance
Clos
destroy a diode unless the current is limited by a suitable series-connected resistor. Reverse break-
lone
reverse resistance.
a
some important differences (see Fig. 2-5). The forward voltage drop of a germanium diode is typically 0.3 V, compared to 0.7 V for silicon. For a germanium device, the reverse saturation current
at 25°C may be about 1 wA, which is much larger than the reverse current for a silicon diode. Finally, the reverse breakdown voltage for germanium devices is likely to be
substantially lower than that for silicon devices. The lower forward voltage drop for germanium diodes can be a distinct
advantage. However, the lower reverse current and higher reverse breakdown voltage of silicon diodes make them preferable to germanium devices for most applications.
Diode Parameters The diode parameters of greatest interest are
Ve
forward voltage drop
38
Electronic Devices and Circuits
te
reverse saturation current
VBR
ff
reverse breakdown voltage
ta
Tpmax)
dynamic resistance Maximum forward current
The values of these parameters are normally listed on the diode data sheet provided by device manufacturers (see Section 2-7). Some of the parameters can also be deter-
mined directly from the diodé characteristics.
For the silicon diode characteristics in Fig . 2-4,
|
Ve ~ 0.7 V, IR = 100 nA, and Vp = 75 r V.
The forward resistance calculated in Ex. 2-1
=—= Figure 2-7
Determination of
is a static quantity. It is the constant resistance
Se
(or dc resistance) of the diode at a particular constant forward current. The dynamic resistance of the diode is the resistance offered to
shesanesistles
uEaaneaaee |
changing levels of forward voltage. The dynamic resistance, also known as the
incremental resistance or ac resistance, is the reciprocal of the slope of the forward characteristics beyond the knee. Referring to Figs 2-4 and 2-7,
| _ Avs
Be
ohh
(2-1)
:
The dynamic resistance can also be calculated from the rule-of-thumb equation
t
a 26 mV
Ip
(2-2)
where If is the de forward current. Thus, for example, the dynamic resistance
for a diode passing a 1 mA forward current is rg = 26 mV/1 mA = 26 0. Equation 2-2 shows that the diode dynamic resistance changes with the level of dc forward current. Since this is not shown in Figs 2-4 and 2-5, the
characteristics are approximations of the actual device characteristics. It should also be noted that Eq. 2-2 gives the ac resistance only for the junction. It does not include the dc resistance of the semiconductor material, which
might be as large as 2 depending on the design of the device. The resistance derived from the slope of the device characteristic does include the semiconductor dc resistance. So rq (from the characteristic) should be slightly larger than rj calculated from Eq. 2-2.
Chapter 2
Semiconductor Diodes
39
Example 2-2 Determine the dynamic resistance at a forward current of 70 mA for the diode characteristics given in Fig. 2-4. Using Eq. 2-2, estimate the diode dynamic resistance. Solution In Fig. 2-4 at Ip = 70 mA, Alp=60mA Ea. q 2-1:
rg =
AVE A i.
and _
AV,#0.025 V
0.025 V 60 mA
oD.2-7) (see Fig.
= 0.42 0, Eq. 2-2:
#4 = 26 mV
_ 26 mV
Ip
70mA
= 0.37 0,
Practice Problems 2-2.1 Calculate the resistances offered by a diode with the characteristics in Fig. 2.5 at 30 V reverse bias and at 60 mA of forward current. 2-2.2 Determine the dynamic resistance at a 50 mA forward current for a
diode with the characteristics in Fig. 2-5. Use Eq. 2-2 to estimate the
_ diode dynamic resistance. 2-3
DIODE APPROXIMATIONS
Ideal Diodes and Practical Diodes As already explained, a diode is essentially a one-way device, offering a low resistance
when
forward-biased
and
a high
resistance
when
biased
in
reverse. An ideal diode (or perfect diode) would have zero forward resistance and zero forward voltage drop. It would also have an infinitely high reverse resistance, which would result in zero reverse current. Figure 2-8a shows the current/voltage characteristics of an ideal diode. Although an ideal diode does not exist, there are many applications where diodes can be assumed to be near-ideal devices. In circuits with supply voltages much larger than the diode forward voltage drop, Vr can be assumed to be constant without introducing any serious error. Also, the diode reverse
current is normally so much smaller than the forward current that the reverse current
can
be
ignored.
These
assumptions
lead
to the
approximate, characteristics for silicon and germanium
near-ideal,
or
diodes shown in
Figs 2-8b and c. Example 2-3 investigates a situation where the diode Vs is
assumed to be constant.
40
Electronic Devices and Circuits
~t
Ver
Vr ml
ty
a
Var
Vr
0.7V
Ik
0.4V
Ip
Ip
R
fee fener
KR
le
t
Ve>
,
Vr
{
t
(a) Ideal diode characteristics _ (b) Germanium diode approximate characteristics
_(c) Silicon diode approximate characteristics
be treated as 2-8 An ideal diode has V; = 0 and Ip = 0. Practical diodes can Figure near-ideal devices if the forward voltage drop is taken into account.
Example 2-3 A silicon diode is used in the circuit shown in Fig. 2-9. Calculate the diode current. Solution E=
Ig Ry
+
Vr
E-Vp
15V-O07V
Ry
4.7kO,
E
=
V7
= 3.04mA
Figure 2-9
Circuit for Ex. 2-3.
Piecewise Linear Characteristic When the forward characteristic of a diode is not
(mA)
available, a straight-line approximation called
the piecewise linear characteristic may be em-
7%”
ployed. To construct the piecewise linear characteristic, Vp is first marked on the horiz-
160
ontal axis, as shown in Fig. 2-10. Then, from Vz,a_
straight line is drawn with a slope equal to the
diode
dynamic
resistance.
Example
2-4
{1 dynamic a silicon diode which has a 0.25 i
current.
|
Ir |
y 40
Al
|
02
04
wy
0.6 08
Ve
Construct the piecewise linear characteristic for resistance
tq
0
Example 2-4 Bina
~fB +H
0
demonstrates the process.
x
(Vg + AVR)
pF
a
and
a 200 mA
maximum ;
forward
Figure 2-10
Diode piece-
aa ee a
r straight-line approxima-
tion of the diode forward characteristic.
Chapter2
Semiconductor Diodes
41
Solution
Plot point A on the horizontal axis at Ve =0.7V
(see Fig. 2-10)
AVz = Alp X rg = 200 mA X 0.25 0 = 0.05 V Plot point B (on Fig. 2-10) at
Ip=200mA
and
Vp = (0.7V + 0.05 V)
Draw the characteristic through points A and B.
DC Equivalent Circuits An equivalent circuit for a device is a circuit that represents the device behavior. Usually, the equivalent circuit is made up of anumber of components, such as resistors and voltage cells. A diode equivalent circuit may be substituted for the device when VE investigating a circuit containing the diode. — —— Equivalent circuits may also be used as device (a) Basic de equivalent circuit models for computer analysis. In Ex. 2-3, a forward-biased diode is assumed . oy Meal
to have a constant forward voltage drop (Vr) and
a
fe
a
negligible series resistance. In this case the diode
equivalent circuit is assumed to be a voltage cell with a voltage Vx (see Fig. 2-11a). This simple dc equivalent circuit is quite suitable for a great .
oer
(6) Complete de equivalent _— Figure 2-11
DC equivalent
circuits for a junction diode.
many diode applications. . A more accurate equivalent circuit includes the diode dynamic resistance (ra) in series with the voltage cell, as shown in Fig. 2-11b. This takes account of the small variations in Vp that occur with change in forward current. An ideal
diode is also included to show that current flows only in one direction. The equivalent circuit without rg assumes that the diode has the approximate characteristics illustrated in Fig. 2-8b or c. With rg included, the equivalent circuit represents a diode with the type of piecewise linear characteristic shown in Fig. 2-10. Consequently, the circuit in Fig. 2-11b is termed the piecewise linear equivalent circuit.
Example 2-5 Calculate Ip for the diode circuit in Fig. 2-12a assuming that the diode has Vg = 0.7 V and rg = 0. Then recalculate the current taking rq = 0.25 ©.
42
Electronic Devices and Circuits
.
Solution
Substituting Vy as the diode equivalent circuit (Fig. 2-12b), Ip
_E-Vp_15V-07V 100
Ry = 80mA
Substituting Vp and rq as the diode equivalent circuit (Fig. 2-12c), Ip
_E-Vp_ Ri +7rg
15V-07V 1092+0.250
= 78 mA
Ry E
i
100
Ve (a) Diode circuit Figure 2-12
7
(b) Diode replaced with voltage cell
(c) Diode replaced with r, and V;
Diode circuits for Ex. 2-5.
1 nected silicon diodes. aum forward current of 100 mA anda
ent when the diode in Problem 2-3.2 is forwith a 15Q resistor and a 3 V battery.
2-4 DC LOAD LINE ANALYSIS DC Load Line Figure 2-13a shows a diode in series with a 100 © resistor (R;) and a supply
voltage (E). The polarity of E is such that the diode is forward-biased, so that there is a diode forward current (Ip). As already discussed, the circuit current can be determined approximately by assuming a constant diode
forward voltage drop (Vg). When the precise levels of the diode current and voltage must be calculated, graphical analysis (also termed dc load line analysis) is employed.
Chapter 2
Semiconductor Diodes
43
(mA)
50N%e 40
Q
30
DC toadjtine =}
Ip
Y 20
NO
—
+— Diode 10
0
|
characteristic
lA 0
1
2)
3
4
5
6
E> (V)
Ve (a) Diode-resistor series circuit
(b) Plotting the dc load line on the
diode characteristics Figure 2-13
Drawing a dc load line on the diode characteristic.
For graphical analysis, a dc load line is drawn on the diode forward characteristics (Fig. 2-13b). This is a straight line that illustrates all dc conditions that could exist within the circuit. Because the load line is always straight, it
can be constructed by plotting any two corresponding current and voltage points and then drawing a straight line through them. To determine two points on the load line, an equation relating voltage, current, and resistance
is first derived for the circuit. From Fig. 2-13a,
E=
(Ip R)
a
Ve
(2-3)
Any two convenient levels of Ip can be substituted into Eq. 2-3 to calculate corresponding Vy levels, or vice versa. As demonstrated in Ex. 2-6, it is convenient to calculate Vp when Ip = 0, and to determine Ig when Vz = 0.
Example 2-6 Draw the dc load line for the circuit in Fig. 2-13a on the diode forward char-
acteristic given in Fig. 2-13b. Solution Substitute Ip = 0 into Eq. 2-3, E or
Ve
=
(Ip Ri)
+
Vp
=
=E=5V
Plot point A on the diode characteristic at Ip =O and
Vp
=
5 V
04+
Ve
44
Electronic Devices and Circuits;
Now substitute Vp = 0 into Eq. 2-3,
E = (Ip Ry) +0 vin
BIVINS
be EH = 2
FR
1000
= 50 mA
Plot point B on the diode characteristic at Ip = 50 mA and
Vz = 0
Draw the dc load line through points A and B.
Q-Point The relationship between the diode forward voltage and current in the circuit in Fig. 2-13a is defined by the device characteristic. Consequently,
there is only one point on the dc load line where the diode voltage and current are compatible with the circuit conditions. That is point Q, termed the quiescent point or dc bias point, where the load line intersects the characteristic. This may be checked by substituting the levels of Ip and Vf at point Q into Eq. 2-3. From the Q point on Fig. 2-13b, Ip = 40 mA and Vx = 1 V. Equation 2-3
states that E = (Ip Ri) + Vz. Therefore, E =(40mA X 1009) +1V
=5v So, with E = 5 V and R, = 100 0, the only levels of Ip and Vx that can satisfy
Eq. 2-3 on the diode characteristics in Fig. 2-13b are 40 mA and 1 V. Note that, although 0 and 5 V were used for Vp when the dc load line was drawn in Ex. 2-6, no functioning semiconductor diode would have a 5 V forward voltage drop. This is simply a convenient theoretical level for
plotting the dc load line.
Calculating Load Resistance and Supply Voltage Ina diode series circuit (see Fig. 2-14a), resistor R; dictates the slope of the dc load line, and supply voltage E determines point A on the load line. So the circuit conditions can be altered by changing either Rj or E. When designing a diode circuit, it may be necessary to use a given supply
voltage and set up a specified forward current. In this case, points A and Q are first plotted and the load line is drawn. Resistor R; is then calculated from the slope of the load line. The problem could also occur in another way. For example, R; and the required Ip ate known, and the supply voltage is to be
Chapter 2
Semiconductor Diodes
45
(mA) 4 Ba
|
40 30
Q
Ik
DC lpad line NZ
AZ ‘i
E
20
10
70
NN
1
2
3
Na 4 5
Wy) 6
Ve (a) Diode-resistor circuit Figure 2-14
(b) Resistor determination
Determination of the required circuit series resistance R; from the slope of the
dc load line.
determined. This problem is solved by plotting point Q and drawing the load line with slope 1/R;. The supply voltage is then read at point A.
Example 2-7 Using the device characteristics in Fig. 2-14b, determine the required load resistance for the circuit in Fig. 2-14a to give Ip = 30 mA. Solution
From Eq. 2-3, Substituting
Vp = E — (Ip Ri) Ip = 0,
Vr =E-0=5V
Plot point A on the diode characteristic in Fig. 2-14b at
Ip=OandVp=5V Now plot point Q in Fig. 2-14b at Ip = 30mA Draw the dc load line through points A and Q. From the load line,
AV,
5V
R,= = —_—_ ‘Alp 37.55mA = 133 0
46
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Example 2-8 Determine a new supply voltage for the circuit in Fig. 2-14a to give a 50 ma diode forward current when R; = 100 0.
Solution
Plot point Q on the diode characteristic in Fig. 2-15 at Ip = 50 mA From the characteristic, read
VR=11V From Eq. 2-3,
Ve =E-—
(Ig Rj)
When Ir changes from 50 mA to 0, Alp = 50 mA and
(see Fig. 2-15)
AVz = Ip Ry = 50 mA X 100 0
(see Fig. 2-15)
=5V The new supply voltage is E=Vpet+AVp=11V+5V =6.1V Point A may now be plotted (on Fig. 2-15) at Ip = 0 and E = 6.1 V, and the
new dc load line may be drawn through points A and Q. (mA) 60 50+—6IN
AVE
40
\
te 30
DQ load line
AS
Alp
20
S
10
0
"
0
i
J
2
3
4
Nu. 5
6
(Vv)
11V
Determination of the required supply voltage for a diode-resistor circuit with Figure 2-15 a given resistor and a specified load current.
Chapter 2
Semiconductor Diodes
47
7%
2-5 TEMPERATURE
EFFECTS
Diode Power Dissipation The power dissipation in a diode is simply calculated as the device terminal voltage multiplied by the current level: P= Ve Tp
(2-4)
Device manufacturers specify a maximum power dissipation for each type of diode. If the specified level is exceeded, the device will overheat and may
short-circuit or open-circuit. The maximum power that may be dissipated in a diode (or any other electronic device) is normally specified for an ambient temperature of 25°C or, sometimes, for a 25°C case temperature. When the
temperature exceeds this level, the device maximum power dissipation must be derated. Figure 2-16 shows the type of power-versus-temperature graph provided
on device data sheets. The maximum power dissipation for any temperature (mW)
1004
“
-
80
—
60 P
,
AP
erating factor|= >>
AT
“NY
AP.
PS
40
~ T
20
0
(°C) 0
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
80
90
100
T Figure 2-16 A power-versus-temperature graph shows how the maximum power dissipation of a device must be derated with
increasing temperature.
48
Electronic Devices and Circuits
is simply read from the graph; then the maximum forward current level is calculated from Eq. 2-4. Instead of a power-versus-temperature graph, some rectifier diode data sheet have a current-versus-temperature graph, which directly gives the maximum forward current at any temperature in the range
of operation. As an alternative to power or current graphs, a derating factor is often listed on device data sheets. The derating factor defines the slope of the power.
versus-temperature graph (see Fig. 2-16); it can be employed to draw the graph or used directly without reference to the graph. The equation for the maximum power dissipation when the temperature changes involves the specified power at the specified temperature (P; at T;), the derating factor (D), and the temperature change (AT). P5
—
(P; at T1)
=
(D
x
AT)
(2-5)
Example 2-9 A diode with 700 mW maximum power dissipation at 25°C has a5 mW/°C derating factor. If the forward voltage drop remains constant at 0.7 V, calculate the maximum forward current at 25°C and at 65°C. Solution At 25°C: From Eq. 2-4,
Ip = >.
F
= a
E
=1A At 65°C: Pz = (P; at T;) — (D X AT)
Kgq. 2-5:
= 700 mW — [5mW/°C &X (65°C — 25°C)] = 500 mW From Eq. 2-4,
I, = BD VY
“a 0.7 V
= 714mA
Forward Voltage Drop Sometimes
it is important to know
the precise level of a diode
forward
voltage drop. In these cases, the graphical analysis techniques discussed it Section 2-4 can be used. However, as explained in Section 1-6 and illustrated
Chapter 2
Semiconductor Diodes
49
(mW) 100
|
jor
60 .
40
|
20 0
/ a 0
04
05
06
ie 07
Figure 2-17
The forward voltage drop
i across a diode decreases b by approx i-
O8
mately 2 mV/°C as the device temperature VE
increases.
in Fig. 2-17, the voltage drop across a forward-biased pn-junction changes with temperature by approximately —1.8 mV/°C for a silicon device and by —2.02 mV/°C for germanium. A diode forward voltage drop at any temperature
can
be
calculated
from
a knowledge
temperature (Vp, at T;,), the temperature voltage /temperature coefficient (AVp/°C).
of
change
Vp
at the
(AT),
| Vin= (Varat Ti) + [AT (AVe/°O)]
starting
and
the
(2-6)
Dynamic Resistance Equation 2-2 for calculating the dynamic resistance of a forward-biased diode is correct only for a junction temperature of 25°C. For higher or lower temperatures, the equation must be modified to
26 mV (4 + a
OS
ke
298°C
(2-7)
where T is the junction temperature in degrees Celsius.
Example 2-10 A silicon diode with a 0.7 V forward voltage drop at 25°C is to be operated with a constant forward current up to a temperature of 100°C. Calculate the diode Vp at 100°C. Also, determine the junction dynamic resistance at 25°C
and at 100°C if the forward current is 26 mA. Solution
Eq. 2-6:
Veo = (V1 at Ti) + [AT (AVg/°C)] = 0.7 V + [(100°C — 25°C)(-1.8 mV/°C)] = 0.565 V (at 100°C)
50
Electronic Devices and Circuits
At 25°C: Eq. q 2-7:
26 mV [T + 273°C _——_— a ie | 298°C |
typo R
WW
a
Vet A
—_—*
Ww
o—
-___}
—
If VN
Con
Cy
(a) Equivalent circuit for
Ca
(b) Equivalent circuit for
a reverse-biased diode
Figure 2-19
-—
|}
(c) AC equivalent circuit for
a forward-biased diode
a forward-biased diode
Equivalent circuits (or models) for reverse-biased and forward-biased diodes,
Reverse Recovery Time
In many applications, diodes must switch rapidly between forward and reverse bias. Most diodes switch very quickly into the forward-biased condition, however, there is a longer turnoff time owing to the junction diffusion capacitance. Vr
| Forward bias
Vp
Reverse
Ve
Forward
bias
bias Ve
Ik
Reverse bias
; ~> t,,.
Figure 2-20 illustrates the effect of a voltage pulse on the diode forward current. When the pulse switches from positive to negative, the diode conducts.in reverse instead of switching off sharply (see Fig. 2-20a). The reverse current (Ig) initially equals the forward current (Ig); then it gradually decreases toward zero. The high level of reverse current occurs because at the instant
of reverse
bias
there
are
charge
carriers
crossing
the
junction
depletion region, and these must be removed. (This is the same effect that produces diffusion capacitance.) The reverse recovery time (t,,) is the time required for the current to decrease to the reverse saturation current level.
Chapter 2
Semiconductor Diodes
53
Typical values of f,, for switching diodes range from 4 ns to 50 ns. The diode
reverse current can be kept to a minimum if the fall time (t,) of the applied voltage pulse is much larger than the diode reverse recovery time. This is illustrated in Fig. 2-20b. Typically Emin) =
10 ib
(2-9)
Example 2-12 Calculate the minimum fall times for voltage pulses applied to a circuit using 1N915 and 1N917 diodes to keep the diode reverse current to a minimum. Solution From diode data sheets,
tr = 10ns for the 1N915
and
t, =3ns for the 1N917
For the 1N915:
Eq..2-9:
ttomin) = 10 trr = 10 X 10 ns = 100 ns
For the 1N917: Rq. 2-9:
tmin) = 10 ty = 10 X 3 ns
= 30 ns
Practice Problems
:
-2-6.1 Determine the maximum reverse recovery time for satisfactory operation of a diode with an applied voltage pulse which has a 0.5 ys fall time:
2-6.2
Estimate a suitable minimum fall time for a pulse which switches a diode from on to off if the reverse recovery time of the diode is 15 ns. 2-6.3. Determine the charge carrier, transit time for a silicon diode which has a capacitance of 11 nF when the forward current is Ip = 50 mA.
2-7
DIODE SPECIFICATIONS
Diode Data Sheets
To select a suitable diode for a particular application, the data sheets, or specifications, provided by device manufacturers must be consulted. Portions of typical diode data sheets are shown in Fig. 2-21 and as data sheets 1 to 3 in Appen-
dix A.
54
Electronic Devices and Circuits oy
Type 1N914 Through 1N917 Silicon Switching Diodes 0.085
| Mechanical ee
0.042
T|r 0165”! 0.220 dimensions in inches
1N916 | 1N917 |
Vp__ I,
Reverse voltage Average rectified forward current
Term
P
Unit
75
50 75
75 75
30 50
Vv mA
Repetitive peak forward current
225
225
225
150
mA
Power dissipation
250
250
250
250
mW
Figure 2-21
Part of data sheet for type 1N914 to 1N917 diodes.
Most data sheets start with the device type number at the top of the page, such as ‘1N914 through 1N917’ or ‘1N5391 through 1N5399’. The 1 (one) in the type number signifies a one-junction device: a diode. This is followed by a short descriptive title, for example, silicon switching diode or silicon rectifier. Mechanical data are also given, usually in the form of an illustration showing the shape and dimensions of the package. The maximum ratings at 25°C are then listed (see Fig. 2-21). The maximum ratings are the maximum voltages, currents, and so on, that
can be applied without destroying the device. It is very important that these ratings not be exceeded; otherwise the diode is quite likely to fail. For reliability, the
maximum ratings should not even be approached. If a diode is to survive a 50 V reverse bias, a device that has a 75 V peak reverse voltage should be selected. Ifthe diode peak forward current is to be 100 mA, a device that can handle 150 mA should be used. It is also important to note that the maximum ratings must be adjusted downward for operation at temperatures greater than 25°C (see Sec-
tion 2-5). A list of other electrical characteristics for the device normally follows the maximum ratings. An understanding of all the parameters specified on a data
sheet will not be achieved
until the data
sheets
have
been
consulted
frequently. However, some of the most important parameters are considered
below. Vror Verm
Peak reverse voltage (also termed peak inverse voltage and dc blocking voltage). This is the maximum reverse voltage that
may be applied across the diode.
Chapter 2
I, or Ip(avy)
Semiconductor Diodes
55
Steady-state forward current. The maximum current that may be
passed continuously through the diode. Igsm
Non-repetitive peak surge current. This current may be passed
for a specified time. The non-repetitive surge current is very much higher than the normal maximum forward current. It is a current that may be allowed to flow briefly when a circuit is first switched on. IgRmM
Ve
Repetitive peak surge current. Peak current that may be repeated over and over again, for example, during each cycle of a recti-
fied waveform. Static forward voltage drop. The maximum forward volt drop for a given forward current and device temperature.
P
Continuous power dissipation at 25°C. The maximum power that the device can safely dissipate continuously in free air. This rating must be downgraded at higher temperatures (see Section 2-5).
Low-Power Diodes The data sheet portion in Fig. 2-21 identifies the 1N914 to 1N917 devices as switching diodes. The average rectified forward current is listed as 75 mA (except for the 1N917). Maximum reverse voltage ranges from 30 V to 75 V. Thus, these diodes are intended for relatively low-current, low-voltage applications, in which they may be required to switch rapidly between on and off states.
Rectifier Diodes The low-power rectifier data sheets (see Appendix A, data sheets A-2 and A-3)
show that the 1N4000 range of rectifiers can pass an average forward current of 1 A, and that the 1N5390 range can pass 1.5 A. Both types have maximum reverse voltages ranging from 50 V to 1000 V. Unlike data sheet A-1, for switching diodes, the rectifier data sheet does not list the reverse recovery
time. Rectifier diodes are generally intended for low-frequency applications
(60 Hz to perhaps 400 Hz) in which switching time is not important. Example 2-13 Referring to Fig. 2-21, determine the following quantities for a 1N915 diode: peak reverse voltage, steady-state forward current, peak repetitive forward
current and power dissipation. Solution For the 1N915: PIV = Ve =50V IlL=75mA
56
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Igrm = 225 mA
P =250 mW
tice’Problems’
. | Referring, to Appendix A, ae
for a 1N5397
2-8 DIODE TESTING
Ohmmeter Tests Diode failure is usually the result of passing excessive forward current through the device, or application of excessive reverse voltage. Both situations can result in devices that offer either an open circuit or a short circuit. Several methods are available for testing diodes. One of the simplest and quickest tests can be made
by using
an ohmmeter
to measure
the
forward and reverse resistance (see Fig. 2-22a). The diode should offer a low
resistance when forward-biased and a high resistance when reverse-biased. A diode is short-circuited when it displays a low resistance for both forward
: Cathode
(a) Testing a diode with
an ohmmeter
Cathode
(b) Testing a diode with
a digital multimeter
Figure 2-22 Analog or digital multimeters may be used for diode testing. When forwardbiased, the diode should display a low resistance, or the typical forward voltage drop. When reverse biased, it should indicate a high reverse resistance.
Chapter 2
Semiconductor Diodes
57
and reverse bias, and open-circuited if a high resistance is measured with
both bias polarities. In the case of an analog ohmmeter with a 1.5 V battery, the low resistance indicated is normally about half the selected range. It is
important to note that when some multi-function instruments are used as ohmmeters, the voltage polarity at the terminals may not be the same as the polarity marked on the instrument. A voltmeter can be used
to check the ohmmeter
terminal polarity.
Use of a Digital Meter Many portable multi-function digital instruments have a diode-testing facility which displays the diode forward voltage when the terminals are connected positive to the anode and negative to the cathode (see Fig. 2-22b). The meter function switch should be set to the diode symbol, as illustrated. When
reverse-connected, a functioning diode produces either an OL display or an
indication of the meter internal voltage.
Plotting Diode Characteristics The forward characteristics of a diode can be obtained by use of the circuit illustrated in Fig. 2-23a. The diode voltage is set at a series of convenient levels, and the corresponding current levels are measured and recorded. The characteristics are then plotted from the resulting table of quantities. The reverse characteristics can be derived in the same way, except that a very sensi-
tive microammeter is required in order to measure the reverse current (Fig. 223b). The microammeter must be connected directly in series with the diode, as shown; otherwise the voltmeter current may introduce a serious error.
Ona (a) Circuit for obtaining diode forward characteristics
we (b) Circuit for obtaining diode reverse characteristics
Figure 2-23 Diode characteristics can be plotted from a table of corresponding current and voltage measurements, obtained by varying the applied voltage in steps and measuring V and I at each step.
Figure 2-24 shows a method of using an XY recorder for drawing the forward characteristics of a diode. The resistor voltage (V1) is directly proportional to the diode forward current (Ir). So Vr; is applied to the vertical input
terminals of the XY recorder, as illustrated. The diode forward voltage (Vp) goes to the horizontal input terminals. When the power supply voltage is slowly increased from zero, the diode forward characteristic is traced out by the pen on the XY recorder.
$8
Electronic Devices and Circuits XY recorder +
Vri { Vertical input
a
Horizontal input Ve {
Figure 2-24
Ry |
Tp
+
a+ o—
Power supply
dD,
An XY recorder can be used for directly plotting diode
characteristics.
If Rj in Fig. 2-24 is a 1 kQ resistor, there is a1 V drop across it for every 1 mA of diode current. Therefore, with the vertical scale of the XY recorder set to
1 V/cm, the (vertical) current coordinate of the graph is 1 mA/cm. A convenient scale for the (horizontal) voltage coordinate is 0.1 V/cm. Diode characteristics can also be investigated by means of a curve tracer, and by computer
graphic analysis software. Example 2-14 The arrangement shown in Fig. 2-24 is to be used to plot the characteristics of a 1N914 diode. Select a suitable resistor for R1, and determine appropriate V/cm scales for the XY recorder. Solution From Fig. 2-21,
56 =75mA
(for the 1N914)
Select a vertical scale of 5 mA/cm for the characteristic so that 75>mA
Vertical scale length (for Ip) = Badia = 15cm Select a vertical scale of 1 V/cm for the XY recorder, so that 15 cm represents 15 V as well as 75 mA. 15 V
Rt = 5 mA = 200 0
and
Pri(max) = (I(max))? Ri = (75 mA)? x 200 O =11W
Chapter2
Semiconductor Diodes
59
Vz might be as large as 0.8 V, so select a horizontal scale of 0.1 V/cm so that
‘ 0.8 V Hi orizontal tal scalescal length (for Vz) i a 01V/em =8cm
Practice Problems _ 2-8.1
/
are
©|
Plot the forward. characteristics for a silicon diode
Sreereaenval data;
bi eit
toy ihe follawiae
apahed ache
28 2 ‘An XY. sagen’ is used ne in Fig. 2-24) tto slat silicon diode forward characteristics to approximately fill a 10 cm by 10 cm square. If the - maximum forward current is to be 100 mA, select suitable V/cm scales . for the recorder and a suitable resistance for Rj.
2-9 ZENER DIODES Junction Breakdown When a junction diode is reverse-biased, there is normally only a very small reverse saturation current: Is on the reverse characteristic in Fig. 2-25a. When
the reverse voltage is sufficiently increased, the junction breaks down and a large reverse current flows. If the reverse current is limited by means of a suitable series-connected resistor (R; in the circuit in Fig. 2-25b), the power
dissipation in the diode can be kept to a level that will not destroy the device. In this case, the diode may be operated continuously in reverse breakdown. The reverse current returns to its normal level when the voltage is reduced below the reverse breakdown level. Ver VR Figure 2-25 A diode can be operated in reverse breakdown if the current is limited by means of a seriesconnected resistor. Zener diodes are designed for operation
(a) Diode reverse characteristic
in reverse break-
(b) Diode-resistor circuit
down.
60
Electronic Devices:and Circuits
Diodes designed for operation in reverse breakdown are found to have a breakdown voltage that remains extremely stable over a wide range of current
levels. This property gives the breakdown diode many useful applications as a voltage reference source. There are two mechanisms that cause breakdown in
a reverse biased pn-junction. With a very narrow depletion region, the electric field strength (volts/width) produced by a reverse bias voltage can be very high. The high-intensity electric field causes electrons to break away from their atoms, thus converting the depletion region from an insulating material into a
conductor. This is ionization by electric field, also called Zener breakdown, and it
usually occurs with reverse bias voltages less than 5 V. In cases where the depletion region is too wide for Zener breakdown, the electrons in the reverse saturation current can be given sufficient energy to cause other electrons to break free when they strike atoms within the deple-
tion region. This is termed ionization by collision. The electrons released in this way collide with other atoms to produce more free electrons in an avalanche effect. Avalanche breakdown is normally produced by reverse voltage levels above 5 V. Although Zener and avalanche are two different types of breakdown, the name Zener diode is commonly applied to all breakdown diodes.
Circuit Symbol and Package
.
The circuit symbol for a Zener diode in Fig. 2-26a is the same as that for an ordinary diode but with the cathode bar approximately in the shape of a letter Z. The arrowhead on the symbol still points in the (conventional) direction of forward current when the device is forward-biased. As illustrated, for operation in reverse bias, the voltage drop (Vz) is positive (+) on the cathode and negative (—) on the anode. Arrowhead indicates Negative terminal for
Zener operation \
conventional current direction when the device is forward-biased
Anode
YSs/
Cathode
Positive terminal for
Zener operation L
(a) Circuit symbol Anode
Cathode
(b) Low-current Zener diode
Figure 2-26 package.
Zener diode circuit symbol and low-current Zener diode
Chapter 2
Semiconductor Diodes
61
Low-power Zener diodes are available in a variety of packages. For the device package shown in Fig. 2-26b, the coloured band identifies the cathode terminal, as in the case of an ordinary low-current diode. High-current Zener diodes are also available in the type of package that allows for mounting on a heat sink.
Characteristics and Parameters The typical characteristics of a Zener diode are shown in detail in Fig. 2-27. Note that the forward characteristic is simply that of an ordinary forward-biased diode. Some important points on the reverse characteristic are Vz
Zener breakdown voltage
Izy Izx
‘Test current for measuring Vz Reverse current near the knee of the characteristic, the minimum
reverse current to sustain breakdown
Iza
Maximum Zener current, limited by the maximum power dissipation j
t Vz
yy
I
“R
_—7
-§
(v) =
-4
yi
=~
-3
-3
1
characteristic
[+
c
Reverse
Ix
Vp—> |
~
|
|
Forward
|
|
characteristic 10
i
tV0
|
| 15
}
tO r
AT
20.
Oty,
ZU
|
| | |
i |
I
|
TZ |
OR Za
|
|
J
|
VN ave
|
30
1
Oe.
VI
40Lt
AB
}
|
L Eee
|
|
rs
(mA)
Figure 2-27
Typical characteristics for a Zener diode. The most im-
portant parameters are the Zener voltage Vz, the knee current Izx, the test current Iz7, and the maximum current Izm.
The dynamic impedance (Zz) is another important parameter that may be
derived from the characteristics:
62
Electronic Devices:and Circuits
ve,
ie eg
,
As illustrated in Fig. 2-27, Zz defines how Vz changes with variations jp diode reverse current. When measured at Izr, the dynamic impedance js designated (Zzr). The dynamic impedance measured at the knee of the
characteristic (Zzx) is substantially larger than Zzr. The Zener diode may be operated at any (reverse) current level between
Izx and Iz. For greatest voltage stability, the diode is normally operated at the test current (Izy). Many low-power Zener diodes have a test curren} specified as 20 mA; however, some devices have lower test currents.
Data Sheet A portion of a data sheet for low-power Zener diodes with voltages ranging
from 3.3 V to 12 V is shown in Fig. 2-28. (See also data sheet A-4 for 2.4 V to 110 V Zener diodes in Appendix A.) Note in Fig. 2-28 that the Vz tolerance is stated as +5% or +10%. This means that the devices can be purchased with either a +5% or +10% tolerance on Vz. For a 1N753 with a +10% tolerance, the actual Vz is 6.2 V +10%, or 5.58 V to 6.82 V. The Zener voltage remains stable
at whatever it happens to be within this range.
_ Type 1N 746 Through 1N759 Silicon Zener Diodes
3.3 V to 12 V (+5% or +10%)
3
Py = 400 mW (derate linearly above 50°C at 3.2 mW/°C). - Electrical characteristics at 25°C ambient temperature Type _ | number (
Nominal Zener
Test current
voltage
Iz (mA)
Zener impedance Zz (Q)
Leakage current
Reverse temperature
Tr (wA)
coefficient
Vz (V)
az (%/°C)_|
IN746 IN747
3.3 3.6
20 20
28 24
10 10
—0.062 —0.055
IN753 IN755
6.2 7.5
20 20
7 6
0.1 0.1
+0.022 +0.045
IN757
9.1
20
10
0.1
+0.056
IN759
12.0
20
30
0.1
+0.060
Figure 2-28
Portions of a data sheet for low-power Zener diodes.
The data sheet also lists the dynamic impedance
(Zz7); reverse leakag
current (Ip), which is the reverse current before breakdown;
and the temper
Chapter2
Semiconductor Diodes
63
ature coefficient (az) for the Vz of each device. The Zener voltages at any
temperature can be calculated as follows:
Temperature-compensated Zener diodes are also available with extremely low temperature coefficients. Low-power Zener diodes are generally limited to a maximum power
dissipation of 400 mW (Pp in Fig. 2-28). Higher power devices are available. All of the power dissipations must be derated with temperature increase, exactly as explained in Section 2-5. When the maximum Zener current is not listed on the device data sheet, it may be calculated from the power dissipation equation:
Pp = Vala :
(2-12)
Example 2-15 Calculate the maximum
current that may be allowed to flow through
a
1N755 Zener diode at device temperatures of 50°C and 100°C. Solution
From data sheet A-4 in Appendix A, it can be seen that for the 1N755 Zener diode, Vz = 7.5 V, Pp = 400 mW at 50°C, and the derating factor = 3.2 mW/°C.
At 50°C:
.
From Eq. 2-12,
Pp _ 400mV
Izm = Ve
75V
= 53.3mA
At 100°C: Eq. 2-5:
Pz = (P; at T;) — [AT X derating factor] = 400 mW
— [(100°C — 50°C) X 3.2 mW/°C]
= 240 mW
fois pacer de Fore ae
Eg a
2Ve, «== = 32mA
TV
64
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Example 2-16 For the Zener diode circuit in Fig. 2-29, E = 20 V, and Ri = 620 (1. The Zener diode is a 1N755. Cal-
culate the diode current and power dissipation.
Solution
Figure 2-29
Circuit for Ex. 2-16
From the data sheet in Fig. 2-28, it is seen that for the 1N755 Zener diode, Vz = 7.5 V Var
=
B—
Vz'=20V
-7.5.V
=125V
Ip = Ip, = VSL = SV ZU
TRTRR, ~~ 6200
= 20.16 mA Pp = Vzlz = 7.5 V
X 20.16mA
= 151 mW
Equivalent Circuit The de equivalent circuit for a Zener diode is simply a voltage cell with a voltage Vz, as in Fig. 2-30a. This is the complete equivalent circuit for the device for all de calculations. For the ac equivalent circuit (Fig. 2-30b), the dy-
namic impedance is included in series with the voltages cell. The ac equivalent circuit is used in situations where the Zener current is varied by small amounts. It must be understood that
——|
Vz -—
(a) DC equivalent circuit Vz
—
Zy
rA\—
(b) AC equivalent circuit cieewese peaachGent: valarieciesaes tara Barer
these equivalent circuits apply only when the diszia. Zener diode is maintained in reverse breakdown. If the device becomes for-
ward-biased, then the equivalent circuit for a forward-biased diode must be used.
Example 2-17
|
A Zener diode with Vz = 4.3 V has Zz equal to 22 O when Iz = 20 mA. Cal culate the upper and lower limits of Vz when Iz changes by +5 mA. Solution
AVz = +(Alz X Zz) = +(5 mA X 22.0)
Chapter 2
Semiconductor Diodes
65
= 4110 mV Vitex) = Vz + AVz =43V + 110 mV =441V
Vaumin) = Vz — AVz = 4.3V - 110 mV = 4.19V Practice Problems 2-9. 1, Calculate the maximum
.
current for a IN753 Zener diode at device
_ temperatures. of 50°C and 100°C.
2-9, 2 A1N749 Zener diode is connected in series with an 820 0 resistor and
a 12,V supply. Calculate the diode current and power dissipation. Review Questions Section 2-1 2-1.
Sketch the symbol for a semiconductor diode, labelling the anode and cathode and showing the polarity and current direction for forward bias. Show the direction of movement of charge carriers when the device is (a) forward-biased and (b) reverse-biased.
2-2
Draw sketches to show the appearance of low-current and medium-current diodes, and show how the cathode is identified in each case.
Section 2-2 2-3.
Sketch typical forward and reverse characteristics for a germanium diode and
2-4
for a silicon diode. Discuss the characteristics, and compare silicon and germanium diodes. —_— For diodes, define forward voltage drop, maximum forward current, dynamic resistance, reverse saturation current, and reverse breakdown voltage.
2-5
Show how the diode dynamic resistance can be determined from the forward characteristics. Write an equation for calculating the dynamic resistance from the de forward current.
Section 2-3 2-6
Sketch the characteristics for an ideal diode and the approximate characteris-
2-7
tics for practical diodes. Briefly explain each characteristic. Draw the dc equivalent circuit for a diode and the piecewise linear equivalent
circuit. Discuss the application of each. Section 2-4 2-8 Explain the purpose of a dc load line. Write the equation for drawing a dc load line for a series circuit consisting of a supply voltage (E), a resistor (R,), and a
diode (D}).
66
Electronic Devices and Circuits
2-9
Define the Q-point in a diode circuit, and explain how it is related to the diode characteristics and the dc load line.
Section 2-5
2-10
Sketch and explain a power-versus-temperature graph for a diode. Define the power-derating factor for a diode.
2-11
Discuss how temperature change affects diode forward voltage drop.
Section 2-6 2-12 2-13
Explain the origins of depletion layer capacitance and diffusion capacitance, and discuss the importance of each. Sketch the complete equivalent circuits for forward-biased and reverse-biased
diodes. Sketch the ac equivalent circuit for a forward-biased diode. Briefly 2-14
explain each circuit. Define reverse recovery time. Sketch waveforms to show the effect of reverse recovery time on a diode switched rapidly from on to off. Explain each waveform.
Section 2-7 2-15 2-16
Discuss the major differences between switching diodes and rectifier diodes. Define the following diode quantities: peak reverse voltage, repetitive peak surge current, and steady-state forward current.
Section 2-8 2-17 Describe how an ohmmeter and a digital multimeter may be used for testing 2-18 2-19
diodes. Sketch circuits for obtaining diode forward and reverse characteristics by measuring corresponding current and voltage levels. Explain. Draw asketch to show how the forward characteristics of a diode may be plotted on an XY recorder.
Section 2-9 2-20
2-21 2-22
Discuss the different types of junction breakdown that can occur in a reverse-
biased diode. Sketch the circuit symbol for a Zener diode, and briefly explain Zener diode operation. Sketch typical characteristics for a Zener diode. Explain the shape of the characteristics, and identify the important points. Sketch the equivalent circuit for a Zener diode. Briefly explain.
Problems Section 2-2 2-1
Calculate
the
static
forward
resistance
for
the
characteristics
in
Fig. 2-31 at a 200 mA forward current. Determine the reverse resistance at 4 75 V reverse voltage.
Chapter 2
Semiconductor Diodes
67
(mA) AAD YUU
QEQ LIU
—25
;
!
r (V) y
r
—50
R
—100 -75
Ha
oI
(v)
ND. L009
es]
4
(wA) Figure 2-31 and 2-9.
2-2 2-3
Diode
characteristics
for Problems
2-1,
2-2,
Determine the dynamic resistance at a 150 mA forward current for a diode with the characteristics shown in Fig. 2-31. Calculate the static forward resistance for the diode characteristics shown in Fig. 2-32 at a 25 mA forward current. Also, determine the dynamic resistance for the device at Ip = 25 mA, using the characteristic and using Eq. 2-2.
Section 2-3 2-4
Calculate the forward current in a circuit consisting of a germanium diode connected in series with a 9 V battery and a 3.3 kQ resistor.
(mA) 60 50 40 Iz
30
20 10
0
0
02
04
06
08
10
12
14
16
18
(V)
VE Figure 2-32 2-11.
Diode characteristics for Problems 2-3, 2-10, and
B 68
Electronic Devices and Circuits
A silicon diode in series with a 2.7 kQ resistor and a battery is to have an Ir of
1.96 mA. Calculate the battery voltage.
Draw the piecewise linear characteristics for a silicon diode 0.6 © dynamic resistance and a.75 mA maximum forward current. Draw a straight-line approximation of the forward characteristic for a
with
a
silicon
diode that has a 0.5 0 dynamic resistance and a maximum forward current of 300 mA. Section 2-4
2-8
2-9
2-10
2-11
A diode with the characteristics in Fig. 2-13b is to pass a 35 mA current froma 9.5 V supply. Draw the dc load line and calculate the required series resistance value. Determine the new current level when the supply is reduced to 3.5 V, A diode with the forward characteristic in Fig. 2-31 is connected in series with a 30 © resistance and a 6 V supply. Determine the diode current, and find the new current when the resistance is changed to 20 0. A diode which has the characteristics shown in Fig. 2-32 is to pass a 20 mA for-
ward current when the supply is 12 V. Determine the value of resistance that must be connected in series with the diode. Calculate the new supply voltage for the circuit in Problem 2-10 to give a 15 mA current level.
Section 2-5
2-12
2-13
2-14 2-15
A diode with a maximum power dissipation of 1000 mW at 25°C is to pass an average forward current of 500 mA. The forward voltage drop for the device is 0.8 ‘V, and the power derating factor is 10 mW/°C. Calculate the maximum temperature at which the diode may be safely operated. The diode specified in Problem 2-12 is to be operated at a temperature of 75°C. Calculate the maximum level of average forward current that the diode can safely pass. Draw the power dissipation-versus-temperature graph for the diode specified in Problem 2-12. A diode with a 0.9 V forward drop has a 1.5 W maximum power dissipation at 25°C. If the device derating factor is 7.5 mW/°C, calculate the maximum for-
ward current level at 25°C and at 75°C. Assume that Vp remains constant. 2-16
Estimate the forward voltage drop at 75°C of the silicon diode in Problem 2-15. Determine the junction dynamic resistances at the temperature extremes if [Fis
2-17
20 mA. A5 V supply is applied via a 150 © resistor to a silicon diode and a germanium diode that are connected in series. Determine the diode current at 25°C and at 100°C.
Section 2-6 2-18 Calculate the minimum fall time reverse recovery time of (a) 6 ns 2-19 A diode has an applied voltage maximum reverse recovery time
for a voltage pulse applied to a diode witha and (b) 50 ns. with a 200 ns fall time. Determine the diode for satisfactory operation.
Chapter 2
2-20 2-21
Semiconductor Diodes
69
Calculate a suitable minimum fall time for a switching waveform applied to a diode that has a 12 ns reverse recovery time. Calculate the minimum fall time for a voltage pulse applied to a circuit with a 1N914 diode.
Section 2-7
2-22
2-23
A diode connected in series with a 560 © resistor has a supply voltage that alternates between peak levels of +150 V and —150 V. Select a suitable device from the data sheets A-1 and A-2 in Appendix A. Referring to data sheet A-3 in Appendix A, determine the peak reverse voltage and average rectified forward current for a 1N5398 diode.
2-24
A rectifier diode has to pass an average current of 55 mA and survive a 40 V peak reverse voltage. Select a suitable device from data sheets A-1 to A-3 in Appendix A.
Section 2-8 2-25
The arrangement shown in Fig. 2-24 is to be used to plot the forward characteristics of a 1N917 diode. Determine a resistance value for Ri, and select appropriate
2-26
V/cm scales for the horizontal and vertical inputs of the XY recorder. The graph should be approximately 20 cm x 20cm. Plot the forward characteristics of a diode from the following experimental data:
30. Section 2-9 2-27
Determine the maximum current that may be used with a 1N757 Zener diode
2-28
at temperatures of 25°C and 80°C. A 1N750 Zener diode is connected in series with an 470 © resistor and a 10 V supply voltage. Calculate the diode current and power dissipation.
Practice Problem 2-2.1 2-2.2 2-3.1 2-3.2 2-3.3 2-4.1 2-4.2 2-4.3 2-5.1 2-5.2
Answers
5.5 0, 30 MQ, 0.5 0,050 2.89 mA (Point A: 0 mA, 0.3 V), (Point B: 100 mA, 0.35 V) 174 mA 20 mA 500 3.45 V 154 mA, 61.5mA 267 mV, 421 mV, 1.23 0, 1.54 2
70
2-5.3 2-6.1 2-6.2 2-6.3 2-7.1 2-7,2 2-8.2 2-9.1 2-9.2
Electronic Devices and Circuits
780 mV 50 ns 150 ns 154 ns 600 V,1.5A,50A 1N5392
Vertical 1 V/cm, Horizontal 0.1 V/cm, 100 0 64.5 mA, 38.7 mA
40.4 mW
CHAPTER 3 Diode Applications Objectives You will be able to:
1 Sketch various diode half-wave and full-wave rectifier circuits and their input and output waveforms. Explain the operation of each circuit. 2 Sketch basic dc power supply circuits using rectifiers and capacitor filters. Discuss the operation and performance of each circuit. 3 Design dc power supply circuits and analyze them to determine diode current and voltage levels, output ripple voltage, line and load effects, and line and load regulation. 4 Sketch Zener diode voltage regulator circuits, and explain their operation. 5 Design and analyze RC and LC m-input and L-input filters for dc power supplies.
6 Design and analyze Zener diode voltage regulator circuits. 7 Draw diagrams for series and shunt clipping circuits and sketch their input and output waveforms. Explain the operation of each circuit. 8 Design and analyze series and shunt clipping circuits. 9 Draw diagrams for clamping circuits and dc voltage multipliers. Sketch the input and output waveforms, and explain the circuit operation. 10 Design and analyze clamping circuits and dc voltage multipliers. 11 Sketch diode AND and OR gate circuits, and explain their
operation. Calculate circuit current and voltage levels.
INTRODUCTION One of the most important applications of diodes is rectification: conversion of a sinusoidal ac waveform into single-polarity half cycles. Rectification may be performed by half-wave or full-wave rectifier circuits. A dc power supply converts a sinusoidal ac supply to dc by rectification and filtering. The filtering process normally involves the use of a large reservoir capacitor, which charges to the peak input voltage level to produce the dc output. The capacitor partially discharges between peaks of the rectified waveform, and this results in a ripple voltage on the output. The ripple can be reduced by the
72
Electronic Devices and Circuits
use of RC or LC filters. Power supplies are specifiedyaccording to the dc output voltage, load current, and ripple voltage. Power supply performance is defined in terms of the output voltage stability when the input voltage o; the load current changes. Other important diode applications include clipping, clamping, de volt. age multiplication, and logic circuits. Diode clipping circuits are used for clipping off an unwanted portion of a waveform. Clamping circuits change the dc voltage level of a waveform without affecting the wave shape. Dc voltage multipliers are applied to change the level of a dc voltage source to a desired higher level. Logic circuits produce a high or low output voltage, depending upon the voltage levels at several input terminals.
3-1
HALF-WAVE RECTIFICATION
Positive Half-Wave Rectifier A diode positive half-wave rectifier circuit is shown in Fig. 3-1a. An alternating input voltage is applied via a transformer (T;) to a single diode connected in series with a load resistor Ri. The transformer is normally necessary to dcisolate the rectifier circuit from the ac supply. The diode is forward-biased
during the during the during the half cycles, waveform ing voltage
positive half cycles of the input waveform, and reverse-biased negative half cycles. Substantial current flows through Ry only positive half cycles of the input. For the duration of the negative the diode behaves almost as an open switch. The output voltage developed across Ry, is a series of positive half cycles of alternatwith intervening very small negative voltage levels produced by
the diode reverse saturation current. When the diode is forward-biased (see Fig. 3-1b), the voltage drop across itis
Vz, and the output voltage is (input voltage) — Vp. So, the peak output voltage is : Vo
ae
Vi
aN
Ve
(3-1)
Note that Vp; = 1.414Vi, where V; is the rms level of the sinusoidal input voltage to the rectifier circuit (from the transformer output).
The diode peak forward current is ee
During the negative half-cycle of the input (Fig. 3-1c), the reverse-biased diode offers a very high resistance. So there is only a very small reverse cu! rent (Ip), giving an output voltage Mort
Ip Ry
(3-3)
Chapter 3
Input waveform
Diode Applications
73
Dy T -
Output waveform
(a) Transformer-coupled half-wave rectifier circuit
ipa waveform
V,pi
+
z, Ve
_
D,
1
V;
Output waveform
i
Ry
a
||*
\*
S
Vo
NL V,
V; po
iF
Oo——uNXOro
V, =i
/
Ry
Cy
+
(c) Effect of negative input
(d) Use of a reservoir capacitor
Positive half-wave rectifier circuit. The diode is forward-biased during the posiFigure 3-1 tive half-cycle of the applied waveform and reverse biased during the negative half-cycle.
While the diode is reverse-biased, the peak voltage of the negative half-cycle of the input is applied to its terminals. Thus the peak reverse voltage, or peak inverse voltage (PIV), applied to the diode is Ve
=
PIV= Voi
(3-4)
The average and rms values of the half-wave rectified waveform can be determined as Voyave) = 0.318 Vpo and Voams) = 0.5 Vpo. However, most rectifier circuits use a reservoir capacitor at the output terminals to smooth the rec-
tified voltage wave into direct voltage (see Fig. 3-1d). It is very important to note that the presence of the capacitor changes the output waveform and that it sub-
stantially affects the load current and voltage and the diode current and voltage. This is discussed in Sections 3-2 and 3-3. Example 3-1
A diode with Vp = 0.7 V is connected as a half-wave rectifier. The load resistance is 500 Q, and the (rms) ac input is 22 V. Determine the peak output voltage, the peak load current, and the diode peak reverse voltage.
74 _ Electronic Devices and Circuits
Solution Vpi = 1.414 V; = 1.414 X 22 V
=311V
Vo = Voi — Vp = 311V -0.7V
Ege
= 30.4V t=
Eq. 3-2:
V’po _ 30.4V
PR,
5000
= 60.8mA
Eq. 3-4:
PIV = V,i = 31.1V
Negative Half-Wave Rectifier Figure 3-2a shows the effect of reversing the diode polarity in the circuit of Fig. 3-1. The negative half-cycle of the ac input waveform (instead of the positive half-cycle) is passed to the load resistor. Consequently, the peak output voltage and current are negative quantities.
Figure 3-2b shows a positive half-wave rectifier circuit with the positive output terminal grounded. This is possible because, as already discussed, the ac input to the rectifier circuit is normally derived from the secondary of a transformer. Either of the two output terminals may be grounded so long as there is no other grounded point in the circuit. Now, when the transformer output waveform is at its peak positive level, the load waveform is actually a peak
Ty
3 TY -
Output waveform
+
(a) Negative rectification by reversing the diode polarity Variac
Ty
Packs
3||
Output waveform
115V
60 Hz E
(b) Negative rectification by grounding the positive output terminal
|
3| wn
Isolation transformer
(c) An isolation transformer should be used when the power supply transformer is not available
Figure 3-2 Negative half-wave rectification is performed when the diode is forward-biased during the negative half-cycle of the input. Negative output half-cycles can also be derived from a positive half-wave rectifier if the positive output terminal is grounded. Rectifier circuit should be transformer-coupled for dc isolation from the input.
Chapter 3
Diode Applications
75
negative quantity, as shown, because output terminal B is negative with respect to the grounded terminal A. The diode is reverse-biased during the negative half-cycle of the transformer output, and so the load voltage is zero. Thus, a
negative half-wave rectified waveform can be generated simply by grounding the positive output terminal of a positive rectifier circuit. It is important to note that one of the rectifier circuit output terminals may be grounded only when the transformer is present to provide complete dc isolation from the ac supply. If a variable transformer (autotransformer or variac) is used without a power supply transformer, a 1:1 isolation transformer must be substituted for the power supply transformer to provide the required dc isolation (see Fig. 3-2c).
Practice Problems 3-1.1 A half-wave rectifier circuit has a15° V ac input and a 330 2 load resistance. Calculate the peak output voltage, the peak load current, and the diode maximum reverse voltage. 3-1.2 A half-wave rectifier (as in Fig. 3-1) produces a 40 mA peak load cur-
rent through a 1.2 kQ resistor. If the diode is silicon, calculate the rms a ee voller and the diode PIV.
3-2 FULL-WAVE RECTIFICATION Two-Diode Full-Wave Rectifier The full-wave rectifier circuit in Fig. 3-3 uses two diodes, and its input voltage is supplied from a transformer (Tj) with a centre-tapped secondary winding. The circuit is essentially a combination
of two half-wave
rectifier circuits,
each supplied from one half of the transformer secondary. When the transformer output voltage is positive at the top, as illustrated in
Fig. 3-4a, the anode of D is positive, and the centre tap of the transformer is connected to the cathode of D; by Ri. Consequently, D, is forward-biased, and load current (I) flows from the top of the transformer secondary through Dj,
through R;, from top to bottom, and back to the transformer centre tap. During this time, the polarity of the voltage from the bottom half of the transformer secondary causes diode Dz to be reverse-biased, as illustrated. For the duration of the negative half-cycle of the transformer output, the polarity of the transformer secondary voltage causes D; to be reverse-biased and D> to be forward-biased (see Fig. 3-4b). I, flows from the bottom terminal
of the transformer secondary through diode D2, through R, from top to bottom, and back to the transformer centre tap. The output waveform is the
combination of the two half-cycles, that is, a continuous series of positive halfcycles of sinusoidal waveform. This is positive full-wave rectification. Figure 3-5 shows that if the polarity of the diodes is reversed, the output waveform is a series of sinusoidal negative half-cycles: negative full-wave
76
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Output waveform
Pr
T,
eee
i
D,
Input waveform
V.
I
O,
Rt = | u¢Vo
=
P
;
«3 mo Dy Figure 3-3
Full-wave rectification can be performed by two diodes used with a trans-
former that has a centre-tapped secondary. The diodes are connected to conduct during positive half-cycles of the transformer output to give a positive output waveform.
Forward-biased
Reverse-biased
+ OO
oF
all
mS|k Vo
V,
Output waveform
=
Output waveform
We
Veo
=) *
=
D,
- Reverse-biased
Forward-biased
(a) D, forward-biased, D, reverse-biased
(b) D, reverse-biased, D, forward-biased
Ina two-diode full-wave rectifier circuit, diodes D; and D2 conduct alternately. Figure 3-4 When D, is forward-biased, Dz is reverse-biased, and vice versa.
Output waveform Input waveform
D,
|__l@q —_ Figure 3-5
Two-diode negative full-wave rectification is produced by connecting the
diodes to conduct during negative half-cycles of the transformer output.
°
Chapter 3
Diode Applications
77
rectification. The centre tap of the transformer is normally grounded, as shown in Fig. 3-5, and so the only way to obtain a negative output from this type of circuit is to reverse the diode polarity.
Bridge Rectifier The centre-tapped transformer used in the circuit of Fig. 3-3 is usually more expensive and requires more space than additional diodes. So a bridge rectifier is the circuit most frequently used for full-wave rectification. The bridge rectifier circuit in Fig. 3-6 is seen to consist of four diodes con-
nected with their arrowhead symbols all pointing toward the positive output terminal of the circuit. Diodes D, and D> are series-connected, as are D3 and D4. The ac input terminals are the junction of D, and D2 and the junction of D3 and Dy. The positive output terminal is at the cathodes of D; and D3, and the negative output is at the anodes of D2 and D4.
During the positive half-cycle of input voltage, diodes D, and Dy are in series with Rj, as illustrated in Figs 3-7a and b. Load current (J,,) flows from
the positive irput terminal through D; to R,, and then through R;, and D, back to the negative input terminal. Note that the direction of the load current through Ry is from top to bottom. During this time, the positive input terminal is applied to the cathode of D2 and the negative output is at the D2 anode (see Fig. 3-7a). So D2 is reverse-biased during the positive half-cycle of the input. Similarly, D3 has the negative input at its anode and the positive Input waveform
Figure 3-6
Output waveform
A full-wave bridge rectifier circuit uses four diodes and a transformer with a
single secondary winding.
output at its cathode during the positive input half-cycle, causing D3 to be reverse-biased. Figures 3-7c and d show that diodes D2 and D3 are forward-biased during the negative half-cycle of the input waveform, while D, and Dy are reverse-
biased. Although the input terminal polarity is reversed, I, again flows through R;, from top to bottom, via D3 and Dp. It is seen that during both half-cycles of the input, the output terminal polarity is always positive at the top of Ry and negative at the bottom. Both
positive and negative half-cycles of the input are passed to the output. The negative half-cycles are inverted, so that the output is a continuous series of
positive half-cycles of sinusoidal voltage.
78.
Electronic Devices and Gircuits)
(b) D, and D, forward-biaseg
+
D3 Ry
| I,
D2 (c) Effect of negative half-cycle of input Figure 3-7
(d) D3 and D, forward-biased
Ina bridge rectifier circuit, diodes D, and D4 are forward-biased during the
positive half cycle of the input, while Dz and Dg are reverse-biased. During the input negative half-cycle, D2 and D, are forward-biased and D, and D, are reversed. In each case current flows through load resistor RA. in the same direction (from top to bottom).
A full-wave derived from a circuit will not However, given
bridge rectifier circuit always requires that the input be transformer that provides dc isolation from the supply. The function correctly if one of its input terminals is grounded. the required dc isolation between supply and output, either
output terminal may be grounded to provide a positive or negative output voltage.
The bridge rectifier has two forward-biased diodes in series with the supply voltage and the load. Because each diode has a forward voltage drop (Vz), the peak output voltage is Vo
= Voi
— 2Vr
(3-5)
The average and rms values of the full-wave rectified waveform can be determined as follows: Voaye) = 0.637Vpo and Voums) = 0.707V5. However, once again it should be noted that most rectifier circuits use a reservoir capacito! to smooth the rectified voltage wave into direct voltage, and the presence of the capacitor changes the output waveform and substantially affects the load current ald voltage and the diode current and voltage. See Sections 3-2 and 3-3.
Chapter 3
Diode Applications
79
Example 3-2 Determine the peak output voltage and current for the bridge rectifier circuit in Fig. 3-7 when Vj = 30 V, Ry, = 300 Q, and the diodes have Vp = 0.7 V.
Solution
Vpi = 1.414V; = 1.414 x 30 V = 42.42 V Vo = Vpi — 2Vr = 42.42 V — (2 X 0.7 V) =41V
Eq. 3-5:
Eq. 3-2:
[=
Vo
41 V “aa
= 137 mA
More Bridge Rectifier Circuits Figure 3-8 shows two common methods of drawing a bridge rectifier circuit. Although they both look more complex than the circuit in Fig. 3-7, they are exactly the same circuit. The cathodes of D; and Ds in all three circuits are connected to the positive output terminal, and the anodes of D2 and Dy, are con-
nected to the negative output terminal. The ac input is applied to the junction of D; and D, and to the junction of D3 and Dy.
Figure 3-8
Two additional ways of drawing a
bridge rectifier circuit diagram.
Both of these circuits have the diodes conn cted exactly as in Fig. 3-6.
Practice Problems
3-2.1 Determine the peak load voltage, peak current, and power dissipation in a 470 load resistor connected to a bridge rectifier circuit that has a 3-2.2
24 V ac input. The rectifier diodes are germanium. A bridge rectifier with silicon diodes and a 680 © load resistor has an 18 V peak output. Calculate the power dissipated in the load resistor
and the rms input voltage.
so
Electronic Devices and Circuits
3-3 HALF-WAVE RECTIFIER POWER SUPPLY Capacitor Filter Circuit When. a sinusoidal alternating voltage is rectified (see Sections 3-1 and 3-2), the resulting output waveform is a series of positive (or negative) half.
cycles of the input; it is not direct voltage. To convert to direct voltage (dc voltage), a smoothing circuit or filter must be employed. Figure 3-9a shows a half-wave rectifier circuit with a single capacitor filter (Ci) and a load resistor (Ri), and Fig. 3-9b shows the output waveform. The capacitor, termed a reservoir capacitor, is charged almost to the peak level of the circuit input voltage when the diode is forward-biased. This occurs at V)j, as
illustrated in Fig. 3-9c, giving a peak capacitor voltage:
(3-6)
Ve =Vpi — Ve Direct voltage
owt
with ripple
Input waveform
+-
Ve
Ve
Rectified wave
Current pulse (a) Half-wave rectifier circuit with a reservoir capacitor
a
(ry
:
(b) Output waveform
Reverse-biased
Pe
o—p|—
+a Voi
— i+
Voi —eon ey
D, pVc=Vpi- Ve
Ga. Gaerne”
|
(c) Gq is charged to V,; — Vp Figure 3-9
x
o—p}
aa.
-Pr a
PO
Cree
oOo}
~
(d) D, is reverse-biased when Vj falls below V,,;
A reservoir capacitor smooths the output from a rectifier circuit by charging
to the peak output voltage and retaining most of its charge between
peaks.
When the instantaneous level of input voltage (at the diode anode) falls
below V>i, the diode becomes reverse-biased because the capacitor voltage (Vc) (at the diode cathode) remains close to (Vpi — Vg) (see Fig. 3-9d). With the diode reverse-biased, there is no capacitor charging current, and th capacitor begins to discharge through the load resistor (Ry). So Ve fall slowly, as shown by the capacitor voltage waveform in Fig. 3-9b.
Chapter 3
—
Diode Applications
81
The diode remains reverse-biased (as Vc decreases) throughout the rest of
the input positive half-cycle, the negative half-cycle, and the first part of the positive half-cycle again until the instantaneous level of Vj becomes greater
than Vc once more. At this point, current flows through the diode to recharge the capacitor, causing the capacitor voltage to return to (Vp; — Vr). The charge
and discharge of the capacitor cause the small increase and decrease in the capacitor voltage, which is also the circuit output voltage. It is seen that the circuit output is a direct voltage with a small ripple voltage waveform superimposed (Fig. 3-9b).
Ripple Amplitude and Capacitance The amplitude of the ripple voltage is affected by the load current, the reservoir capacitor value, and the capacitor discharge time. The discharge time
depends upon the frequency of the ripple waveform, which is the same as the ac input frequency in the case of a half-wave rectifier. With a constant load current, the ripple amplitude is inversely proportional to the capaci-
tance: the largest capacitance produces the smallest ripple.
The ripple amplitude can be calculated from the capacitor value, the load current, and the capacitor discharge time. Consider the circuit output voltage waveform illustrated in Fig. 3-10a. The waveform quantities are as follows:
Eave
average dc output voltage
Eomax)
Maximum output voltage
Eoin)
Minimum output voltage
V, T
ripple voltage peak-to-peak amplitude time period of the ac input waveform
ty
capacitor discharge time
ty
capacitor charge time
0; 0,
phase angle of the input wave from zero to Eocmin) phase angle of the input wave from Eoimin) tO Eoqnax) Direct voltage J with ripple
| V,
= \
+
ae
Ey max
a
PE
|
L
mee t
Current | 90 pulse
\
si_.°
180 ty
°
0;
|
co
J ~
=
Vor
Ro + Rp
Vcg=20V =
20V 4.9k0
= 4.08 mA
Figure 6-7
_
Voltage-divider
bias circuit with a bypassed
emitter resistor. The dc load
is (Rc + Re), and the ac load
is Rc when there is no ca-
Plot point Bat
Ic = 4.08 mA and Vcz = 0
pacitor-coupled load.
Chapter6
AC Analysis of BUT Circuits
20 Ip= ~
0
2
4
6
8
10
12
*
OpA
k=
14C6 18 20
(V)
——-,—-Y
Vor
Figure 6-8
AVcpg
The ac load line for a transistor circuit is drawn through the Q-point.
Draw the dc load line through points A and B.
_ Veo X Rp __ 20V X 82kO R,
+ Ro
18kQ
+ 8.2kO
=63V Vi= Vp— Vez= 6.3V—-0.7V =5.6V ed = Ve _ 5.6V Re 27k = 2.07mA Mark the Q-point on the dc load line at Ic = 2.07 mA Drawing the ac load line: When there is no external Ri, Ryd = Re = 2.2 kO When Ic changes by Alc = 2.07 mA, AVcg = Alc X Rc = 2.07 mA X 2.2kO =455V Plot point C at Alc = 2.07 mA and AVcg = 4.55 V from the Q-point. Draw the ac load line through points C and Q.
245
246
Electronic Devices and Circuits
The Output Voltage Swing In Section 5-1 it was explained that the maximum symmetrical output voltage swing (+Vo(max)) from a common-emitter circuit depends upon the Q-point position on the dc load line. In the case of a circuit with a bypassed emitter resistor or a capacitor-coupled load, the maximum symmetrical output swing depends upon the Q-point position on the ac load line. For the ac load line shown in Fig. 6-8, V
o(max)
x
+4.5
V
Practice Problem 6-2.1. Draw the new ac load line for the transistor circuit in Ex. 6-2 when a 5.6 kQ, external load is capacitor-coupled to the circuit output. Determine the new maximum possible symmetrical output voltage swing.
6-3 TRANSISTOR MODELS AND PARAMETERS T-Equivalent Circuit Because
a transistor consists of two pn-junctions with a common
centre
block, it should be possible to use two pn-junction ac equivalent circuits as the transistor model. Figure 6-9 shows the ac equivalent circuit for a transistor connected in common-base configuration. Resistor r. represents the BE junction resistance, r- represents the CB junction resistance, and 1, represents
the
resistance
of the
base
region
which
is common
to both
junctions. Junction capacitances Cgp and Cpe are also included. If the transistor equivalent
circuit is simply
left as a combination
of
resistances and capacitances, it could not account for the fact that most of the emitter current flows out of the collector terminal as collector current. To
5
Input
i
Cc
T ; |Ib
utput tp
(a) CB connected transistor
Input
1%
Cac
Output
{1,
(b) CB equivalent circuit
Figure 6-9 The T-equivalent circuit, or r-parameter equivalent circuit, for a transistor is essentially a combination of two pn-junction equivalent circuits.
Chapter6
= AC Analysis of BUT Circuits
247
represent this, a current generator is included in parallel with r, and Cgc. The
current generator is given the value ale, where a = I,/Ie. The complete circuit is known as the T-equivalent circuit, or the r-parameter
equivalent circuit. The equivalent circuit can be rearranged in common-emitter or common-collector configuration. The currents in Fig. 6-9 are designated I, I., and J, (instead of Ip, Ic, and Ig) to indicate that they are ac quantities rather than dc. The circuit parameters
To To, Te, aNd @ are also ac quantities. r-Parameters
In Fig. 6-9, r. represents the ac resistance of the forward-biased BE junction, it has a low resistance value (typically 25 (). The resistance of the reverse-
biased CB junction (r,) is high (typically 100 kN to 1 MQ). The base region resistance (r,) depends upon the doping density of the base material. Usu-
ally, rp ranges from 100 © to 300 2. Cpe is the capacitance of a forward-biased pn-junction, and Cgc is that of a reverse-biased junction (see Section 2-6). At medium and low frequencies the
junction capacitances may be neglected. Instead of the current generator (a/.) in parallel with r,, a voltage generator (al.r,) may be used in series with 7.
wo
yn te
Input
a
oc 1,
th 2
Output
Bo—
OB
Bo—
(a) Using current source Figure 6-10
(b) Using voltage source
Transistor low-frequency r-parameter ac equivalent circuits.
Two transistor r-parameter models are shown in Fig. 6-10, one using a current generator and the other using a voltage generator.
Determination of Fr. Because fz is the ac resistance of the BJT forward-biased base-emitter junction, it can be determined from a plot of Ig versus Vz. As illustrated in Fig. 6-11, ig
re This is similar to the determination forward-biased
diode
AVE
dele
(6-1)
of the dynamic resistance (rg) for a
(see Section 2-2). As in the case of a diode,
the ac
248
Electronic Devices and Circuits
(mA)
resistance for the transistor BE junction can be
10+—_—__——
fo
calculated in terms of the current crossing the
gt] , —AVe e
Ig
junction:
Alp
4 nn aon 4 2
0
nt
05
Vor
t—++
0.7 08
26anV
(6-2)
Tp ‘
!
Vee
06
r', =
Ip -
|
04
py:
|
'
.
;
5
5
Like rg for a diode, ri. does not include the resisa ° tance of the device semiconductor material. boa. Consequently, rz is slightly smaller than the ac-
(V)
tual measured value of r. for a given transistor.
Figure 6-11
Determination of = Equation 6-2 applies only to transistors at a
r. from the transistor base-
J
Soe
i!
emitter junction forward
temperature of 25°C. For determination of 1, at
characteristic.
higher or lower temperatures, the equation must be modified.
1 — 26mV 7 +
j
Ip
|
9
298°C
:
h-Parameters It has been shown that transistor circuits can be represented by an /-parameter or T-equivalent circuit. In circuits involving more than a single transistor, analysis by r-parameters can be virtually impossible. The hybrid parameters (or h-parameters) are much more convenient for circuit analysis. These are
used only for ac circuit analysis, although dc current gain factors are also expressed as /-parameters. Transistor h-parameter models
simplify
transistor
circuit analysis by separating the input and output stages of a circuit to be an-
alyzed. In Fig. 6-12, a common-emitter h-parameter equivalent circuit is compared with a common-emitter r-parameter circuit. In each case an external collector
resistor (Rc) is included, as well as a signal source voltage (v,) and source al,
=
Bl,
(a) CE r-parameter equivalent circuit Figure 6-12 circuits.
(b) CE h-parameter equivalent circuit
Comparison of common-emitter r-parameter and h-parameter equivalent
Chapter6
= AC Analysis of BUT Circuits
249
resistance (r,). Note that the output current generator in the r-parameter circuit has a value of al., which equals Bl. The input to the h-parameter circuit is represented as an input resistance (hie) in series with a voltage source (hyeUce): Looking at the r-parameter circuit, it is seen that a change in output current I, causes a voltage variation across
fe. This means that a voltage is fed back from the output to the input. In the
h-parameter circuit, this feedback voltage is represented as the portion hye of the output voltage v¢. The parameter My. is appropriately termed the reverse voltage transfer ratio. The output of the h-parameter circuit is represented as an output resistance (1/hoe) in parallel with a current generator (hjelp), where I is the (input) base current. So, hgelp is produced by the input current [,, and it divides between the device output resistance 1/ho- and the collector resistor Rc. I, is the
current passed to Rc. This compares with the r-parameter equivalent circuit, where some of the generator current (6],) flows through r,. The current generator parameter (hfe) is termed the forward transfer current ratio. The output conductance is hoe, so that 1/ho. is a resistance.
r,, Equivalent Circuit An approximate h-parameter model for a transistor CE circuit is shown in Fig. 6-13a. In this case, the feedback generator (yeUce in Fig. 6-12b) is omitted. The effect of hye is normally so small that it can be neglected for most
practical purposes. The approximate h-parameter circuit is reproduced in Fig. 6-13b with the components labelled as r-parameters: 1, = Nie, Bly = hjelp, and r- = 1/Noe-. This
circuit, known
as a hybrid-m model,
is sometimes
used
instead
of the
h-parameter circuit.
OE
(a) CE h-parameter transistor model Figure 6-13
(b) CE r,, transistor model
Transistor h-parameter and r, equivalent circuits.
Definition of h-Parameters The e in the subscript of hie identifies the parameter
as a common-emitter
quantity, and the i signifies that it is an input resistance. Common-base and common-collector input resistances are designated hj, and h;,, respectively. As an ac input resistance, hie can be defined as the ac input voltage di-
vided by the ac input current.
250
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Vb Rie
a
I,
This is usually stated as V hie aa
a
Tb
(6-4)
|Veg
This means that the collector-emitter voltage
(iA)
(Vcg) must remain constant when hij. is measured. :
.
a
‘
The input resistance can also be defined in terms of changes in dc levels: AY
he =—
Alp
oot
(6-5)
lve
80 +
I
=: AV pe
Nie= TF
60 + ” 40 4
204
|
0
(V)
Equation 6-5 can be used for determining hie VBE
from the transistor common-emitter input characteristics. As illustrated in Fig. 6-14, AVpg
Figure 6-14
and Alp are measured at one point on the char-
teristics,
.
Derivation of hj.
from the CE input charac-
acteristics, and hie is calculated.
The reverse transfer ratio /y. can also be defined in terms of ac quantities, or as the ratio of dc current changes from a plot of Vgg versus Vcr. In both cases, the input current (Ig) must be held constant.
Nee
_ AVpe AV cg
(6-6) Tz
The forward current transfer ratio hye can similarly be defined in terms of
ac quantities, or as the ratio of dc current changes. In both cases, the output voltage (Vcr) must be held constant.
I he= 7
bl
or
AI he = —— Alp
Vex
|vcp
(6-7)
(6-8)
Chapter6
Von = 45V an)
1 \
Me~
rs
(uA) + 80
8
the CE current gain characteristics. Figure 6-15
7
shows the measurement of Alc and Alg at one point on the characteristics for the hg. calcula-
6
tion.
4
The output conductance, hoe, is the ratio of ac collector current to ac collector-emitter voltage, and its value can be determined from the com-
60
40
Ig
\
mon-emitter output characteristics (see Fig. 6-16). 2
Alc ||\
P| Me = AT
i
= 20
254
Equation 6-8 can be used to determine hy. from
+S —t4 \
AC Analysis of BUT Circuits
QO
hoe ==
0
ce
( 6-9)
{Ip
Ip Figure 6-15
Derivation of hr.
from the CE current gain
5
characteristics.
0
=2.
=-4
[=6
-6 Ve:
-I0
Pewee
r
ate
oe ~ AV ck
-12
—-45V
-—i4
|i,
(6-10)
(V) Figure 6-16
Derivation of ho. from
the CE output characteristics.
Example 6-3 Determine hye and Moe for Vcg = 4.5 V and Ig = 40 wA from the transistor
characteristics in Figs 6-15 and 6-16. Solution From the current gain characteristics at Vcg = 4.5 V and Ip = 40 pA, Alc =4mA
and Algp® 30pA
252
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Al he. = Alc
Eq. 6-8: *
fe
4mA
Alp
30 pA
= 133 From the output characteristics at Vcg = 4.5 V and Ip = 40 pA, Alc
Eq. 69:
= 400
pA
and
fy SS es AV cE
AVcE
=6V
6V
= 33.3 wS (micro Siemens)
1 Vi. == [Moe 33.3 1S = 30k
Common-Base and Common-Collector h-Parameters The common-base and common-collector /-parameters are defined similarly to common-emitter h-parameters. They may also be derived from the CB and CC characteristics. Common-base parameters are identified as hiv, ha, etc., and common-collector parameters are designated hic, hj, and so on. Com-
mon-emitter, common-base, and common-collector h-parameter equivalent
circuits are further investigated in Sections 6-4 to 6-8. Parameter Relationships Device manufacturers do not list the values of all parameters on transistor data sheets. Usually, only the CE h-parameters are stated. However, CB and CC h-parameters can be determined from the CE h-parameters. 7-Parameters
can also be calculated from the CE /-parameters. Table 6-1 shows the parameter relationships. Table 6-1
Conversion from CE h-parameters to CB and CC h-parameters and to r-parameters
CE to CB
h-parameters x
hie —
hw
ro)
1
h
=
a
oe
4s Nie
Nfe
1 + Ige
CE h-parameters
h-parameters
to r-parameters
h,.
hin ~ TF he Nie Noe
CE to CC
—h re
= h;
cos
h,=1Tc
Nee
=
]
Ne |e ee
at
+
1 + Ni
h re
Cc
=
hfe
i=
TL
1 + hg Noe
Nie
£ digs
h hop
~
ve
Nise
me
Rese
Yb
=
hie
1 + hye
=
=
7!
Ne(1 + aMfe ) Mre(1 Noe
tr B
= —
hie hte
Chapter6
= AC Analysis of BUT Circuits
253
Example 6-4 Calculate hfc, hop, and a from the parameters determined in Ex. 6-3.
Solution
From Table 6-1:
hee = 1 + he = 1 + 133 = 134 her ee
Drees OU 1+hp
33.3 S 1+ 133
= 249 nS eae Nee
_
l+k.
133
1+ 136
= 0.993
Example 6-5 A transistor in a circuit has its current levels measured as follows: Ip = 20 pA and Ic = 1 mA. Estimate the CE input resistance. Determine r, and . Solution , _26mV fe = Th
Eq. 6-2:
_ 26mV imA
= 260,
hig 8
Ic
imA
Ip
20pA
= 50
hie = (1 + hye) re = (1 + 50) X 26 0 = 1.33 kO Va = hie
=
133 kO0
B = I = 50
Practice Problems 6-3.1 6-3.2 6-3.3
Determine hy. and Moe at Vcr = 6 and Ip = 20 pA from the commonemitter output and current gain characteristics in Fig. 4-30. Calculate a and r, from the h-parameter values determined in Problem 6-3.1. Calculate h;. for a transistor at a temperature of 50°C when the emitter current is 1.3 mA and hj. = 80.
254
Electronic Devices and Circuits
6-4 COMMON-EMITTER CIRCUIT ANALYSIS Common-Emitter Circuit
Consider the transistor amplifier circuit shown in Fig. 6-17. When the capacitors are regarded as ac short circuits, it is seen that the circuit input terminals are the transistor base and emitter, and the output terminals are the collector and the emitter.
So, the emitter terminal is common to both input and output, and the circuit termed common-emitter (CE).
configuration
is
The current and voltage waveforms for the CE circuit in Fig. 6-17 are illustrated in Fig. 6-18. It is seen that there is a 180° phase shift between the input and output waveforms. This can be understood by considering the effect of a positive-going input signal. When vg increases in a Figure 6-17 Transistor common-emitter amplifier with coupling and bypass capacitors.
f5*
input
positive direction, it increases the transistor base-emitter voltage (Vgz). The increase in Vp;
raises the level of Ic, thereby increasing the voltage drop across Rc, and thus reducing the level
of the collector voltage (Vc). The changing level of Vc is capacitor-coupled to the circuit output to produce the ac output voltage (v,). As uv, increases in a positive direction, 0, goes in a negative direction, as illustrated. Similarly, when »,
changes in a negative direction, the resullant decrease in Vpg reduces the Ic level, thereby
re-
ducing Vec and producing a positive-going oulput. The circuit in Fig. 6-17 has an input impedance
(Z\), and an output impedance (Z,). These can cause voltage division of the circuit input and output
voltages, as illustrated
in Fig. 6-19. So,
for most transistor circuits, Z; and Z, are important parameters.
The circuit voltage
amplifica-
tion (A,), or voltage gain, depends on the transistor parameters and on resistors Rc and R;.
h-Parameter Equivalent Circuit Figure 6-18
Voltage and cur-
rent waveforms in a common-emitter amplifier.
The first step in ac analysis of a transistor circuil is to draw the ac equivalent circuit, by substituting short-circuits in place of the power
Chapter6G
=
hei
255
supply and capacitors. When this is done for the circuit in Fig. 6-17, it gives the ac equivalent circuit shown in Fig. 6-20a (reproduced from Fig.
VU,X Z;
@
AC Analysis of BUT Circuits
Zi
6-6b).
The
h-parameter
circuit is now
drawn
simply by replacing the transistor in the ac equivalent circuit with its h-parameter
model
(from Fig. 6-12b). This gives the CE h-parameter equivalent circuit in Fig. 6-20b. Note that the feedback voltage generator (h;eVc) in Fig. 6-12b
is omitted in Fig. 6-20b. As discussed, the effect of hyed, in a CE circuit is unimportant for most practical purposes. The current directions and voltage polarities in Fig. 6-20b are those that occur when the in-
(b) Division of output voltage Figure 6-19 Circuit input and output voltages are divided
stantaneous level of the input voltage is moving
in a positive direction.
by the effects of Z; and Z.
(a) ac equivalent circuit for CE transistor circuit
Transistor h-parameter equivalent circuit
I
i.e
B
Ry
©
I
Nie Zp
I
wets
wilt Re
ES
Hise
=
holy
E
Z.
RL |
© (b) h-parameter equivalent circuit for CB circuit with unbypassed base
Figure 6-37 AC equivalent circuit and h-parameter circuit for a CB amplifier with an unbypassed base resistor.
272
Electronic Devices and Circuits
(Fig. 6-37b). The presence of the unbypassed base resistors can substantially affect the transistor input impedance and the circuit voltage gain. Analysis
of the h-parameter circuit shows that Ze = hip + Rp(1
Abe
and
— Np)
(6-33)
hep(Re|| Rx) ee hy + Rp
(6-34)
— App)
Comparing Eq. 6-33 to Eq. 6-28 (Ze with C; present), it is seen that Rp(1 — hp) is added to hy to give Ze without C; present. Equation 6-34 is similar to Eq. 6-32 (A, with C; present), except that Rp(1 — /ig) is again
added to hj, to give the CB circuit voltage gain without C; (Eq. 6-34). Typically hg = 0.99 and (1 — hg) = 0.01. Summary of CB Circuit Performance With the base bypassed to ground: Device input impedance
Ze = hip
Circuit input impedance
Z, = Ze||Re
.
z
1
Device output impedance
Leg= >
Circuit output impedance
Zo * Re
Circuit voltage gain
Nob
he(Rc||R
Ay =mala ib
With the base unbypassed:
Device input impedance
cpt eaten
ircuit voltage gain
Ze = hin + Rp(1 — hp) OS
_flRellR) Hy
Rall
= kad
impedance, ACB circuit has good voltage gain and relatively high output imlike a CE circuit. But unlike a CE circuit, a CB circuit has a very low input e amplifier applica pedance, and this makes it unsuitable for most voltag
The tran tions. It is normally employed only as a high-frequency amplifier.
be bypassed sistor base terminal in a CB circuit should always
to ground,
voltage am When this is not done, the input impedance is increased and the plification is substantially reduced.
Chapter6
AC Analysis of BUT Circuits
273
Example 6-10 The transistor in the CB circuit in Fig. 6-38 has the following parameters:
hie= 2.1 KO and hfe= 75. Caleulate the circuit input and output impedances and voltage gain.
- Solution _ 2.1k0
hie
hy =
From Table 6-1,
7s
L
1 + hye
= 27.60, 75
Nye
hy =
and
1+75
Ll+hp
= 0.987
Vee
12V
fo——— C.
R,
"s
82 kO
Figure 6-38
CB circuit for Ex. 6-10.
Z; = hp||Re = 27-6 0||4.7 ko = 2740,
Zo = (1/hop)||Re* Re
Eq. 6-31:
= 3.9kO A, =
Eq. 6-32:
(Rc||Ri)
hi
0.987 (3.9 kQ ||82 kQ)
a eee
= 133 Example 6-11
circuit in Ex. 6-10 Calculate the input impedance and voltage gain for the CB when capacitor C; is disconnected. Solution
Eq. 6-33:
Ze = hip+ Rp(1 — hw)= 27-6 0 + (68 kQ||56 kQ)(1 — 0.987)
274
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Eq. 6-29:
Eg. 634
= 426.80 Zi = Ze||Re = 426.8 04.7 kO = 3910 he(Rel|R
A, =m hiy +
ORell Ry) _ Rg(1 — hp)
987
27.6 D
—_ + (68
(3.9 kQ||82 ko
Me
kO||56 kQ)(1 — 0.987)
= 8.6 Practice Problems 6-7.1
Calculate Z;, Z,, and A, for a CB circuit (as in Fig. 6-38) with the follow-
ing component values and parameters:
Rj =56
kO, R) = 39 kQ,
Re = 5.6 kO, Rg = 3.3.kO, Ry = 47 kO, hie = 1 kO, and he = 100.
6-7.2 Determine Z; and A, for the circuit in Problem 6-7.1 when capacitor C, is disconnected.
6-8
COMPARISON
OF CE, CC, AND CB CIRCUITS
Table 6-2 compares Zi, Zo, and Ay for CE, CC, and CB circuits. As already dis-
cussed, the CE circuit has high voltage gain, medium input impedance, high output impedance, and a 180° phase shift from input to output. The CC circuit has high input impedance, low output impedance, a voltage gain of 1,
and no phase shift. The CB circuit offers low input impedance, high output impedance, high voltage gain, and no phase shift. Table 6-2.
Comparison of Common-emitter, Common-collector, and Commonbase Circuits
Circuit Configuration
Zo
Ay
Phase Shift
eC
medium high
® Re low
high ~1
180° 0
CB
low
= Re
high
0
CE
Zi
Device manufacturers normally only list the CE h-parameters on a transis-
tor data sheet. Although these can be converted to CC and CB parameters, it is convenient to use CE parameters for all three types of circuits. Table 6-3
gives the circuit impedance equations in terms of CE h-parameters. In the case of input and output impedances, it is helpful to think in terms of the terminal being looked into.
Chapter 6
Table 6-3
275
Common-emitter, Common-collector, and Common-base Circuit
Equations
Using CE h-parameters
“Circuit Configuration CE
CE
AC Analysis of BUT Circuits
with
Zz
iy iy Wigs
hie
—=
17 Noe
—
1 / Nee
hie + Rg(1
+ hfe)
Zz.
unbypassed Rg
CC
Nieie +
CB
hie (Re||Rx)(1
ae
hte)
_
hie 1
CB with
unbypassed Rp
+ Rp
aNye
1+
a
+
= 1 + he
Nee
Nee
hie + Rg
1 + hie
1 + hfe
Hoe
Impedance at the Transistor Base
2 > = hig + Rg(1 + Age)
= hi, (with Cg)
ce,
Consideration of each type of circuit shows that the input impedance (Z;) depends upon which transistor terminal is involved. In both the CE and CC circuits, the input signal is applied to
Lt
the transistor base terminal. So, Z; is the imped-
T Ce ane
ance ‘looking into’ the base. Figure 6-39 shows that, for a CE circuit with an unbypassed emit-
= Figure 6-39
ter resistor, Zp = Nie + Re(1 + hye)
Impedance at
the transistor base terminal.
When Rg is bypassed, the Rg(1 + hye) portion can be treated as zero, so that Ly = hie
The CC equations for Z; are almost identical to the CE equations, except that they use hj. and hj, which are essentially equal to hie and hfe (see Table 6-3). A rough approximation for the base input impedance of any transistor circuit
with an unbypassed emitter resistor is Zp © Mye(impedance in series with the emitter) The circuit input impedance for both CE and CC configurations is Z, in parallel with the bias resistors: A= Zp||Ral|Re
Impedance at the Transistor Emitter The transistor emitter is the output terminal for a CC circuit and the input terminal for a CB circuit. So, the device impedance in both cases is the
276
Electronic Devices and Circuits
impedance ‘looking into’ the transistor emitter terminal (Ze). Although the Z, equations for the two circuits look different, they can be shown to give exactly the same result in similar situations. For a CC circuit or a CB circuit with an unbypassed base (using CE parameters),
z.
= hie + Rg ©
1+
Nfe
where Rg is the impedance when ‘looking back’
from the transistor base. As shown in Fig. 6-40, Rg includes the signal source resistance (/s) fora
CC circuit. A CB circuit normally has its base bypassed as shown, so that the impedance at the emitter is hie
fe
Tt the
For all circuit arrangements, the impedance at the transistor emitter terminal is With CC
With CB
Figure 6-40
Impedance in series with the base
7
circuit
circuit
Impedance at the
e
transistor emitter terminal.
1+h
fe
Vig
Impedance at the Transistor Collector The output for CE and CB circuits is taken from the transistor collector terminal. So, the imped-
Re
ance ‘looking into’ the collector is the device output impedance. This is normally a very large quantity at low and medium signal frequencies.
As illustrated in Fig. 6-41, the circuit output impedance at the collector is essentially Zo™ Re
Figure 6-41
Impedance at the
transistor collector terminal.
Voltage gain In the case of a circuit with an unbypassed emitter resistor, the ac voltage al the emitter follows the ac input at the transistor base. So, a CC circuit (an
emitter follower) has a voltage gain of 1. With both CE and CB circuits, the ac input (vj) is developed across the
base-emitter junction, and the ac output (v9) is produced at the transistor col-
lector terminal (see Fig. 6-42). Thus (as discussed in Section 6-7), the magnitude of the voltage gain is the same for CB and CE circuits with similar component values and transistor parameters. The CE voltage gain equation can
be used for the CB circuit, with the omission of the minus sign that indicates
Chapter6
AC Analysis of BUT Circuits
277
CE phase inversion. Although the voltage gains are equal for similar CB and CE circuits, the low input impedance of the CB circuit can substantially attenuate the signal voltage, and result in a low amplitude output. This is demon-
strated in Ex. 6-12.
Ap —
~
Mele
|
R
L)
1e
— Figure 6-42
CE and CB voltage gain.
Figure 6-43
Circuit for Ex. 6-12.
Example 6-12 A 50 mV signal with a 600 (© source resistance is applied to the circuit in Fig. 6-43. Calculate v, for (a) CE circuit operation with v, at the transistor
base and Rx bypassed, and (b) CB circuit operation with v, at the emitter and the base resistors bypassed. The transistor parameters are je = 1.5 kQ and Ne =
100.
Solution
(a) CE circuit
— Ige(Re||Rt) _ 100 (5.6 kO||33 kO) Vv
—
= Zp = Z; = =
Ne
1.5 ko
319 hie = 1kO Zp||Ri||R2 = 1 kQ|]100 kQ|]47 ka 970.0,
_ 0.x Zi _ 50mvV x 970 0 % + Z; 6000 + 9700 = 30.9 mV
Uy = Av X 0; = 319 X 30.9 mV =99V
278
Electronic Devices and Circuits
(b) CB circuit
Ru) _ 319 Ay = hre(Rell hie
From Table 6-3,
Z, = —“#e_ = 15k 1+ hy = 14.850
1+ 100
Zi = Z.||Re = 14.85 0||5.6 kO = 14.810
5 ota
2, _ Kim k Lal @
r,+Z, =12mvV
6009 + 14.810
Up = AyX 4 = 319 X 1.2mV = 383 mV
Practice Problems 6-8.1 Using the appropriate CE equations from Table 6-3, calculate Z;, Z,, and A, for a CB circuit (as in Fig. 6-38) with the following component values and parameters: Ri = 56 kQ, Rp = 39 kQ, Rc = 5.6 kQ, Re = 3.3 kQ, Ry = 47 kO, hie = 1 kQ, and hy. = 100. 6-8.2
Determine 2, for the circuit in Problem 6-8.1 when a 30 mV
ac signal
with r, = 400 2 is capacitor-coupled to the transitor emitter.
6-9 EBERS-MOLL BJT MODEL Figure 6-44a shows the Ebers-Moll transistor model which is used in some computer programs, and also used as a large-signal model. The npn BJT model illustrated consists of two diodes with parallel-connected dependent current generators. Diodes Dg and Dc represent the base-emitter and basecollector junctions, respectively, and each generator produces a current that
is dependent on the current in the opposite diode. I,}=apIpg
and
I2=apglpc
The diode currents (Ipc and Ipg) can be calculated from the Shockley equation (Eq. 1-13). When
the BJT is biased for normal operation, Ipc = Ico, the
junction reverse saturation current, and Ip, is the current flowing across 4 forward-biased junction. The forward current gain factor ag can be thought
of as the relationship between Ic and Ig, and this is typically 0.99, making the collector current almost equal to the emitter current (see Section 4-2). The
Chapter 6
AC Analysis of BUT Circuits
279
reverse current gain factor ag determines the relationship between emitter and collector currents when the voltage polarities are reversed, so that the collector behaves as an emitter and the emitter is operating as a collector. Because the BJT is fabricated with an emitter-base junction area much smaller than the area of the collector-base junction, the emitter performs poorly as a
collector. Consequently, ag is typically 0.5. For a transistor biased for normal operation, i
(Ipc = Ico) SR
x
are
315
Se
Characteristic
Symbol |
Small-Signal Characteristics
_
ae
Current-gain-bandwidth product
fr
(Ic = 10 mA de, Veg = 20 V, f = 100 MHz)
Min
Max
i
Unit
, MHz
2N3903 2N3904
250 300
—_ _—
Figure 8-6 Specification of transistor cutoff frequency on the 2N3903 data sheet.
and 2N3904
an input capacitance (Cibo), which corresponds
Vee
to Cpe. It should be noted that in both cases, the
capacitance values are specified for reversebiased junctions with zero current levels. Cop. varies when Vcg is altered; however, the
changes are usually a maximum of approximately +3 pF. Cjp. changes substantially from the specified capacitance when the baseemitter junction is forward biased (as it always is for linear BJT operation).
Characteristic
Symbol |
Output capacitance (Veg
=5 Vdc,
Ik
= 0,
f=
Figure 8-7
All transistors
have junction capacitances.
Min
Max
Unit
Cas
_
4.0
pF
Cre
=
8.0
pF
1.0 MHz)
Input capacitance (Vpp = 0.5 Vde, Ic = 0, f = 1.0 MHz)
Figure 8-8
Junction capacitance specifications for 2N3903 and 2N3904 transistors.
When an emitter current flows across the BE junction, there is a diffusion
capacitance (see Section 2-6) at the junction. This is directly proportional to the current level. It can be shown that
_ 61g
er
(8-8)
316
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Miller Effect Figure 8-9 shows an input signal (+AVj) applied to the base of a transistor connected in CE configuration. If the circuit voltage amplification is —Ay, then the collector voltage change is AV,
=
—Ale
x
AV;
Meg Re
Ravi ce
(a) AV, and —A,AV;, change Vc Figure 8-9
(b) Cin = Cue + (1 + Ag)Cic
Because of the Miller effect, the input capacitance for a
common-emitter amplifier is Cin = Cpe + (1 + Av)Core-
Note that, because of the phase reversal between input and output, the collector voltage is reduced by (A, AV;) when the base voltage is increased by AV;. The increase in Vg and decrease in V¢ result in a total collector-base volt-
age reduction of AVcp
=
AV; + A,AV;
This voltage change appears across the collector-base capacitance. From the equation Q = C X AV, it is found that the charge supplied to the input of the circuit is Q = Cre X AV{(1 + Aj) or
Q=
(1 + Ap)Cre X AV;
appears to be Therefore, ‘looking into’ the base, the collector-base capacitance
(1 + A,)Chc. So the capacitance is amplified by a factor of (1 + A,). This is
known as the Miller effect. lel The total input capacitance (Cin) to the transistor is (1 + Ay)C). in paral with the base-emitter capacitance (Cpe):
Cn. = Che. FP
AV ebe
(8-9)
It should be noted that the Miller effect occurs only with amplifiers that have a 180° phase shift between input and output (an inverting amplifier). Consequently, it occurs with CE circuits but not with CB and emitter-follower circuits.
Chapter 8
BUT Specifications and Performance
317
Example 8-4 The transistor in the circuit in Fig. 8-10 has Ic = 1 mA, hye = 50, hie = 1.3 kQ, fr = 250 MHz, and C,, = 5 pF. Calculate the input capacitance'when the circuit is operated as a CE amplifier with Rg bypassed.
Figure 8-10 The upper cutoff frequency for a transistor circuit can be limited by the input capacitance.
Solution From Eq. 6-12,
re
_ 50 x (8.2 kQ||100 kQ)
hge(Rc||Rz) hie.
-
1.3kO
= 291
ee:
s
(
6.11
be
fp
Be pups
6.1 X 1mA
«250 MHz
= 24.4 pF Cin = Che + (1 + Av)Cprc = 24.4 pF + [(1 + 291) X 5 pF]
Eq. 8-9:
= 1.48 nF
Practice Problem
8-3.1 A CE circuit with a voltage gain of 100 has Ic = 0.75 mA, Cyc = 3 pF, and fr = 300 MHz. Calculate Cin when a 45 pF capacitor is connected across the collector-base terminals.
8-4 BJT CIRCUIT FREQUENCY RESPONSE Coupling and Bypass Capacitor Effects Consider the typical transistor amplifier frequency response illustrated in Fig. 8-5, As explained in Section 8-2, the amplifier voltage gain is constant
over a middle range of signal frequencies, and it falls at the low and high ends of the frequency range.
318
Electronic Devices and Circuits
The gain fall-off at low signal frequencies is due to the effect of coupling and bypass capacitors. Recall that the reactance of a capacitor is X¢ = 1/(2nfC). At medium and high frequencies, the factor f makes Xc very small, so that all coupling and bypass capacitors behave as ac short circuits. At low frequencies, Xc is large enough to divide the voltages across the capacitors and series resistances (see Fig. 8-11). As the signal frequency gets lower, the capacitive reactance increases, more of the signal is lost across the capacitors, and the circuit gain continues to fall. Coupling and bypass capacitors are further investigated in Section 12-1.
Signal lost across X¢,
=
Signal lost across Xc
Figure 8-11 The low-frequency fall-off in voltage gain in a transistor amplifier is due to signal loss across coupling and bypass capacitors.
Input-Capacitance Effect on CE and CB Circuits The input capacitance of an amplifier (discussed in Section 8-3) reduces the circuit gain by 3 dB
when the capacitive impedance equals the resistance in parallel with the input (see Fig. 8-12). That is when
Xq = Zillts Thus
all circuits
(8-10)
have
an
input-capacitance-
Beco
limited upper cutoff frequency (fri). As already explained, the input capacitance of a CE circuit is amplified by the Miller effect, but Miller effect
does
not
occur
in a CB
circuit.
Figure 8-12 ta
The input resis-
(Z;
i | 7 ae : : lees parallel with the circuit input capacitance (Ci,).
Consequently, a CB circuit operates to a much higher signal frequency than a similar CE circuit.
Chapter 8
BUT Specifications and Performance
319
Example 8-5 Calculate the input-capacitance-limited upper cutoff frequency for the circuit
in Fig. 8-13 (reproduced from Fig. 8-10): (a) when the circuit is used in CE
configuration with Rg bypassed, and (b) when operating as a CB circuit with the base bypassed to ground. As in Ex. 8-4, Che =5 pF and Cre = 24.4 pF.
Also, hfe = 50, hie = 1.3 kO, hi, = 24.5 0 (= 1’), and rs = 600 2.
Figure 8-13
Circuit that may be connected to
function in either CE or CB configuration.
Solution
(a) Common emitter circuit:
Z; = Ri||Rol|hie = 100 kQ||47 kO||1.3 kO = 1.20 kD
rs||Z; = 600 O||1.25 kO = 405
From Ex. 8-4,
Cin = 1.48nF
(due to Miller effect) 1
yen
fatiy = mee
~ On X 1.48 nF X 405 0
= 266 kHz
(b) Common base circuit:
Z, = Re||hp = 4.7 kO||24.5 0 = 2440 r,||Z; = 600 0||24.4 0
= 23.40 Cin = Che + Coc = 24.4 pF +5 pF = 29.4 pF
320
Electronic Devices and Circ uits
From Eq.q. 8-10,
1 F240)i) = QmCin(relZ;)
1 = 20 X 29.4 pF Xx 23.4.0
= 231 MHz Input-Capacitance Effects on Emitter Follower
When a transistor is used as an emitter follower, its BE junction voltage is not significantly altered by the ac input signal, because virtually all of 4; appears at the emitter as vp (see Fig. 8-14). Since there is no Miller effect to amplify C,., the input capacitance is Cp9||Copo. So the input-capacitancelimited cutoff frequency for an emitter follower is very much higher than that for a CE circuit.
See
Stray Capacitance Figure 8-15 illustrates the fact that stray capacitances (C,, and C,,) exist in all transistor circuits.
This is capacitance between connecting wires and ground, and normally it is extremely small. The stray capacitance at the device base is usu-
ally much smaller than the input capacitance at
Figure 6-14. ‘Thera leno Miller effect input-capacitance amplification with an
emitter follower circuit.
the base, so that it can usually be neglected. When this is not the case, the stray capacitance must be included with the input capacitance for CE circuit cutoff-frequency calculations.
Figure 8-15
Stray capacitance can cause a
reduction in the transistor amplifier gain at high frequencies.
At the circuit output, the impedance of the stray capacitance (C,,) is very
high at low and medium signal frequencies, so that it has no effect on the gain. At high frequencies, the stray capacitive impedance becomes small enough to shunt away some of the output current, and thus it reduces the circuit gain. In Fig. 8-15, it can be seen that the circuit ac load consists of the output stray capacitance (Co) in parallel with Rc and R,.. Rewriting the voltage gain equation for CE and CB circuits gives
Chapter 8 —_ BUT Specifications and Performance
|Ayl =
321
hge(Re | Ry | X cso) Hie
If the transistor cutoff frequency has not caused the gain to fall off at a lower
frequency, then the gain falls by 3 dB when X¢so = Rc||Rz. This is an outputcapacitance-limited cutofffrequency (f2(0)). If the voltage gain falls by 3 dB at fue because of the transistor, and by 3 dB at the same frequency because of the stray capacitance, then the gain is down
by 6 dB (see point A
in Fig. 8-16). Consequently, the amplifier upper cutoff
frequency is lower than fe. This is illustrated by point B in Fig. 8-16.
As discussed, there is an additional 3 dB attenuation when Xcso = Re | Ry. If
Xcso = 2(Re l|Rx) at fae, the additional attenuation can be shown to be 1 dB. With Xcso = 5(Re|| Rr) at foe, there is only a 0.2 dB additional attenuation (point C). In some circumstances it is desirable to set the upper cutoff frequency of a
circuit well below the transistor cutoff frequency (see point D in Fig. 8-16). This is done simply by connecting a capacitor from the collector terminal to ground exactly as C,, is shown in Fig. 8-15. The capacitance value is calcu-
lated at the desired cutoff frequency to give
Xo =Re l Rp
(8-11)
oO oie
V,
=f
NG
a
G
°
—3 dB
\
—5
“6
\
fo
—7
fo.
+
fy selected
Soe
by an external capacitor by
Cas
or
“are
f,2when ».
=
(Re
at
fore
I Ry)
upper cutFigure 8-16 The BJT cutoff frequency (fr) determines the output the of off frequency of a circuit so long as the impedance
stray capacitance (C.0) is much larger than Re||RL. When Xeso is
much smaller than Re||R., the circuit upper cutoff frequency is determined by Cso-
322
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Example 8-6
A transistor with fr = 50 MHz and he = 50 is employed in the CE amplifier
in Fig. 8-17. Determine the upper 3 dB frequency for the device. Calculate the capacitance required for Cy to give a 60 kHz upper cutoff frequency. Assume that Ri >> Rc.
Figure 8-17
Solution From Eq. 8-7,
From Eq. 8-11,
;
f
T
fae = Nee ~
50 MH 50
Circuit for Ex. 8-6.
7
= 1 MHz 1
4 = OafaeRe 2X
1
X 60kHz x 10KO
= 265 pF
Practice Problems 8-4.1
In a CE amplifier circuit, Rc = 5.6 kO and Ry = 56 k). The transistor
used has hye = 60, hie = 1.5 kD, Coe = 192 pF, source resistance is 1 kQ,, and the voltage R, = 82 kO and Ro = 39 kM. Determine the upper cutoff frequency. 8-4.2 A transistor in a single-stage CE amplifier
and C,. = 6 pF. The signal divider bias resistors are input-capacitance-limited has hy = 75 and f; = 12
MHz. The load resistance is Rc||R_ = 20k. Determine the upper 3 dB frequency (2) for the circuit. Also, calculate the output stray capacitance
that will produce an additional 3 dB attenuation at fy.
8-5 TRANSISTOR SWITCHING TIMES Turn-On Times For transistor switching circuits (see Sections 4-4 and
5-10), the switching
speed of the device can be an important quantity. Consider the circuit in Fig. 8-18a. When the base input current is applied, the transistor does not
Chapter 8
BUT Specifications and Performance
323
switch on immediately. Like frequency response, the switching time is affected by junction capacitance and the transit time of electrons across the junc-
tions. The time between the application of the input pulse and the beginning of collector current flow is termed the delay time (tg) (see Fig. 8-18b). Even when the transistor begins to switch on, a finite time elapses before Ic reaches
its maximum level. This is known as the rise time (t,). The rise time is specified as the time required for Ic to go from 10% to 90% of its maximum level. As il-
lustrated, the turn-on time (ton) is the sum of tg and t,.
Turn-Off Times When the input current is switched off, Ic does not go to zero until after a turn-off time, tor, made up of a storage time (t,) and a fall time (t,), as illustrated. The fall time is specified as the time required for Ic to go from 90% to 10% of
‘ Ic 90% Ie tinax)
10% Ic (max)
At
marr LI
vt
role tfon
—
ee tort —>1
_ (a) Transistor base and
|
(b) Current waveform relationships
collector currents
Figure 8-18
The turn-on time for a switching transistor is the sum of the delay time (ty)
and the rise time (,). The transistor turn-off time is the sum of the storage time (t,) and the fall time (t)).
its maximum level. The storage time is the result of charge carriers being trapped in the depletion region when a junction polarity is reversed. When a
transistor is in a saturated on condition (see Section 5-10), both the collectorbase and emitter-base junctions are forward biased. At switch-off, both junctions are reverse biased. Before Ic begins to fall, the stored charge carriers
must be withdrawn ot made to recombine with opposite-type charge carriers. For a fast-switching transistor, ton and fog must be of the order of nanoseconds. The excerpt from a 2N3904 transistor data sheet in Fig. 8-19 specifies the following switching times: ta = 35 ns, tr = 35 ns, ts = 200 ns, and t, = 50 ns.
324
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Characteristic
Symbol |
Switching Characteristics (2N3904) Delay time
Voc
=3V,
Ver
Min
Max
Unit |
e =05V,
ly
—
35
ns
Rise time
Ic =10mA, Ip; = 1 mA
b,
~
35
ns
Storage time
Vcc = 3 V,I¢ = 10 mA,
bs
—
200
ns
Fall
Ip,
ty
—_—
50
ns
time
Figure 8-19
=
Tp2
=lmA
Transistor switching times, as specified on a data sheet.
Example 8-7 The circuit shown in Fig. 8-18a uses a 2N3904 transistor and has an input pulse with a 5 pis pulse width (PW). Determine the time from the beginning
of Ic until the transistor turns off. Solution
Ic begins at ty (at 10% of Ic(max)) after the start of the input pulse, and ceases at (t; + ts) (at 10% of Ic(max)) after the end of the input pulse. t= PW
-tgt+t,+tp=5 ws — 35ns+ 200 ns + 50 ns
= 5.215 ps
Rise Time and Cutoff Frequency Just how fast a circuit can switch from off to on is related to its upper cutoff
frequency (fy). It can be shown that 0.35
a
(8-12)
r
So, for example, if the output pulse from the circuit in Fig. 8-18a has a rise time of 100 ns and the input pulse has a very much smaller rise time,
==
fa = 100 ns
95
2
It should be noted that in this case fj; is the same as fe, because a common-
emitter circuit is involved (see Section 8-3). Pulse testing can be used for
rapidly determining the upper cutoff frequency of a circuit or device. Switching Time Improvement The turn-on time can be shortened by overdriving the transistor, that is, applying a larger base current than required for transistor saturation. However,
BUT Specifications and Performance
Chapter 8
325
a larger Ip level produces an increased storage time and thus lengthens the
device turn-off time. Turn-off time can be reduced by the application of a
large negative input voltage to rapidly discharge the forward-biased junctions at switch-off. But the effect of this would be to make the turn-on time longer, because the transistor base would have to be raised from its negative
level before switch-on can begin.
Ideally for fast switching, the transistor base-emitter voltage should start
at zero, and Ip should be large at switch-on but should rapidly settle down to level required for transistor saturation. Also, a large negative
the minimum
voltage should be applied for switch-off to rapidly discharge the forward-bi-
ased junctions, but this voltage should quickly return to zero. These desirable conditions are achieved by connecting a capacitor (C;) in parallel with the base resistor, as in Fig. 8-20a.
Capacitor C1, known as a speed-up capacitor, short-circuits Rp when a positive input (+Vs) is applied, and thus the initial level of base current is
Vir
ios LORY OV
en
= Vs
—
-23V
(b) Waveforms showing effect of
(a) Switching circuit with
the speed-up capacitor
speed-up capacitor C;
Figure 8-20 capacitor.
J
OV
Vs
Vec
p—
p Transistor switching times can be improved by the use of a speed-u
the base increased to shorten the switch-on time. Without C, in the circuit, current is calculated from
Eq. 5-26: With Cy, The
capacitor-charging
Fig. 8-20b).
n=
i
ly = current
Vs — VBE
aoe Re
Vs — Ver
spike
(8-13)
Re
flows
into
the
base
terminal
(see
326
Electronic Devices and Circuits
When the capacitor is completely charged, I, returns to the normal Ig level
for Q; saturation, and the capacitor voltage is then Vai= TpRp
At switch-off, Vs goes to zero and —Vc; is applied to the transistor base,
thus improving Q; switch-off time. After switch-off, Vci returns to zero (discharged by Rg), so that there is no negative base-emitter voltage to affect the turn-on time. A suitable speed-up capacitance value is calculated by allowing C, to
charge by 60% during the specified transistor turn-on time. This will keep |, close to its maximum level during a reduced turn-on time, so as to turn Q; on as quickly as possible. C, charges via the signal source resistance (Rs), and it can be shown that for a 60% charge, ton = RgCy
_
giving
_ fon
CoS
(8-14)
Rs
Capacitor C; has the undesirable effect of limiting the maximum signal frequency that may be used with the circuit. After Q; switches on, C, has to be completely charged before switch-off begins. Also, after Q; switches off, C; has to be completely discharged to near zero volts before another switch-on pulse can be applied. A capacitor will charge or discharge by more than 99% in a time period of 5CR. Charge to C; is via Rs and discharge is via Rs. The time between switch-on and switch-off is the pulse width (PW) (see Fig.
8-20b), and this should not be less than PWomin) = 5RsCy
(8-15)
The time between switch-off and switch-on is the space width (SW) (Fig. 8-20b), which should be a minimum of
SWenin) = 5RpCy
(8-16)
The maximum signal frequency that may be used with a given switching circuit is dictated by the sum of the minimum pulse and space widths: T= PW+SW
giving
1
Ff (max) = PWian) +teeWieas SWea
(8-17)
Example 8-8 The circuit in Fig. 8-20a uses a transistor with a 100 ns turn-on time. Calculate
a suitable speed-up capacitor value, and determine
frequency that may be used with the circuit.
the maximum
signal
Chapter 8
BUT Specifications and Performance
327
Solution
= 8
Eq. 8-14:
= 167 pF (use 160 pF standard value) Eq. 8-15:
PWmin)= 5 Rs Ci= 5 X 600 0. X 160 pF
= 0.48 ys Eq. 8-16:
SW (min) = 5 Rp Cy; = 5 X 4.7kO, X 160 pF = 3.76 us fmax) = ll
Eq. 8-17:
1
PWomin) + SWanin)
_
1
0.48 ps + 3.76 ps
236 kHz
Practice Problems 8-5.1 Calculate the turn-on time and turn-off time for a transistor with tq =10ns,t, = 12ns,t, = 15 ns, and tf; = 12 ns. Also determine the time
from the beginning of a 100 ns input pulse to the end of the BJT on time. 85. 2 The upper cutoff frequency for a switching circuit (as in Fig. 8-18) is measured as 1.7 MHz. Calculate the rise time of the output when a pulse with negligible rise time is applied as input. 8-5.3 A direct-coupled switching circuit using a 2N3904 BJT has a 12 kO base resistance and a 350 {) source resistance. Determine a suitable speedup capacitor value. Calculate the minimum input pulse width and space width that should be used with the circuit.
8-6 TRANSISTOR
CIRCUIT NOISE
Unwanted signals at the output of an electronics system are termed noise. The noise amplitude may be large enough to severely distort or completely swamp the wanted signals. Conse-
A *°7
+ SSS
quently, the noise level dictates the minimum
signal amplitude that can be handled. Noise originates as atmospheric noise from outside the system and as circuit noise generated within resistors and devices. Consider a conductive material at room tem-
_ bo en AAA f Figoreé-24 Noleswoleaues
perature (Fig. 8-21). The motion of free electrons
are generated within a re-
drifting around in the material constitutes a flow of many tiny random electric currents.
sistor by random movements of electrons.
328
Electronic Devices and Circuits
These currents cause minute voltage drops, which appear across the ends (or terminals) of the material. Because the number of free electrons available and the random motion of the electrons both increase as temperature rises, the generated voltage amplitude is proportional to temperature. This unwanted, randomly varying voltage is termed thermal noise. Thermal noise is generated in resistors, and when the resistors are at the input stage of an amplifier, the noise is amplified and produced as an output. Noise from other resistors is not amplified as much as that from the resistors right at the input; consequently, only the input stage resistors need be considered in noise calculations. Noise is also generated within a transistor, and like
resistors, the input stage transistor of an amplifier is the most
important
because its noise is amplified more than that from any other stage. Because thermal noise is an alternating quantity, its rms output level from
any amplifier is dependent upon the bandwidth of the amplifier. It can be shown that the rms noise voltage generated in a resistance is
e, =V4kTBR
where
(8-18)
k = Boltzmann’s constant = 1.374 x 10°" J/K (i.e., joules per degree K)
T = absolute temperature (K) R = resistance (Q)
B = circuit bandwidth
(a) Common-emitter amplifier circuit
(b) Equivalent noise input circuit
Thermal noise at the input of an amplifier depends upon the Figure 8-22 equivalent resistance of the bias and signal source resistances.
In the circuit shown in Fig. 8-22a, R; and R2 are the bias resistors and ¢, is a signal voltage with source resistance rs. The total noise-generating resis-
tance (Rc) in parallel with the amplifier input terminal is
Rg = re||RillRo
(8-19)
Chapter 8
BUT Specifications and Performance
329
In the noise equivalent circuit (Fig. 8-22b), e, is the noise voltage generated
by Re. If the device input resistance is Rj, then the noise voltage is divided: soit Bisel
Rac Rj + Re
If the amplifier voltage gain is A,, the output noise due to Rg is no = Aveni
21)
With a circuit collector resistance Rc and load resistance R,, the noise output
power produced by Rg is 2 P=
Daal
(8-22)
eno
on
\|Ry
To specify the amount of noise generated by a transistor, manufacturers usually quote a noise figure. To arrive at this figure, the transistor noise output is measured under specified bias conditions and with a specified source resistance, temperature, and noise bandwidth. The noise figure defines the
amount of noise added by the transistor to the noise generated by the specified resistance (Rc) at the input. Recall that Rg is the combined bias and signal source resistances, as seen from the amplifier input.
Noise Characteristics (2N4104) Test conditions
Parameter
Veg = 5 V, Ic = 30 pA,
Rg = 10k, f= 10 Hz
Veg = 5V, Ic = 30 pA, NE Spot noise figure
Max
15 dB
0, f = 100 Hz Rg == 10k0,f
4 dB
Veg =5V, Ic =5 pA, Rg = 50kQ, f = 1 kHz
1dB
Veg
1dB
=5 Vi
Ic
=
5 pA,
Rg = 50 kO, f = 10 kHz
Figure 8-23
Min
Data sheet specification of noise characteristics for a 2N4104 transistor.
330
Electronic Devices and Circuits
The section of data sheet in Fig. 8-23 specifies spot noise figures for a 2N4104
transistor. This means that the noise has been measured for a bandwidth of 1 Hz. The bias conditions are listed because the transistor noise can be affected by Vcg and Ic. Note that the specified Ic levels are very low (5 1A to 30 1A),
because transistor noise increases with increasing current levels.
The noise factor (F) is the total circuit noise power output divided by noise
output power from the source resistor.
Be Po
(8-23)
Pac
The noise figure (NF) is the decibel value of F:
NF=10log,, F
(8-24)
Ideally, a transistor would add no noise to the circuit, and its noise figure would be zero. Obviously, the smallest possible transistor noise figure is the
most desirable. If the circuit in which the transistor is employed does not have the source resistance and the bias conditions specified, the specified noise figure does not apply. In this case the noise figures can still be used to compare transistors, but for accurate estimations of noise, a new measurement
of the noise
figure must be made. From Eq. 8-23, the total noise output power due to Rc and the input transistor is Pus
=F
XK Pag
(8-25)
Example 8-9 Calculate the noise output voltage for the amplifier
in Fig. 8-24 if the
transistor is completely noiseless. The circuit voltage gain is 600, the base
input resistance is 3 kQ, and the cutoff frequencies are f, = 100 Hz and fo = 40 kHz. The circuit temperature is 25°C.
Figure 8-24
Circuit for Examples
8-9 and 8-10.
Chapter 8 = BUT Specifications and Performance 331
Solution
Eq. 8-19:
Rg = rs||Ri||Ro = 30 kQ||30 kO||30 ka = 10k0 T = 25°C = (273 + 25) K = 298 K (degrees Kelvin)
B= fy — f, = 40 kHz — 100 Hz = 39.9 kHz Eq. 8-18:
€, = VAKTBR
= V4 Xx 137 x 10773 x 298 x 39.9 kHz X 10kO = 2.6 pV
Eq. 8-20:
4
R; Kk —— 1
=e,
= 9;
3kO —__
eri = On X RR, = ORV X BE + 10K = 0.59 pV
Eq. 8-21:
Eno = Ay eni = 600 X 0.59 LV
= 354 nV Example 8-10 The circuit in Ex. 8-9 uses a 2N4104 transistor with the following bias conditions: Ic = 30 pA and Vcg = 5 V. Calculate the total noise output voltage for
the amplifier. Solution From Fig. 8-23,
NE = 4 dB
F =antilog ( ~
From Eq. 8-24,
10
= antilog (
225
(°C)
Te Figure 8-27
Power derating graph for 2N3055 transistor.
Plot point B at Pp = 0 and T = 197°C. Draw the power derating graph through points A and B. From the graph, at T = 100°C,
Pp = 65 W
Maximum
Power Dissipation Curve
When the maximum power that may be dissipated ina transistor is determined, the maximum Ic level may be calculated for any given V cg, or vice versa. The
corresponding voltage and current levels may be more easily determined by drawing a maximum power dissipation curve on the transistor output characteris-
tics. To draw this curve, the greatest power that may be dissipated at the operat-
ing temperature is first calculated. Then, the corresponding collector current levels for the maximum power dissipation are calculated, using convenient
collector-emitter voltages. The curve on the device characteristics is plotted, using these current and voltage levels. Example 8-13 demonstrates the process.
Chapter 8
BUT Specifications and Performance
335
The transistor voltage and current conditions must at all times be mainta ined
in the portion of the characteristics below the maximum power dissipation curve. This means, for example, that all point on load lines must be below the curve.
Example 8-13 Draw
a maximum
power
dissipation curve for Pp = 80 W
on the Ic/ Vcr
characteristics in Fig. 8-28. (A) 10
0
0
10
20
30
40
50
60
Veg Figure 8-28 Transistor maximum power dissipation curve drawn on the Ic/Vce characteristics.
Solution
When en Vcz "CE = 60V, , TL
=
eee C "Vee (60V =
OO
Os
=13A
Plot point 1 on the characteristics at VcE
=60V
80 W
When Vcg = 40 V,
le = Foy
When Vcr = 20V,
80 W Ic = DOV
and
724
Ic =13A
(point 2)
. 4A (point 3)
(V)
336
Electronic Devices and Circuits
When Vcg = 10V,
Ic =
80 W = 8A 10V
(point 4)
Draw the maximum power dissipation curve through the points on the graph. a sk
edznis
with Ppvsc)= 310 mw
‘ ad the device maximum power dissipation at 7
v, deen
he four suitable points for drawing
"the maximum power. dissipation curve for the transistor in the above problem when Te; = 75°C.
8-8 HEAT SINKING When power is dissipated in a transistor, the heat generated must flow from
the collector-base junction to the case and then to the surrounding atmosphere. When only a very small amount of power is involved, as in a small-signal transistor, the surface area of the transistor case is normally large enough to allow all of the heat to escape. For the large power dissipations that can occur in high-power transistors, the transistor surface area is not large enough. Heat sinks must be used to increase the area in contact with the atmosphere. For small transistors, the clip-on star-type heat sinks illustrated in Fig. 8-29a may be used. For higher-power transistors, sheet-metal and aluminum-extrusion heat sinks are available, as illustrated
in Figs 8-29b and c.
(a) Clip-on type heat sink with TO-18 transistor enclosure
(b) Sheet-metal heat sink with TO-220 transistor
Figure 8-29
Heat sinks
are used to conduct heat from a transistor case so that the device will not
overheat when power is (c) Aluminum extrusion heat sink with TO-3 transistor
dissipated.
Chapter8
BUT Specifications and Performance
337
Figure 8-30a shows the cross-section of a high-power transistor fastened to a heat sink. The heat generated at the collector-base junction must flow from the junction to the transistor case, then from the case to the heat sink, :
Junction
+
+
7
Case
+
/
Collector-base junction Mica gasket
T;—-Ta
Te—Ts
_ :
Transistor ame
. Heat sink 6
Ts—Ta
. (a) Transistor and heat sink
Shs
SA
~
Air
(b) Thermal resistance circuit
Figure 8-30 The thermal resistances between the collector-base junction of a transistor and the air surrounding the transistor heat sink constitute a series thermal circuit. The thermal equivalent of Ohm’s law may be applied for circuit analysis.
and finally from the heat sink to the surrounding air. In many cases, a mica gasket is inserted between the transistor case and the heat sink for electrical insulation (see Fig. 8-30a). Each part of the path that the heat must pass
through has a thermal resistance. These are: 6;-—junction-to-case thermal resistance @cs—case-to-sink thermal resistance @sa—sink-to-air thermal resistance
Figure 8-30b shows the thermal equivalent circuit for the transistor and heat
sink. This consists of the three thermal resistances connected in series. The size of heat sink required for a transistor with a given power dissipation may be determined from the thermal equivalent circuit. The temperature difference between the transistor collector-base junction
and the air surrounding the heat sink (Tj — T,) causes the dissipated power
(Q) to flow through each of the thermal resistances in turn. The thermal resistance series circuit is analogous to an electrical series resistive circuit. The
power flow in the thermal circuit is similar to the current flow in the electrical circuit. Also, the temperature drop across each thermal resistance is analogous to the voltage drop across each electrical resistance (see Fig. 8-30b). Ohm’s law may be applied toa thermal series circuit exactly as in the case of
an electrical series circuit.
338
Electronic Devices and Circuits
For an electrical series resistive circuit,
= E/R or
voltage difference
current flow = ————_____—— total resistance For a series thermal resistance circuit,
P
ower flow
=
temperature difference total thermal resistance
aT
or
ope oh jc
(8-27)
+ O0cs + Osa
When the temperatures are in degrees Celsius (°C) and the thermal resistances are in degrees Celsius per watt (°C/W), Q is the power dissipated in watts (W).
The value of 0c depends upon the transistor case style, and it is usually specified on the data sheet. See the excerpt from a 2N3055 data sheet in Fig. 8-31. 8cs is dependent on the transistor case and on the mechanical contact between the case and the heat sink. The contact may be dry, have a layer of heatconducting compound, or have an insulating gasket. Table 8-1 shows typical cs values for three case styles and three contact conditions. 6s, is determined
by the size and style of the heat sink (see Table 8-2 and Appendix A-10). Thermal Characteristic (2N3055) Characteristic
Junction-to-case thermal resistance
Ic
Max
Unit
1.52
°C/W
Figure 8-31 Section of 2N3055 data sheet showing the transistor junction-to-case thermal resistance.
Table 8-1
Typical Case-to-sink Thermal Resistances for Various Mechanical
Connections
|
Acs (°C/W)
8cs (°C/W)
Transistor = .Case
Dry
TO-220
1.2
0.7
1.0
TO-3
0.6
0.4
0.5
TO-66
1.5
0.5
23
Metal-to-Metal With Compound
With Mica Insulator and Compound
Chapter 8
Table 8-2
BUT Specifications and Performance
339
Typical Sink-to-air Thermal Resistances for Various Heat Sinks
“aa Heat Sink Style
sige __Wakefield Transistor Case _ Heat Sink Type
Star-type clip-on
_
Natural Convection Osa Osa
TO-18
201
65°C/W
65°C @1 W
Sheet metal with fins
TO-220
289
25°C/W
50°C @2 W
Aluminum extrusion
TO-3
401
2/°CIW
80°C @ 30 W
=
a
”
403
1.8°C/W
55°C @ 30 W
id
o
”
421
1.2°C/W
58°C @ 50 W
it
#
”
423
0.94°C/W
47°C @50 W
i
2
”
44]
0.59°C/W
47°C @ 80 W
ve
.
“
621
5°C/W
75°C @15W
Equation 8-27 may be used to calculate 4s, when all other quantities are known. The smallest heat sink with a thermal resistance equal to or lower than the calculated value is then selected. Alternatively, when a given heat
sink is used, Eq. 8-27 may be applied to calculate the transistor junction temperature.
Another method used to specify heat sink thermal resistances is shown in
Table 8-2. For the Wakefield 621 heat sink, Os, is listed as 75°C at 15 W
for
natural convection. This means that the maximum temperature difference between the case and the surrounding air will be 75°C when the heat sink is dissipating 15 W. This can be redefined as _ dok
"8A ~ 15 W
= 5°C/W
Example 8-14 A transistor with
Vcg = 20 V and Ic = 1 A has a 1°C/W
thermal resistance. The TO-3 case is fastened directly conducting compound is used. Calculate the thermal sink that will keep the maximum junction temperature bient temperature is 25°C. Select a suitable heat sink
junction-to-case
to the heat sink, and resistance for a heat at 90°C when the amfrom Appendix A-10.
Solution Q=Vcgle =20VX1A = 20 W From Table 8-1, @cs = 0.4°C/W From Eq. 8-27,
Osa =
Ty — Ta a
(TO-3 case, direct contact with compound)
— (Ac + 4s)
340
Electronic Devices and Circuits
25°C _ 90=°C 20 W
~ (1°C/W + 0.4°C/W)
= 1.85°C/W
From Table 8-2 (and Appendix A-10), the 403, 421, 423, and 441 all have 65, less than 1.85°C/W for natural convection. Select the smallest and least expensive of the three—the 403.
Practice Problems 8-8.1
A 2N6121 transistor (see Appendix A-9) is fastened to a heat sink with
the use of a mica insulator and compound. Calculate the thermal resistance of a suitable heat sink if the device is to dissipate 10 W and the maximum junction temperature temperature is 25°C.
is to be 100°C.
The
ambient
8-8.2 A TO-3 style transistor with Tymay = 140°C and 6jc = 0.6°C/W is fastened
dry
to a heat
sink
with
a Oc, = 1.3°C/W.
Determine
the
maximum power that may be dissipated when T, = 40°C.
Review Questions Section 8-1 8-1 Define the following BJT quantities listed on a device data sheet: Vcno, Vcro. Vepo, and Vc£(sat)8-2 Define the following BJT quantities: Ic, Icgo, Ico, Mre, and hye. Section 8-2
8-3
Write the equations for determining power gains and power level changes in decibels (a) when
8-4
two power levels are measured
and
(b) when
two voltage
levels are measured. Sketch a typical frequency response graph for an amplifier, and identify the upper and lower cutoff frequencies and the bandwidth. Briefly explain.
Section 8-3 8-5
Define fue, fab, and ft for a BJT. Briefly explain.
8-6
Explain CB and CE junction capacitances, and identify the quantities that determine junction capacitance values.
8-7
Describe the Miller effect, and derive an equation for the input capacitance of
an inverting amplifier. Section 8-4 8-8
Identify the quantities that cause the gain of an amplifier to fall off at low frequencies. Briefly explain.
8-9
Discuss
the quantities that cause
frequencies.
the gain of an amplifier
to fall off at high
Chapter 8
BUT Specifications and Performance
341
Section 8-5 8-10
Sketch the waveforms of input and output currents for a switching transistor. Show the various switching times involved and explain the origin of each.
8-11
Draw the diagram of a direct-coupled BJT switching circuit using a speed-up capacitor. Explain how the capacitor affects the device switching times, and discuss the limits of input pulse width and space width that can be used with the circuit,
Section 8-6 8-12
Explain thermal noise, and discuss the effect of resistor noise at the input of a
transistor. Define noise figure and noise factor for a transistor.
Section 8-7 8-13 8-14
Sketch a typical power-temperature derating graph for a transistor. Briefly explain. Describe how a transistor maximum power dissipation graph may be drawn on the Ic/ Vcr characteristics.
Section 8-8 8-15
Sketch the cross-section of a power transistor and heat sink. Label the thermal resistances in the power dissipation path.
8-16
Write the equation thermal resistance.
e at ret egrets ities 85 NOMB
Draw the thermal resistance equivalent circuit for a transistor and heat sink. relating power
dissipation, temperature difference, and
Problems Section 8-1 8-1
From Appendix A-9, determine the following quantities for a 2N6125 transistor: maximum
Vcg, maximum
collector current, maximum
Vee, HEE max), and
hrg(min) atIc = 1.5A.
8-2
From the 2N3055 data sheet A-8 in Appendix A, determine the following quantities: maximum collector-base voltage, maximum collector current, maximum emitter-base voltage, hpg minimum, and /ipg maximum at Ic = 4A.
Section 8-2
8-3
The output power from an amplifier is 100 mW when the signal frequency is 1 kHz. When the signal frequency is increased to 25 kHz, the output power falls to 75.mW. Calculate the decibel change in output power.
8-4
8-5
Calculate the power gain for an amplifier resistances when v; = 100 mV and v, = 3 V.
with
equal
input
and
load
The output voltage of an amplifier is 2 V when the signal frequency is 1 kHz. Calculate the new output voltage when it has fallen by 4 dB.
342
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Section 8-3 8-6 The input capacitance of a CE circuit is measured
as 800
pF.
The
circuit
has Rc = 7 kQ, and the device has the following parameters: Mj. = 60 and hie = 1.5 kQ. If the base-emitter capacitance is 15 pF, calculate the collector8-7
8-8
base capacitance. A transistor with hj = 100, hie = 2.2 kN, Ca, = 3 pF, Ic = 1.2 mA, and fr; = 4 MHz is connected as a CE amplifier with Re||Ri = 6.8 kQ. Calculate the amplifier input capacitance.
= Calculate the new value of Ci, for the amplifier in Problem 8-7 when a 100 pF capacitor is connected (a) between emitter and base and (b) between collector and base.
8-9
For acommon
emitter amplifier, A, = 50, Cin = 414 pF, and C,. = 8 pF. Calcu-
late the base-emitter capacitance.
Section 8-4 8-10
The circuit in Problem 8-7 uses voltage-divider bias with R; = 56 kf) and Rz = 15 kO. The signal source resistance is 3.3 k. Calculate the input-capaci-
8-11 8-12
tance-limited upper cutoff frequency for the circuit. Repeat Problem 8-10 for the circuit connected to function as a CB amplifier. A voltage-divider bias circuit (as in Fig. 8-24) has the following components: R, = 68 kQ, R2 = 47 kQ, Rc = 5.6 kO, Re = 4.7 kQ.. The supply voltage is 12 V,
8-13 8-14
and the transistor has ff = 35 MHz and C,, = 3.5 pF. Calculate the input-capacitance-limited upper cutoff frequency when the circuit is connected as a CE amplifier with Rg bypassed. The signal source resistance is 1.5 k{. Repeat Problem 8-12 for the circuit employed as a CB amplifier with the transistor base bypassed to ground. The circuit in Problem 8-12 is modified to function as an emitter follower with Rc shorted and the output taken from the emitter. Determine capacitance-limited upper cutoff frequency for the circuit.
8-15
the
input-
A transistor employed in an amplifier has My. = 75 and f4, = 12 MHz. The collector load is Re|| Ri = 20 kO, and there is 100 pF stray capacitance at the out-
8-16
put. Determine the stray-capacitance-limited upper 3 dB frequency. Atransistor amplifier with Re|| R, equal to 15kO hasa75 kHz upper 3 dB frequency. Assuming that f; is determined by the stray capacitance at the transistor collector
terminal, calculate the value of the stray capacitance.
Section 8-5 8-17
Determine the turn-on and turn-off times for a switching circuit with a 2N3251
transistor (see Appendix A-7). 8-18
If the circuit in Problem 8-17 has a 2 kHz square wave input at the transistor base, calculate the time from the instant that the collector current first reaches 90°» of its
maximum level until it falls to 10% of maximum. 8-19
A switching circuit is to be turned on and off by a 1 MHz
square wave input.
The output rise and fall times are not to exceed 10% of the transistor o/! time.
Determine the maximum value for f, and f;.
Chapter 8
BUT Specifications and Performance
343
—__—
8-20
A direct-coupled
switching circuit in which Rp = 4.7 kQ uses a BJT with
ton = 150 ns. The signal source resistance is Rs = 400 . Determine a suitable
value of speed-up quency.
8-21
capacitor, and
calculate the maximum
pulse input fre-
Determine a suitable value of speed-up capacitor for the BJT switching circuit in Fig. 5-56. Assume that the signal source resistance is 500 and that the transistor has ton = 200 ns. Calculate the minimum input pulse width that can be used with the circuit.
Section 8-6
8-22
An amplifier with a 2N4104 input transistor (see Fig. 8-23) has 3 dB points at 2 kHz and 10 kHz, respectively. The transistor bias conditions are: Vcg = 5 V and
Ic = 5 pA; the amplifier voltage gain is 40. Calculate the noise output voltage at 25°C if Rc = 50 kO and R; = 10 kQ. 8-23
A transistor amplifier where A, = 100, B = 15 kHz, and Rj = 12 kQ has input
bias resistors equivalent to Rg = 33 k©. If the maximum noise voltage at the output is not to exceed 100 ,V, determine the largest tolerable noise figure for the input transistor. 8-24
An amplifier with B = 10 kHz, Rg = 5 kQ, and Rj = 3.3 kO has a maximum
output noise of 150 1V. Assuming that the transistor is noiseless, determine the amplifier voltage gain. Section 8-7 8-25 Calculate the maximum ambient temperature for a transistor with a 200 mW
power dissipation if Ppy2sec) = 310 mW and D = 2.81 mW/°C. 8-26
The device in Problem 8-25 is to be operated at 80°C maximum ambient with a 5 mA collector current. Determine the maximum
8-27
Vc¢ level that may be used.
Referring to Appendix A-9, draw a power derating graph for a 2N6121 transistor and determine the maximum power dissipation at a case temperature of
8-28 8-29
7°C. Calculate the maximum case temperature for a 2N3251 transistor when its power dissipation is 0.25 W. A2N3055 transistor is to be operated at a maximum case temperature of 125°C. Construct a suitable Ic/Vcg graph, and draw the maximum power dissipation
curve for the device at this temperature. 8-30
For the Pp = 80 W maximum power dissipation curve in Fig. 8-28, draw the de
load line for the smallest possible value of Rc when the circuit supply voltage is 50 V. Determine the value of Rc(min).
Section 8-8
8-31
A 2N3055 transistor has a Vcg of 10 V and an Ic of 500 mA. The case temperature is not to exceed 30°C when the ambient temperature is 25°C. The device is
fastened to a heat sink by means of a mica gasket and compound. Calculate the maximum
sink-to-air thermal resistance for a suitable heat sink.
Electronic Devices and Circuits
8-32
A 2N3055 transistor dissipating 9 W is directly fastened to a NC403 heat sink by means
of compound
(see Appendix A-10). If the ambient
temperature is
25°C, calculate the transistor case temperature and junction temperature.
8-33
A 2N4900 transistor has a specified maximum power dissipation of 25 W ata
case temperature of 25°C, and a derating factor of 0.143 W/°C. If the transistor is to dissipate 20 W, determine its maximum
case temperature and calculate
the maximum sink-to-air thermal resistance for a suitable heat sink. Assume
that the TO-66 case is directly connected to the heat sink with compound. 8-34
A TO-220 case style transistor with a Vcg of 30 V and an Ic of 500 mA is fastened to a heat sink with a mica gasket and compound.
mum
Calculate the maxi-
sink-to-air thermal resistance for a suitable heat sink if the transistor
maximum junction temperature is 150°C and the junction-to-case thermal resistance is 2.7°C/W.
Practice Problem Answers 8-1.1 8-2.1 8-3.1 8-4.1 8-4.2 8-5.1 8-5.2 8-5.3 8-6.1 8-6.2 8-7.1 8-7.2 8-8.1 8-8.2
90, 100, 40 V, 5 V,6 dB —12 dB 4.86 nF 191 kHz 49.7 pF 22 ns, 27 ns, 127 ns
206 ns 200 pF, 0.35 ys, 12 ps
2.14mV 4.28 mV (310 mW, 25°C), (0, 135°C) (40 V, 4.24 mA), (30 V, 5.65 mA), (20 V, 8.48 mA), (10 V, 16.95 mA) 3.38°C/W 40 W
CHAPTERS Field Effect Transistors Objectives
You will be able to:
1 Explain the operation of nchannel and p-channel junction field effect transistors (JFETs). Draw typical JFET
characteristics. Identify the
regions of the characteristics and all important current and voltage levels. For JFETs, define saturation current, pinch-off voltage, forward transfer admittance,
output admittance, and drainsource on resistance. Determine JFET parameter
values from manufacturers’
data sheets. From the data sheet information, draw the maximum and minimum
transfer characteristics for any given JFET type number. 6 Solve problems involving JFET characteristics and parameters.
7 Show how a JFET can be used
for voltage amplification and for switching. 8 Explain the operation of enhancement-mode and depletion-enhancement-mode MOSFETs.
Draw typical drain and transfer characteristics for MOSFETs, and discuss the differences between MOSFETs and JFETs. 10 Solve problems involving MOSFET characteristics and parameters.
11 Explain the operation of
VMOSFETs, sketch typical characteristics, and discuss the advantages of VMOS. 12 Sketch circuit symbols for JFETs, MOSFETs, and VFETs.
Identify all terminals, current directions, and voltage polarities.
INTRODUCTION A field effect transistor (FET) is a voltage-operated device that can be used in amplifiers and switching circuits, similar to a bipolar transistor. Unlike a BJT, a FET requires virtually no input current. This gives it an extremely high input resistance, which is its most important advantage over a BJT. There are
two major categories of field effect transistors: junction FETs and MOSFETs.
These are further subdivided into p-channel and n-channel devices.
346
Electronic Devices and Circuits
9-1
JUNCTION FIELD EFFECT TRANSISTORS
n-Channel JFET The operating principle of an n-channel junction field effect transistor (JFET) is illustrated by the block representation in Fig. 9-1a. A piece of n-type semiconductor material, referred to as the channel, is sandwiched between two smaller pieces of p-type (the gates). The ends of the channel are designated the drain (D) and the source (S), and the two pieces of p-type material are connected together and their terminal is named the gate (G). With the gate left unconnected and a drain-source voltage (Vp) applied (positive at the drain, negative at the source), a drain current (Ip) flows, as
shown in Fig. 9-1a. When a gate-source voltage (Vcs) is applied with the gate negative with respect to the source (Fig. 9-1b), the gate-channel pn-junctions
are reverse biased. The channel is more lightly doped than the gate material, so the depletion regions penetrate deep into the channel. Because the depletion regions are regions depleted of charge carriers, they behave as insulators. The result is that the channel is narrowed, its resistance is increased, and Ip is reduced. When the negative gate-source bias voltage is further increased, the depletion regions meet
at the centre of the channel
(Fig. 9-1c), and Ip is cut off.
+Vp
Drain
oe
Drain (D)
+p
WiyPS
channel
tap
55
b
current
Depletion
£P. letion
regions
regions
meet \ Fi
.
Vv, GS
p-type 74
gates (G)
V Gs
Voss cst fe
Source (S)
(a) No gate-source
(b) Small negative gate-
Ip De) +~—_ Pinch-off region
8
24
0
0
Le
!
ft
}
|
|
|
!
6+
44
Vos = 0
|
|
fgg =
Ip
|
||
o Li
|
|| |
-—}-—_+—__+—_}+—__}+—__+—__ 12 14 8 10 6 4 2 Vos Vp
++ 16 18
(v)
f Breakdown
voltage Figure 9-8
Ip/Vps characteristic for an n-channel JFET with Vos = 0.
Chapter9 =
Field Effect Transistors
351
voltage drop along the channel. This results in some depletion penetration of the channel (as explained for Fig. 9-6), but it is so small that it has no signifi-
cant effect on the channel resistance. With further small increases in Vpg, the drain current increase is approximately linear and the channel behaves as an almost constant-value resistance (see Fig. 9-8).
The channel continues to behave as a fixed-value resistance until the voltage drops along it become large enough to produce considerable depletion region penetration. At this stage the channel resistance begins to be affected by the depletion regions. Further increases in Vps now produce smaller Ip increases, as shown by the curved part of the characteristic. The increased Ip
levels, in turn, cause more depletion region penetration and greater channel resistance. Eventually, a saturation level of Ip is reached where further Vps increase seems to have no effect on Ip.
At the point on the characteristic where Ip levels off, the drain current is referred to as the drain-source saturation current (Ipss) (10 mA in Fig. 9-8). The
shape of the depletion regions in the channel at the Ipss level is such that they appear to pinch off the channel (see Fig. 9-6). Thus, the drain source voltage at this point is termed the pinch-off voltage (Vp) (4.5 V in Fig. 9-8.) The region of th.
characteristic where Ip is constant is called the pinch-off region, as illustrated. The channel mostly behaves like a resistance between the points where Vps = 0 and Vps = Vp;so this part of the characteristic is referred to as the channel ohmic region. If Vps is continuously increased (in the pinch-off region), a voltage is
reached at which the (reverse-biased) gate-channel junctions break down (see Fig. 9-8). When this happens, Ip increases rapidly and the device may be destroyed. The pinch-off region of the characteristic is the normal operating region for the FET.
Drain Characteristics with External Bias A circuit for obtaining the Ip/Vps characteristics for an n--channel JFET when
an external gate-source bias (Vgs) is applied is shown in Fig. 9-9. In this case, Ves is set to a convenient (negative) level (such as —1 V). Vps is increased in steps, and
the corresponding level of Ip is noted at each Vps step. The Ip/Vps characteristic for a Veg of
—1 Vis then plotted, as illustrated in Fig. 9-10. When a —1 V external gate-source bias voltage is applied, the gate-channel junctions are reverse Vps = 0,
biased the
even
when
depletion
Ip = 0. So when
regions
are
already
Figure 9-9 Circuit for obtaining the Ip/Vps characteristic
penetrating to: some depth into the channel. Because of this, a smaller voltage drop along
for an n-channel junction field effect transistor with vadoustete-aenmes tins
the channel (smaller than when Ves = 0) will
voltages.
352
Electronic Devices and Circuits
increase the depletion regions to the point at which they produce channel pinch-off. Consequently, when Vcg = —1 V the pinch-off voltage is reached at a lower Ip level than when Vos = 0. The Ves = —1 V characteristic in Fig. 9-10 has Vp = 3.5 V. (mA)
Rt Ipss
—
10
Saturation
4] 4 Veogss0 | GS
- | |1
dens
| Liste
Vcgs = -1V
—-1V
it
|
|
|
|
1 |
|
Ip
|
'
eer
Ves
current for
7 :
ff
—__|
|
ei
| |
fy
|
—
|
) |
14
|
|| |
| te
16
18
1] | 0
a 0
2
4
6
8
Vp
10
12
Vps
14
(V)
Breakdown
:
voltage for
Pinch-off
Veg = -1V
voltage for Figure 9-10
[,/Vps characteristics for Ves = 0 and Ves = —1 for an n-channel! JFET.
A family of drain characteristics can be obtained by using several levels of negative gate-source bias voltage (see Fig. 9-11). If a positive Veg is used, a
higher level of Ip can be produced, as shown by the characteristic for Ves = +0.5
V. However,
Vcs is normally
kept
negative
to avoid
the
possibility of forward-biasing the gate-channel junctions. The dashed line from the zero point on the characteristics in Fig. 9-11
is
drawn through the points at which Ip saturates for each level of gatesource bias voltage. When Vcs=0, Ip saturates at Ipss, and_ the characteristic shows Vp = 4.5 V. When a —1 V external bias is applied, the
gate-channel junctions still require —4.5 V to achieve pinch-off. This means that a drop of 3.5 V instead of 4.5 V is now required along the channel, and the lower voltage drop is achieved with a lower Ip. Similarly,
when Ves = —2 V and —3 V, pinch-off is achieved with 2.5 V and 1.5 V, respectively, along the channel. The 2.5 V and 1.5 V drops are, of course,
obtained with further reduced Ip levels. Suppose a —4.5 V gate-source bias is applied to a device with the
characteristics shown in Fig. 9-11. This is a Vgs level equal to the pinch-
off voltage Vp. Without any additional channel voltage drop produced by Ip, the depletion regions penetrate so deep into the channel
that they
Chapter9
10 1.5 V3.5 25V45V Figure 9-11
V,
Field Effect Transistors
122
#144
«6
#18
353
(V)
iS
Family of Ip/Vps characteristics for an n-channel JFET
with various levels of Vgs.
meet in the middle, completely cutting Ip off. So, a gate-source bias equal to
the pinch-off voltage reduces Ip to zero. The bias voltage required to do this is termed the gate cutoff voltage (Vcsiorm), and, as explained,
Vesvoty = Ve.
Note in Fig. 9-11 that the drain-source voltage at which breakdown occurs is reduced as the negative gate-source bias voltage is increased. because — Vcs adds to the reverse bias at the junctions.
This
is
Example 9-1 Plot the Ip/ Vps characteristic for a JFET from the following table of values obtained with Vcs = 0. Determine Ipss and Vp from the characteristics.
Solution On Fig. 9-12, plot point 1 where Vps = 0 and Ip = 0.
Plot point 2 at Vps = 1 V and Ip = 3 mA, Vps = 9 V and Ip = 8 mA. and so on through Draw the drain characteristic for Vcs = 0 through points 1 to 10. From the characteristic, Ipsg = 8 mA and Vp = 3.75 V.
354
Electronic Devices and Circuits
(mA) 12 10
(V)
Figure 9-12
FET characteristics for Ex. 9-1.
Transfer Characteristics The transfer characteristics for an n-channel JFET are a plot of Ip versus Vs. The gate-source voltage of an FET controls the level of the drain current; so the transfer characteristic shows how Ip is controlled by Vcs. As illustrated
in Fig. 9-13a, the transfer characteristic extends from Ip = Ipss at Vcs = 0, to Ip = 0 at Ves = —Vos(orpFigure 9-13b shows a circuit for determining experimentally
a table of
quantities for plotting the transfer characteristic of a given FET. The drain-
-5 -4 -3 -2 -1
0
i
Ves(ott)
(a) Transfer characteristic Figure 9-13
(b) Circuit for determining
the transfer characteristic
The transfer characteristics for a FET are a plot of Ip versus Ves.
source voltage is maintained constant, Vcsis adjusted in convenient steps, and the corresponding levels of Vs and Ip are recorded.
Chapter 9
The
transfer
characteristic
for a FET
Field Effect Transistors
can be derived
from
355
the drain
characteristics. A line is drawn vertically on the drain characteristics to represent a constant Vps level. The corresponding Ip and Vgs values along this line
are noted
and
then
used
to plot the transfer
characteristic.
The
process is demonstrated in Ex. 9-2.
Example 9-2 Derive
the
transfer
characteristic
for
Vps=8
V
from
the
FET
drain
characteristics in Fig. 9-11. Solution
On Fig. 9-11, draw a vertical line at Vps = 8 V. From the intersection of the line and the char-
acteristics, read the following quantities:
On Fig. 9-14, plot point 1 at Vcg=0 Ip = 10 mA.
> 10
and
Plot point 2 at Ves = —1 V and
Ip = 7 mA, and so on through Ves = —4 V and Ip = 0.5 mA. Draw the transfer characteristic through these points.
p-Channel JFET Characteristics
Ves Figure 9-14 Transfer characteristics for Ex. 9-2.
Figure 9-15 shows a circuit for obtaining the
characteristics of a p-channel JFET. Note the direction of the arrowhead on the FET symbol, and the drain current direction. Note also the supply voltage polarity and the polarity of the gate-source bias voltage. The drain terminal is negative with respect to the source, and the gate
terminal is positive with respect to the source.
of quantities wefor plotting a To obtain a table . Sf
drain characteristic, Vcs is maintained constant
ee ining
Glroult fordeter-
the characteristics of
a p-channel JFET.
at the desired (positive) level, — Vps is increased in steps from zero, and the Ip levels are noted at each step.
Typical p-channel JFET drain characteristics and transfer characteristics are shown in Fig. 9-16. It is seen that these are similar to the characteristics for an
356
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Transfer characteristic 4
(mA)
Drain characteristics
wet
-Veg= =0.5-VSS
|
Figure 9-16
_
|
bs = 9
Transfer and drain characteristics for a p-channel JFET.
n-channel JFET, except for the voltage polarities. In Fig. 9-16, when
Vcs = 0,
Ipss = 15 mA, and progressively more positive levels of Vcs reduce |p toward cutoff Vesory) = +6 V. Using Ves of —0.5 V produces a higher Ip than when Vcs = 0. As in the case of the n-channel JFET, forward bias at the gate-channel
junctions should be avoided; consequently, negative Vcs levels are normally
not used with a p-channel JFET. The transfer characteristic for a p-channel device can be obtained experi-
mentally or can be derived from the drain characteristics, just as for an n-channel FET.
Practice Problem 9-2.1
The following table of Ip/Vps values for a FET was obtained with a Vcs
of 0. Plot the drain characteristic and determine Ipss and Vp. 10 ae }
12 SS
9-3 JFET DATA SHEETS AND PARAMETERS Maximum Ratings
Typical FET data sheets A-11 and A-12 are shown in Appendix A, and part of a FET data sheet is reproduced in Fig. 9-17. As with other device data sheets, a
device type number and brief description are usually given at the top. Maximum ratings follow, and then the electrical characteristics are stated for
Chapter9 _
FieldEffect Transistors
357
25457, 2N5458, 2N5459 (Silicon) ~ N-Channel FET Silicon N-channel junction field-effect transistors _ designed fot general-purpose audio and switching
applications. j
Bae
|
Maximum ratings
(TO-92)
omige
cinain andl ponte
Symbol | Value |
g
may be interchanged: Drain-source voltage
Drain-gate voltage | Reverse gate-source voltage | 2 Gate current ~
a?
Figure 9-17
‘2
if tA
‘
Unit
Vos
25
Vac
Vpc
25
Vac
Vegi)
25
Vite
Ig
10
mA
>
Part of data sheet for n-channel JFET.
specific bias conditions. From Fig. 9-17, the maximum drain-source voltage
(Vpg) for the 2N5457 to 2N5459 devices is 25 V, and the maximum drain-gate
urce voltage (Vpc) is also 25 V. This means, for example, that if a —5 V gate-so bias is used, the drain-source voltage should not exceed
Vos= Vpcimax) — Ves = 25V —5V =20V
is Note in Fig. 9-17 that the maximum reverse gate-source voltage (Vos) specified as 25 V. This is considerably greater than the (typically 5 V) maximum base-emitter reverse voltage for a BJT.
No maximum drain current is specified in Fig. 9-17, but this can be calcu-
ed lated from the maximum power dissipation and the Vps level. The specifi eel
ons gate current (Ic) is the maximum gate current if the gate-channel juncti
become forward biased. Saturation Current and Pinch-off Voltage
Voesiotf) The drain-source saturation current (Ipss) and the pinch-off voltage (Vp or
have already been discussed in Section 9-2. Values for these are listed in the excerpt from a JFET data sheet showing the ‘off characteristics’ and ‘on characteristics’ in Fig. 9-18. It can be seen that Vso for a 2N5457 (underline) ranges
from a minimum of —0.5 V to a maximum of —6 V. Also, the Ipss level for a
5 mA. 2N5457 (dashed underline) is a minimum of 1 mA and a maximum of
nana ORR Rees
Se
nyeeraslagte em 24:
The FET transfer characteristic approximately follows the equation:
Ip
=
Ipss
1
a
Ves 7 V cscoff)
(9-1)
358
Electronic Devices and Circuits 2N5457, 2N5458, 2N5459
Off Characteristics Characteristic
Symbol}
Gate-source cutoff voltage (Vps
=15V
dc, Ip
=
10 nA
Min
Typ
Max
Vegs(ofh)
Unit
Wale
dc)
2N5457
0.5 | —
2N5458
1.0
2N5459
—
2.0
=
60 ae
0
On Characteristics Zero gate voltage drain current (Vps
=15V
dc,
Vos
=
Ipss
mate
0)
2N5457
1.0
2N5459
4.0
2N5458
3.0
|
5.0__|
a9.0 | 16.0 ee
Figure 9-18 Gate-source cutoff voltage and drain-source saturation current specifications for n-channel JFETs.
When Ipss and Vegi) are known, a table of corresponding values of Ip and Vgs can be determined from Eq. 9-1. These may be used to construct the
FET transfer characteristic. Because of the wide range of specified values for Ipss and Vesiof, the transfer characteristic can differ substantially from one device to another one with the same type number. This creates a problem in FET bias circuits (see Chapter 10).
Example 9-3 Using the information provided on the data sheet (Fig. 9-18), construct the minimum and maximum transfer characteristics for a 2N5459 JFET. Solution
From Fig. 9-18,
Vos(ott) = —2 V (min), —8 V (max)
and
Ipss = 4 mA (min), 16 mA (max)
To construct the minimum
transfer characteristic, substitute Voes(otf(miny and
Ipss(min) into Eq. 9-1, together with convenient levels of Vs.
Eq. 9-1: For Vg = 0,
Ip = Ios Ip =4mA[I
-
Vos
i
Voes(off)
— (0/2 V) PF =4mA
Chapter 9
Field Effect Transistors
359
transfer characteristic on Fig. 9-19 at Ves = 0
Plot point 1 for the minimum and Ip = 4mA. For Ves = 0.25 Vesvors),
Ip = 2.25 mA:
point 2
For Ves = 0.5 Vescotf,
Ip = 1 mA:
point 3
For Ves = 0.75 Ves(ort,
Ip = 0.25 mA:
point 4
For Ves = Vascoff),
Ip = 0:
point 5
The minimum transfer characteristic is now drawn through points 1 to 5. For the maximum transfer characteristic, the above process is repeated using Ves(of = —8 V and Ipss = 16 mA.
ForVcs=0,
— (0/8 V)/? =16mA
Ip=16mA[l
Plot point 6 for the maximum transfer characteristic on Fig. 9-19 at Ves = 0 and
Ip
=
16mA.
For Ves = 0.25 Vescote),
Ip = 9 mA:
point 7
For Vos = 0.5. Vescorty,
Ip = 4mA:
point 8
For Ves = 0.75 Ves(otp,
Ip = 1 mA:
point 9
For Ves = Ves(off),
In = 0:
point 10
Draw the maximum transfer characteristic through points 6 to 10. (mA) tis 6 /
16
Ipss(max)
14
ee nm
Mem: MeAR
N
12
Figure 9-19 0
Maximum and mini-
mum transfer characteristic for a 2N5459 JFET constructed for
Ex. 9-3.
360
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Forward Transfer Admittance
The forward transfer admittance (Y¢.), which is also known as the trans conductance (gm Or grs), for a FET defines how the drain current is controlled by the gate-source voltage.
Y=
ManaGon in Ip
(when Vp. remains constant)
variation in Veg
Vis
ai
Ailip
(9-2)
AVcs|Vps
The units used for Y;, are microSiemens (wS), which can be restated as
microamps per volt (uA/V). MilliSiemens (mS), or milliamps/volt (mA/V) may also be used. For a FET with Y;, = 2 mA/V, Ip changes by 2 mA when
V¢z is al-
tered by 1 V. In the portion of a FET data sheet in Fig. 9-20, the Y;, units are ywmhos. The mho (ohm written backwards) is another (older) name for the Siemens, the unit of conductance. For the 2N5457 (underlined) the value of Vn
is specified as a minimum of 1000 wmhos, and a maximum of 5000 wmhos. An
inverted ohm symbol is also sometimes used instead of the Siemens symbol. 2N5457, 2N5458, 2N5459
Dynamic Characteristics Characteristic
Symbol}
Forward Transfer Admittance (Vps
= 15 V dc,
Vos
= 0, f=
Typ
Max
Ye
Unit
pavthos
1 kHz)
2N5457 2N5458 2N5459 Figure 9-20
Min
1000 1500 2000
3000 4000 4500
5000 5500 6000
JFET forward transfer admittance specification.
Because Y;, defines the relationship between Ip and Vgg, it can be determined from the slope of the FET transfer characteristic. This is demonstrated in Ex. 9-4 and illustrated in Fig. 9-21.
Example 9-4 Determine Y;, at Vcg = —1 V and Vgs = —4 V from the 2N5459 FET transfer
characteristic in Fig. 9-21. Solution At Ves
Eq. 9-2:
=
-1V,
y, - Alp _ 43mA AVee
125
= 3.4mA/V = 3400 pS
Chapter 9
Field Effect Transistors
361
(mA) 18
vey
4.3\mA
Yop
ay
R 4.7 MO
Using the FET universal transfer characteristic, determine Ip(max) and Vpgiminy for the voltage-
divider bias circuit in Fig. 10-48:
| Ip =
Solution
(EF
From data sheet A-11 in Appendix A, the 2N5458
RI / 5458
has Ipss(max) = 9 mA and Vos(otf(max) = 7 V.
:
Bq. 10-7:
: Ve=
X Rp Vpp
"GR ER,
Ry
X 1MO, 22V
=
1MQ
47M + 1MQ
=3.9V -
_
="
Figure 10-48
When Ves = 0, — Ves/Vescot) = 0
and
Voltage-divider
bias circuit for Ex. 10-13.
IpRs = Vo
Vo
39V
===
°°
ID = —
ace
Ipss_
7
=
27kO
=14mA
= 0.16
9mA
Plot point X on the universal transfer characteristic in Fig. 10-45 at Ip/Ipss = 0.16 When Ves/ Veso
= 0.5,
and
Ve¢s/Vesor) = 0
Ves = 0.5Ves(or) = 0.5 X (—7 V)
=-3.5V From Eq. 10-6,
IpRs = Ve — Ves = 3.9V — (-3.5 V) =74AV
so
_IpRs
Ip = Ip
:
Ipsg
74V
Rs
-O7KQ
2.7mA ss
9mA
|
2
mA
0.3
Plot point Y on the universal transfer characteristic where Ip/Ipss =03
and
Vos/Ves(ots)
= 0.5
Draw the voltage-divider bias line through points X and Y, and where the bias line intersects the universal transfer characteristic, read Ip/ Ipss
giving
=
0.29
Ip = 0.29Ipsg = 0.29 X 9mA = 2.61mA
Chapter 10
—
_FET Biasing
417
Vps = Vpp — Ip(Rp + Rs) = 22V — 2.61 mA(2.7 kQO + 2.7 kQ) =7.9V
i: Riokrsal ‘tasted Sqnin) for the circuit.
avackidugt
to determine Bias and
10-9:2, Using the FET ‘universal transfer characteristic, analyze the circuit in Visi 10-6:to ene ae
V;; Wee = =4. 5 V, and Rp = sc 7 kQ. Use the: FET universal
ens
a _ transfer characteristic to determine Ipimax) and. Vps(min)ae ae
ee
als
Sn
10-10 MOSFET BIASING DMOS Bias Circuits DMOS bias circuits are similar to JFET bias circuits. Any of the FET bias circuits already discussed can be used to produce a negative Vas level for an
n-channel MOSFET or a positive Vag for a p-channel device. In this case, both
devices would be operating in the depletion mode, just like JFETs. To operate an n-channel DMOS
in the enhancement mode, the gate terminal must be
made positive with respect to the source. A p-channel DMOS in the enhancement mode requires the gate to be negative with respect to the source. Consider the four MOSFET bias circuits shown in Fig. 10-49, and assume that each device has the transfer characteristics in Fig. 10-50. In Fig. 10-49a, the OVpp
Rp
:
(a) Zero gate bias
Figure 10-49
(b) Positive bias
Various DMOS bias circuits.
(c) Self-bias
(d) Voltage-divider bias
418
Electronic Devices and Circuits
gate-source bias voltage is zero, so the bias line is drawn vertically on the
transfer characteristics at Vcg = 0, as shown in Fig 10-50. The FET in Fig. 10-49b has a positive gate-source bias voltage; consequently, its bias line must be drawn vertically at Veg = +Vg. The self-bias circuit in Fig. 10-49c has its
bias line drawn from Ip = 0 and Vgg = 0 at a slope determined by Rs, exactly as for a JFET self-bias circuit. Similarly, the bias line for the voltage divider
bias circuit in Fig. 10-49d is drawn from the point where
Ip = 0 and
Vcs = +Vg with a slope set by Rs.
As always, Ipiminy and Ipimax) for any circuit are indicated by the bias line
intersections with the maximum
and minimum
transfer characteristics.
Figure 10-50 shows that in some cases the FET is operating in depletion mode,
and in other cases it is operating in enhancement mode. Analysis and design procedures for these circuits are essentially the same as for similar JFET bias circuits.
MOSFETs can also be used discussed in Section 10-8.
with
a plus/minus
supply
voltage,
as
(mA)
46 t | Biad line
for_
Maximum transfer
|
charact
Fig. 10-49a
391A.
Bias line for
jf
NY
Bias line for
A
|
Minimum tran ser characteristic
~
Fig. L0-49¢
~
[
Fig. 10-49b f4_.
/
ristic
|
yf
yh Ma
L
-6
SL
LT
(V) « -5
-4 _
/
aS
-3 —Ves
Ve
A409
Pe
-2
10-50
Na
Bias line|for
Fig. 10-49d
PS
-1
0
1
2
{
Vo Figure
| NY
3 + Vos
Vo
|
sac
Ps 4
P>—+ 5
(V) 6
—_—__—
Vo
DMOS transfer characteristics and bias lines for the circuits in Fig. 10-49.
EMOS Bias Circuits Enhancement MOSFETs (such as the VMOS and TMOS devices discussed in Section 9-5) must have positive gate-source bias voltages in the case of n-channel devices, and negative Vcs levels for ap-channel FET. Thus, the gate bias circuit in
Fig. 10-49b and the voltage-divider bias circuit in Fig. 10-49d are suitable for EMOS devices. In each case, the bias line is drawn exactly as already discussed.
g FET Biasiniy
ap ter 10 Chap
419
Vp
—
Example 10-14
a
the bias circuit in Determine Ip and Vps for the device has the Fig. 10-51, assuming that Fig. 10-52. transfer characteristic in
Ri 5.6 MQ
|!
Solution
:
_ Vpp X Ra _ 40V X 1MQ 56MO+1MO R,+R, G7
Ry 1MQ
= 6.06V ally on the transfer Draw the bias line vertic . = 6.06 V (see Fig. 10-52) characteristic at Vcs
line intersects From the point where the bias
= Figure 10-51
EMOS gate
bias circuit for Ex. 10-14
the transfer characteristic,
Ip =62
A
Q) 40V — (6.2mA X 4.7 = Rp Ip — p Vp = Vps =109V (A)
204 18-
8.6 A
|
0 6.7V Figure 10-52
s lines. racteristic and bia EMOS transfer cha
f+ (v)
420
Electronic Devices and Circuits
The drain-to-gate bias circuit shown in Fig. 10-53 is uniquely suitable for an
EMOSFET. The FET gate is directly connected to the drain terminal via resistor Rg, so that Ves = Vps. If the drain current is higher than the design level,
a higher voltage drop is produced across Rp. This tends to reduce Ves and thus reduce Ip back toward the design level. Similarly, a lower Ip than intended produces a lower IpRp voltage drop. This results in a higher Vcg, which drives Ip back up toward the desired current. Corresponding levels of Ip and Vgs can be calculated and plotted on the device transfer characteris-
tics to draw the circuit bias line. Vop
Example 10-15
2V
Analyze the bias circuit in Fig. 10-53 to determine the typical levels of Ip and Vpg. Figure 10-52 shows the typical transfer characteristic for the device.
3 DS
Solution When
Ves
ie
=
Vps
=
10 V,
Figure 10-53
Vpp — Vas _ 20V — 10V
a
Ry
EMOS
to-gate bias circuit.
150
drain-
=6.7A
Plot point A on Fig. 10-52 at Veg = 10 Vand Ip = 6.7A When
Ves
= 0,
_Vpp = Ves _ 20V — 0 Ip =
Rp
~
150
=13A Plot point B on Fig. 10-52 at Ves = 0 and Ip = 13 A. Draw the bias line for Rp = 1.5 0 through points A and B. Where the bias line intersects the transfer characteristics,
Ip=86A Vps
= Ves
and
Vgs=67V
=6.7V
Practice Problems
10-10.1 The MOSFET voltage-divider bias circuit in Fig. 10-49d has Vpp= 30 V, Roos 330. kO, Ro=
150 kQ, and Rp= Rs = 680 Q. The FET has
the transfer characteristics in Fig. 10-50. Analyze the circuit to deter-
mine Vpg(miny and Vps(max)-
10-10. 2 A drain-to-gate bias circuit, as in Fig. 10-53, has Vpp = 35 V, and a MOSFET with the transfer characteristics in Fig. 10-52. Calculate an approximate resistance for Rp to give Vps = 5 V.
__
Chapter 10
10-11
FET Biasing
421
BIASING FET SWITCHING CIRCUITS
JFET Switching A field-effect transistor in a switching circuit is normally in an off state with zero drain current, or in an on state with a very small drain-source voltage.
When the FET is off, there is a drain-source leakage current so small that it can almost always be neglected. When the device is on, the drain-source volt-
age drop depends on the channel resistance (7pgjo,)) and the drain current (Ip):
(10-20)
Voston) = Iptps(on)
Field-effect transistors designed specifically for switching applications have very low channel resistances. For example, the 2N4856 has rps(on) = 25 2 (see
data sheet A-12 in Appendix A). With low Ip levels, Vpsion) can be much smaller than the 0.2 V Vcxisat) typical for a BJT. This is an important advantage of a FET switch over a BJT switch.
Direct-Coupled JFET Switching Circuit A direct-coupled JFET switching circuit is shown in Fig. 10-54a, and the circuit waveforms are illustrated in Fig. 10-54b. When V; = 0, the FET gate and source voltages are equal, and there is no depletion region penetration into the channel. The output voltage is now V, = Vpsion), aS expressed by
Eq. 10-20. When Vj exceeds the FET gate-source cutoff voltage, the device is switched off, and the output voltage goes to Vpp, as illustrated.
|
tl lL
Vpp
:
s
Input
{to
_
Vi > Ves(ott)
| *
Vpp
—O
+
Rg V;
he 0
Qi)
4
Output > |
_
Y
D!Ds\on)
reo
Seas
(a) Direct-coupled JFET switch Figure 10-54
\
(b) Circuit waveforms
Direct-coupled JFET switching circuit and the waveform of
the circuit input and output voltages.
Assuming that Vpsion) is very small, the drain current level is determined
from the equation Vpp
as)
IpRp
(10-21)
422
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Equation 10-21 can be used to calculate Rp when Vpp and Ip are specified, or to calculate Ip when
Rp is known.
The Ip level can then be employed
to
determine Vpg(on). The lowest drain current that can be used must be very much greater than the drain-source leakage current specified for the device. To switch the FET off, V; should exceed the maximum gate-source cutoff
voltage. However, V; must not be so large that the drain-gate voltage (Vpg = Vpp + Vi) approaches the breakdown voltage. A rule of thumb is to select the off input voltage 1 V larger than Ves(otfmax)-
The gate resistor (Rg) in the circuit in Fig. 10-54 is provided solely to limit any gate current in the event that the gate-source junctions become forward-bi-
ased. The circuit might operate satisfactorily with an Rg of 1 MQ; however, high-value resistors can slow the switching speed of the circuit. Thus, much smaller resistance values are often used for Rc.
Example 10-16 Design the JFET switching circuit in Fig. 10-54 to have Vpsion) not greater
than 200 mV. A 2N4856 FET is to be used with a 12 V supply. Solution
From data sheet A-12 in Appendix A, rps(on) = 25 2. and Vesiory = 10 V (max) F
eae
Eg. 10-20, ek
Ip
_ Vpsen) _ 200 mV D
=
DS(on)
25 0
=8mA From Eq. 10-21,
Rp &
Vpp _ Ip
12V
= BMA
= 1.5 kO (standard value)
Eq. 10-22:
Vi = —(Vesctmax) + 1 V) = —(10 V + 1 V) =-11V
Capacitor-Coupled JFET Switching Circuits Two capacitor-coupled JFET switching circuits are shown in Fig. 10-55. The FET in Fig. 10-55a is normally on because it has Veg = 0, and the device in Fig. 10-55b is normally off with —Vgs greater than the pinch-off voltage. In both circuits, the FET is switched on or off by a capacitor-coupled input
pulse. The design procedure for these circuits uses the equations already discussed for the direct-coupled JFET switching circuit.
FET Biasing 423
Chapter 10
—_—_—— Vpp
Rp
Cc
|
OVpp
{to C
2)
oy
Y Ves
Rg
Rg O— Ve
(a) Normally-on circuit
Figure 10-55
(b) Normally-off circuit
Normally-on and normally-off capacitor-
coupled JFET switching circuits.
MOSFET Switching
Figure 10-56 shows two capacitor-coupled MOSFET switching circuits. In Fig. 10-56a, the FET is biased off because Vs = 0. A positive-going input
signal is required to turn the device on. The FET in Fig. 10-56b is biased on by the positive Vcg provided by the voltage divider (R; and R2). In this case,
a negative-going
input
voltage
must
be applied
to turn the FET
off.
Equations 10-20 and 10-21 can be applied to these circuits to calculate Ip and Vps(on). To set the device on to a desired level of drain current, the transfer characteristics can be employed for determining Ves if they are available.
Alternatively, Eq. 9-5 can be used to estimate the required gate-source bias voltage, as explained in Section 9-5. To ensure that the FET is off, the gatesource voltage must be driven below the minimum threshold voltage for the device.
Vos
(a) Normally-off circuit Figure
10-56
(b) Normally-on circuit
MOSFET normally-on and normally-off capaci-
tor-coupled switching circuits.
424
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Example 10-17 The MOSFET in the switching circuit in Fig. 10-56b is to be biased on to have the smallest possible Vps(on). Determine suitable resistances for R; and R3, and calculate Vpgion). The device has the transfer characteristics shown in Fig. 10-52, and its drain-source on resistance is 0.25 . Solution
From Eq. 10-21,
i
Vpp
_ 50V =F
=5A
From the transfer characteristics in Fig. 10-52, atIp =5A,
Vos ¥ 5.7 V
Select
Ro = 1MQ
FromEq.10-13,
R, = “= =
nay,
ene = cay si
= 7.7 MQ, (use 6.8 MO, to make Vcs > 5.7 V to ensure that the FET is biased on)
Eg. 10-20:
Vps(on) = Iprps(on) = 5 A X 0.25 0 =1.25V
Practice Problems
_
10-11.1 A normally-off JFET switching circuit, as in Fig. 10-55b, is to use a
2N4861 FET with a 30 V supply, and is to have an Ipgnax) of 10 mA.
Calculate Rp, Vps(ony, and the required Vc level. 10-11.2 The normally-off MOSFET switching circuit in Fig. 10-56a is to be
employed to pass 15 A through a 3 C0) resistor. The device used has the transfer characteristics shown in Fig. 10-52, and rps(on) = 0.2 0.
Calculate approximate levels for the supply and input voltages.
Review Questions Section 10-1 10-1 Identify the components that constitute the de load in a FET bias circuit. Explain the procedure for drawing the dc load line on the FET drain characteristics.
10-2
Explain the selection of a Q-point on a FET dc load line, and discuss the limitations on the output voltage swing.
Chapter 10 _- FET Biasing
-——
425
Section 10-2 10-3
Sketch a gate bias circuit using an n-channel JFET. Identify the polarities of Vpp,
Vos, Vc, and Ves. Show the Ip direction. Briefly explain the circuit operation.
10-4
Repeat Question 10-3 for a gate bias circuit using a p-channel JFET.
10-5
Write equations for Vpsimax) and Vpsimin) for a JFET gate bias circuit.
10-6
State a typical maximum resistance for gate resistor Rg in a gate bias circuit.
10-7
Briefly explain. Explain why the device maximum and minimum should be used in FET bias circuit analysis.
transfer characteristics
Section 10-3 10-8 Sketch a self-bias circuit using an n-channel JFET. Identify the polarities of Vpo; Vos, Vs, Vc, and Ves. Briefly explain the circuit operation. 10-9 Repeat Question 10-8 for a self-bias circuit using a p-channel JFET. 10-10 Write equations for Vps(max) and Vpsmin) for a FET self-bias circuit. Write the
equation used for drawing the circuit bias line on the transfer characteristics. Section 10-4.
|
10-11 Sketch a voltage-divider bias circuit using an n-channel JFET. Identify the po-
larities of Vpp, Vps, Vs, Vc, and Veg. Briefly explain the circuit operation. 10-12 Repeat Question 10-11 for a voltage-divider bias circuit using a p-channel JFET.
10-13 Write equations for Vpsimax) and Vpsimin) for a FET voltage-divider bias circuit.
Write the equation used for drawing the circuit bias line on the transfer characteristics. Section 10-5 10-14 Compare the performance of the three basic JFET bias circuits in terms of the differences between Ipimax) and Ipgmin) in each circuit and the predictability of circuit Q-points. Section
10-6
10-15 Briefly explain the procedure for testing a FET bias circuit. List common errors made when bias circuits are tested.
10-16 List possible errors in a JFET bias circuit with Vp ~ Vpp in the case of (a) gate bias; (b) self-bias, and (c) voltage-divider bias. 10-17 List possible errors in a JFET bias circuit with Vps~ 0 in the case of (a) gate bias,
(b) self-bias, and (c) voltage-divider bias.
Section 10-7 10-18 Write the equation for calculating Rp in a gate bias circuit. 10-19 Explain why the FET maximum drain characteristics should be used when designing a JFET bias circuit.
426
Electronic Devices and Circuits
10-20 Write the equation for calculating Rp and Rs in a JFET self-bias circuit. 10-21 Write the equation for determining Rp, Rs, Ri, and R2 ina JFET voltage-divider bias circuit.
Section 10-8 10-22 Sketch an n-channel JFET voltage-divider bias circuit using a plus/minus sup-
ply. Identify the polarities of Vpp, Vps, Vs, Vc, and Ves. Briefly explain the circuit operation.
10-23 Repeat Question 10-22 for a similar circuit using a p-channel JFET. 10-24
Sketch an n-channel JFET drain feedback bias circuit. Identify all voltage polar-
ities, and explain the circuit operation. 10-25 Repeat Question 10-24 for a drain feedback bias circuit using a p-channel JFET.
10-26 Sketch an n-channel JEET constant-currenf bias circuit using voltage-divider bias at the gate. Identify all voltage polarities and current directions, and explain the circuit operation.
10-27 Repeat Question 10-26 for a constant-current bias circuit using a p-channel JFET. 10-28 Sketch an n-channel JFET constant-current bias circuit using a plus/ minus
supply. Label all voltage polarities and current directions, and explain the circuit operation. 10-29 Repeat Question 10-28 for a constant-current bias circuit using a p-channel
JFET.
Section 10-9 10-30 Write the equation used for constructing a JFET universal transfer characteristic. Briefly explain the universal transfer characteristic and its application.
Section 10-10 10-31 Sketch n-channel DMOS gate bias circuits using (a) Vcs = 0, (b) Ves = +Ve. Identify all voltage polarities and current directions, and explain the operation of each circuit.
10-32 Draw the diagram of a self-bias circuit using an n-channel DMOS transistor. Show all voltage polarities and current directions, and explain the circuit operation.
10-33 Draw a voltage-divider bias circuit using an n-channel DMOSFET. Show all voltage polarities and current directions, and explain the circuit operation. 10-34 Sketch approximate maximum and minimum transfer characteristics for a DMOSFET. On the transfer characteristics, draw typical bias lines for the circuits in Questions 10-31 to 10-33. Briefly explain. 10-35 Draw a circuit diagram for a drain-to-gate bias circuit using an n-channel EMOSEFET. Explain the circuit operation. 10-36 Draw a circuit diagram for a drain-to-gate bias circuit using a p-channel EMOSFET. Explain.
Chapter 10
FET Biasing
427
Section 10-11 10-37 Sketch a circuit diagram for a direct-coupled switching circuit using an nchannel JFET. Sketch input and output waveforms, and explain the circuit
operation. 10-38 Draw circuit diagrams JFET switching circuits. 10-39 Sketch circuit diagrams switching circuits using
for normally-on and normally-off capacitor-coupled Explain the operation of each circuit. for normally-on and normally-off capacitor-coupled EMOSFETs. Explain the operation of each circuit.
Problems Section 10-1
10-1
The circuit in Fig. 10-57 has a JFET with the characteristics in Fig. 10-58. Draw the dc load line for the cir-
10-2
10-3
10-4 10-5
cuit, and select a suitable gate voltage to give the maximum possible symmetrical output voltage swing. Estimate the maximum possible symmetrical output voltage swing for the circuit in Problem 10-1 when Vg = -2V. A JFET circuit like the one in Fig. 10-57 is to have Vps = 10 Vand Ip = 2 mA. If Vpp = 18 V, draw the de load line on the drain characteristics in Fig. 10-58, and determine the required resistance for Rp. Using the drain characteristics in Fig. 10-58, draw the dc load line for the circuit in Fig. 10-59.
Figure 10-57
Determine the Ip and Vps levels for the circuit in Problem 10-4 if the gate-
source voltage is —1.5 V.
(mA)
Ves =0
2
4
6
8
10
12
14
16
18
20 22
(Vv)
Vos Figure 10-58
Figure 10-59
428
10-6
Electronic Devices and Circuits
A JFET circuit as in Fig. 10-57 has Rp = 4.7 kQ.. The
ce
bias conditions are to be Vps = 8 V and Ip = 1.5 mA.
Rp
Draw the dc load line on the drain characteristics in
3.3 kO
Fig. 10-58, and determine a suitable supply voltage.
Ip | e—O
Section 10-2 10-7 The gate bias circuit in Fig. 10-60 has a JFET with the transfer characteristics in Fig. 10-61. Analyze the circuit to calculate Vpg(maxy and Vps(min): 10-8 Repeat Problem 10-7 using Eq. 9-1 instead of the transfer characteristics.
Qi ” 1 MO »,
= iD Vv
Figure 10-60
(mA)
I
/\
ar
An A wv)
-6
-5
-4
-3
-2
-1
|
0
/
18
1
ees View
2
3
4
45
i
6
(v)
o> Figure 10-61
10-9
The JFET used in a gate bias circuit has the transfer characteristics in Fig. 10-61. If Rp = 2.2 kO, Vpp = 20 V, and Vg = —2 V, draw
the bias line and calculate
Vps(max) and Vps(min)10-10 Repeat Problem 10-9 using Eq. 10-8 instead of the transfer characteristics. 10-11 Analyze the circuit in Fig. 10-62 to determine Vpsimax) and Vps(min): Section 10-3 10-12 Determine the maximum and minimum levels of Vps for the JFET self-bias circuit in Fig. 10-63. Assume that the device has the transfer characteristics in Fig. 10-61.
_FET Biasing
Chapter 10
429
> Vp +25 V
Ry 3.3 MQ, O
fe Ry 1MO
Figure 10-62
Figure 10-63
Figure 10-64
10-13 AJFET self-bias circuit (as in Fig. 10-63) has Vpp = 30 V, Rp = 4.7 kQ, Rs = 8200, and Rg = 1 MQ. If the FET is a 2N5457, calculate the minimum level of Vps.
10-14 Recalculate Vpg(min) for the circuit in Problem 10-13 when the device is changed to a 2N5458.
Section 10-4 10-15 Assuming that the JFET in the voltage-divider bias circuit in Fig. 10-64 has the transfer characteristics in Fig. 10-61, determine the maximum and minimum Vpgs levels.
10-16 A JFET
Vpp = 20 V,
voltage-divider bias circuit (as in Fig. 10-64) has
Rp = Rs = 2.7kQ, R; = 7.7 MQ, and R2 = 1 MQ. Using the JFET transfer characteristics in Fig. 10-61, determine the maximum
and minimum
Vps levels.
10-17 A JFET with the transfer characteristics in Fig. 10-61 is connected in a voltagedivider bias circuit with Vpp = 22 V. The circuit components 3.9 kQ, Ri = 7.8 MQ,
and R2 = 1 MQ. Calculate Vps(max) and
are: Rp = Rs =
Vos min):
10-18 A 2N5457 JFET is used in a voltage-divider bias circuit with Vpp = 20 V. The circuit components are: Rp = 4.7 kQ, Rs = 3.9kQ, Ry = 1.2 MO, and R2 =300 kf. Determine Vpsmin):
Section 10-7
10-19 A JFET gate bias circuit is to have Ipmax) = 5.5 mA and Vpgimin) = 7 V. The supply voltage is 25 V, and the FET transfer characteristics are shown in Fig. 10-61.
Determine the required bias voltage and suitable resistor values. 10-20 Design a gate bias circuit using a 2N5457 JFET. The circuit is to. have Ipimax) = 45 mA and Vps(min) = 7-5 V, and the supply voltage is to be 20 V.
430
Electronic Devices and Circuits
10-21 A JFET self-bias circuit is to have Vpp = 25 V, Ip(max) = 2.5 mA, and Vpsmin) = 7 V. Using the FET transfer characteristics shown in Fig. 10-61, design the circuit.
10-22 Design a self-bias circuit using a 2N5457 JFET with Vpp = 20 V, Ip(max) = 2mA, and Vpsimin) = 7.5 V. 10-23
A JFET voltage-divider bias circuit is to have Vpp = 25 V, Ipymax) = 2.5 mA, and
Vps(min) = 7 V. Using the device transfer characteristics shown in Fig. 10-61, design the circuit.
10-24 Design a JFET voltage-divider bias circuit to have Vpp = 20 V, Ipqmax) = 2 mA,
and Vps(min) = 7.5 V. Use a 2N5457 JFET. 10-25 A JFET voltage-divider bias circuit is to have Vpp = 22 V, Ipimax) = 1.5 mA, and Vps¢min) = 9 V. Using the device transfer characteristics in Fig. 10-61, design the circuit.
10-26 A JFET with the device transfer characteristics in Fig. 10-61 is used in a voltagedivider bias circuit with Vpp = 20 V and Rp = 4.7 kQ.. Determine suitable val-
ues for R,, Rz, and Rg to maintain Ip within the limits of 1 mA to 1.3 mA. Section 10-8 10-27 Using the transfer characteristics in Fig. 10-61, design the circuit shown in Fig. 10-65. 10-28 Analyze the circuit designed for Problem 1027. to determine the levels of Vpsimax) and Vps¢nin)-
10-29 A JFET circuit like the one in Fig. 10-65 is to
have the following voltage and current levels: Vpp
=
20 V,
Vg
=
-10 V,
Ip(«max)
=1.5 mA,
and Vpg(nin) = 8 V. Design the circuit to use a 2N5458 JFET. Select suitable standard-value
resistors.
10-30 Analyze the circuit designed for Problem 1029 to determine Vpsmin).
Figure 10-65
10-31 Design the circuit shown in Fig. 10-66 using the JFET transfer characteristics in Fig. 10-37. Select suitable standard-value resistors.
10-32 Analyze the circuit designed for Problem 10-31 to determine Vps(min)-
Vpsimax) and
10-33 A JFET circuit like the one in Fig. 10-66 is to have the following voltage and current levels: Vpp = 22 V, Ip(max) = 1.5 mA, and Vps(min) = 9 V. Design the circuit to use a JFET with the transfer characteristics in Fig. 10-61. Select suitable standard-value resistors.
10-34 Analyze the circuit designed for Problem 10-33 to determine the maximum and minimum levels of Vps.
10-35 Design the JFET circuit shown in Fig. 10-67
Vpp +24 V
using the transfer characteristics in Fig. 10-61. Select suitable standard-value resistors.
Ip
10-36 Analyze the circuit designed for Problem 10-
> | 2.5 mA(max)
35 to determine all voltage and current levels. Section
431
FET Biasing
Chapter 10
oO
rr
10-9
3)
}
8 V(min)
10-37 Use the FET universal transfer characteristic in
Fig. 10-45 to determine Vpsimin) for the gate bias circuit in Fig. 10-62. 10-38 Use the FET universal transfer characteristic in Fig. 10-45 to determine Vpsimin) for the circuit
=
in Fig. 10-63. The actual device transfer characteristics are shown in Fig. 10-61. 10-39 Assuming that a 2N5458 JFET is connected in the voltage-divider bias circuit in Fig. 10-64, determine
Vpsimin)
using
the FET
universal
transfer characteristic in Fig. 10-45. Section 10-10 10-40 The MOSFET in the gate bias circuit in Fig. 10-68 has the transfer characteristics in Fig. 10-69. Draw
the bias line and calculate
Vps(max) and Vos min):
10-41 Using the transfer characteristics in Fig. 10-69, design the MOSFET gate bias circuit shown in Fig. 10-70. Select suitable standard-value resistors.
Figure 10-67
‘
10-42 Analyze the circuit designed for Problem 10-
Vien
41 to determine all voltage and current maxi-
Rp go 20V
mum and minimum levels.
1.5kO
10-43 Design the MOSFET voltage-divider bias circuit shown in Fig. 10-71 using the transfer characteristics in Fig. 10-69. Select suitable standard-value
| ——
resistors.
Ee)
10-44 Analyze the circuit designed for Problem 10-43 to determine all voltage and current maximum and minimum levels. the transfer characteristics in Fig. 10-52, Using 10-45
determine
suitable resistors for the MOSFET
Ro 1MQ
i Figure 10-68
432.
Electronic Devices and Circuits
f
(V)
x
——[ -12
-10 ~+—
-8
-6
(Vv) -4
-2
0
2
4
Ves
6
8
Ves
———-
10
12
Figure 10-69
drain-to-gate bias circuit in Fig. 10-72. Calculate the drain-source voltage.
Section 10-11 10-46 Calculate Vps for the direct-coupled JFET switching circuit in Fig. 10-73 when the FET
is off and when it is on. Data sheet A-12 in Appendix A shows the data sheet for the 2N4861. 10-47 A direct-coupled JFET switching circuit (as in Fig. 10-73) is to be designed to use a 2N4861, and Vpp = 18 V. Vps is not to exceed 100 mV when the device is on. Determine suitable re-
_
Figure 10-70
sistor values and a suitable input voltage amplitude. 10-48 The JFET switching circuit in Fig. 10-74 is to have Vps ~ 50 mV when the de-
vice is on. Select a FET from the 2N4856 to 2N4861 range, calculate appropriate resistor values, and determine a suitable input voltage amplitude. 10-49 The switching circuit in Fig. 10-75 is required to pass 5 A through a 5 1 resistance. Calculate a suitable rpsion) for the device. Determine a suitable input voltage amplitude from the transfer characteristic in Fig. 10-52.
FET Biasing
Chapter 10
433
Figure 10-72
Vpp .
12 V
Rp
e—O
Qi
Rg b ate — =
Figure 10-73
Figure 10-74
10-50 The MOSFET in the switching circuit in Fig. 10-76 has the transfer characteristic in Fig. 10-52 and rpg(on) = 0.2 2. Calculate Vpp 28 V the required drain current and suitable values for resistors R; and R2.
Practice Problem
Rp
50
e—O
Answers
EP)
E
10-1.1 10-1.2 10-2.1 10-2.2 10-3.1 10-4,1 10-7.1 10-7.2
8V £5 V 8.4 V, 17.6 12.7 V 8.8 V, 16.1 V 14 V, 18.7 V —1.7 V, 1 MOQ, 4.7 kQ 1 MQ, 3.9 kQ, 1.5 kO
Ip 5A
tr
o—)
a Re
Figure 10-75
434
Electronic Devices and Circuits
10-7.3 10-8.1 10-8.2 10-8.3 10-9.1 10-9.2 10-9.3 10-10.1 10-10.2 10-11.1 10-11.2
4.7 MQ, 1 MO, 5.6 kQ, 5.6 ko 1 MQ, 3.3 kQ, 8.3 kO 1 MQ, 10 kQ, 5.6 ka (2.2 MQ + 220 kQ), 1 MQ, 2.7 kO, 2.7 kO 12.4V | 10 V 14.1V 9.6 V,12.3V 120 3.3 kQ, 0.6V, -5V 48 V,8.6V Figure
10-76
CHAPTER 11 AC Analysis of FET Circuits 4
4S
Objectives You will be able to:
common-drain, and common-
1 Explain the need for coupling and bypass capacitors in FET
gate circuits.
circuits, and draw ac equivalent circuits for FET circuits
4 Analyze various CS, CD, and CG FET circuits to determine input resistance, output
containing capacitors.
resistance, and voltage gain. 5 Compare the performance of
2 Draw ac load lines for basic FET
CS, CD, and CG circuits, and
circuits.
compare FET and BJT circuits.
3 Sketch ac equivalent circuits for
6 Calculate the cutoff frequencies
various FET common-source,
for FET circuits.
INTRODUCTION Like BJT circuits, FET amplifiers have ac signals capacitor-coupled circuit input, and loads capacitor-coupled to the output terminals. capacitors are also employed both in FET and BJT circuits to maximum. ac voltage gains. Because of the ac-coupled load and
to the Bypass ensure the ac-
bypassed components, the ac load for a given circuit is different from the de
load; consequently, the ac load line is different from the dc load line. There are three basic FET circuit configurations: common-source, common-drain, and common-gate. emitter,
common-collector,
and
These are similar to the BJT common-
common-base
circuits,
respectively.
The
common-source circuit is capable of voltage amplification, and it has a high input impedance. The common-drain circuit is a buffer amplifier, with a voltage gain of approximately one, high input impedance, and low output impedance. The common-gate circuit has voltage gain, low input impedance,
and good high-frequency performance.
436
Electronic Devices and Circuits
11-1
COUPLING, BYPASSING, AND AC LOAD LINES
Coupling Capacitors | This subject is treated for BJT circuits in Section 6-1, and the discussion there applies equally to FET circuits. As explained, coupling capacitors are required at a circuit input to couple a signal source to the circuit without affecting the bias conditions. Similarly, loads are capacitor-coupled to the circuit output to
avoid the change in bias conditions produced by direct coupling. Input and output coupling capacitors (C; and C3) are shown in the FET circuit in Fig. 11-1. Vop Coupling
capacitor
Coupling
= R
~—
capacitor aP
Bypass capacitor Figure 11-1
FET circuit with coupling
and bypass capacitors.
Bypassing Capacitors Bypass capacitors are also just as necessary in FET circuits as in BJT circuits.
Bypass capacitor C) in Fig. 11-1 provides an ac short-circuit across resistor Rs. As will be shown, if C2 is not present, Rs substantially reduces the ac voltage gain of the circuit. | OVpp Figure 11-2 illustrates another situation where bypassing capacitor is required. The MOSFET drainto-gate bias circuit shown would have its voltage
gain reduced by feedback from the drain to the gate via Rg (ac degeneration) if capacitor C2 were not present. The feedback is eliminated by splitting Rg into two equal resistors and ac shorting the junction to ground via C2.
=
AC Load Lines
Once again, this is a subject that applies equally to ah
cea
‘
f
BJT and FET circuits (see Section 6-2). The de load for the FET circuit in Fig. 11-1 is (Rp + Rs). With Rs
Figure 11-2
MOSFET
circuit with bypass
Capatiterte eliminate ac degeneration.
ac-bypassed and R;, absent, the ac load is Rp. With the capacitor-coupled load present in Fig. 11-1, the ac load is Rp||Ry. The dc load line is drawn in the usual way, and the Q-point is marked;
then the ac load
through the Q-point, as shown in Fig. 11-3.
line is drawn
AC Analysis of FET Circuits
Chapter 11
-
12
Figure
11-3
437
14
FET circuit dc and ac load lines.
Yop y
Example 11-1 Draw the de and ac load lines for the transistor circuit in Fig. 11-4 using the FET drain
a 1.5
characteristics in Fig. 11-3, and identifying the
Ip} ©
Q-point current as Ip =2 mA.
°) 1
Solution DC load line:
Re 1MQaS
Rude) = Rp + Rg = 1.5 kO + 1.5kO
Figure
The equation for Vps is
Vps = Vpp — Ip (Rp + Rs) Ip =
0,
Plot point A at
Vps =
Vpp
=
Ip = 0 and
18 V
Vps = 18 V
Vpp
When Vos = 0,
D> RO + Rs
_
18V
3kO
=6mA
Plot point B at
Cs =
=3kO
When
Rs 15k0
= 0 Ip = 6mAand Vps
Draw the dc load line through points A and B.
Mark the Q-point on the dc load line at Ip = 2 mA.
11-4 Circuit for Ex 11 -1.
438
Electronic Devices and Circuits
AC load line: Ric) = Rp = 1.5 kO (when Rs is bypassed)
When Ip changes 2 mA, AVps= Alp X Rp. = 2mA
X 1.5 kO
=3V Plot point C at
Alp = 2mA and AVps = 3 V from the Q-point.
Draw the ac load line through points C and Q.
Practice | roblem
11-1.1 In the circuit in Fig 141, Toe= 2.2kQ, Rs = 1.8 kO, Ry = 15 kO, and -Vpp= 20'V. Determine the de and ac load resistances, and draw both load lines on the characteristic in Fig 11-3. Assume that the Q-point is -drain current is 2.5.mA.
11-2
FET MODELS AND PARAMETERS
FET Equivalent Circuit The complete equivalent circuit for a field effect transistor is shown It is seen that the source terminal is common to both input Therefore this is a common-source equivalent circuit. Resistor Rgs gate and source terminals is the resistance of the reverse-biased
in Fig. 11-5a. and output. between the gate-source
junction, and C,, is the junction capacitance. So a signal applied to the input ‘sees’ Reg in parallel with C,..
The output stage of the equivalent circuit is represented as a current source (Ys Ugs) supplying current to the drain resistance (rg). Since Y;, is the forward
transfer admittance for the FET, and v,, is the ac signal voltage developed
Sts Cc gd
8
Ig
7T
{
gs « Cog al Ss
Vf,
Res
Ugs
|
"4 :
$40
“A Iq
Ye
i
(a) Complete equivalent circuit
Figure 11-5
g %gs < Res S
o—
Ugs
"d $—o
S
S
(b) Low-frequency and mediumfrequency equivalent circuit
The complete equivalent circuit for a FET includes capacitances between
terminals. For low- and medium-frequency operations, the capacitances are omitted.
Chapter 11 = AC Analysis of FET Circuits
meetin
439
across the gate-source terminals, the ac drain current is (Y¢s Ugs). The drain-
source capacitance (Cy.) appears in parallel with rg, and the gate-drain capacitance (C,q) is shown connected between the input and output stages. For low- and medium-frequency operations the capacitances can be neglected, and the equivalent circuit is then as shown in Fig. 11-5b. This is the FET model (or equivalent circuit) normally used in ac circuit analysis.
Equivalent Circuit Parameters The parameters used in the equivalent circuit are discussed in Section 9-3. As explained above, Rgg is a junction reverse resistance with a 10’ O typical value for a JFET. Because its resistance is so high, Rcg is often regarded as an open circuit. Instead of Rcs being listed on a device data sheet, the gate-
source reverse current is usually specified, and a value for Res can be calculated from this quantity. The forward transfer admittance (Yj, or gj) varies widely for different types of FET. For a small-signal or switching JFET, Y‘, typically ranges from 1000 xS to 5000 wS. For an EMOSFET, Y;, might be 2.9 S. The drain resistance (rg) shown in the equivalent circuit is the ac resistance offered between the drain and source terminals of the FET when operating in the pinch-off region of the drain characteristics. This quantity is usually defined in terms of an output admittance (Y.s) which equals Li Pas
Typical values of rg range from 20 kQ to 100 kO for a JFET.
ent
y all components, list typical component values, and briefly
ES » explain how the equivalent circuit represents the device.
CIRCUIT
11-3 COMMON-SOURCE ANALYSIS
Common-Source Circuit The circuit of a FET common-source amplifier is shown in Fig. 11-6. With the capacitors treated
as
ac
short-circuits,
the
circuit
input
terminals are the gate and source, and the output terminals are the drain and the source.
So the source terminal is common to both input
Figure 11-6
= FET common-
SONS AIP RTSE CHOU
and output, and the circuit configuration is known as common-source (CS). The current and voltage waveforms for the
CS circuit in Fig. 11-6 are illustrated in Fig. 11-7.
Electronic Devices and Circuits
increases the FET gate-source voltage (Vas), thus raising the level of Ip and increasing the voltage drop across Rp. This produces a decrease in the level of the drain voltage (Vp), which is capacitor-coupled to the circuit output as
v, {\_ J 2cinput »
A
The 180° phase shift between the input and output waveforms can be understood by considering the effect of a positive-going input signal. An increase in Vs
ccm
440
() =, 4-4-4~Vv
a negative-going ac output voltage (vo). Consequently,
negative direction, as illustrated. Conversely, when vs; changes in a negative direction, the resultant decrease in
Ves reduces Ip and produces a positive-going output.
=
as Us increases in a positive direction, vo changes in a
09 aoa
Vp
J
The circuit in Fig. 11-6 has an input impedance (Z;), an
output impedance (Z,), anda voltage gain (Ay). Equations
oe
for these quantities can be determined by ac analysis of (\
the circuit.
Common-Source Equivalent Circuit The first step in ac analysis of a FET (or BJT) circuit is to draw the ac equivalent circuit, by substituting ac shortcircuits in place of the power supply and capacitors. When
aL
this is done for the circuit in Fig. 11-6, the ac
equivalent circuit shown in Fig. 11-8a is created. For ac
% |-4-- Soniye aa \ Figure 11-7 Voltage and
Surent
analysis, the FET equivalent circuit (from Fig. 11-5b) is eS eeee common-source now substituted. in place of the device. This results in circuit. the CS ac equivalent circuit in Fig. 11-8b. The current directions and voltage polarities in Fig. 11-8b are those that occur when the instantaneous level of the input voltage is moving in a positive direction.
Input Impedance Considering the input section of the equivalent circuit in Fig. 11-8b we can see that the input impedance at the FET terminals is
2g
= Res
(11-1)
Recall that a typical value of R,, for a low-current JFET is 10° ©. At the circuit input terminals, resistors R; and R2 are seen to be in parallel with Z,. So the circuit input impedance is
Zi = Ril[RallZ,
(11-2)
441
AC Analysis of FET Circuits
Chapter 11
_—
—e —=
(a) ac equivalent circuit for FET CS circuit
FET equivalent circuit
7
Se
: Ry
Is
%4 Ds
Ry
2 —
Zs, oe
Yés 0gs
A
Rg.
fr
pats
=
BD
Eee
R
Rp
re
7%
Jo
os,
Bt
+
S (b) Substitution of the FET equivalent circuit into the CS ac equivalent circuit
Figure 11-8
A common-source ac equivalent circuit is drawn by first replacing the power
of supply and all capacitors with short-circuits. Then the FET model is substituted in place
the device.
is almost
always
Secs
Because Z, is so large, the circuit input impedance determined by the bias resistors.
(11-3)
—
me
Zi = Ryl|Ro So the input impedance
of a FET circuit can usually be determined simply by
calculating the equivalent resistance of the bias resistors. However, as already pointed out, very high input resistance is one of the most important properties of a FET. When it is necessary to achieve the highest possible input resistance, the signal source may be directly connected in series with the gate terminal, and in this case Zj ~ Z,.
In the case of the self-biased circuit in Fig. 11-4, the circuit input impedance is equal to the gate bias resistor Kg. Output Impedance
‘Looking into’ the output of the CS equivalent circuit in Fig. 11-8b, the output impedance at the FET drain terminal is
Za =a
(11-4)
At the circuit output terminals, resistor Rp is in parallel with Zg. So the circuit
output impedance is
Zo = Rpllra
(11-5)
442
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Because rq is usually 100 kQ, and Rp is usually much lower than 50 kQ), the
circuit
output
impedance
is approximately
equal
to
Rp.
With: this
information, the output impedance of a CS circuit can be discovered simply
by reading the resistance of Rp.
Ze XoRp
(11-6)
Voltage Gain Amplifier voltage gain is given by the equation
A ax a From Fig. 11-8b, and sO
Uo = Iq (ral|Rp||Rx) Ig = —Yfp 0;
-Y%50i(rall Rp | Rx) Ay = —-— Oj
or
Ay = —Y¢(rall Rp|| Ri)
(11-7)
The minus sign in Eq. 11-7 indicates that v, is 180° out of phase with v;. (When
dj increases, Vp decreases, and vice versa.) It is seen that the voltage gain of a common source amplifier is directly proportional to the Y;, of the FET. If the appropriate Y;, value and the resistance of Rp and Ry, are known, the voltage gain of a CS circuit can be quickly estimated. For Y;, = 5000 pS and Rp = 4.7 kQ, and with Ry >> Rp and rg >> Rp, the voltage gain is —23.5.
The voltage gain of a FET common-source amplifier is typically about one-tenth of the gain of a BJT common-emitter circuit. Low voltage gain, caused by the low Yj, value, is the major disadvantage of JFET circuits compared to BJT circuits. The same is generally true of MOSFET circuits,
except for EMOSFET devices (VMOS and TMOS), which have much larger Y¢s values. However, EMOSFETs use relatively large drain currents, and they are normally unsuitable for small-signal applications.
Summary of Typical CS Circuit Performance Device input impedance
Z, = Rg,
Circuit inputimpedance
—_Zj = Rj ||R2||Z,~ Ri||Ro
Device output impedance
Za = Trg
Circuit output impedance
Z, = Rp||ra* Rp
Circuit voltage gain
Ay = ~Y¢(ra||Rp||Rx)
Chapter 11 = AC Analysis of FET Circuits
—e
443
The common-source circuit has voltage gain, 180° phase shift, high input impedance, and relatively high output impedance.
Example 11-2 Using the FET typical parameters, calculate the input impedance, output impedance, and voltage gain for the common-source circuit in Fig. 11-9.
Figure 11-9
Circuit for Ex. 11-2.
Solution From the 2N5457 data sheet,
os
and Eq. 11-3: Eq. 11-5: Eg. 11-7:
Le
= 100 kO Yfs = 3000 pS Z;, = Ry||Ro = 1 MQ||5.6 MO = 848 kO Zo = Rp||ra = 2.7 kQ||100 kO = 2.63 kO Ay = —Y¢(ra||Rp|| RL) = —3000 pS (100 kQ||2.7 kQ)
= -79 Practice Problems 11-3.1 Calculate
the typical
input impedance,
output
impedance,
and
_,, _ Voltage gain for the circuit in Fig. 11-4 if the FET is a 2N5458. 11-3.2 A circuit similar to the one in Fig. 11-4 has Rg= 470 kQ, Rp = 3.9 kQ, and a 2N5457 FET. Determine the typical input impedance, output _ impedance, and voltage gain for the circuit.
444
Electronic Devices and Circuits
11-4 CS CIRCUIT WITH UNBYPASSED
SOURCE RESISTOR
Equivalent Circuit When an unbypassed source resistor (Rs) is present ina FET common-source
circuit, as shown in Fig. 11-10a, it also appears in the ac equivalent circuit (Fig. 11-10b). In the complete equivalent circuit, Rs must be shown connected
between the FET source terminal and the circuit common input-output terminal (Fig. 11-11). As with the previous equivalent circuit, the current directions and voltage polarities shown in Fig. 11-11 are those that occur when the instantaneous input voltage is positive-going. The presence of Rg
without a bypass capacitor significantly affects the circuit voltage gain.
: (a) Circuit with unbypassed Rg
+
(b) ac equivalent circuit
Figure 11-10 FET common-source circuit with unbypassed source resistor and ac equivalent circuit. I
Figure 11-11
An unbypassed source resistor in a FET circuit must be included in the
complete ac equivalent circuit.
Input Impedance An equation for the input impedance at the FET gate can be determined from vy; and I,. From Fig. 11-11, Uj = Ugs+ Ig Rg = gs + YisgsRs = Ugs(1 + YiRs)
Chapter 11
AC Analysis of FET Circuits
445
Vv
an d
I, — Res
-
Zs
_
Oo
» _
Oodl gs(
I, or
+ Yar fs s)
Ugs/ Res
Ze = Res (1 + Y‘eRs)
(11-8)
Equation 11-8 gives the input impedance at the FET gate terminal. The circuit input impedance is again given by Eq. 11-2: Zi = Ry||Rol|Z,
In this case, since Z, is much larger than R;||R», the circuit input impedance is determined by the gate bias resistors.
Eq. 11-3:
Zi
Ri||Ro
Output Impedance To calculate the circuit output impedance, the ac signal voltage (Vs) is assumed to be zero, and an ac voltage (v,) is applied at the output (see Fig. 11-12a). The ac output current (Iq) is calculated in terms of Vo; then Zo is
determined as v, divided by Ig. Figure 11-12a shows that when 4, is zero, the ac voltage across source resistor Rs is applied as a gate-source voltage: Ugs
= IgRs
Actually, IgRs is divided across rg | | Rgand R,,. However, Rgs > 1s ||Rc, so that
all of IgRs is effectively applied as a gate-source voltage. The v,, produced in this way generates an ac drain current which opposes the drain current
produced by vo, [=
—Yg0gs
= —Y¢(IaRs)
Uo
(a) Circuit output stage with input shorted
Figure 11-12
(b) Current source replaced with a voltage source
Analysis of the output impedance of a common-source circuit with an
unbypassed source resistor.
446
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Converting the current generator (Yj¥g. in parallel with ra) ta voltage generator (Y;,0,.rq in series with rg) gives the equivalent circuit in Fig. 11-12b,
The equation for the voltage drops around this circuit is la(ra + Rs)
giving
=p
— (Yts Ig Rs Ta)
Up = Ia(tg + Rg + YisRsra)
and
Za = a = tq + Rg + YRsra d
or
Za = tq + Rg + YeeRsra
(11-9)
The circuit output impedance is
Eq. 11-5:
Zo = Rp||Za
Because the output impedance at the FET drain terminal is much larger than the drain resistor (Rp), the output unbypassed source resistor is still Eq.
11-6:
impedance
of
the
circuit
with
the
Ls yy Rp
Voltage Gain From the derivation of the input impedance equation, Uj = Ugs(1 + YsRs) Neglecting rq,
0 = Ia(Rp|| Rt) = —Yis0g5(Rv|| Rx) Vo
so
Ay = = Oj
ivi
SIVINE
Usually,
so
~ Y¢s0gs(Rp| [Rr)
= — Ugs(1
+ Y¢5Rs)
—Y¢(RpllRx)
Ao
enya eT
1+
Y¢Rs
11-10)
YsRg >> 1
~(Rpl|R
Ay = aRelo
(11-11)
The voltage gain of a FET common-source circuit with an unbypassed source resistor can be quickly estimated from Eq. 11-11. For the circuit in Fi g. 11-10a with Rp = 4.7 kO, Rs = 2.2 kO, and Ry >> Rp, Ap¥ —2.1.
Chapter 11
AC Analysis of FET Circuits
447
Summary of Performance of CS Circuit with Unbypassed Rs Device input impedance
Z,=R,,(1 + Y¢Rs)
Circuitinput impedance
Zj = Rg||Z,~ Ri ||Ro
Circuit output impedance
Z,.~Rp
iti voltage ga Circu i
in
A
i
—Y¢( is Rp||Rr)
»
ass ge ee
—(Rpj||R © e Aym s
Circuit voltage gain
The most significant feature of the performance of a CS circuit with an unbypassed source resistor is that its voltage gain is much lower than that for aCS circuit with Rs bypassed. Example 11-3 For the common-source circuit in Fig. 11-13, calculate the gate input impedance, the drain output impedance, the circuit input and output impedances, and the voltage gain. Use the typical parameters for the FET. Vpp +25 V
Rp 4.7
QO,
C;
Cy
2N 2)
5458
R,
°s
33k
Re 1MQ
Rs
's
3.3kO
aL Figure 11-13
Circuit for Ex. 11-3.
Solution From the 2N5458 data sheet,
fq = —
D
1
Fise
= 100k0
Yi = 4000 pS and So
Ig =1nA_ Res
a
Ves we Ig
when Veg = 15V EN15V
1nA
=15x10°0
448
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Eq. 11-8:
Zg = Res(1 + 'YisRs) = 15 X 10° O1 + (4mS x 3.3kM)] = 2.13 10"
From Eq. 11-3,
Zi = Rg = 1M
Eq. 11-9:
Za = tat Rg + (YisRsra)
= 100kO + 3.3k0 + (4mS x 3.3kO x 100 kQ) ~1.4MO,
Eq. 11-5:
Zo = Rp||Za= 4.7 kO||1.4 MO = 4.68 kO
=
2 Ys (Rp||Ri) Ao 1+ Y;.Rs 1 + (4mS X 3.3 kQ) = -1.16 —(Rp|[Rt) 4.7 kQ||33 ko ap Rs 3.3 kO = —1.24
. 11-10;
E
=
< 1
-]1:
y
=
arin!
: Practice Problem: UR OE T1-4.1 Calculate the gate input
pedis drain output impedance, circuit
input and output impedance, and voltage gain for the circuit in Fig. 11-4
when the. source
pe
cap citor i is removed. Assume that the FET is
a QN5458 5: a. | 11-4.2 Determine ‘the items listed in . Problem 11-4.1 for the circuit in _ Fig. 119 when the s source ‘bypass capacitor is removed.
~°Ypo
( |
R,
Rg aa
Figure 11-14
in Fig.
11-14 has the output voltage developed across the source resistor (Rs). The external load (Ri)
co R,
CIRCUIT
Common-Drain Circuit The FET common-drain circuit shown
Q;
Nel” =
44-5 COMMON-DRAIN ANALYSIS
= Common-drain
is capacitor-coupled to the source terminal of the FET, and the gate bias voltage (Vg) is
derived from Vpp by means of voltage-divider resistors R; and Ro. No resistor is connected in series with the drain terminal, and no source
circuit, also called a source follower. The ac input is
invpassxaiacifor: 1 PPase hepaneens ENub
the output is taken fromthe sours semnnay.
Fig. 11-14, note that the dc gate volta ge (Vc) isa constant quantity and that the source voltage is
applied to the FET gate, and
a
ed.
;
To understand the operation of the circuit in
Vs=Vot Ves
Chapter 11
AC Analysis of FET Circuits
449
—_
When an ac signal is applied to the gate via capacitor C;, the gate voltage is increased and. decreased as the instantaneous level of the signal voltage rises and falls. Also, Vcs remains substantially constant, so the source voltage increases and decreases with the gate voltage. (See the waveforms in Fig. 11-15.) Thus, the ac
output voltage is closely equal to the ac input voltage, and the circuit can be said to have unity gain. AC analysis of the circuit shows that vp is slightly smaller than v;. Because the output voltage at the source terminal follows the signal voltage at
the gate, the common-drain circuit is also known as a source follower. Common-Drain Equivalent Circuit As in the case of other circuits, the supply voltage and
a ftps rr)
coupling capacitors in Fig. 11-14 must be replaced with
° |” (+
short-circuits performance.
in order to study the circuit This gives the common-drain
ac ac
} “c Ty yi
equivalent circuit in Fig. 11-16a. The input terminals of the ac equivalent circuit are seen to be the FET gate and drain, and the output terminals are the source and drain.
%s {4-3 -
Because the drain terminal is common to both input and output,
the
circuit .
°
configuration *
is named
.
common-
.
_
an
drain (CD). The complete CD ac equivalent circuit is drawn by substituting the FET model into the ac equivalent circuit (Fig.
11-16b).
The
voltage polarities
indicated
are, once
current
again,
directions
those
that
and
are
produced by a positive-going signal voltage. LA
~
°
= , -Y_ o
_|acoutput Y
Figure 11-15 Voltage waveforms in a common-drain
circuit.
b
Qy Re
R, | Ry
“&
V.
=%
(a) ac equivalent circuit for FET CD circuit
FET equivalent circuit gs lg
m——
+
*% 4) Zic>
Rik
G
Ro
20>
0)
—
A
‘
*
Rs Y fs Ups
CG) w=
Rg
+
(Rg ||r,), effectively all of v is applied as an
ac gate-source voltage. Therefore, I; = YtsVo an
d
Zep = 2 = — 2
or
Log
and
Es =
se
YU
11-17)
1g.
-
6
1/Ye
Zn = Zeal lra
Therefore Equation
(ge Fig.
SS
6
= (1/55) lta 11-13
gives
the device
output
(11-13)
impedance.
The
circuit
output
impedance also involves Rs.
Zo = (1/Y¢)||Rs|lra
r.I|Re =
Yps%ps(4)
>
Zs
ee
Vy
eo
Lia
a
~
o
Zi
Yo
_
Rgs
=
ps
+
G
>
(b) Complete common-gate ac equivalent circuit Figure 11-21 A common-gate ac equivalent circuit is drawn by first replacing the power supply and all capacitors with short-circuits; then
a
ee
the FET model is substituted for the device.
Ry
454
Electronic Devices and Circuits
circuit are seen to be the FET source and gate, and the output terminals are
the drain and gate. Since the gate terminal is common to both input and output, the circuit is named common-gate. The complete CG ac equivalent circuit is drawn by substituting the FET model into the ac equivalent circuit (Fig. 11-21b). As always, the current directions and voltage polarities indicated are those produced by a positivegoing signal voltage.
Input Impedance ‘Looking into’ the source and
gate
terminals of
the CG circuit in Fig. 11-21b is similar to ‘looking into’ the output of a common-drain circuit, Therefore, the equation for the common-gate device input impedance (Z;) is derived in the same way as the equation for Z, in the commonFigure 11-22
Because a
drain circuit.
common-gate circuit
ha as low
input
|
impedance, some of
Ze = 1/Y%
(11-17)
the signal voltage is
lost when it is divided
across r, and Z;.
So
The circuit input impedance is Rs in parallel with
the device input impedance.
Z = 0/5) | Rs
(11-18)
With a typical Y;, of 5000 pS, the input impedance of a common-gate circuit is around 200 ©. Low input impedance is the major disadvantage of the common-gate circuit, because the signal voltage is divided across r; and Z; (see Fig. 11-22). (11-19)
Output Impedance The output of a common-gate circuit is taken from the drain terminal, as in the case of a common-source circuit. So the common-gate output impedance is the same as the common-source output impedance. At the drain terminal: Eq. 11-4:
Za = tq
and the circuit output impedance is given by
Eq. 11-5:
Zo = Rp||ra
Voltage Gain From Fig. 11-21b,
U = Ia(Rp||Rt) = Yg0;(Ro|| Rr)
Chapter 11
and
Ay =
or
Ay =
AC Analysis of FET Circuits
455
Yq _ Ytsvi(Rp Il Rr) Oj
Oj (11-20)
Y(Rp|| Ry)
Equation 11-20 is similar to Eq. 11-7 for the voltage gain of a common-source circuit, except that there is no minus sign in Eq. 11-20. So the voltage gain for a common-gate circuit is the same as the voltage gain for a common-source circuit with the same component values. As already discussed, there is no phase shift between the input and output of a common-gate circuit; hence the
absence of the minus sign in Eq. 11-20.
Qi
Effect of Unbypassed Gate Resistors If capacitor C; is not present in the CG circuit in
°
Rs
Fig. 11-19, the FET gate is not ac-short-circuited to 2, @
Rp
nS
Res
ground. So a resistance (Rg = Rj||Rz) must be included in the ac equivalent circuit (see Fig. 11-23)
=
and in the complete CG ac equivalent circuit. The Figure 11-23 When the gate _ presence’ of the unbypassed gate resistors affects the circuit input impedance and voltage gain.
ae tie sivalent m resistance of the gate bias
Analysis of the equivalent circuit shows that
resistors (Rg) must be
:
oe o
a2 yk
and that Bete f 4v ~~
Re
included for circuit analysis.
+
(11-21)
Res
. (11-22)
(Rp||R L) pape Re + Res
4 fs\4ND
When R,, >> Rg (which is usually the case), Eq.
11-21 gives Zi = 1/Y{, and Eq. 11-22 gives Ay = Y;(Rp||Ri), which are the equations for a CG circuit with the gate bypassed to ground. The Z; and A, effects occur only in situations where very high-value bias resistors are used in a CG
bo
circuit. Figure 11-24 shows a CG circuit that uses self-bias. In this case, Rc is omitted because there
is no signal applied at the gate input; the gate is 11-24 =A commondirectly grounded and no gate bypass capacitor Figure gate circuit that uses self‘
aed
is required.
bias can have its gate directly grounded.
456
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Summary of CG Circuit Performance With the gate bypassed to ground: Device inputimpedance
Z,=1/Y¢%
Circuit input impedance
Z; = (1/Y¢)||Rs
Device outputimpedance
Zg= Trg
Circuit output impedance
Z, = Rp|lra
Circuit voltage gain With the gate unbypassed:
Ay = Y5 (Rp ||Rx)
Circuit inputimpedance
Z; = (1/Y¢,)
out Rg
+ Rgs
RR gs
Fath Circuit voltage gain
gs Ay = Y¢5(Rp|| Rr) Re + Ry
A common-gate circuit has a voltage gain, no phase shift between input and output, low input impedance, and relatively high output impedance.
Example 11-5 The common-gate circuit in Fig. 11-24 has a FET with Y;, = 3000 wS and r, =
50 kO. Determine the device and circuit input and output impedances, and the circuit voltage gain. Calculate the overall voltage gain if the signal source impedance is r, = 600 0.
Solution
Eq. 11-17:
Zs = 1/Y = 1/3000 pS = 333.0
Eq. 11-18:
Zi = (1/Y%)||Rs = 333 0||3.3 kO
= 302.0
Eq. 11-4:
Za = tq = 50kO
Eq. 11-5:
Zo = Rp||ra = 4.7 kQ||50 ko
Eq. 11-20:
= 43k | Av = Ys(Rp||Rt) = 3000 pS X (4.7 kQ||50 kQ) = 129
If Eqs 11-19 and 11-20 are combined, the overall voltage gain is
igs Y¢s(Rp|| Rr)Z; i.
Pt = 4.3
+Z
129 * 302.0
6002 + 302 0
AC Analysis of FET Circuits 457
Chapter 11 BS A
I
GS
ir i
we
n Fig. ‘1-19 has the following components: 10, Rp
= 33
KO,
Rg = 1.5
kQ,
and
Ree
be 5 m8 and tae2170 ko, and the signal source
ae voltage gain, and the bite
voltage gain.
aan 11-6. 1 has Rg, = 10 MO, determine the circuit
11-7 COMPARISON
OF FET AND BJT CIRCUITS
CS, CD, and CG Circuit Comparison Table 11-1 compares Z;, Z,, and A, for CS, CD, and CG circuits. The CS circuit has voltage gain, high input impedance, high output impedance, and a 180° phase shift from input to output. The CD circuit has high input impedance, low output impedance, a voltage gain of approximately 1, and no phase shift. Table 11-1
Comparison of Common-source, Common-drain, and Common-gate Circuits Z
Zo.
Ay
Phase. Shift
cs
Ro
Rp
—Ys(RollRx)
180°
CG
=1/Y¢,
—_-Yg(RpilRu)
0
=Rp
The CG circuit offers low input impedance, high output impedance, voltage gain, and no phase shift. Impedance at the FET Gate Consideration of each type of circuit shows that the input or output impedance depends upon
which
device
terminal
is involved.
In
both the CS and CD circuits, the input signal is applied to the FET gate terminal, and so Z; is
the impedance when ‘looking into’ the gate.
Figure 11-25 shows that for CS and CD circuits
the gate input impedance is
and the circuit input impedance is
Figure 11-25
FET circuit
impedance at the gate
4i= Re||Res
terminal.
458
Electronic Devices and Circuits
where Rg is the equivalent resistance of the bias resistors. Because the reverse-biased gate-source resistance (Rgs) is so large, an unbypassed source resistor has no significant effect on Z; at the gate. The circuit input impedance
is largely determined by Rg in both the CS and CD circuits. Zi* Ro = R,||Rz (in the case of voltage-divider bias)
impedance at the FET Source
(Fe
The FET source is the output terminal for a CD circuit and the input terminal for a CG circuit. The device impedance in each case is the impedance seen on looking into the source (see
4 OZ
=(1/Yg) I R
Rs
Fig. 11-26):
Z,=s=
1.
1/Ye
The circuit impedance at the source terminal must include the source resistor:
Figure 11-26 FET circuit impedance at the source
terminal.
OV,
Zor Zo = (1/Ys)||Rs
“
Rp
Impedance at the FET Drain The output for CS and CG circuits is produced at the FET drain terminal. So the impedance seen when looking into the drain is the device output impedance (ra). As
illustrated
in Fig.
11-27, the circuit output
impedance for any circuit with the output taken from the FET drain terminal is
> Voz, Vg will be only slightly affected
by any variation
in Vpg
(due to temperature change or other effects).
Consequently, Ig and Ic remain fairly stable at Ic ~ Ip = Ve /Rz. A minimum Vg of 5 V gives good bias stability in most circumstances (see Fig. 12-2a). With
supply voltages less than 10 V, Vz might have to be reduced to 3 V to allow for reasonable levels of Vcg and Vrc. Normally, an emitter-resistor voltage drop
less than 3 V is likely to produce poor bias stability. Once Vx, Vcr, and Ic are selected, Vac is determined: Vac = Vee — Vez — Ve Then, Rc and Rx are calculated: V Rc = —RE Ie
and
V Rg & —* Ic
(see Fig. 12-2b)
Bias Resistors As explained in Section 5-7, selection of the voltage divider current (Iz) as
Ic/10 gives good bias stability and reasonably high input resistance. Where the input resistance is not important, I, may be made equal to Ic for excellent
bias stability. The bias resistors are calculated as follows: . Vcc — Va
472
Electronic Devices and Circuits
|
Selecting R2 = 10Rg gives Ip ~ Ic/10 (Fig. 12-2b). The precise level of Iz can be
calculated as Ip = Vg/R», and this can be used in the equation for R;.
Bypass Capacitor All capacitors should be selected to have the smallest possible capacitance
value, both to minimize the physical size of the circuit and for economy (large capacitors are the most expensive). Because each capacitor has its highest impedance at the lowest operating frequency, the capacitor values are
calculated at the lowest signal frequency that the circuit is required to amplify.
This frequency is the circuit lower cutoff frequency, or low 3 dB frequency (fi) (see Fig. 12-3).
Bypass capacitor C2 in Fig. 12-1 is normally the largest capacitor in the circuit because it has the smallest resistance in series with it (rz) (see Section
8-4). So C2 is selected to set f; at the desired frequency. Equation 6-21 (for voltage gain) was developed for a CE circuit with an unbypassed emitter resistor (Rx). Rewriting the equation to include X; in parallel with Rg gives
7
—hge(Re|| Rt)
v
hie
10
20
40
100
200
+
400
(1
et he)(Rx|| Xco)
1k
2k
4k
10k
fark
|
f, 1
t
Norimally selected by
emitter bypass capacitor Figure 12-3
Typical frequency response for a transistor amplifier.
20k
40k
f f. 2
100k
(Hz)
Chapter 12
—
Small-Signal Amplifiers
473
Since normally Re >> X~, Rg can be omitted. Also, Xc2 is capacitive; therefore
—hre(Re|| Ri)
y=
(12-2)
V hd + [1 + Me) Xca)¥")
When hie = (1 + hfe) Xco, —he(Rc||Ri) _= mid-frequency gain |A,| _=
V2
+
"he
= (mid-frequency gain) — 3 dB Therefore, at fi,
Nie = (1 + hfe) Xc2 =
xX
or
h: 1e
t
1 + hye a
ce
fi
From Table 6-1 (in Section 6-3), h;
hip =
ea
jopck
1 + hye
(12-3)
Xc2 = hip at fy
So
,
= (impedance seen on ‘looking into the emitter)
> Zo, and often Zj >> rs, so that Zo and r, can be omitted in Eqs 12-4 and
12-5. Once
again, the equations give minimum
capacitance
values, so that the next larger standard values should always be chosen for
C, and C3. Equations 12-4 and 12-5 give an impression that approximately 10% of the signal and output voltages are lost across C; and C3. This would be true if the
476.
Electronic Devices and Circuits
quantities were resistive. However, Xci and Xc3 are capacitive while Z; and R, are usually resistive. So, when the actual loss is calculated, it is found to
be only about 0.5% for each capacitor. Another approach to the selection of coupling capacitors is to make Xc, equal to Z; at two octaves below fi. Thus,
Xey= Ziat fi/4
(12-6)
The output coupling capacitor is then determined by making the impedance of C3 equal to Ry at two octaves below fil4:
Xc3 = Ryat fi/16.
(12-7)
es
When Egs 12-6 and 12-7 are used to determine the values of the coupling capacitors, it can be shown that the capacitor attenuations are less than 5% of Ay.
Shunting Capacitors Sometimes an amplifier is required to have a particular upper cutoff frequency (f2 in Fig. 12-3). The transistor must be selected to have a much higher cutoff frequency than fo. The upper cutoff frequency for the circuit can then be set by connecting a small capacitor from the transistor Figure 12-7
collector terminal to ground (C4 in Fig. 12-7). The
effect of the : shunt
capacitance :
;
oe
at the
= A shunting
can be used at
S Santcircuit Ge toSEInGlemitter select the
transistor collector is discussed in Section 8-4.
upper 3 dB frequency.
Design Calculations
Vie
Example 12-2 Calculate
suitable
resistor
values
for
the
™ = Re
common-emitter amplifier in Fig. 12-8. Cy
as
oH
Solution
Select
Re & Ry 5 Ry,
Rc = 70
mS Rr
ith ka
120k Ts
= 12 kQ, (standard value)
Figure 12-8
Common-
emitter amplifier for Ex.12-2.
Chapter 12 = Small-Signal Amplifiers Select
Ve=5Vand
Vcp
477
=3V
Vere = Vcc — Veg — Vg = 24V-3V—-—5V =16V Vre le = eS Re
=
16V 12 kO
=13mA
VE Rr
a
5V
i
Ic
1.3mA
=3.75kV
(usea3.9 kO standard value to make Ic a little less than the
design level, thus ensuring that Vcr is not less than 3 V.)
Ry = 10Rg = 10 X 3.9kO = 39 kQ (standard value) I
_VetVpp
5V+07V
Ry
39 kO
~ 146 pA Veco —~ Vp Ry
=
I
24V-5.7V =
146 pA
125 kO (use 120 kO standard value)
Example 12-3 Determine suitable capacitor values for the CE amplifier in Ex. 12-2. The signal source resistance is 600 ©, and the lower cutoff frequency is to be 100 Hz.
Solution From data sheet A-5 in Appendix A for the 2N3904,
hge = 100 Bg. 6-2:
—
26mV Ig
= 200
Eq. 12-3:
Xc2 = re at fi
_ 26mV 1.3mA
478
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Therefore,
ae
2
as
1
=
TfiKe
1
Zw X 100 X 200
= 79.5 wF (use 80 wF standard value) hie = (1 + he) re = (1 + 100) X 200
~2kO,
:
Z; = Ril|Ro ||hie = 120 kQ||39 kQ||2 0 = 187kO From Eq. 12-4,
Cy
i
~ Qarfx(Zi + 15)/10 1 Qar X 100 Hz X (1.87 kO + 600 Q)/10 = 6.4 pF (use 6.8 wF standard value)
F
Eq. 12-5, a
q
6
———
1
27 f1(Re ao
R,)/10
1 ~ Qer X 100 Hz X (12kO + 120k)/10 = 0.12 wF (standard value) The complete common-source circuit designed in Examples 12-2 and 12-3 is
shown in Fig. 12-9.
Figure 12-9 CE amplifier circuit designed in Examples 12-2 and 12-3.
Chapter 12
Small-Signal Amplifiers
479
practice Problems 12-1.1 Determine suitable resistor values for a CE amplifier (see Fig. 12-9) that uses a 20'V supply and has a 68 kQ capacitor-coupled load.
12-1.2 Determine suitable capacitor values for the circuit in Problem 12-1.1
to have a 40 Hz lower cutoff frequency and to use a 2N3903 transistor. Assume that r, = 500 (2.
12-2 SINGLE-STAGE COMMON-SOURCE
AMPLIFIER
Specification Bias circuit design for the common-source amplifier in Fig. 12-10 is treated in Chapter 10, and ac analysis of FET circuits is covered in Chapter 11. As with the common-emitter BJT circuit in Section 12-1, the design begins with specification of the supply voltage, amplification, frequency response, load impedance, and so on.
Ry
rs
|
Rs
T
Ry
Cy
.
Figure 12-10
Design of a common-source
Circuit design begins with a specification for the circuit performance.
Selection of /p, Rp, and Rs Since the circuit shown in Fig. 12-10 has no provision for negative feedback, it should be designed to achieve the largest possible gain. From Eq. 11-7, the voltage gain of a CS circuit is Av = —Y¢s (Ro||Ri)
Because A, is directly proportional to Rp||R., a design for the greatest
voltage gain normally requires that the largest possible drain resistance be chosen. However, a very large value of Rp might make the drain current too
480
Electronic Devices and Circuits
small for satisfactory FET operation. Also, low Ip levels give small Y;, values,
which result in lower ac voltage gain. Furthermore, Rp should normally be much smaller than Rr, so that Ry, will have little effect on the circuit voltage gain.
For a given Ip, the largest possible voltage drop across Rp gives the greatest Rp value (Rp = Vrp/Ip). To make Vp as large as possible, Vps and Vs should be held to a minimum (see Fig. 12-11a). The drain-source voltage should usually be Vpsqnin) = (Vas(ofmax) + 1 V). This is large enough to
ensure that the FET operates in the pinch-off region of its characteristics. It also allows for a drain voltage swing of +1 V, which is usually adequate for a small-signal amplifier. If the gate-source bias voltage (Vgs) is other than zero, then, as illustrated in Fig. 12-11a, the minimum Vps should be calculated as follows:
Vidsuniny = Vieswtpiiex) +1 VY — Veg O
(12-8)
Vop
Vep ~ (Vpp — Vps)/2
bi
=~ Ves(off\(max) +
1 V
_
Vos
Vs = (Vpp — Vps)/2
(a) Voltage and current selection Figure 12-11 circuit.
(b) Resistor determination
Voltage and current selection and resistor determination for a CS amplifier
Recall from Chapter 10 that for good bias stability, the source resistor voltage drop (Vs) should be as large as possible. Where the supply voltage is
small, Vs may be reduced to a minimum to allow for the minimum level of Vps. A reasonable approach for most FET circuits is to calculate the the sum of Vs and Vprp from the equation
Vs + Vrp = Vop — Vos (min) and then make
Vs = Van= Se
(12-9)
Chapter 12
Small-Signal Amplifiers
484
—_—_~or
Once Vs, ‘oan. and Ip are selected, Rp and Rg are calculated:
Rp ==u
and Rg w— (ee Fig. 12-11b)
D
Ip
As already discussed in Section 10-4, a bias line should be drawn upon the FET transfer characteristics to determine a suitable gate bias voltage (Vc). The maximum
drain current selected (Ipimax)) is plotted on the maximum
transfer characteristics for the FET used. The bias line is then drawn through
this point with a slope of 1/Rs. The gate bias voltage is read from the intersection of the bias line and the Vg scale. As an alternative to drawing the bias line, Ves can be read from the transfer characteristic when Ipimax) is
plotted. Then, Vg = Vs — Vas
Instead of using the FET transfer characteristics, Vcs(ofp(max) and [pss(max) Can be substituted into Eq. 10-8 to calculate the Vgg level.
Bias Resistors With a voltage-divider bias circuit (as in Fig. 12-11b), Ro is usually selected as
1 MQ, or less. Smaller resistance values may be used where a lower input impedance is acceptable. Larger resistance values may also be used; however, as explained in Section 10-7, there are distinct disadvantages to using resistances higher than 1 MQ.
With R» determined, R; is calculated
from R» and the ratio of Vr; to Vro
i= —
(12-10)
Capacitors As for a BJT capacitor-coupled circuit, coupling and bypass capacitors should be selected to have the smallest possible capacitance values. The largest capacitor in the circuit (source bypass capacitor C2 in Fig. 12-10) sets the circuit low 3 dB frequency (f1). Equation 11-10 was developed for the voltage gain of a common-source circuit with an unbypassed source resistor
(Rs). Rewriting the equation to include X¢ in parallel with Rs gives
_ _~Yis(Rol} Ru) "1
+ Y¢(Rsl|Xca)
Normally Rg >> Xc2, so Rg can be omitted. And since X¢ is capacitive,
A
~Y¢(Rp||Ri)
TU
= ——[—[—==——S—
VEb +t (YeXeo)"]
(12-11)
482
Electronic Devices and Circuits
When Y%.Xc2 = 1,
|A,| =
—Y;,(Rp||Ri) | mid-frequency gain =
V(1 + 1)
V2
= (mid-frequency gain) — 3 dB
Therefore, at fi, Ye Xc2
or
Xe
=1
hee Ys fi
(12-12)
From Section 11-7,
Zs -
So, at fi,
Vg
= (impedance seen on ‘looking into’ the FET source)
Xc2 = (impedance ‘looking into’ the source terminal)
= (impedance in series with Xc2) (see Fig. 12-12)
Equation 12-12 gives the smallest value for the source bypass capacitor. When a standard
Qy
value is selected, the next larger capacitance value should be chosen. This will give a cutoff
\\_|
frequency slightly lower than thef, valueusedin
Rs
the calculations. As explained in Section 12-1, it is important to note that the bypass capacitor is calculated in terms of the resistance seen when looking into the device terminal (the resistance in series
C2). The capacitance . value is not determined with : in terms of the parallel resistor (Rs).
A Eg L CG
xX,
i Figure 12-12 InaCs amplifier circuit, the signal voltage can be divided
across the source bypass
Capacitor and the source
resistance (1/Y;.).
The input and output coupling capacitors should have almost zero effect on the circuit frequency response. In Section 12-1 it is explained that Xc; in series with Z; and Xc3 in series with Ry constitute voltage dividers that can attenuate the ac input and output voltages. To minimize the attenuation, the reactance of each coupling capacitor is selected to be approximately one-tenth of the impedance in series with it at the lowest operating frequency for the circuit
(fi). Equations 12-4 and 12-5 apply once again for the calculation of the
minimum C; and C? values.
Eq. 12-4:
Li'+ f,
Xa == 0 = at Fy
Chapter 12
Eq.
12-5:
Xo
=
———
Small-Signal Amplifiers
483
at fii
As in BJT circuits, Ry is usually much larger than Z,, and Z; is often much
larger than r,; therefore Z, and r, can often be omitted in Eqs 12-4 and 12-5. As always, since the equations give minimum capacitance values, the next larger standard values should always be chosen for C; and C3. Alternatively, as explained in Section 12-1, Equations 12-6 and 12-7 may
be used for determining coupling capacitor values. Design Calculations Example 12-4 Calculate suitable resistor values for the common-source circuit in Fig. 12-13. Vpp
Ri s
ne
Cy FI
Ry
120 kO
5) Ry I,
| Rg
T Cy Figure 12-13 Common-source amplifier circuit for Ex. 12-4.
é +
Solution
Refer to the 2N5459 transfer characteristics in Fig. 9-19. A reasonable level of Ip(max) might be 1.5 mA. Y;, becomes smaller at lower Ip levels.
Ves = Vesior [1 — V Up/Ipss)]
Eq. 10-8:
Using Ves(otf(max) ANd Ipsg(max) from data sheet A-11 in Appendix A (and from
Fig. 9-19) gives
Vog = 8V[1 — V(1.5 mA/16 mA)] =5.6V Eq. 12-8:
Vps(min) = Ves(off\(max) FIV
—Vese=8V+1V—56V
=34V
Vop — Vostmi Eq.
12-9:
Vs
—
Vero
=
2
24V -3.4V ee
==
2
=
484
Electronic Devices and Circuits
=103V
_. _ Vero _ 10.3V Rs= Rp= Ip 15mA = 6.87 kO (use 6.8 kO, standard value) Rp should be Rg
hg
(13-14)
Cc
This quantity is modified by negative feedback according to (a rewritten) Eq. 13-6: Lay=
Ze 1 + Aye
Then, as always, the circuit output impedance is given by Eq. 13-7, which
must also be rewritten for the circuit in Fig. 13-23: Zout = Zo | Ro
An emitter follower output stage can be added to any of the amplifiers previously discussed. However, the combination of an emitter follower out-
put stage with a differential amplifier has a particular significance that will be explained in Chapter 14. Example 13-9 Calculate the output impedance for the circuit modification in Fig. 13-23, assuming that hic = hie = 2 kO, and hg = hfe = 100. Also
25 000 and B = 1/33.4, as for Examples 13-7 and 13-8. Solution
Big, 13-14
Zz, = Nie 7 Rg _ 2kO + 10 kO = 1200
Eq. 13-6:
Zo =
—_— 1+ A,B
as 1 + (25 000/33.4)
= 0.162 Eq. 13-7:
Zot = Rg |Z. = 10 kO|]0.16 © = 0.160
assume
that A, =
Chapter 13
Amplifiers with Negative Feedback
569
My ‘o-stage differential amplifier with negative feedback, as in Fig. 13-22,
134.0 A
‘ is to use 2N3904 and 2N3906 BJTs with a +15 V supply. The closed-loop ~ gain is to be 50. Determine suitable resistor values. 13-42 Calculate the minimum open-loop gain for the circuit in Problem
mee 13-41. Determine Z;, and Zou.
sks
eA
Baers 2
43-5 EMITTER CURRENT FEEDBACK Emitter Current Feedback Circuit Emitter current feedback is produced by connecting an unbypassed resistor (termed a swamping resistor) in series with the emitter terminal of a transistor, as shown in Fig. 13-24a. The effects of an unbypassed emitter resistor in a CE
circuit were analyzed in Section 6-5, where it was shown that the circuit impedances and voltage gains are as follows:
Eq. 6-20; —
Zp = hie + Rex(1 + hye)
Eq. 6-12:
Zin = Ri||Re||Zp
Eq. 6-14:
Zout = (1/Noe) || Rce*Re
Bg, 6-21:
|
—h,.(Rc||R fe(Rc||
Rr)
hie + Rey(1 + Age)
Eq. 6-22:
Ry
120 kO = C
ails 0.15 pF Ry =
39 kQ a Emitter current
A
Ys
feedback resistor
(swamping resistor)
(a) Emitter current feedback circuit
Figure
13-24
(b) Signal, input, and feedback voltages
Single-stage CE amplifier using emitter current feed-
back. The voltage gain is A, ~ (Ro||R/Res-
570
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Equation 6-20 shows that the input impedance at the base of a transistor
with an unbypassed emitter resistor is considerably increased above its normal value without feedback (h;-). This raises the circuit input impedance, as
defined by Eq. 6-12. Therefore, emitter current feedback increases the circuit input impedance. Figure 13-24b shows that the circuit feedback loop is from the transistor base to the emitter, then back to the base again. The collector resistor is outside the feedback loop. The circuit output impedance remains approximately equal to Rc (see Eq. 6-14). So, emitter current feedback has no effect on the circuit output impedance (see Section 6-5). The precise voltage gain for the circuit in Fig. 13-24a is given by Eq. 6-21, and Eq. 6-22 can be used for calculation of the approximate
voltage
gain.
Equation 6-22 is derived from Eq. 6-21 by assuming that hie> r¢, so the capacitor can be calculated from
(13-15)
Xco = Re at fy Example 13-11
Modify the CE amplifier circuit designed in Examples 12-2 and 12-3 to use emitter current feedback to give Ay = 70 (see Fig. 13-25). The lower cutoff frequency is 100 Hz, and the signal source resistance is 600 (2.
Figure 13-25 Emitter current feedback circuit for Ex. 13-11.
Solution
From Eq. 6-22,
Re|[RL _ 12kO|}120 ka
Ren “Ay
70
= 156 © (use 150 © standard value) Reo = Re - Re = 3.9 kO — 150 0 = 3.75 kO (use 3.9 kQ)
572
Eq.
Electronic Devices and Circuits 6-20:
Z (min) = hie + Rgy(1 af hfe) =2kQ0
Eq. 6-12:
+
150 Od
+
100)
= 17.2kO Zin = Ri ||Ro|| Zp = 120 kO||39 kO || 17.2 kO = 10.8kO 1
Eq.
12-4:
Ci
=
arf, (Zp, +7,
/10
1 ~ 2arx 100 Hz x (10.8 kQ + 600 )/10 =14 pF Eq.
13-15:
(use 1.5 uF standard value)
Xc2 = Rr at fi
Co
_
2: *! 1 Qa fiRe, 27x100Hzx 1500
= 10.6 pF (use 10 pF standard value)
Two-Stage Circuit with Emitter Current Feedback All of the two-stage amplifiers discussed in Chapter 12 can be designed to use
emitter current feedback for voltage gain stabilization and increased input impedance. The design procedures are essentially those already discussed. Consider the two-stage, capacitor-coupled circuit in Fig. 13-26. The volt-
age gain for stage 1 is calculated as follows:
From Eq. 6-22,
Agi ©
and for stage 2,
Ay =
RallZing
Re
— RgllRy R
9
(13-16)
(13-17)
The overall voltage gain is Ay = Ay
X Ay
When designing a two-stage circuit with emitter current feedback, the gain
of each stage is determined as
Au = Ay = VA,
(13-18)
Although the two stages can be designed for identical gains, R3|| Zing is un-
likely to equal Rg||Rz. So Ry and Rg are likely to be unequal.
—
Amplifiers with Negative Feedback
Chapter 13
.
573
© Vec
|
Cy
as Figure 13-26 Two-stage, capacitor-coupled BUT amplifier using emitter current feedback in each stage.
For the reasons discussed in Section 12-3, the emitter bypass capacitors
are determined from
Xc4=0.65R, at f,
and
(13-20)
The circuit input impedance is, once again, given by Eqs 6-20 and 6-12, and the output impedance is simply the collector resistor in the second stage (see Eq. 6-14). Example 13-12 The circuit in Fig. 13-25 is to be modified for use as each stage of the circuit in Fig. 13-27. The overall voltage gain is to be 1000, and the lower cutoff frequency is to be 100 Hz. Determine suitable emitter resistor values. Assume transistor parameters of lie = 2kQ and hye = 100.
Solution
Ay
Eq. 13-18:
= Aw = VA,
. ine
= 31.6
From Eq. 13-17,
Roe Rg|[Ru _ 12 kO|[120 ko |
Aw
31.6
= 345 © (use 330 2 standard value) Rio = Rg — Ro =
3.9 kO — 330.0
= 3.57 kO (use 3.9 kQ)
574
Electronic Devices and Circuits
R3
Re
12kQ
_ 120k9
Rg
220 0,
Ry
39 kO
Figure 13-27 Emitter current feedback amplifier circuit for Examples 13-12 and 13-13.
Ay2 becomes
_Rsl[Ri Re
12 kO||120 ko 330 2
~33 Therefore,
From Eq. 6-20,
Avy — 1000 An®— Ay = —— 33 = 30.3 Zp2 = Hie + Ro(1 + hee)
= 2k + 330.A(1 + 100) = 35.3 kO From Eq. 6-12,
Zin = Ro||R7||Zv2 = 120 kO||39 kO|/35.3 kA = 16kO
From Eq. 13-16,
_R3llZing _ 12kO.|[16 kO a 30.3 = 220 2 (use 220 0 standard value) Rs = Rg — Rg =3.9kO — 2200 = 3.68 kQ, (use 3.9 kQ)
Example 13-13 Calculate suitable capacitor values for the two-stage circuit in Ex. 13-12. Solution
Eq. 6-20: = 24.2 kO
Chapter 13 — Amplifiers with Negative Feedback
——_—
575
Eg. 6-12: Zina = Ri ||Ro||Zv1 = 120 kQ|]39 kO||24.2 kO = 13.3k0 Eq. 12-4:
=
Cy
1
1
2Qarfi(Zint + emitter).
Chapter 13
Amplifiers with Negative Feedback
577
Figure 13-30 AC equivalent for the current feedback circuit Fig. 13-29, showing ac voltages and currents.
Thus, some of the signal current is diverted away from the base of Q). This means that the output current (i,2) is less than it would be if there were no
current feedback; consequently, the circuit current gain is reduced.
2 ei
iene
eeN
emit,
9, co
Current Gain To determine the effect of negative feedback on the circuit current gain, first
investigate the current gain without feedback (the open-loop current gain). Suppose that Rr in Fig. 13-30 has a bypass capacitor connected across it so that there is no negative feedback. Assuming that the resistance of Rp; is very much larger than the Q; input impedance (hie), virtually all of i, enters the base of Q; (See Fig. 13-30).
So and
ig ¥ iy gy © Niger 11
Current i,; divides between R; and Zj2. Using the current divider equation,
ig X Ry Rh + ee
2 een
ig = 1c2 = yer ive
a
i, = Nfer tea Ry - Nor Mfer ii Ra Ry + Zi Ry + Zia
The open-loop current gain is i A,
==
i
—_ hfen fer Ra
578
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Now derive an equation for the current gain with negative feedback. Referring to Fig. 13-30, it is seen that i, (in the emitter circuit of Q2) divides between Rp; and Rr, giving ‘ _
lo *
Rp
_
iB
Rpt + Reo where
Rpg
Le
Rr, + Rep
Also, and
ig = i, + ig = ij + (0B
ip= Aji; Therefore, ig= i; + (Aj 4B) = (1 + A;B) The closed-loop current gain is
(CL)
oe
i,
(1 + A,B)
(13-22)
heap:
If A;B >> 1, then
ee
AaaOs Bia BAG)
a
Rei
Re
Re
(13-23 )
It is seen that
parallel current negative feedback stabilizes circuit current gain. It should be noted that, in the current gain equations, the ac output current is taken as the current in the collector circuit of transistor Q,. How this current divides between a capacitor-coupled external load (R,) and the Q> collector resistor (R3) depends on the values of Ry, and R3.
Output and Input Impedances In the circuit shown in Figs 13-29 and 13-30, the Q> collector resistor (R>) is
outside the feedback loop. Therefore, like the case of emitter current feedback, the output impedance of this circuit is largely unaffected by feedback. (It can be shown that the impedance ‘looking into’ the collector of Q> is increased by current feedback.) So the circuit output impedance is Zo
Ro
Assuming that Rp; >> hiei, the circuit input impedance without feedback
is given by
UD;
Zi © hier = >
Ss
Chapter 13
= Amplifiers with Negative Feedback
579
As already shown, with negative feedback, is = i,+ ig = i;(1 + AjB)
1,
i(1 oe
AjB)
jes Eero es
or
,
1+
(13-24)
A,B
Therefore, parallel-current negative feedback reduces circuit input impedance by a factor of (1 + A;B).
Another way
of looking at the circuit input impedance is in terms of the
feedback resistor Ry; and the voltage gain of the first stage. It can be shown that R
(13-25)
Zi = Nea | = v1
Circuit Design As with other negative feedback circuits, the designing of a parallel current negative feedback amplifier is approached by first ignoring the ac negative
feedback components. Resistors Rg) and Rs in Fig. 13-29 are calculated as a single emitter resistor (Rg = Rp) + Rs) to fulfil the desired de conditions. Also, Rp is calculated (as for other dc feedback bias circuits) to provide the required base current to Q;. Rp is then calculated from Eq. 13-23. Usually, the resis-
tance of Rr; is very large, and this results in a calculated resistance for Rr larger than (Rp2 + Rs)! In this case, the base resistor for Q; should be made up of two resistors, one of which is bypassed: see (Rz = Rp, + Rz) in Fig. 13-31. Rp; is the unbypassed portion of R2, and this is calculated in relation to Rpo.
2.2kQ
Rg1000
150k
Ry Cc
Rs
2.2 kO.
18 uF as
Figure 13-31
Current feedback
circuit with part of Re bypassed. The current gain is given by Aicy ~ (Re + Ra)/Ra-
580
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Bypass capacitor C (in Fig. 13-31) is calculated to give Xcz = Rp» at the desired lower cutoff frequency. Because the signal is derived from a current source, the impedance of the input coupling capacitor (C;) at f, should be much smaller than the (normally high) impedance of the signal source. Capacitor C3 is determined by making Xc3 very much smaller than Rp; at f..
Example 13-14 Analyze the circuit in Fig. 13-31 to determine the current gain and the input impedance. Assume transistor parameters of hje = 100 and hie = 2 kO.
Solution From Eq. 6-20,
Zi2 = Nieg + (1 + hfer)Rg = 2kO + (1 + 100)100 1 = 12.1k0
Open-loop current gain: hfe hfegRy _ 100 x 100 X 5.6kD
Eq. q 13-21:
AiR + Zp = 3164 Ry
From Eq. 13-23,
-5.6kO + 121 KO 100 O
B= Ret+Rg
2.2k0 +1000
_i 23 Closed-loop current gain:
Eq. . 13-22 13-22:
(CL) MCO-
Aj
=
Ty AB
3164
~
1+ (3164/23)
= 228 Act)© (Re + Ra)/Ra. Z.=
Eq. 13-24:
hieie
1+AB
2k on, ee
1+ (3164/23)
= 1460 Practice Problems 13-6.1 Modify the dc feedback pair circuit shown in Fig. 12-25a to give violas “Ae =
162
55 and ih
80 Hz. Assume that r, = 12 kQ.
Assuming transistor parameters of hie = 1kO and hg. = 50, calculate
= Zand Axctyf for the circuit in Problem 13-6.1.
Chapter 13
pins siesta
~_—__
13-7
Amplifiers with Negative Feedback
581
ADDITIONAL EFFECTS OF NEGATIVE FEEDBACK
Decibels of Feedback Negative feedback can be measured in decibels. A statement that 40 dB of feedback has been applied to an amplifier means that the amplifier gain has been reduced by 40 dB (that is, by a factor of 100). Thus, Act == Ay — 40 dB
== Be 100
Bandwidth Consider the typical gain-frequency response of an amplifier, as illustrated in Fig. 13-32. Without negative feedback, the amplifier open-loop gain (A,) falls
off to its lower 3 dB frequency ( fi1)), as illustrated. This is usually due to the impedance of bypass capacitors increasing as the frequency decreases. Similarly, the open-loop upper cutoff frequency (f2(o1)) is produced by transistor
cutoff, by shunting capacitance, or by a combination of both. As discussed in Section 8-2, the circuit open-loop bandwidth is given by BWox = f2o1) — fio1) Now look at the typical frequency response for the same amplifier when negative feedback is used. The closed-loop gain (Act) is much smaller than the open-loop gain, and Ac, does not begin to fall off (at high or low frequen-
40
100
200
400
1k 2k 4k = f (Hz) ——
10k
20k
100
BWo) fou
fuct
fou)
fact)
Figure 13-32 Amplifier frequency response with and without negative feedback. Negative feedback extends the amplifier bandwidth.
582
Electronic Devices and Circuits
cies) until A, (open-loop gain) falls substantially. Consequently, f1(c1) is much lower than fio1), and fucty is much higher than f2o1). So the circuit band-
width with negative feedback (the closed-loop bandwidth) is much greater
than the bandwidth without negative feedback.
BWat = fac — fcr) From Eq. 13-2, Aq, =
Ay 1 + A,B
It can be shown that there is a 90° phase shift associated with the openloop gain at frequencies below fio1) and above f201). Thus, Eq. 13-2 must be rewritten as =jAy
Act, =
1 — jA,B Ay
“
Mal = Ts ay
When A,
= 1/B,
1/B
Act
Mel = Fay A
v2
a
= Ac. — 3 dB Thus, for a negative feedback amplifier designed to have the widest possible bandwidth,
the cutoff frequencies would
occur when
the open-loop
gain
falls to the equivalent of 1/B. Thus, faci) occurs when Ay = 1/B®
Aq,
(13-26)
So, for example, the cutoff frequencies for a negative feedback amplifier designed for a closed-loop gain of 100 would occur when the open-loop gain falls to 100. It is seen that
negative feedback increases amplifier bandwidth. The upper cutoff frequency
for an amplifier is usually
greater than
20 kHz, and the lower cutoff frequency is around 100 Hz or lower. So fy >> fi,
and consequently,
This means that the amplifier bandwidth is essentially equal to the upper cutoff frequency. Now refer to Fig. 13-32 once again. The amplifier gain multiplied by the upper cutoff frequency is a constant quantity. This is known as the gainbandwidth product. Therefore,
Chapter 13
Amplifiers with Negative Feedback
583
Act X fact = Av X far)
or
Ay f 2(OL)
Fact) =
(13-27)
Aci
Thus the closed-loop upper cutoff frequency for a negative feedback amplifier can be calculated from the open-loop upper cutoff frequency, the open-
loop gain, and the closed-loop gain.
Harmonic Distortion Harmonic distortion occurs when a transistor or other device is driven beyond
the linear range of its characteristics. Figure 13-33 shows the Ic/Vpg characteristics of a transistor biased to a base-emitter voltage Vz. As illustrated,
when the base-emitter voltage changes (+vp-) are very small, the collector current changes by equal positive and negative amounts (+i,). When +0p¢ is
large, the change in +7, is greater than the change in —i¢. This is because of the nonlinearity in the Ic/Vgg characteristics. The result is harmonic distor-
tion (or non-linear distortion) in the waveform of i, and in the amplifier outThe distorted waveform can be shown to consist of a fundamental frequency waveform and a number of smaller amplitude harmonic components (see Fig. 13-34). The fundamental waveform is the amplified signal, or ampli-
inne
aa
Hh
ee mee
itaalewtS Saeee
put.
V
iL
A
r+
10.8
B
(V)
Fundamental
|
(v
te)
|
Harmonics (v4) + Ube
Hf
|
+VUbe
—Ube
Figure 13-33
Harmonic distortion in the output ofan
amplifier is caused by non-linearity in transistor characteristics. Negative feedback reduces this type of distortion by a factor of (1 + A,B).
Figure 13-34
Harmonic dis-
tortion in an amplifier is reduced by negative feedback.
584
Electronic Devices and Circuits
fier output voltage (v,), and the harmonics are unwanted voltage components
(vy). The harmonic distortion is the rms value of vy expressed as a percentage of the rms value of v,. The harmonics (generated within the feedback loop) are reduced by negative feedback by a factor of (1 + AyB). Thus,
% distortion with NFB =
% distortion without NFB
(13-28)
(1 4.A,B)
Therefore,
negative feedback reduces harmonic distortion.
Attenuation Distortion Attenuation distortion occurs when different frequencies are amplified by dif-
ferent amounts. This type of distortion is the result of the amplifier open-loop gain being frequency-dependent (see Fig. 13-35). When negative feedback is used, the closed-loop gain is a constant quantity largely independent of signal frequency within the circuit bandwidth. Like harmonic distortion, attenuation distortion is reduced by a factor of (1 + AyB) by negative feedback. Equation
13-28 applies. Thus, negative feedback reduces attenuation distortion.
i (Hz)-——+> Figure 13-35
Attenuation distortion, resulting from different signal
frequencies being amplified by different amounts,
is reduced
by
negative feedback.
Phase Shift Input signals to an amplifier go through phase shifts from the input to the output. The waveforms in Fig. 13-36 show that, ina two-stage circuit, there is
a 180° phase shift from v; to v1, and a further 180° shift from vo; to Vo2. In
Chapter 13 — Amplifiers with Negative Feedback
—
some
cases,
an
amplifier
can
produce
585
different
hase shifts for different signal frequencies. For
example,
higher
frequency
signals
might
be
shifted by more than 180° at each stage, resulting
mae
in an undesirable
phase difference (¢) between
input and output, as illustrated. Audio (and other) signals at an amplifier input
are usually made up of a combination of component waveforms with different amplitudes and different frequencies. Consequently, any variation in amplifier-introduced phase shift will create distor-
tion in the output waveform that is not present in the input. To investigate the effect of negative feedback
Phase
on amplifier phase shift, assume that the openloop gain has a phase shift angle of ¢,and that the n ift isi shift phase d-loop sata:
and
.
P
ac waveforms
‘
Pc. ihe
T
shift Figure 13-36 Undesirable ifts ini amp lifier phase shifts
open-loop gain = A,/¢
Aci [Ga
=
iv
ewe
Ald ~ 1+ A,B/p
=o-
ene
are re-
duced by negative feedback.
A,B sin b = ; ‘ 1+ A,Bcos¢ + jA,B sin d
=
A,Bsind
_,
a
(
1+A,B cos
Oe
13-29
)
Thus,
negative feedback reduces amplifier phase shift by an angle of
tan!
an
A,B sin
1 + A,Boos ¢
Example 13-15 A negative feedback amplifier has an open-loop gain of 60 000 and a closedloop gain of 300. If the open-loop upper cutoff frequency is 15 kHz, estimate
the closed-loop upper cutoff frequency. Also, calculate the total harmonic distortion with feedback if there is 10% harmonic distortion without feedback. Solution Av f1(0L)
Eq. 13-27:
facy =
4 a
= 3 MHz
Eq. 13-28:
_ 60000
x 15 kHz
300
586
Electronic Devices and Circuits
distortij on withi NEB
% di
% distortion without NFB _ =
(1+ A.B)
~
10%
1+ (60000/300
= 0.05%
Noise Circuit noise generated within the feedback loop of an amplifier is reduced by
a factor of (1 + A,B) in the same way that unwanted harmonics are reduced.
It should be noted that only the noise generated within the feedback loop is reduced by feedback. Noise produced by bias resistors outside the feedback
loop will not be affected by feedback.
Negative feedback reduces circuit noise.
Circuit Stability In Chapter 16, it is explained that, for a circuit to oscillate, the loop phase shift must be 360° when the loop gain is 1. The loop phase shift is the phase shift around the loop from the amplifier input to the output, and back via the feedback network to the input. Similarly, the loop gain is the product of the amplifier open-loop gain and the feedback network attenuation (A,B).
The loop phase shift of an amplifier can approach 360° as the gain falls off at the high end of the bandwidth. In this case, the amplifier might oscillate, and it is said to be unstable. The usual method of combating this kind of instability is to include small shunting capacitors from the transistor collector terminals to ground. These tend to cause the loop gain to fall below 1 before
the loop phase shift approaches 360°. Amplifier instability and compensation techniques are further covered in Chapter 15.
Practice Problems 13-7.1 The amplifier in Ex. 13-15 has a 15° open-loop phase shift at high signal frequencies. Calculate the phase shift with negative feedback. 13-7.2
A negative feedback amplifier with a closed-loop gain of 250 has
a 4 MHz upper cutoff frequency. Calculate the open-loop cutoff frequency if the open-loop gain is 200 000.
Review Questions Section 13-1 13-1
13-2
Draw a
sketch to illustrate the principle of series voltage negative feedback,
and briefly explain. List the major effects of negative feedback on an amplifier.
Derive an equation for the voltage gain of an amplifier that uses series voltage
negative feedback.
Chapter 13 — Amplifiers with Negative Feedback
13-3
13-4 13-5
587
Derive an equation for the input impedance of an amplifier that uses series voltage negative feedback. Derive an equation for the output impedance of an amplifier that uses series voltage negative feedback. Discuss the effect of input bias resistors on the input impedance of a negative feedback amplifier, and the effect of a collector resistor at the output of a BJT negative feedback amplifier.
Section 13-2 13-6
Sketch the circuit of a two-stage, capacitor-coupled BJT amplifier that uses series voltage negative feedback. Briefly explain how the feedback operates, and write an equation for the voltage gain in terms of the feedback components.
13-7
Briefly discuss the procedure for determining the negative feedback components for the circuit in Question 13-6.
13-8
For the circuit in Question 13-6, write equations for the input impedance and
output impedance in terms of the circuit components and transistor parameters.
Section 13-3 13-9
Sketch the circuit of a direct-coupled, two-stage BJT amplifier that uses series
voltage negative feedback. Q; should be an npn device, and Q2 should be a pnp transistor. Briefly explain the feedback operation, and write the equation for voltage gain in terms of the circuit components. 13-10 For the circuit in Question 13-9, write equations for Zin and Zou in terms of the transistor parameters and the circuit components.
13-11 Briefly discuss the design procedures for the circuit in Question 13-9. 13-12 Sketch the circuit of a dc feedback pair that uses series voltage negative feedback. Explain the operation of the feedback network, and write an equation for the voltage gain in terms of the circuit components. 13-13 For the circuits in Question 13-12, write equations for Zin and Zin
terms of
the transistor parameters and the circuit components. 13-14 Briefly discuss the design procedures for the circuit in Question 13-12.
13-15 Sketch the circuit of a direct-coupled, two-stage BIFET amplifier that uses series
voltage negative feedback. Explain the operation of the circuit, and write an equation for the voltage gain in terms of the circuit components. 13-16 For the circuits in Question 13-15, write equations for Zj, and Zou; in terms of the transistor parameters and the circuit components.
13-17 Briefly discuss the design procedures for the circuit in Question 13-15.
Section 13-4 13-18 Sketch the circuit of a two-stage, direct-coupled negative feedback amplifier that uses a two-transistor, emitter-coupled input stage. Explain the operation of the circuit.
588
Electronic Devices and Circuits
13-19 Write equations for Avct), Zin, ANA Zout for the circuit in Question 13-18. 13-20 Briefly discuss the design procedures for the circuit in Question 13-18.
Section 13-5 13-21 Sketch the circuit of a single-stage common emitter amplifier that uses emitter current feedback. Briefly explain the operation of the circuit. 13-22 For the single-stage circuit sketched for Question 13-21, write equations for
AyCLy Zin, and Zout13-23 Briefly explain the design procedure for the circuit in Question 13-21. 13-24 Sketch a two-stage, capacitor-coupled BJT amplifier that uses emitter current feedback in each stage. Briefly explain the operation of the circuit. 13-25 Discuss the design procedure for the two-stage circuit in Question 13-24. 13-26 Sketch the circuit of a direct-coupled, two-stage, BJT amplifier that uses emitter current feedback. Q; should be an npn device, and Q2 should be a pup transistor. 13-27 Write equations for A,c1), Zin, aNd Zox¢ for the circuit in Question 13-26.
Section 13-6 13-28 Sketch a direct-coupled dc feedback pair amplifier that uses parallel current
negative feedback. Briefly explain the operation of the circuit, and discuss its performance characteristics. 13-29 Write equations for Aic1), Zin, and Zou for the circuit in Question 13-28.
13-30 Discuss the design procedure for the two-stage circuit in Question 13-28.
Section 13-7 13-31 Using illustrations, explain the effects of negative feedback on the bandwidth of an amplifier. Discuss the effect of open-loop gain reduction on the closedloop gain.
13-32 Draw sketches to explain how harmonic distortion occurs in an amplifier. Discuss the effects of negative feedback on harmonic distortion. 13-33 Explain attenuation distortion, and discuss the effects of negative feedback on attenuation distortion.
13-34 Explain how phase shift distortion occurs in an amplifier, and discuss how negative feedback affects phase shift. 13-35 Discuss the effect of negative feedback on circuit noise.
13-36 Briefly discuss amplifier stability with negative feedback.
Problems Section 13-1 13-1 A two-stage BJT amplifier has an open-loop voltage gain of 224 000 when the transistors have a maximum hf. value, and 14 000 when the transistor /1 fe Val-
ues are a minimum. Calculate the closed-loop gain for both cases when negative feedback is used with a feedback factor of 1/125.
Chapter 13 — Amplifiers with Negative Feedback
—_—_——
13-2
589
The amplifier in Problem 13-1 has an input impedance of 1.2 kO at the base of
the input transistor when negative feedback is not used. Voltage divider bias with R; = 150 kO and R2 = 56 kO is used at the input transistor. Calculate the
circuit input impedance (with negative feedback) at both hy. extremes.
13-3
The output transistor in the amplifier in Problem 13-1 has 1/hoe 80 kO. and a 5.6 kO collector resistor. Calculate the circuit output impedance at both h¢extremes.
13-4
The closed-loop gain of a negative feedback amplifier is measured as 99.7 when the feedback factor is 1/100, and as 297 when a feedback factor of 1/300
is used. Determine the open-loop gain.
Section 13-2 13-5
The circuit in Fig. 13-16 is to be modified to have an overall voltage gain of 50 and a lower cutoff frequency of 150 Hz. Calculate the new values for Rr, Rrz, Co and
13-6
13-7
Cri.
Analyze the negative feedback input and output impedances. hie = 800 2, hfe = 60, and 1/hoe A two-stage, capacitor-coupled
amplifier in Problem 13-5 to determine the Assume that the transistor parameters are = 90 kO. The open-loop gain is 97 000. BJT amplifier as in Fig. 12-15 has the following
components: R; = 150 kO, Rz = 56 kQ, R3 = 4.7 kQ, Rg = 5.6 kQ, Rs = 150 kO,
Re = 56 kQ, Ry = 4.7 kO, Rg = 5.6 kQ, Ry = 47 kO, C) = 10 pE Co = 180 pF
C3 = 10 pE, and Cy = 180 uF. Modify the circuit to use series voltage negative feedback.
13-8
The voltage gain is to be 180, and the required lower cutoff fre-
quency is 90 Hz. Calculate the input and output impedances for the circuit in Problem 13-7. Assume
that
the
transistor
parameters
are
hje= 1.2
kQ,
hte = 90,
and
1/Roe = 75 kQ.
Section 13-3 13-9
A two-stage, direct-coupled BJT amplifier as in Fig. 12-20 has the following components: R; = 100 kQ, R2 = 39 kQ, R3 = 3.9 kO, Ra = 3.9 kQ, Rs = 2.7 kQ,
Re = 3.9kO, Ry, = 33 kQ, Cy = 8 pF Cp = 150 wE,C3 = 150 pF. Modify the circuit to use series voltage negative feedback to give a gain of 75 and a lower cutoff
frequency of 60 Hz. 13-10 Calculate the input and output impedances for the circuit in Problem 13-9 if the transistor parameters are Itie = 1 kQ,, hfe = 120, and 1/Nge = 100 kO.
13-11 The two-stage, direct-coupled BJT amplifier designed in Examples 12-8 and 12-9 (and analyzed in Ex. 12-10) is to be converted into a negative feedback amplifier with a voltage gain of 120 and a lower cutoff frequency of 20 Hz. Make the necessary modifications and determine the new component values. 13-12 A two-stage, direct-coupled amplifier with complementary transistors is to be designed to use negative feedback, as in Fig. 13-17. The overall voltage gain is to be 150, and the lower 3 dB frequency is to be 200 Hz. Calculate suitable values for Rpy, Rp2, and C2.
590
Electronic Devices and Circuits
13-13 A dc feedback pair using negative feedback (as in Fig. 13-18) is to have Ayct = 80, f1 = 120 Hz, and fz = 50 kHz. Calculate suitable component values for the feedback network. 13-14 Calculate Zi, and Zou: for the circuit in Fig. 13-18. Use the component values
shown and the transistor parameters hie = 1.2 kO,, hfe = 90, and 1/hoe = 95 kQ, 13-15 A two-stage, negative feedback BIFET amplifier, as in Fig. 13-19, is to have Ao(ct) = 19 and f; = 400 Hz. Calculate suitable values for Rri, Rr2, and Cry.
13-16 Calculate the direct current through the feedback networks in the circuits in Figs 13-17 and 13-19 when the feedback network is directly connected instead
of capacitor-coupled. Section 13-4 13-17 The circuit in Fig. 13-21 is to be designed to have Ayci) = 175. Using Vec = +12.5 V, select suitable current and voltage levels, and calculate resistor values.
Use 2N3904 and 2N3906 transistors. ' 13-18 Calculate the minimum values of Ay c1), Zin, and Zout for the circuit in Problem 13-17.
13-19 A two-stage differential amplifier circuit (as in Fig. 13-21) is to be designed to amplify a 10 mV input to 750 mV. The amplifier supply is +9 V, and the transistors to be used have hp = Age = 150, hie = 1.5 kO, and 1/A oe = 150 kf. Determine suitable resistor values.
13-20 Calculate Z; and Z, for the circuit in Problem 13-19.
Section 13-5 13-21 Design a single-stage BJT common-emitter amplifier with emitter current feedback. The circuit has the following specifications: Q; = 2N3906, Vec = —-18 V,
Ry = 150 kO, A, = 45, and f; = 50 Hz. 13-22 Analyze the circuit designed for Problem 13-21 to determine A>, Zin, Zou, and fi.
13-23 A common-emitter amplifier as in Fig. 12-1 has the following components: Ry = 120 kO, Ro= 33 kO, Rc = 6.8k0, Rg = 3.3 kO, and Ry = 68 kQ. Modify
the circuit to use emitter current feedback. The voltage gain is to be 23, and the required lower cutoff frequency is 60 Hz. The transistor parameters are
the following: hie = 1.2 kO, hie = 90,1/hoe = 95kO, andr, = 13 2. 13-24 Calculate Ay, Zin, and Zou: for the circuit in Problem 13-23. 13-25 Two stages of the circuit in Problem 13-23 are to be connected in cascade to give an overall voltage gain of approximately 1600 and a lower cutoff frequency of 50 Hz. Determine the necessary modifications. 13-26 An amplifier is to be designed using two stages of the circuit designed for Problem 13-21. The overall voltage gain is to be 900 and the lower cutoff frequency is to be 100 Hz. Determine the necessary modifications.
13-27 Analyze the circuit designed for Problem 13-25 to determine Ay, Zin, and Zout: 13-28 Analyze the circuit designed for Problem 13-26 to determine A,, Zin, and Zout: 13-29 A dc feedback pair (as in Fig. 12-25a) is to be modified to use emitter current feedback. The circuit specifications are Vcc = 15 V, R, = 80 kQ, A, = 400, and fi = 70 Hz. Design the circuit to use 2N3904 BJTs.
Chapter 13
Amplifiers with Negative Feedback
591
13-30 Analyze the circuit designed for Problem 13-29 to determine Ap, Zin, and ZoutSection 13-6 13-31 A dc feedback pair is to be designed to use parallel current negative feedback, as in Fig. 13-29. Using Vcc = 22 V and transistors with Mrz = hfe = 75 and
hie = 2.2 kO, design the circuit to have Ic = 0.9 mA, Aj = 22, and f; = 200 Hz. 13-32 Calculate A; and Z;,, for the circuit in Problem 13-31. 13-33 A dc feedback pair as in Fig. 12-25a has the following components: R; = 12 kQ, Rg = 330 kO, R3 = 4.7 kO, Ra = 2.7 kQ, and Cy = 240 pF. Determine the neces-
sary modification to give Aj = 30 and ff = 75 Hz. 13-34 Analyze the circuit designed for Problem 13-33 to determine Aj and Zin. Assume
that h¢e, = hgeo = 100 and that hier
= Aieg = 1 kO.
Section 13-7 13-35 The amplifier in Example 13-4 has 5% total harmonic distortion in its output waveform when negative feedback is not used. Calculate the new distortion
content with negative feedback. 13-36 If the amplifier in Example 13-4 has a 17° open-loop phase shift at high frequencies, determine the phase shift with negative feedback. 13-37 The negative feedback amplifier in Examples 13-7 and 13-8 has a 30 kHz openloop upper cutoff frequency. Calculate the upper cutoff frequency with negative feedback. 13-38 A negative feedback amplifier with B = 1/105 produces a 2 V output when the input is 20 mV. Distortion content in the output is 1%. Find the new sig-
nal level to give 2 V output when the negative feedback is disconnected. Also, determine the new distortion content in the output.
Practice Problem
13-1.1 13-2.1 13-2.2 13-3.1 13-3.2 13-4.1 13-4.2 13-5.1 13-5.2 13-6.1 13-6.2 13-7.1 13-7.2
Answers
1.42 kQ, 5.2 kO, 26.3 kQ, 28 , 134.9 100 0, 3.9 kO, 33 pF, 10 kO, 33 wF 27.5kQ, 113.0 3300, 68kQ, 171 pA 150 0, 2.7kQ, 5.6 pF, 30 pF, 3000 pF 4.7kQ, 10 kQ, 6.8 kQ, 10 kM, (220k + 1 kQ), 4.7 kO, 4.7 kO, 15 kO 4.7k0, 34.90 (68 kO + 10k), 47 kQ, 4.7 kQ, 120 Q, 4.7 kO, 2.7 kQ, 150 0, 3.9 kO 2.7 pF, 27 pE, 22 pF, 0.47 pF 100 9, 5.6 kO, 1.8 pF, 20 pF, 39 pF 610,878 0.08° 5 kHz
CHAPTER
14
IC Operational Amplifiers
and Basic Op-Amp Circuits Objectives You will be able to:
1 Sketch and briefly explain an operational amplifier circuit symbol and the basic input and output stages, and identify all terminals.
2 List and discuss the most important op-amp parameters.
3 Design op-amp bias circuits, and show how to null the output offset. 4 Sketch the following linear op-amp circuits in directcoupled and capacitor-coupled configuration and explain the operation of each: ° voltage follower ¢ non-inverting amplifier ¢ inverting amplifier 5 Analyze and design circuits of the type listed in Objective 4 above.
Sketch the following linear opamp circuits and explain the
operation of each: * summing amplifier ¢ difference amplifier ¢ instrumentation amplifier
Analyze and design circuits of the type listed in Objective 6 above. Sketch the following nonlinear op-amp circuits and explain the operation of each: * zero crossing detector
¢ inverting Schmitt trigger circuit
° non-inverting Schmitt trigger Analyze and design circuits of the type listed in Objective 8 above.
INTRODUCTION An operational amplifier is a high-gain amplifier circuit with two highimpedance input terminals and one low-impedance output. The inputs are identified as inverting input and non-inverting input. The basic circuit consists
of a differential amplifier input stage and an emitter follower output stage. The voltage gains of integrated circuit (IC) operational amplifiers are extremely high, typically 200000. Because of this high voltage gain, externally connected resistors must be employed to provide negative feedback. Design of IC op-amp circuits involves determination of suitable
Chapter 14 values
for
the external
components.
(C Operational Amplifiers
593
The design calculations are usually
much simpler than for discrete-component circuits.
14-1
INTEGRATED CIRCUIT OPERATIONAL AMPLIFIERS
Circuit Symbol and Packages Figure 14-1a shows the triangular circuit symbol for an operational amplifier (op-amp). As illustrated, there are two input terminals, one output terminal, and two supply terminals. The inputs are identified as the inverting input
(— sign) and the non-inverting input (+ sign). A positive-going voltage at the inverting input produces a negative-going (inverted) voltage at the output terminal. Conversely, a positive-going voltage at the non-inverting input generates an output which is also positive-going (non-inverted). Plus /minus supplies are normally used with op-amps, and so the supply terminals are identified as +Vcc and —Vgp. Non-inverting
Yee
input
14
8
Inverting
2% 34 Al
7 6 5
mE
oO —VeEE
(a) Op-amp circuit symbol
Top view (b) Terminal connections
for DIP package
Top view (c) Terminal connections
for metal can package
Operational amplifier circuit symbol! and terminal connections. The + and Figure 14-1 — signs identify the non-inverting and inverting input terminals, respectively.
Two typical op-amp packages are illustrated in Figs 14-1b and c. For both the dual-in-line plastic (DIP) package and the metal can package, terminals 2 and 3 are the inverting and non-inverting inputs, respectively, terminal 6 is the output, and terminals 7 and 4 are the + and — supply terminals.
Basic Internal Circuit The basic circuit of an IC operational amplifier is essentially as shown in Fig. 13-23 and further illustrated in Figs 14-2a and b. (The actual op-amp
internal circuitry is much more complex.) The differential-amplifier input stage has two (inverting and non-inverting) high-impedance input terminals, and the emitter follower output stage has a low impedance. An intermediate stage between the input and output stages is largely responsible for the op-amp high voltage gain. Figure 14-2a shows a BJT input stage, while Fig. 14-2b has a FET input stage. Op-amps that exclusively use BJTs are termed bipolar op-amps, and those that use a FET input stage with . BJT additional stages are referred to as BIFET op-amps.
594
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Iz GaP
vad
Ole cs Iz
(a) Basic input and output stages for a bipolar op-amp
Figure 14-2
(b) Basic input and output stages for a BIFET op-amp
Input and output stages for bipolar and BIFET operational amplifiers. The
FET gate current is very much smaller than the BUT base current.
Important Parameters Some of the most important parameters for the 741 operational amplifier (one of the most commonly used) are listed in the data sheet portion shown
in Fig. 14-3. The large-signal voltage gain (Ay), also called the open-loop gain (Ayov)), for the 741 is listed as 50 000 minimum and 200 000 typical. This means that a
signal applied as a voltage difference between the two input terminals is amplified by a factor of at least 50 000. The typical amplification is 200 000, and the maximum amplification can be considerably greater. This is similar to the
situation with
the hy of a BJT, where
the
manufacturer
specifies
minimum, typical, and maximum values. Electrical characteristics (Ve = 415 V, T, = 25°C unless otherwise specified)
Parameters
Largesignal Palace cainitA,)
Conditions
~ V0RL =2kQ, = +10V
Min
Rg = 10 kO.
Input offset current (Io)
| Input resistance (r;)
Output resistance (79)
Figure 14-3
Max |
Unit
80
500 |
nA
1.0
5.0 | mV
20
200
50.000 | 200000
Input bias current (Ijp) Input offset voltage (Vio)
Typ
Portion of data sheet for a 741 op-amp.
0.3
nA
2
MQ
75
a
Chapter 14
—_‘|C Operational Amplifiers
595
The input bias current (Ig) is the base current for the op-amp input stage
transistors. In Fig. 14-3, pg is listed as 80 nA typical and 500 nA maximum.
Ideally, the input stage transistors should be perfectly matched, so that zero voltage difference between the two input (base) terminals should produce a zero output voltage. In practice, there is always some difference
between the base-emitter voltages of the transistors, and this results in an
input offset voltage (Vio), that might be as large as 5 mV for a 741 op-amp. Similarly, because of mismatch of input transistors, there is also an input offset current (Io). For the 741 Ito is a maximum of 200 nA. The input resistance (r;) and the output resistance (ro) are the resistances at
the op-amp terminals when no feedback is involved. Since virtually all opamp
applications
use negative
feedback,
these
(resistance)
quantities
are
modified in practical circuits. The de supply voltage for electronic circuits can vary when the supply current changes, and in some cases there is an ac ripple voltage superimposed
on the dc. The supply voltage changes can be passed to the output of an amplifier. Ideally, the supply voltage variations should have no effect on the circuit output. How good the amplifier is at attenuating supply voltage variations is determined by the power supply voltage rejection ratio (PSRR). This is usually specified in decibel form. Common mode inputs are voltage changes that are applied simultaneously to both input terminals of an operational amplifier. Common-mode input voltages can be passed to the output. The common-mode rejection ratio (CMRR) (expressed in dB) defines how good the amplifier is at attenuating commonmode input voltages.
Practice Problems 14-1.1 Determine the following parameter values from the LM108 op-amp data sheet A-14 in Appendix A: large signal voltage gain, input bias current, input offset voltage, and input resistance. 14-1.2 Repeat Problem 14-1.1 for the LF353 op-amp data sheet A-15 in Appendix A.
14-2
BIASING OPERATIONAL AMPLIFIERS
Biasing Bipolar Op-amps Like other electronic devices, operational amplifiers must be correctly biased if they are to function properly. As already explained, the inputs of an operational amplifier are the base terminals of the transistors in a differential amplifier. Base currents must flow into these terminals for the transistors to Operate. Consequently, the input terminals must be directly connected to
suitable dc bias voltage sources.
596
Electronic Devices and Circuits
|
The most appropriate dc bias voltage for op-amp inputs is approximately halfway between the positive and negative supply voltages. One of the two input terminals is usually connected in some TV Ge way to the op-amp output to facilitate negative
fu
ground via a signal source (see Fig. 14-4). Base
pal
3 5
feedback. Where a plus/minus supply is used, the other input might be biased directly to thas
vo. pe
current Ip; flows into the op-amp non-inverting
input via the signal source, while Ip2 flows from = _L the output into the inverting input, as Figure 14-4 Op-amp circuit illustrated. with one input terminal
Figure 14-5 shows a situation in which one .
;
.
input is connected via resistor R; to ground, and the other is connected via R2 to the op-amp output.
Once
grounded via a signal generator, and the other
input directly connected to the output.
again base current for the input
stage transistors flows into both input terminals. Resistors R; and R» should have equal values, so that voltage drops JpgiR1 and Ip2R2 are approximately
equal. Any difference in these two voltage drops appears as an op-amp dc input voltage, which may be amplified to produce a dc offset at the output. + Vee
Cy
Tp, —_—_—_—_—
o-) Us
3 Ri
I,
in the circuit in
Fig. 14-5, then a very small input resistance (Ri) would
be offered to a
capacitor-coupled signal source. On the other hand, if Rj and R» are very
large, the voltage drops Ip1R; and Ip2R2 may be ridiculously high. An acceptable maximum voltage drop across these resistors must be very much smaller than the typical Vpg level for a forward-biased base-emitter junction.
(This is also discussed in Section 5-8.) Vri © Vpz/10
—
Rigmax) = Vri/Tp(max)
and Upe
Therefore,
PS
nBh a Bo 1) Py
Rigas) =
Vv.
‘
_\BE
0D grax)
_
—_‘|C Operational Amplifiers
Chapter 14
597
Figure 14-6 shows a voltage divider (R; and R) providing an input terminal bias voltage derived from the supply voltages. The voltage-divider
current I, should be very much larger than the input bias current. This is to ensure that Ip has a negligible effect upon the bias voltage. Usually, the minimum Ip is selected as . Io¢nin)
=
100
(14-2)
TB (max)
Then R; and Rare simply calculated as Vz;/In and Vpo/ In, respectively. Resistor R3 in Fig. 14-6 should be approximately equal to Ri ||R2 to
minimize any difference between Igi(Rj||Ro) and Ip2R3 that could act as a de input voltage.
Figure 14-6
Op-amp circuit using a voltage-
divider bias circuit.
Example 14-1 Calculate the maximum resistance for R; and Rp» in Fig. 14-7a if a 741 op-amp is used. Determine suitable resistances for Ri, Rz, and R3 in Fig. 14-7b to give
Vp = 0 when the supply voltages are +15 V. —O
+ Vee
Ry IBl
-
| Ih
VB
NJ iy
6
3|°
—O
4
R,
= %
al, —Veg (a) Grounded input circuit
Figure 14-7
(b) Voltage-divider bias
Op-amp circuits for Ex. 14-1.
598.
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Solution Fig. 14-7a:
Vez
0.7 V (for op-amps with BJT input stages)
From the 741 data sheet A-13 in Appendix A,
Eq
VBE
Ruma) = 19 Ty¢nany =
* 14-1:
=
0.7 V
10 X 500 nA
= 140 kO (use 120 kO standard value) Ry = Ry
=
120 kD
Fig. 14-7b: Eq. 14-2:
Ip = 100 Ipq@nax) = 100 X 500 nA = 50 pA Vri
=
Vro =15V
_,
Ry = Ro =
. Vr
15V
In 50pA
= 300 kO (use 270 kO standard value)
R3 = Ry||Rz = 270 kO||270 kO = 135 kO (use 120 kO standard value)
A single-polarity supply voltage can be used with an operational amplifier. For example, a 741 could use a +30 V (as illustrated in Fig. 14-8) instead of a +15 V supply. Resistors Rj and R2 are normally selected to set Vp = Vec/2. The input offset voltage referred to in Section 14-1 and the resulting output offset can be reduced or eliminated in the circuit shown in Fig. 14-6 by making one of the resistors adjustable. Similarly, if R3 in Fig. 14-8 is a variable
+Voc Ry
i \h
Vp
Ro ot
3 i
6
“ei
LANA,
—1
‘ Figure 14-8
Op-amp circuit using a sing lepolarity supply.
599
_|C Operational Amplifiers
Chapter 14
resistor, it could be adjusted to reduce the op-amp output offset voltage. The
process is termed voltage offset nulling. Figure
offset
14-9 shows
nulling
with
another method
of voltage
a 741
A
op-amp.
10
+ Vee
kQ
potentiometer is connected to the differential amplifier input stage via terminals 1 and 5, as illustrated. With the moving contact connected to
° 3 0—Z i
—Vzx, the potentiometer can be adjusted to null the
>
10 kQ
output offset voltage.
O —Veg
Biasing BIFET Op-amps The input bias current for a BIFET op-amp is
Figure 14-9 Output oe aie a 7%
typically 50 pA, which is very much smaller that
op-amp with a 10 kO
that for a bioplar op-amp. So the bias resistor selection method already discussed would produce
potentiometer Sia c d5
very high
This is undesirable
resistor values.
terminals"
ee™"
because electric charges can accumulate at the FET gates and thus make the bias levels unstable. Also, stray capacitance becomes
more
effective with
high-value bias resistors, possibly resulting in unwanted circuit oscillations. Furthermore, large resistors at an amplifier input can produce unacceptable levels of thermal noise output (see Section 8-6). To combat these effects, the largest resistor in a BIFET op-amp bias circuit should normally not exceed 1 MQ. Because there is virtually no input current with a BIFET op-amp, there is no need for equal resistance values at the inverting and non-inverting input
terminals.
Example 14-2 Determine suitable resistor values for the type of circuit shown in Fig. 14-7b when a BIFET op-amp is used. The supply is +9 V and the output is to be
biased to +3 V. Solution
Select
Ry = 1 MQ (standard value) Va=V,=t+3V Vero = Va —- Vez =3V
— (-9 V)
=12V Vri
=
Vec
— Vs
=9V-3V
=6V ;
Vro_
2 RR,
12V
1MO
600
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Vix:
RS
6.
pA
= 500 kO, (use 470 kO. + 33 kQ) R3 =0
Practice Problems = 14-2.1 A
Le
eins
{ f
741 op-amp is used with a +24 V supply in the type of circuit
shown in Fig. 14-8. Determine suitable bias resistor values. 14-2.2 Repeat eee 14-2,1 to bias the input to +10 V.
14-3
VOLTAGE FOLLOWER CIRCUITS
Direct-Coupled Voltage Follower The IC operational amplifier can be employed for an infinite variety of applications. The very simplest application is the direct-coupled voltage follower shown in Fig. 14-10a. The output terminal is connected directly to the inverting input terminal, the signal is applied to the non-inverting input, and the load is directly coupled to the output. {
+Vee
O+Vcc
External connection ‘
(b) Basic op-amp circuit connected as a voltage follower Figure 14-10 Ina voltage follower circuit, the output terminal is directly connected to the inverting input terminal. As the input voltage changes, the output follows the input to keep the inverting input terminal voltage equal to the non-inverting terminal voltage.
Chapter 14 —=— IC Operational Amplifiers
—
601
Figure 14-10b shows the basic op-amp circuit connected as a voltage follower. With the differential amplifier input stage (see Sections 12-8 and
13-4), V2 (which equals V,) must equal V;. When V2 is higher or lower than V,, the voltage difference is amplified to move the output back to equality
with the input. Suppose V, were slightly higher than V;. The voltage at Q» base (terminal 2) would be higher than that at Q; base (terminal 3); therefore Ic2 would be increased above its normal level. This would cause an increase in the voltage drop across Rc, thus reducing Vp3 and driving Vo back to
equality with Vj. Similarly, when V, is lower than Vj, Q2 base voltage is lower than that at Q; base and Ic is reduced, thus reducing Vrc, increasing Vp3, and driving V, back up toward Vj. This is, of course, negative feedback
as described in Section 13-4.
When the input voltage (at terminal 3) is increased or decreased, the feedback effect causes the output to follow the input almost perfectly. The actual difference between the input and output voltage is easily calculated from the output voltage level and the op-amp open-loop voltage gain. Like an emitter follower, the voltage follower has a high input impedance, a low output impedance, and a voltage gain of 1. However,
follower
performance
demonstrated
is superior
to that of the emitter
the voltage
follower.
As
in Ex 14-3, the typical difference between input and output
voltage with a voltage follower is only 5 .V when the input amplitude is 1 V. With an emitter follower, there is a 0.7 V dc voltage difference between input
and output. The voltage follower also has a much higher input impedance and a much lower output impedance than the emitter follower. The actual values of Zin and Zo. can be calculated from the negative feedback equations
derived in Chapter 13.
Example 14-3 Calculate the typical difference between the input and output voltage for a voltage follower using a 741 op-amp with a 1 V input, as in Fig. 14-11. Also, determine typical Zin and Zour values.
Solution From data sheet A-13 in Appendix A, typical parameters are:
open-loop voltage gain (Aor or Ay) = 200 000, rj = 2 MQ, ro = 75 0 +Vec
7 +O
7 i
vgth 3) 2
a
+
lke
741
6
io +
4
%
—Ver
_
Figure 14-11 Ex. 14-3.
Voltage follower circuit for
602
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Va = V,-V; V5 1V Y%,=—2 Ay 200000 =5 pV
;
Z, = (1 + ApB)r; = [1 + (200 000 x 1)] x 2MQ
From Eq. 13-4,
= 400000 MO
From Eq. 13-6,
z.
75 0
ae
~ 1+A,B 1+ (200000 x 1) = 0.375 x 107° 0
Capacitor-Coupled Voltage Follower When
a voltage follower is to have capacitor-coupled
input
and
output
terminals, the non-inverting input must be grounded via a resistor (Rj in Fig. 14-12). As explained in Section 14-2, the resistor is required for passing bias current to the non-inverting input terminal. It also offers an input resistance to the signal source, rather than a short-circuit. Because
coupled,
the
dc
output
offset voltage
might
seem
the load
to
be
is capacitor-
unimportant.
However, the dc offset voltage at the op-amp output terminal can limit the amplitude of the ac output voltage. So a resistor (Rz) equal to R; should be included in series with the inverting input terminal to equalize the IpR,
voltage drops and thus minimize output offset voltage. Designing the capacitor-coupled circuit in Fig. 14-12 involves the calculation of Ry, Cy, and C). The circuit input impedance is Rj || Z;; however, Z; is always much larger than Rj. So the circuit input impedance is simply taken as
Ain = Ry
(14-3)
Figure 14-12 A Capacitor-coupled voltage follower must have the opamp non-inverting terminal grounded via a resistor to provide a path for input bias current.
—
Chapter 14
—_‘|C Operational Amplifiers
603
Normally, the load resistance R, is much smaller than R,, and consequently, the smallest capacitor values are calculated when C> is selected
to set the circuit lower cutoff frequency, f,. Therefore, Xe
= (Z, + Ry) at fi
(14-4)
Capacitor C; should then be calculated from the equation Xc1 = (Zin + rs)/10 at f;, so that it has no significant effect on the circuit lower cutoff frequency: Xc
= (Ry + r,)/10 at fi
(14-5)
Coupling capacitor equations are discussed in Section 12-1.
Example 14-4 Design a capacitor-coupled voltage follower using a 741 op-amp. The circuit lower cutoff frequency is to be 70 Hz, the load resistance is 4 kQ, and the signal source resistance is much smaller than Rj. Solution See Fig. 14-13. From data sheet A-13 in Appendix A, Tpqmax) = 500 nA Eq.
14-1:
Ry (max)
=
VBE _ 0.7 V 10 Ip@max) 10 X 500nA
= 140 kO (use 120 kO standard value) Ro = R, = 120k0 From Eq. 14-4,
Co
ae
wl _ . 2rf,;R, 2m X 70Hz X 4kO
~ 0.56 wF (standard value)
From Eq. 14-5,
Cy
_
1 2mf,R1/10
_
1 2m X 70Hz X 120k0/10
0.19 pF (use 0.2 F standard value) Cy
C 9
0.2 wF Ri
0.56 pF
120k.
RL
4kQ =
Figure 14-13 Capacitor-coupled voltage follower for Ex. 14-4.
604
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Abiapret al
oe Ppbies n pe
. 10 kQj is to hove os ne Hz. ae Determine coupling Capi
a
Mohlower with 75 ~ 22 KO and’R) = ne suitable capacitor values. or values for the circuit in part (b)o
Ex 11 woe = * 600 0, Ry = 8.2kO, and f, = 20 Hz. ximum de offset voltage that might be produced at of the
aoe ne | 1a
circui designed i in part (a) of Ex. 14-1 when R, is
el
14-4 NON-INVERTING AMPLIFIERS Direct-Coupled Non-Inverting Amplifier The non-inverting amplifier circuit in Fig. 14-14 behaves similarly to a voltage follower circuit with one major difference. Instead of all of the output voltage being fed directly back to the inverting input terminal (as in a voltage follower), only a portion of V, is fed back. The output voltage is divided by
resistors R2 and Rs, and the voltage across R3 is applied to the inverting input terminal. As in the case of the voltage follower, the output voltage changes as necessary to keep the inverting input terminal voltage equal to that at the noninverting input. Thus, the voltage Vr3 always equals Vj, and the output voltage is then determined by the resistances of R2 and R3. ig Vee
Figure 14-14
Op-amp non-inverting
amplifier circuit. The signal is applied to
the non-inverting input terminal. The circuit voltage gain is Ac. = (Ro + R3)/R3.
Because the signal voltage is applied to the op-amp non-inverting input
terminal, the output always has the same polarity as the input. A positivegoing
input produces
a positive-going
output,
and
vice versa.
Thus,
the
input is not inverted (at the output), and the circuit is identified as a non-
inverting amplifier. The voltage-divider current (12) is always selected to be very much larger
than the operational amplifier imput bias current, and
bea= Vi SDR,
(14-6)
Chapter 14
—_‘[C Operational Amplifiers
605
Also, in Fig. 14-14 it is seen that
eo
(14-7)
Ry + R3
The circuit voltage gain is
An
= Vo _ Ip(Rz + R3) cL => = Vi Ty Rg
Therefore,
Ro
+
Ac, = “8
(14-8)
3
Figure 14-15 shows a non-inverting amplifier circuit with a resistor (R1) connected in series with the non-inverting input terminal. As other op-amp circuits, this is done to equalize the resistor produced by the input bias currents. In this case, Ri is approximately equal to the resistance ‘seen looking out of’
in the case of voltage drops chosen to be the inverting
input terminal. Thus,
Ry'= Ro||R3
(14-9)
Figure 14-15
Non-inverting
amplifier circuit with a resistor R, in series with the input. R; is
selected to be approximately equal to Ro||R3.
The input and output impedances for a non-inverting amplifier are easily determined from the negative feedback equations in Chapter 13. Design of a non-inverting amplifier mostly involves determining suitable voltage-divider resistors (Rz and Rs). So, as explained in Section 14-2, design begins with the selection of a voltage divider current that is much larger than
the op-amp input bias current. Example 14-5
Design a direct-coupled non-inverting amplifier (as in Fig. 14-15) to use a 741 op-amp. The output voltage is to be 2 V when the input is 50 mV.
606
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Solution
From the 741 data sheet A-13 in Appendix A, T3(max)
From Eq. 14-2,
=
500 nA
Tognin) = 100 Ip(max) = 100 X 500 nA = 50 pA
From Eq. 14-6,
poe In
50
pA
= 1kO (standard resistor value)
From
Eq. 14-7,
aes
V =—=
+R,
a
SS
Ro
2V
= 40kO, Ro = (Ro + R3) — Rg = 40 kO — 1kO
= 39 kO (standard value)
From Eq. 14-9,
Ry = Ra||R3 = 39 kQ||1 kO 1k
(use 1 kO standard value)
Example 14-6 Calculate
typical
input
and
output
impedances
for
the
amplifier designed in Ex. 14-5. Solution From data sheet A-13 in Appendix A, typical parameters are Ay = 200 000, 7, = 2 MQ, ro = 75 0 Also,
Rs Ro+R3
B
1ka 39k +1kO
4 40 200 000 From
Eq.
13-4,
Zi =
ol
10
FromEq.136,
o
A,B) B=
i
+
40
000 MQ.
to
20-7 > aR 14 0.015 0
75 0,
(200 000/40)
xX
2MQO
non-inverting
Chapter 14
——_——
_—[C Operational Amplifiers
607
Capacitor-Coupled Non-Inverting Amplifier
hae plete
| apnesare =
When a non-inverting amplifier is to have a signal capacitor coupled to its
input, the op-amp non-inverting input terminal must be grounded via a resistor to provide a path for the input bias current. This is illustrated in Fig. 14-16, where R; allows for the passage of Ipi. As in the case of the
capacitor-coupled voltage follower, the input resistance is essentially equal to R; for the capacitor-coupled non-inverting amplifier. + Vee
—
Figure 14-16 A capacitor-coupled noninverting amplifier circuit must have the
se.
able amg
non-inverting input terminal grounded via a resistor to provide a path for the input bias current.
Resistors R1, R2, and R3 in the capacitor-coupled circuit are determined
exactly as for a direct-coupled non-inverting amplifier. The capacitor values are calculated in the same way as for a capacitor-coupled voltage follower.
Example 14-7 Calculate the voltage gain and lower cutoff frequency for the capacitorcoupled non-inverting amplifier circuit in Fig. 14-17. Solution
~_ ig, lee
An
= Rp + R3 _ 50kM + 2.2kO R3
eh
22kO,
era hae
aaranlin
= 26.5
Figure 14-17 Capacitor-coupled noninverting amplifier circuit for Ex. 14-7.
608
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Yeo
From Eq. 14-4,
1
fAi= QmCoRy 2a
X 8.2 pF Xx 600 2
' = 32.3 Hz *,
1
Practice Problems _ Uh, ub eon 8X4 14-41 A direct-coupled non-inverting deuplitier using a 741 op-amp is to have a 100 mV input voltage amplitude and a voltage gain of 40, Select suitable resistor values.
14-4.2 Design a capacitor-coupled non-inverting amplifier using a 741 opamp to have a+5 V output amplitude when the input is +250 mV. The 14-43
load resistance is 820 , and the lower cutoff frequency is to be 20 Hz. Redesign the circuit in Problem 14-4.1 to use a BIFET op-amp.
14-5
INVERTING AMPLIFIERS
Direct-Coupled Inverting Amplifier The circuit in Fig. 14-18 is termed an inverting amplifier because, with V, applied via R; to the inverting input terminal, the output goes negative when the input goes positive, and vice versa. Note that the non-inverting input terminal is grounded via resistor R3. With the non-inverting terminal
grounded, the voltage at the op-amp inverting input terminal remains close to ground. Any increase or decrease in the (very small) difference in voltage between the two input terminals is amplified by the op-amp open-loop gain and fed back via Rz and R; to correct the change. Because the inverting input terminal is not grounded but remains close to ground,
the inverting input
terminal in this application is termed a virtual ground or virtual earth. The circuit input current in Fig. 14-18 can be calculated as
1 = VR 1
Ri
Vee
G7
W= Ry
uf Vri
"
+Voc
Ry Zi
Js
Virtual
Vi
aN
=] i
+
ground
|
Figure 14-18 Op-amp inverting amplifier. The
6 +
m
3-74
go
yy
~
Rs
|: —
BE
i
Signal voltage is
applied via resistor Ri
16 29 NR
to the inverting input
terminal. The circuit voltage gain is Aci
=
—Ro/R3.
Chapter 14
—_—_—
[COperational Amplifiers
609
The input voltage is applied to one end of Rj, and the other end of R; is at
ground level. Consequently, Vai = Vj
and
V;
k=
(14-10)
Ry
I, is always selected to be very much larger than the op-amp input bias current (Ip). So virtually all of I; flows through resistor Rz (see Fig. 14-18), and
the voltage drop across R> is Vro
=
IR
The left side of Ry is connected to the op-amp inverting input terminal, which, as discussed, is always at ground level. This means that the right side of R2 (the output terminal) is Vo below ground. So
Vo = -LRo
on, lilt ass
From Eq. 14-10,
VY, = Ry
Therefore the circuit voltage gain is Vo
ten ncRNA
A
amen
(14-11)
or
=
Ac, =
—I1R2
—
SO
Vi
==K
Ry
GR
2
(14-12)
If the input of the inverting amplifier is grounded, the circuit is seen to be exactly the same as a non-inverting amplifier with R3 as the input resistor and zero input voltage. Thus, negative feedback occurs (as in a non-inverting amplifier) to maintain the op-amp inverting input terminal at the same voltage level as the non-inverting input terminal. The output impedance of an inverting amplifier is calculated in exactly the same way as for a non-inverting amplifier (using Eq. 13-6). As in the case
of the non-inverting amplifier, the output impedance is very low for an inverting amplifier. The input impedance of an inverting amplifier is easily determined by recalling that the right side of Rj (in Fig. 14-18) is always at ground level and
that the signal is applied to the left side of Ri. Therefore, Zi
a
Ry
(14-13)
Design of an inverting amplifier is very simple. Voltage-divider current I;
is selected to be very much
larger than the op-amp
input bias current.
610
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Resistors R; and R2 are calculated from Eqs 14-10 and 14-11, or 14-12, and R3 is chosen to be approximately equal to Ri || Ro.
Example 14-8 Designa direct-coupled inverting amplifier, as in Fig. 14-19, to use a 741 Op-amp.
The input voltage amplitude is 20 mV and the voltage gain is to be 144. R, WW
56kQ I; +Vec
oya
ee
390 0
-——o
+
3-74 R
390.0 =
—-V,
mE Figure 14-19
~
Ex. 14-8.
Inverting amplifier for
Solution For the 741, Select
TB(max) = 500 nA Tyqnin) = 100 Ipgmaxy = 100 X 500 nA
= 50 pA
F rom Eq. . 14-10, 14-10
V;
Ry == i,
20mvV
50pA
= 400 O (use 390 0 standard value) From. Eq. 14-12,
Ro = Aci Ry = 144 x 3900
= 56.2 kO (use 56 kO standard value)
R3 = Ry||Rz = 390 Q||56 kO = 390 QO (use 390 Q)
Capacitor-Coupled Inverting Amplifier A capacitor-coupled inverting amplifier circuit is shown in Fig. 14-20. In this case, the bias current to the op-amp inverting input terminal flows (from the output) via resistor Ro, so that the input coupling capacitor does not interrupt the input bias current. A voltage drop IgR2 is produced at the inverting input by the bias current flow, and this must be equalized by the IpR3 voltage drop
atthe non-inverting inverting circuit,
input.
Therefore,
R3 = Ry
for
the
capacitor-coupled
non-
(14-14)
Chapter 14
—
IC Operational Amplifiers
Figure 14-20
Ry
644
Capacitor-coupled
inverting amplifier circuit. Note
:
that the flow of bias current is not interrupted by capacitor C}.
Apart from the choice of Rs, the circuit is designed exactly as the directcoupled circuit, and the capacitor values are calculated in the same way as
for a cqpaaitor-toupled non-inverting amplifier.
Practice
Problems
14-5.1 A di ect-coupled inverting amplifier using a 741 op-amp is to have a 300 mv input voltage amplitude and a voltage gain of 15. Calculate Suitable resistor values. 14-5.2: The circuit in Problem 14-5.1 is to have a 1 kQ capacitor-coupled load
and a 600 Q capacitor-coupled signal source. Determine suitable capacitor values for a 20 Hz lower cutoff frequency. ee 3 Redesign ie circuit in Problem 14-5.1 to use a BIFET op-amp.
14-6 SUMMING
AMPLIFIER
The summing amplifier circuit in Fig. 14-21 is simply a direct-coupled inverting amplifier with two inputs applied to two resistors (R; and R2). With Vax
~S
+o Ay Ry
+o
R
Veo cS
Vin
iA
hy he
AWm7
= |
Vin
_
Figure 14-21 voltages.
Virtual
_
ground
~
B
An op-amp summing amplifier amplifies the sum of two, or more, input
612
Electronic Devices and Circuits
two input voltages (Vj; and Vj2) there are two input currents (J; and I). Also,
because the op-amp inverting input terminal behaves as a virtual ground (as for an inverting amplifier), the input currents are =17
Via
Vip I, 2 =—* Rs
Ry’
All of I; and Ip flows through resistor R3, giving
Vo=—| “
Vin LZ
=|/—
°
With
Ry =
+ bh) Rs va R, |
+—!IR
°
Rz,
—R Vo
sy mm
(Vii
+ Vi2)
(14-15)
1
When R3 = R; = Roz, the output voltage is the direct (inverted) sum of the two inputs. When R3 is greater of the sum of the inputs. Asumming amplifier is number of inputs, and the amplifiers are designed in
than R; and R2, the output is an amplified version not limited to two inputs. There can be almost any output remains the sum of the inputs. Summing the same way as ordinary inverting amplifiers.
Example 14-9 Design a three-input summing araplifien
as in Fig. 14-22, to use a BIFET
op-amp and to have a voltage gain of 3. Calculate the resistor currents and the output voltage when all three inputs are 1 V.
R3
4,
o—\W
ce + Ve
—Veg
ohn
Figure 14-22
it
Three-input summing
amplifier for Ex. 14-9.
Solution
Select
Ry =1MO, 7
From Eq. 14-12,
R
1 == %Ry
=
R
Rg
3 ==Act
=
1MQ
3
= 333 kO (use 330 kO standard value)
Chapter 14
te
3
V;
_|C Operational Amplifiers
613
1V
R330 KO
= 3.03 pA Ig =], + h + 5 = 3.03 pA + 3.03 pA + 3.03 pA
= 9,09 pA Vo = —Iy Ry = —9.09 pA X 1 MO, = —9.09 V
Or, from Eq. 14-15,
Vv.
o=
—R, R,
(
-1MO, (1V+1V +1V) V,,+-V,,+V,3)=——— il + i2 is) 330 kQ (
= —9,09 V
Practice Problems 14-6.1 A two-input summing amplifier is to be designed to produce a 5 V output from two 0.25 V inputs. Calculate suitable resistor values for a circuit using a 741 op-amp. 14-6.2 If the circuit designed in Ex. 14-9 has 0.75 V, 1.5 V, and 1.25 V inputs,
J determine Vo, ha, bb, Is, and Ts.
14-7
DIFFERENCE AMPLIFIER
Circuit Operation A difference amplifier amplifies the difference between two inputs. The circuit shown in Fig. 14-23 is a combination of inverting and non-inverting amplifiers. Resistors Ri, R2, and the op-amp constitute an inverting amplifier for a voltage (Vii) applied to Rj. The same components (Rj, R2, and the op-
amp) also function as a non-inverting amplifier for a voltage (Vp) at the nonRy
—\W\-
V,
Figure 14-23 An op-amp difference amplifier amplifies the difference between two input voltages.
614
Electronic Devices and Circuits
inverting input terminal. It is seen that Vrs is derived from input voltage V,,
by the voltage divider R3 and Rs. To understand the circuit operation,
consider the output produced by each input voltage when the other input is zero. —R
With V;j2 = 0,
Vol
With V;; = 0,
Vo = “1
R,
ae
VR
Therefore With
R3
Vo2 =
Ry and
= =
Rg
=
xX Vin
1
+R
Ry
Rg = ———
x Vra
ROR,
X J;
R; + Ro
Bact Ry + Ry EY
ye R
Rg
i2
Ro,
Ro X V; Von 02 = = Ry i2 When both inputs are present, Vo = Von + Vor
R
= z Vig + 1
Therefore
—R
ze
Vin
Ro
Vo= z (Viz — Vin)
(14-16)
1
When R2 = R1, the output voltage (as calculated by Eq. 14-16) is the direct
difference between the two inputs. With R2 greater than Rj, the output becomes an amplifier version of (Viz — Vii).
Input Resistances Consider the input portion of the difference amplifier circuit reproduced in Fig. 14-24. The resistance at input terminal 1 is the same as the input impedance for an inverting amplifier: Zi) = R;. The input resistance at the op-amp non-inverting input terminal is very high (as in the case of a noninverting amplifier), and this is in parallel with
resistor
R4.
So
the input
impedance at terminal 2 in Fig. 14-24 is Zi2 = R3 + Rq. Equation 14-16 was derived by assuming that R3 = Ry and Ry = Ro. It can be shown that the same result is obtained when the ratio R4/R3 equals R2/R1,
so that the actual resistor values do not have
to be
equal.
For
equal
resistances at the two input terminals, select
Rg + Rg = Ry
(14-17)
Chapter 14 =‘ (C Operational Amplifiers
a,
615
© Ma
|
Figure 14-24
Difference
amplifier circuit input impedances.
=
Then, calculate the resistances of R3 and R4 from
a Rz
(14-18)
Ry
A simple rule of thumb can be used for determining suitable resistance values for R3 and R4 when the two input resistances do not have to be exactly equal. Select Ra = R2/Act, which always makes Ry = R,. Then, calculate R3 as R3 = R, / Act:
Example 14-10 A difference amplifier is to be designed to amplify the difference between two voltages by a factor of 10. The inputs each approximately equal 1 V. Determine
suitable resistor values for a circuit using a 741 op-amp
Fig. 14-25). Solution Select
I, ~ 100 Ip = 100 X 500 nA = 50 pA Rg
AWN
R 1
I1
Ry Vir
+
2
iv
Ip |
741
P
Vi2
OL] R
ok
=
4
I—o —
a
Vy, - VEE
iL =
te
.
‘
Figure 14-25 Difference amplifier circuit for Ex. 14-10.
(see
616
Electronic Devices and Circuits
a, = Ya __1V Ty 50pA = 20 kO (use 18 kO standard value) Ro = Ac,
Ri
=
10
x
18 kQ
= 180 kQ (standard values) Rg
— R,
R3
=
=
Ry AcL
18kO
= s
18 kX 10
= 1.8 kO (standard value)
Common-Mode Voltages A common-mode input voltage is a signal voltage (dc or ac) applied to both input terminals at the same time. This is illustrated in Fig. 14-26, where Vj, Viz, and the common-mode voltage (V,) are all represented as inputs from de
sources. As shown, the input voltages at terminals 1 and 2 are changed from Vii and
Viz to (Va
2 Vi) and
(Vai
+ Viz).
R,
WW
+3 1
Bi 2
V, n + V; il
,&
va i Vio
—
V n
L
Vat Vig
Figure 14-26
-
>
mode
Common-
input voltage applied
to a difference amplifier.
Equation 14-16 shows that the output voltage is the amplified difference between the two input voltages. So, R
Vy = R [Viz + Va) — (Vir + V,)I Ro = Ri (Vio — Vin) This shows that the common-mode input is completely cancelled. However,
recall that the gain equation depends upon the resistor ratios (Ry/R3 and
R2/Rj) being equal. If the ratios are not exactly equal, one input will undergo a larger amplification than the other. Moreover, the common-mode voltage at
Chapter 14
IC Operational Amplifiers
one input terminal will be amplified by a larger amount
By
than that applied to the other input
terminal. In this case, common-mode
WwW
inputs
will not be completely cancelled. Because it is difficult to match resistor ratios Bi perfectly (especially for standard-value com- oN — ponents), some common-mode output voltage is almost certain to be produced where a common-
+Vec
~ Vex
mode input exists. Figure 14-27 shows a circuit
modification
for
minimizing
common-mode
6417
Ry
outputs from a difference amplifier. Resistor Ry is
Common-mode
adjustment
made up of a fixed-value resistor and a smallvalue adjustable resistor connected in series.
This provides adjustment of the ratio Ry/R3 to match R2/R1,so that common-mode outputs can
ras dike
sil
nulled by adjustment of R4.
be nulled to zero.
Practice Problems 14-7.1 If the circuit designed in Ex. 14-10 has Vi = 0.75 V and Vi2 = 1.5 V, determine
Vg
Tr, Tro, Ip3, and
Vera.
14-7.2 ‘A 500 © resistor is connected in series with Ry in the circuit designed “in Ex. 14-10. Calculate the common-mode gain. 14-7.3 A difference amplifier is to be designed to produce a 3 V output when ~ the inputs are 1.5 V ard 2 V. Determine suitable resistor values for a
circuit using a BIFET op-amp. 14-8 INSTRUMENTATION AMPLIFIER Circuit Operation At first
glance,
the
instrumentation amplifier circuit in Fig. 14-28 looks complex, but when considered section by section it is found to be quite simple. First, note that the second stage (consisting of op-amp A3 and resistors R4 to R7) is a difference amplifier that operates exactly as described in Section 14-7. Next, look at A; and resistors Rj and R2; this is a noninverting amplifier. Similarly, Az, combined with resistors R2 and R3, constitutes another non-inverting amplifier. Because the first-stage circuits share a single resistor, their operation is slightly different from the usual non-
inverting amplifier operation. The first stage accepts a differential input voltage (Vicait)), and produces a differential output voltage (Voqait)). The differential input could be the
618
Electronic Devices and Circuits Interconnected non-invertin g amplifiers
.
Difference amplifier
+Voe
_.
!
!
Rs
—WW—
| | l | I
Ry Vicaif) J
Vea
Re
l
i | |
i |
Ry
-
| | ! |
—Ver
|
Figure 14-28 An instrumentation amplifier has two interconnected non-inverting amplifiers as the first stage, and a difference amplifier as the second stage.
difference between two grounded inputs (Vj; and
Viz), as illustrated. But
often a differential ungrounded input voltage is derived, for example, from two voltage monitoring electrodes connected to a human body for medical purposes. In this case, there could be a large common-mode
input voltage,
which can be shown to pass to the output of the first stage without amplification. The difference amplifier second stage accepts V air) from the first stage as an input and produces an output to a grounded load, as shown on the circuit diagram. As explained in Section 14-7, the difference amplifier tends to reject common-mode voltages, and the circuit can also have an adjustment for reducing common-mode outputs to zero. The instrumentation amplifier is now seen to be a circuit with two highimpedance input terminals and one low-impedance output. The differential input voltage is amplified and converted to a single-ended output, and common-mode inputs are attenuated.
Voltage Gain Recall that, with a non-inverting amplifier, the feedback voltage to the op-
amp inverting input terminal always equals the input voltage to the noninverting input terminal. Therefore, the voltage at the R,R» junction equals
Via, and that at the R2R3 junction equals Vir. Consequently, the voltage drop across R2 equals the difference between the two input voltages. That also
_|C Operational Amplifiers
Chapter 14
619
means that Vp equals the differential input voltage (Via). The current ah a eelniildeneeee +
through R2 can now be calculated as
b= Viqait)
RD
The voltage drop across R,, R2, and R3 is the differential output voltage of the
kt er
first stage (Vovaiey): Vowdin
= Ip (Ri + Ro + Rs)
ne
Vera: = —
Ry
ee,
+
Ro
+ R3)
The (closed-loop) voltage gain of the differential input-differential output first stage is Aci =
Ry
Voit) _
Vicaif)
+
Ro
+
R3
Ry
Normally, Ri and R3 are always equal. So, the first stage gain can be written as +
(14-19)
Agia = = Ry
From Eq. 14-16, the second-stage gain is
a. cL2 =~ BsR
The overall voltage gain is Act
= Acu
x Aci2
The second stage is often designed for a gain of one, so that the overall voltage gain can be calculated from Eq. 14-19. Note that, as shown in Fig. 14-28, R> can be a variable resistor for adjustment of the circuit overall
voltage gain.
Example 14-11 Calculate
the
overall
voltage
gain
for the instrumentation
amplifier
in
Fig. 14-29. Determine the current and voltage levels throughout the circuit when a +1 V common-mode input (V,) is present along with +10 mV signals. Solution From Eqs 14-16 and 14-19,
2R, + Ro, Rs x Ry AcL 2a Ry
620
Electronic Devices and.Circuits
Rs
WW 15 kO
Rg
I,
Wr
I5kQ
R,
NS
“
-
4”
-
f
15 kQ
Veg
15 mS
Figure 14-29
Instrumentation amplifier circuit for Ex. 14-11.
_ (2X 33 kQ)
+ 300 O
300 2,
x
15. kO 15kQ
= 221
At the junction of R; and Rz, Vp
=
Vi
+
Vn
=
10mMV
+1V
= +1.01 V
At the junction of R2 and R3, Ve=
V2 + Va = -10mMV+1V
= +0.99V
The current through Roz, b=
2
Va = Ve _ 1.01V — 0.99V
Ry
300 2
= 66.67 pA
At the output of A, V, = Vp + (2 X Ry) = 1.01 V + (66.67 pA X 33 kQ) = +3.21 V
At the output of A2,
Va = Ve — (In X Rs) = 0.99 V — (66.67 pA X 33 kQ) =-121V
_IC Operational Amplifiers
Chapter 14
—
At the junction of Re and R;,
Ve= Vax
ee
621
.
R
ee
Rt
x
15kQ,
cae + Tk
= —0.605 V At the junction of R4 and Rs, Ve = Ve = —0.605 V The current through R4,
i= Va-Ve _ 3.21 V — (-0.605 V) Rg
15 kO
= 254.3 pA At the output of A3,
Vz = Ve — (Ig X Rs) = —0.605 V — (254.3 pA X 15 k®) = -4.42V
practlee Problem
14-8. 1 An instrumentation amplifier is to be designed to produce a 4.75 V output when the differential input is 50 mV. Using 741 op-amps, etermine suitable resistor values.
14-9 VOLTAGE LEVEL DETECTORS Op-amps in Switching Applications ‘Operational amplifiers are often used in circuits in which the output is switched between the positive and negative saturation voltages +Voicaty and
—Voyeat). The actual voltage change that occurs is known as the output voltage swing. For many op-amps (such as a 741), the output saturation voltages are
typically the supply voltage levels minus 1 V. Thus, as illustrated in Fig. 1430, the typical output voltage swing is 2
For many
(Vcc
—1 V)
a (VEE
+
1V)
(14-20)
op-amps the output can be switched from one supply level to
the other (there is no 1 V drop), so that AV = Vcc — Vee
This is referred to as rail-to-rail operation.
(14-21)
622
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Output waveform
+Vec
—
tVosat)~ tVe-1V
Vejen Figure
14-30
— Verh 1V
An operational amplifier used in a switching application produces an
output voltage that switches between positive and negative saturation levels.
The switching speed, or rate of change, of the op-amp
output voltage is
termed the slew rate (SR). Refering to Fig. 14-30,
SR
=
AV a
14(14-22)
—
Suppose the output changes from —10 to +10 V; the voltage change AV is 20 V. If the transition time (or rise time, see Section 8-5) is At = 1 us, the slew rate is 20 V/s. Another integrated circuit known as a voltage comparator is often used in
place of an operational amplifier in switching applications. Voltage comparators are similar to op-amps in that they have two input terminals (inverting and non-inverting) and one output terminal. However, comparators
are designed exclusively for switching,
and
they
have slew
to be
simply an
and
the signal
rates much faster that those available with op-amps.
Zero Crossing Detector The
zero crossing detector circuit in Fig. 14-31a
is seen
operational amplifier with the inverting input grounded
applied to the non-inverting input. When the input is above ground level, the
output is saturated at its positive maximum, and when the input is below ground, the output is at its negative maximum level. This is illustrated by the input and output waveforms, which show that the output voltage changes from one extreme to the other each time the input voltage crosses zero. The input waveform could have any shape (sinusoidal, pulse, ramp, and so on),
but the output will always be a rectangular-type wave. The actual input voltage that causes the output to switch is not precisely zero, but some very small voltage above or below zero, depending upon the
op-amp open-loop gain. If the op-amp non-inverting input is grounded and the signal is applied to the inverting input in Fig. 14-31a, the output is negative when the input is
Chapter 14
—‘|C Operational Amplifiers ils
=
or
V o(sat)
= ie
|
623
a
7\
|
Oo
T1350
feria
\
moe
40
\L
—90°
—225
Phase hift
°™
FEOP
—225°
20 +18 dB/octave —> 100
"
10k
100 k
1M
Soa
fos
Soi
> (kHz)
Signal frequency
Figure 15-2
The three stages of an op-amp (internal) circuit each has its own gain/
frequency response with a 6 dB/octave fall-off, and its own
phase shift/frequency
response with a maximum phase shift of 90°. These responses combine to give the overall op-amp A,/f and 6/f responses.
loop phase shift is in addition to the —180° phase shift that normally occurs from the op-amp inverting input terminal to the output. Thus, the total loop phase shift (¢,) at f,1 is (—45° — 180°) = —225°; atfpa, bt. = (—135°
— 180°) =
—315°; and at f3, o, = (—225° — 180°) = —405°. As already pointed out, oscillations occur when the loop gain equals or exceeds 1 and the loop phase shift is 360°. In fact, the phase shift does not have to be exactly 360° for oscillation to occur. A phase shift of 330° at A,B = 1 can make the circuit unstable. To avoid oscillations, the total loop phase shift must not be greater than 315° when A,B = 1. The difference
between 360° and the actual loop phase shift at A,B= 1 is referred to as the phase margin (¢m). Thus, for circuit stability, the phase margin minimum
should bea
of Om = 360° — 315° = 45°
Compensated Op-amp Gain and Phase Response The open-loop gain/frequency and phase/frequency responses for two internally compensated operational amplifiers are shown in Figs 15-3 and 15-4. The 741 frequency response graph in Fig. 15-3 shows that the gain starts at 100 dB and falls by 20 dB/decade over most of its frequency range. The phase shift remains —90° or less for most of the frequency range. The openloop gain falls off to 1 (0 dB) at a frequency of approximately 800 kHz. The 741 is known as a general purpose operational amplifier for use in relatively
low-frequency applications.
Chapter 15 = Operational Amplifier Frequency Response (dB) :
pees
culs
100+
—r
807
0°
+ 4
Voltage gain
643
+ —45°
607
ccocamal ah
4
404
Phase shift
—90°
50+
eee
sl
qf 0
1
10
Pet
100
1k
10k
100k
Frequency
Figure 15-3
+
(Hz)
{1M
800 kHz
Approximate gain/frequency and phase/frequency
responses for a 741 op-amp.
The AD843 frequency response in Fig. 15-4 shows an open-loop gain of 90 dB at low frequencies, falling off at 20 dB per decade to A, = 1 at 34 MHz. Instead of the open-loop phase shift, the phase margin is plotted versus frequency. The phase margin is close to 90° over much of the frequency range, starts to become
and falls to approximately
smaller around 3 MHz,
40° at
f =34MHz.
Amplifier Stability and Gain From Eq. 13-3, the overall voltage gain of an amplifier with negative feedback is 1
Act * 5 (dB)
Voltage
100
100°
80
80°
60
60°
40
40°
20
20°
gain
0°
0
Figure
Phase margin
100
15-4
1k
10k
100k 1M Frequency
10M]100M 34 MHz
(Hz)
Approximate gain/frequency and phase-
op-amp. margin/frequency response for an AD843
644
Electronic Devices and Circuits
and the loop gainfa is
Ae A,B ©~ Aen
So the loop gain (A,B) equals 1 when Aci = Ay
This is one of the conditions required for circuit oscillation. To determine if oscillation will occur in a given circuit, it is necessary first to find the frequency at which Aci, ~ Av, and then to determine
the op-amp
phase
margin at that frequency.
Example 15-1 The inverting amplifier in Fig. 15-5 is to be investigated for stability. Determine the frequency at which the loop gain equals 1, and estimate the phase margin if the operational amplifier is (a) one with the gain/frequency characteristics in Fig. 15-2, (b) a 741, and (c) an
AD843. Figure
Solution
15-5
Inverting
amplifier circuit for Ex. 15-1.
(a) Refer to the A,/f and 6/ f graphs reproduced in Fig. 15-6 (from Fig. 15-2). Act = Ry _ 560 kO Ry 18k0 = 311
or
Act = 20 log 311
~50 dB Draw a horizontal line on the frequency response graph at A, = Ac, = 50 dB (Fig. 15-6). Draw a vertical line where the horizontal line intersects the A,/f
graph. The frequency at this point is identified as f2. f2® 150 kHz (logarithmic scale) From the 6/f graph, the op-amp phase shift at fy is
= —165° The loop phase shift is
di = 8 — 180° = —165° — 180° = —345°
and
$m = 360° — py = 360° — 345° = 15°
Chapter 15
_—— (dB)
t
104 100
a
a
90
PN
80
oN
gain
1
A"
N
70 loop
+ —45°
os
T _o9¢ IN
60
_I
AN
N
50
—180°
7 a |
30
se
GR
+
|
;
§
4+ -135°
L Oe eee cies ee
op
a0" smn: stance
645
Operational Amplifier Frequency Response
+ ~295°
N
i
20 |
100
Figure 15-6
1k
10k 100k Signal frequency h
(kHz)
1M
A,/f and 6/f characteristics for the op-amp in Ex. 15-1a.
Because the phase margin is less than 45°, the circuit is likely to be unstable. (b) For a 741:
A horizontal line at 50 dB on the frequency response in Fig. 15-3 gives fp¥1.5kHz and @*—90°
dy, = —90° — 180° = -270° bm = 360° — 270°
and
= 90° (stable circuit) (c) For an AD843:
Ahorizontal line at 50 dB on the frequency response in Fig. 15-4 gives
fx 90 kHz
|
$m * 90° (stable circuit)
and
50 dB A circuit with the frequency response in Fig. 15-6 and with Ac, =
= 70 dB, reconsideration was shown to be unstable. If the amplifier had Aci
shows that it is stable. That is, an amplifier with a high closed-loop gain is more likely to be stable than one with the lower gain. Low-gain amplifiers are more difficult to stabilize than high-gain circuits. The voltage follower
s to (with a closed-loop gain of 1) can be one of the most difficult circuit
stabilize.
646
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Some internally compensated op-amps are specified as being stable to closed-loop
gains
as
low
as
5.
In
this
case,
external
compensating
components must be used with lower gain circuits.
Practice Problem 15-1.1 Investigate the stability of an inverting amplifier with a closed-loop gain of 60 dB if the operational amplifier is (a) one with the gain/ frequency characteristics in Fig. 15-2, (b) a 741, and (c) an AD843.
15-2
FREQUENCY COMPENSATION
METHODS
Phase-Lag and Phase-Lead Compensation Lag compensation stabilize op-amp additional phase still so small that
and lead compensation are two methods often employed to circuits. The phase-lag network in Fig. 15-7a introduces lag at some low frequency where the op-amp phase shift is additional phase lag has no effect. It can be shown that at
frequencies where Xc; >> R», the voltage v2 lags behind v; by as much as 90°.
At higher frequencies where Xc
“< R2, no significant phase lag occurs, and
the lag network merely introduces some attenuation. The effect of this attenuation is that the A,/f graph is moved to the left, as illustrated in Fig. 15-7b. Thus, the frequency (fa) at which A,B = 1 [for a given closed-loop Ry
Wr
R,
CG
Cy Oh
02
v7
R2
v2
Ry
(a) Lag compensation network
(c) Lead compensation network
ecco
e
|
Pw | psec
|
“(Compen sated | — 45° BF Fesporise
as
f
~ Uncompens
ted 7
_ofrespins f
fa
x1
(b) Effect of lag compensation
Figure 15-7
0°
|
tN
ia
—90°
Ps.
—_
Be
0
¥
(d) Effect of lead compensation
A phase-lag network reduces an amplifier open-loop gain, so that the phase
shift at AB = 1 is too small for instability. A phase-lead network cancels phase lag.
Chapter 15 — Operational Amplifier Frequency Response __6 47
gain (Act)] is moved to a lower frequency (f,2), as shown. Because fxz is less than f,1, the phase shift at fo is less than that at f,; and the circuit is likely to be stable. The network in Fig 15-7c introduces a phase lead. In this network, when
Xci >> R1, the voltage v2 leads v,. This phase lead cancels some of the unwanted phase lag in the operational amplifier 0/f graph (see Fig. 15-7d),
thus rendering the circuit more stable. Phase-lag and phase-lead networks
are both used internally to compensate op-amp circuits. Both types of circuit
can also be used externally.
Manufacturer’s Recommended Compensation Most currently available operational amplifiers contain internal compensating components and do not require additional external components. Some have internal compensating resistors and need only a capacitor connected externally to complete a compensating network. For those that require
compensation,
IC
component
recommended
list
manufacturers
values and connection methods on the op-amp data sheet. An example of this is illustrated in Fig. 15-8 for the LM108.
(dB) 120
100+—%p
2 RiX30PF ¢, (a) Phase lag compensation
80 --— Voltage
60
gain 40 +--+
20 +
0 (b) Alternate phase lag
1
leon se
she Nhe
ses a Bh
10
100
NL
2
1k 10k Frequency
_
100k
+>
1M
(Hz)
(c) Approximate gain/frequency response
compensation Figure 15-8
quency Manufacturer’s recommended compensation methods and gain/fre
response for the LM108 op-amp. (Reproduced with permission of National Semiconductor Corp.)
648
Electronic Devices and Circuits
When
standard
value
compensating
R, —W\y——
capacitors are selected, the next larger values should be used. This is termed over-
" compensation and it results in better amplifier oN R
2
stability, but it also produces a smaller circuit
bandwidth.
: R
Example 15-2 The inverting amplifier in Fig. 15-9 is required to amplify a 200 mV input by a factor of 4.5. Determine suitable component values.
E
a Figure 15-9
—Vap Cy Op-amp circuit
for Ex. 15-2.
Solution
Because the LM108 has a very low input bias current (see data sheet A-14 in Appendix A), it should be treated as a BIFET op-amp. Select
R, = 1MQ Ry
=
Rg Aci
1I1MQ 4.5
eS
= 222 kO, (use 220 kO standard value) R3 = Ri||Ro = 220 kQ||1 MO = 180 kO, (standard value)
From
ie 158 Fig.
c, — RX 30pF _ 220k0 x 30 pF
15-8,
fR,
+R.
220kQ0 +1MQ
= 5.4 pF (use 10 pF standard value for over-compensation)
Connect C; between terminals 1 and 8, as shown in Fig. 15-9. Miller-Effect Compensation Miller effect (discussed in Section 8-3) involves capacitance between the output
and
input
terminals
of
an
inverting
amplifier.
Miller-effect
compensation of an op-amp circuit is very simple, and it is often the only external method
available for stabilizing a circuit where
the
op-amp
is
internally compensated. A capacitor (C;) is connected across the feedback
resistor (R¢), as shown in Figs 15-10a and b. The capacitor value is calculated to have an impedance equal to the feedback resistor value at the desired
signal cutoff frequency (f2):
Xcp= Reat f.
(15-1)
Chapter 15
Operational Amplifier Frequency Response
(a) Inverting amplifier with Miller-
(b) Non-inverting amplifier with
effect compensation Figure 15-10
649
Millér-effect compensation
Miller-effect frequency compensation for amplifier circuits.
This reduces the closed-loop gain by 3 dB at the selected frequency. So long as the op-amp is stable at this frequency, the circuit will not oscillate. The opamp used should have an upper cutoff frequency much higher than f2.
Example 15-3 Calculate a suitable Miller-effect capacitor to stabilize the circuit in Fig. 15-10a at fo = 35 kHz.
Solution
From
Eq. 15-1 er
(eg £ OnfyR;
: X 68kO 2m X 35kHz
~ 67 pF (use 68 pF standard value)
Pract
em:
15-2.1 The components
of the lag and
lead
compensation
network
in
"Fig. 15-7 are Rj = 6.8 kO, Rp = 390 0, and C; = 500 pF Calculate the
| 15-2.2 Calculate a suitable Miller-effect capacitor to stabilize the circuit in
Fig, 15-10b at fo = 50 kHz.
-mee-—
- ew ew
-
oes “approximate phase lag and phase lead at a frequency of 50 kHz.
15-3
OP-AMP
CIRCUIT BANDWIDTH
AND
SLEW RATE
Low Cutoff Frequency Operational amplifiers are direct-coupled internally, and so where they are
employed in direct-coupled applications, the circuit lower cutoff frequency (ft)
is zero.
In
capacitor-coupled
circuits,
the
lower
cutoff
frequency
is
650
Electronic Devices and Circuits
determined by the selection of coupling capacitors. The circuit high cutoff
frequency (f2) is, of course, dependent on the frequency response of the operational amplifier.
High Cutoff Frequency In Section 13-7 it is shown that for a negative feedback amplifier the high cutoff frequency occurs when the amplifier open-loop gain approximately
equals the circuit closed-loop gain:
Eq. 13-26:
:
Ao® Act
So, the circuit high cutoff frequency (f2) can be found simply by drawing a horizontal
line at A, ~ Ac,
on
the op-amp
open-loop
gain/ frequency
response graph. Because the op-amp low cutoff frequency (f;) is zero (as explained above), the circuit bandwidth is BW
=f.
-fi
=fr Consequently, the op-amp high cutoff frequency is often referred to as the
circuit bandwidth. The frequency response graphs published on manufacturer’s data sheets are typical for each particular type of operational amplifier. Like all typical device characteristics, the precise frequency response differs from one op-
amp to another. All frequencies derived from the response graphs should be taken as typical quantities. The process of determining circuit cutoff frequency from the op-amp frequency response graph is demonstrated in Ex. 15-4.
Example 15-4 Determine the typical upper cutoff frequency for the inverting amplifier in Fig. 15-11 when
the compensating
capacitor
(C;) value is (a) 30 pF and
(b) 3 pF. The A,/f graph for the LM108 is shown in Fig. 15-12. Solution
“0 KO AWN
— Rg _ 100k
Act = RS
TKO
= 100 = 40 dB
fr occurs at (a) For Cr = 30 pF:
Ay = Act= 40 dB ;
R
oN
+Meos 2
F
kt
3
ine R
“Veg
tt
Draw a horizontal line on the A,/f graph at
Ay = 40 dB.
Figure 15-11 for Ex. 15-4.
Amplifier circuit
Chapter 15
—
6511
= Operational Amplifier Frequency Response
(db) 120
100 80 Voltage gain
60 40
20} 10
100 1k Frequency
10k 8kHz
100k
1M
(Hz)
StraightFigure 15-12 line approximation of
LM108 gain/frequency response.
80kHz
Where the line cuts the A,/f characteristic for C; = 30 pF, read fr
8 kHz
(b) For Ce = 3 pF: Where the A, = 40 dB line cuts the A,/f characteristic for C; = 3 pF, read
fo 80 kHz Gain-Bandwidth Product The gain-bandwidth product (GBW), or unity-gain bandwidth, of an operational amplifier is the open-loop gain at a given frequency multiplied by the frequency. Referring to the A,/f response for the 741 reproduced in Fig. 15-13, itis seen that at Ayia) = 104, the frequency is fia) + 80 Hz. Thus,
GBW = Aya) X fia) = 10* x 80 Hz =8xX10°
Similarly, at Aw) = 10, fo) © 80 kHz, again giving GBW = 8 x 10°. Also, at
Ayo = 1, fig * 800 kHz, once more giving GBW=8
x 10°. This last
determination explains the term unity-gain bandwidth, because the GBW is
simply equal to the frequency at which A, = 1. Because the high cutoff frequency for an op-amp circuit occurs when the closed-loop gain equals the open-loop gain, the circuit upper cutoff frequency can be calculated by dividing the gain-bandwidth product by the
closed-loop gain: GBW
haa
(15-2)
652
Electronic Devices and Circuits
(dB) +
120
105 + 100
Aya)
19 +
80
103+
60
an
102 +
40
Aro)
10 + 20
Voltage
|
bI
| Aye)
—>
i+
0
(Hz)
100 1k 10k Frequency ——>-
i) Figure 15-13
{100k
fey
|1M
fro
The gain-bandwidth product (GBW) for an operationa! amplifier can be
used to determine the cutoff frequency for any closed-loop gain.
It is important to note that Eq. 15-2 applies only to operational amplifiers that have a gain/frequency response that falls off to the unity-gain frequency at 20 dB/decade. Where the A,/f response falls off at some other rate, Eq. 15-2
cannot be used.
Example 15-5. Using the gain-bandwidth product, determine the cutoff frequencies for the circuit in Ex. 15-4 (reproduced in Fig. 15-14) when the compensating capacitor is (a) 30 pF and (b) 3 pF. Solution
(a) For C; = 30 pF: Referring to the LM108 A,/f graph for C; = 30 pF in Fig. 15-12, we see that
GBW = fat A, = 1 800 kHz
Eq. 15-2:
Bx GBW _ 800 kHz 2 Ags 100
Figure 15-14
for Ex. 15-5.
Amplifier circuit
Chapter 15
Operational Amplifier Frequency Response
653
= 8 kHz (b) For C¢ = 3 pF:
Referring to the LM108 A,/f graph for C; = 3 pF in Fig. 15-12, we see that
at Ay = 20 dB = 10, f=: 800 kHz
GBW =f X A, = 800 kHz x 10 = 8 MHz
152.
—g_GBW _8MHz
Ege
2
"Aa
100
= 80 kHz Full-Power Bandwidth and Slew Rate The A,/f response graphs, upper cutoff frequencies, and GBW specified on op-amp data sheets normally refer to the operational amplifier performance as a small-signal amplifier. In this case, the measurements are usually made for output amplitudes not exceeding 100 mV peak-to-peak. Where an amplifier
circuit has to pruduce a large output voltage, the op-amp full-power bandwidth (fp) must be used. The AD843 operational amplifier, for example, is specified as having a typical unity gain bandwidth of 34 MHz for an output amplitude of 90 mV peak-to-peak, and a typical full power bandwidth of 3.9 MHz when the output amplitude is 20 V p-to-p. The op-amp slew rate (SR) (see Section 14-9) can be used to calculate the
full-power bandwidth for a given output amplitude. For a sinusoidal voltage waveform, the fastest rate-of-change of voltage occurs at the point where the waveform crosses from its negative half-cycle to its positive half-cycle, and vice versa. This is illustrated in Fig. 15-15a. It can be shown that the voltage rate-of-change at this point is AV /At = 21 f Vp (volts/second)
The maximum rate-of-change of the waveform is limited by the maximum slew rate of the op-amp used. Where the waveform amplitude or frequency
AV
At
Maximum rate-of-change
(a) Sine wave maximum rate-of-change Figure 15-15
(b) Sine wave distortion caused by the slew rate
The op-amp slew-rate limits the upper cutoff frequency of an op-amp
circuit and the output amplitude at a given frequency.
654
Electronic Devices.and Circuits
is higher than the limits imposed by the slew rate, distortion will occur as illustrated in Fig. 15-15b. The slew rate can be equated to the sine wave rate-of-change:
SR = 27f,V,
(15-3)
where fp is the slew-rate limited frequency, or full-power bandwidth, and V, is the peak level of the circuit output voltage. Equation 15-3 can be used to determine the full-power bandwidth of an op-amp circuit for a given Output voltage amplitude. Sometimes Eq. 15-3 gives an fp value greater than that
determined from the A,/f graph or the GBW product. In these cases, the
circuit bandwidth is still dictated by the A,/f graph or the GBW product. Example 15-6 (a) Calculate the full-power bandwidth for an
AD843 op-amp circuit (Fig. 15-16), given a 1 V peak input and op-amp slew rate of 250 V/s. (b) Determine
the
maximum
peak
output
voltage obtainable from a 741 op-amp circuit with a 100 kHz signal frequency. (SR = 0.5 V/s for a 741.)
Solution
Figure 15-16
(a) For the AD843:
siliaalaathes
Ry+ Rs
Yee
Amplifier circuit
ong
Mie
_ 39kO + 4.7kO
azeg
TV
=93V
_
From Eq. 15-3,
SR
Po 2nV,
_ 250V/ps
20X93V
= 4.2 MHz
(b) For a 741: From Eq. 15-3,
0.5 V/s V= SR P 24 fo ~ 2a X 100 KHz =0.79V
Practice Problems,
:
15-3. 1 Determine the typical upper
:
cutoff
frequency
for
an
inverting
amplifier with a closed-loop gain of 15 using a 741 op-amp. The A,/f “graph for the 741 is shown in Fig, 15-13.
Chapter 15 —
Operational Amplifier Frequency Response
655
15-3.2 Using the gain-bandwidth product, calculate the cutoff frequencies
for an inverting amplifier with a closed-loop gain of 30 when the Oop-amp used is (a) 741 and (b) an AD843.
15-3.3 Calculate the full-power bandwidth for an LF353 op-amp circuit with
a4 V peak-to-peak output voltage. 15-4 STRAY CAPACITANCE EFFECTS Stray capacitance (C,) at the input terminals of an operational amplifier
effectively introduces an additional phase-lag network in the feedback loop (see Fig. 15-17), thus making the op-amp circuit unstable. Stray capacitance problems can be avoided by good circuit construction techniques that keep the stray to a minimum. The effects of stray capacitance also depend upon the resistor values used in the feedback network. High resistance values make it easier for small stray capacitances to produce phase lag. With low resistances, small stray capacitances normally have little effect on the circuit
stability. Ry
W\id Vee
Rj + (Ry + fs) | Ro
“T
—Ver
(b) C, and its series resistance
(a) Stray capacitance (C,) at amplifier input Figure 15-17
Stray capacitance can cause instability in an op-amp circuit by introducing
additional phase lag in the feedback network.
Analysis of an RC phase-lag circuit shows that the capacitor voltage lags behind the input voltage by 45° when the capacitor impedance (Xc) equals the series resistance (R). Also, when Xc = 10R, the phase lag is approximately 10°; it is this 10° of additional phase lag that might make the circuit oscillate if its phase margin is already close to the minimum for stability. If the phase margin is known to be large at the frequency where A,B = Ac, (the
frequency at which the circuit is likely to oscillate), the stray capacitance may be unimportant. Where the phase margin is small, for circuit stability the opamp input stray capacitance should normally be much less than 1
Cs = dr F(1OR)
(15-4)
656
Electronic Devices and Circuits
where R
with
is the equivalent resistance in series
the
stray
capacitance.
In
Fig.
2
15-17,
I :
R = R3 + (Ri + 7,)||Ro.
|
AAA}
From Eq. 15-4 it is seen that (as already
2
mentioned) the larger the resistor values, the
cc
smaller the stray capacitance that can produce
circuit
instability.
If the
signal
source
+—|-
is
ate
disconnected from the circuit, R becomes equal to (Ro + Rs), which is much larger than
L =p
[Re + (fs +Ri)|[R2].
In
this
situation,
an
extremely small stray capacitance can make the circuit unstable.
=
figure 15-18
ile
2 ~Veg
Use of Miller
effect compensation for
stray Capacitance at the
Miller-effect compensation can be used to
re
al
compensate for stray capacitance at an op-amp
input, as shown in Fig. 15-18. To eliminate the phase shift introduced by the stray capacitance,
the division
of the output
voltage produced by C, and C) in series should be equal to the division produced by R, and R>. Therefore,
Kea By This gives
Xeo
R,
C2R2
= CSR
(15-5)
Note that Eq. 15-5 does not allow for r, or R3 in Fig. 15-17. Where r, is not very much smaller than Rj, it must be added to R;. Also, resistor R3 could be
bypassed with another capacitor to reduce the total series resistance.
Example 15-7 Calculate the op-amp input terminal. stray capacitance that might cause instability in the circuit of Fig. 15-19 if the amplifier cutoff
frequency is 800 kHz. Determine a suitable Miller-effect compensating capacitor value. Solution
Stray capacitance: Eq. 15-4:
Gy
1
~ Qa X 10[(rz + Ry)|| Ral
Figure 15-19
Op-amp
amplifier circuit for Ex. 15-7.
Chapter 15
Operational Amplifier Frequency Response
657
1 ~ 2a X 800 kHz X 10[(600 2 + 1kQ)|}10 kQ]
= 14.4 pF Compensation:
hes
c ee. Ry
14.4
pFx (6000 ee 10 kO
+ 1kO
= 23 pF
Practice Problems 15-4.1 Determine the op-amp
input stray sapacitaxgen that might cause
instability in an inverting amplifier with Ry= 1.8 kOQ, Ro= 560 kQ, and f, = 600 kHz (a) when the signal source is open-circuited, and (b) when 7, = 600 O and Rj and R2 are reduced by a factor of 10.
15-4.2 Determine a suitable Miller-effect compensating capacitor value for the circuit in part (b) of Problem 15-4.1.
15-5
LOAD CAPACITANCE EFFECTS
Capacitance connected at the output of an operational amplifier is termed load capacitance (C_). Figure 15-20 shows that C_ is in series with the op-amp output resistance (ro), so that C, and r, constitute a phase-lag circuit in the
feedback network. As in the case of stray capacitance, another 10° of phase lag introduced by Cy and r, could cause circuit instability where the phase margin is already small. The equation for calculating the load capacitance that might cause instability is similar to that for stray capacitance: it
1-5 f(10r,) i :
cc
~1LE Figure 15-20
Load capacitance at an op-amp output can cause instability by
introducing additional phase lag in the feedback network.
(15-6)
658
Electronic Devices and Circuits
In Eq. 15-6, f is the frequency at which A,B = Act. If fo is reduced, Eq. 15-6 gives a larger C, value. Thus, an op-amp with a low output resistance can tolerate more load capacitance than one with a higher output resistance.
One method often used to counter instability caused by load capacitance
is shown in Fig. 15-21a. A resistor (R,), usually ranging from 12 2 to 400 0, is connected in series with the load capacitance. The presence of R, (with R,
connected at the op-amp output) can severely reduce the phase lag produced by ro and C,. However, R, also has the undesirable effect of increasing the circuit output impedance to approximately the resistance of Ry. A Miller-effect capacitor (C2) connected across feedback resistor R, may be
used to compensate for the load capacitance (see Fig. 15-21b). In this case, C, introduces some phase lead in the feedback network
to counter the phase
lag. The equation for calculating a suitable capacitance for C) is, once again, similar to that for stray capacitance: CoR>
=
CLLo
(15-7)
C2
=} | 71
Ry
WW, - Vee
Ry
ot v
Cy
(b) Miller-effect compensation for C;
Ry Cy +Voc
oN
R
ig R3
= Ver
“LT |
(c) Inverting amplifier with combination of R, and C, for C, compensation
Figure 15-21
ty (d) Non-inverting amplifier with R, and C, combination for Cy compensation
Compensation methods for load capacitance.
Chapter 15
Operational Amplifier Frequency Response
659
A modified form of Miller-effect compensation for load capacitance is shown in Fig. 15-21c. An additional resistor (Rx) is included in series with Cy
to reduce the phase lag. But now, R2 is connected at the junction of Rx and C_,
so that (because of feedback) R, has no significant effect on the circuit output impedance. Also, C2 is connected from the op-amp output terminal to the
inverting input. With this arrangement, Eq. 15-7 is modified to
CR. = Ciro +R)
(15-8)
It should be noted from Eqs 15-7 and 15-8 that, as for stray capacitance, smaller resistance values for R give larger, more convenient compensating
capacitor values.
Example 15-8 Calculate the load capacitance that might cause instability in the circuit of Fig. 15-22a if the amplifier cutoff frequency is 2 MHz and its output resistance is 25 Q. Determine a suitable compensating capacitor value for the circuit as modified in Fig. 15-22b with a 0.1 wF load capacitance. Solution Load capacitance: i Eq.
15-6:
Cr
~ Qnf(l0r,) = 318 pF
(a) Non-inverting amplifier with
load capacitance (C;) Figure 15-22
Circuits for Ex. 15-8.
i
2a X 2MHz x 10 x 250
(b) Amplifier compensated with
R, and C,
J
660
_Flectronic Devices and Circuits
/ Compensation:
, Eq. 15-8:
ar_
(25.0 + 25 0) City + Ry rin_ 0.1 pF X aca
= 500 PF —
a)
Practice Problems | 15-5.1
Calculate the load capacitance that might cause instability in the
circuit in Ex. 15-7 if the op-amp output resistance is 20 9. Determine
___ asuitable Miller-effect compensating capacitor value.
15-5. 2° The circuit in Problem 15-5.1 is modified as in Fig. 15-21c with R, = 8) Ro and Cy, = 0.5 pE. Calculate the required C value.
15-6
CIRCUIT STABILITY PRECAUTIONS
Power Supply Decoupling Feedback along supply lines is another source of op-amp circuit instability.
This can be minimized by connecting 0.01 wF high-frequency capacitors from
each supply terniinal to ground (see Fig. 15-23). The capacitors must be
connected as closely as possible to the IC terminals. Sometimes larger-value
Capacitors are required.
a Vee
Supply decoupling capacitors
Signal
source connected
Small-value resistors
Figure 15-23 For op-amp et 5 : circuit stability, keep resistor values to a minimum, use the recommended compensating componenis, bypass the supply terminals to ground, and keep the signal source connected.
Stability Precautions The following precautions should be observed for circuit stability:
1. Where low-frequency performance is required, use an internally compensated op-amp. Alternatively, use Miller-effect compensation to give the lowest acceptable cutoff frequency. 2. Use small-value resistors in the feedback network if possible, instead of
using the largest possible resistor values.
oe .
t
ated
'
3. With an. op-amp wut by Mot components
4, Keep all component
2rational Amplifier Frequency Response
resistorOr ;
. pF
ca
|
ck
Sey
acitors
‘
|
© circuit in Fig. 15-10a if the op-amp has the
of ‘the op-amp vg@. amp is: a 741.
Connect these capa
5
citors close to the? jney for the circuit in Fig. 15-19 if the op-amp is (a)
have a signal
6, Always
663
.
apa e
body r i
should have the eerie 0.1 ;
5, Use
ib)
as
Jeads as
t placement
iti
nt
*
.
ce col
sou” ting” product, determine the upper cutoff frequencies for
Alternatively, ground the circu
"A's 1,
small stray capacitances can causftn product to determine the upper cutoff frequencies
7. Do not connect
and b if they both have LM108 op-amps with C; =
ia
oti
terminals. Instrument input ¢
A if a dicuit is unstable aft/£xamples
observed, reduce the va
for
14-5 and
14-8 use 741
op-amps.
Use
,
the gain-
ncy for each circuit. the upper cutoff f frequency i duct to detetermine / Fig. 15-11 has the LM108 replaced with an LF353, use the gain-
resistors). Also, reduce product to determine the upper cutoff frequency.
the full-power bandwidth for an amplifier using a 741 op-amp if the
; ._./Oltage is to be (a) 5 V peak-to-peak and (b) 1 V peak-to-peak. Review Questio late the full-power lease each _ in eaviem 15-15 if the 741 yiaced with an LF353.
Section 15-1
culate the full-power bandwidth
for the circuit in Ex. 14-5 if the peak
15-1 Show howtput is to be 2 V. Determine the maximum peak output voltage that can be Explain throduced by the circuit at the cutoff frequency calculated in Problem 15-13. 15-2 Show fi Calculate the slew-rate limited cutoff frequency for the circuit in Ex. 14-8 if the Insta vaamaplengetti yin
os60>
aa
-
= peak input is 20 mV. Determine the maximum
peak output voltage at the
circuit cutoff frequency calculated in Problem 15-13.
Section 15-4
ah
15-19 A circuit as in Fig. 15-10a with C; removed has a cutoff frequency of 600 kHz. 1
Determine
the op-amp
input stray capacitance
that might
cause
instability
(a) when the signal source is open-circuited and (b) when a 300 Q signal source is connected.
15-20 Determine the input stray capacitance that might make the circuit in Fig. 15-10b become unstable when a 300 2 signal source is connected. Assume that the circuit cutoff frequency is 30 kHz and that C; is removed. 15-21 Calculate the Miller-effect capacitor value required to compensate for 250 pF of
input stray capacitance in the circuitry of Problem 15-19b. 15-22
Calculate the Miller-effect capacitor value required to compensate for 90 pF of
stray capacitance in the circuit of Problem 15-20.
15-23 An inverting amplifier (as in Figs 15-19) uses an LF353 op-amp and has r, = 600 , R; = 220 kQ, Rz = 2.2 MO, fo = 18 kHz. Calculate the input stray capacitance that might make the circuit unstable; (a) when the signal source is connected and (b) when the signal source is open-circuited.
15-24 Repeat Problem 15-23 when R; and R; are each reduced by a factor of 10.
‘ational Amplifier Frequency Response
ds component placem:
ent. A | res js
|
Y circuit in Fig. 15-10a if the op-amp has the
should have the resistor bod
5, Use 0,01 uF capacitors (of “amp (0! supply terminals of the oe a neil
ig.
itors clo
ct thes
come the sourcece |‘a a nena "ys 10) Alternatively, ground the circu!
“i 6 ,ii Always
small stray capacitances can cause
663
and 15-4. response graphs in Figs 15-3
Product to determine the upper cu toff frequencies for
ct oscilloscopes 9>-10a and b if they both have LM108 op-amps with C; = Do not conne 7, terminals. Instrument input ¢ 8. If a circuit is unstable a sbserved :
-xamples
14-5 and
14-8 use 741 op-amps.
Use the gain-
reduce the ¥ yf to determine the upper cutoff frequency for each circuit. ” Fig. 15-11 has the LM108 replaced with an LF353, use the gain-
resistors). Also, reduce Broduct to determine the upper cutoff frequency. the full-power bandwidth for an amplifier using a 741 op-amp if the .
:
Review Que stio
Bectiog 161 = 15-1
oltage is to be (a) 5 V peak-to-peak and (b) 1 V peak-to-peak.
late the full-power bandwidth in each case in Problem 15-15 if the 741 faced with an LF353.
ulate the full-power bandwidth for the circuit in Ex. 14-5 if the peak
Show how tput is to be 2 V. Determine the maximum peak output voltage that can be
Explainthroduced by the circuit at the cutoff frequency calculated in Problem 15-13. 2 Show f Calculate the slew-rate limited cutoff frequency for the circuit in Ex. 14-8 if the instal
Ry rd
peak input is 20 mV. Determine the maximum
peak output voltage at the
circuit cutoff frequency calculated in Problem 15-13.
Section 15-4
15-19 A circuit as in Fig. 15-10a with C; removed has a cutoff frequency of 600 kHz. 1
Determine the op-amp input stray capacitance that might cause instability (a) when the signal source is open-circuited and (b) when a 300 Q signal source is connected.
15-20 Determine the input stray become unstable when a circuit cutoff frequency is 15-21 Calculate the Miller-effect input stray capacitance in 15-22
capacitance that might make the circuit in Fig. 15-10b 300 2 signal source is connected. Assume that the 30 kHz and that C; is removed. capacitor value required to compensate for 250 pF of the circuitry of Problem 15-19b.
Calculate the Miller-effect capacitor value required to compensate for 90 pF of
stray capacitance in the circuit of Problem 15-20. 15-23 An inverting amplifier (as in Figs 15-19) uses an LF353 op-amp and has rs = 600 0, Ri = 220 kM, Ro = 2.2 MQ, fp = 18 kHz. Calculate the input stray capacitance that might make the circuit unstable; (a) when the signal source is connected and (b) when the signal source is open-circuited.
15-24 Repeat Problem 15-23 when R; and R; are each reduced by a factor of 10.
Chapter 15 — Operational Amplifier Frequency Response
663
Section 15-3 15-9 Determine the bandwidth of the circuit in Fig. 15-10a if the op-amp has the
gain/ frequency response graph in Fig. 15-2. Determine the bandwidth of the circuit in Fig. 15-10b if the op-amp is a 741. 15-10 Find the upper cutoff frequency for the circuit in Fig. 15-19 if the op-amp is (a) a 741 and (b) an AD843. Use the response graphs in Figs 15-3 and 15-4. 15-11 Using the gain-bandwidth product, determine the upper cutoff frequencies for
the circuits in Problem 15-10. 15-12 Use the gain-bandwidth product to determine the upper cutoff frequencies for
the circuits in Figs 15-10a and b if they both have LM108 op-amps with C; = 30 pF. 15-13 The circuits in Examples 14-5 and 14-8 use 741 op-amps. Use the gainbandwidth product to determine the upper cutoff frequency for each circuit. 15-14 If the circuit in Fig. 15-11 has the LM108 replaced with an LF353, use the gainbandwidth product to determine the upper cutoff frequency. 15-15 Calculate the full-power bandwidth for an amplifier using a 741 op-amp if the output voltage is to be (a) 5 V peak-to-peak and (b) 1 V peak-to-peak.
15-16 Recalculate the full-power bandwidth in each case in Problem 15-15 if the 741 is replaced with an LF353. 15-17 Calculate the full-power bandwidth for the circuit in Ex. 14-5 if the peak output is to be 2 V. Determine the maximum peak output voltage that can be
produced by the circuit at the cutoff frequency calculated in Problem 15-13. 15-18 Calculate the slew-rate limited cutoff frequency for the circuit in Ex. 14-8 if the peak input is 20 mV. Determine the maximum
peak output voltage at the
circuit cutoff frequency calculated in Problem 15-13.
Section 15-4 15-19 A circuit as in Fig. 15-10a with C; removed has a cutoff frequency of 600 kHz.
Determine the op-amp input stray capacitance that might cause instability (a) when the signal source is open-circuited and (b) when a 300 2 signal source
is connected. 15-20 Determine the input stray capacitance that might make the circuit in Fig. 15-10b become unstable when a 300 2 signal source is connected. Assume that the circuit cutoff frequency is 30 kHz and that C; is removed. 15-21 Calculate the Miller-effect capacitor value required to compensate for 250 pF of
input stray capacitance in the circuitry of Problem 15-19b, 15-22 Calculate the Miller-effect capacitor value required to compensate for 90 pF of stray capacitance in the circuit of Problem 15-20. 15-23 An inverting amplifier (as in Figs 15-19) uses an LF353 op-amp and has ts = 600 Q, Ry = 220 kO, Ro = 2.2 MQ, fp = 18 kHz. Calculate the input stray capacitance that might make the circuit unstable; (a) when the signal source is connected and (b) when the signal source is open-circuited. 15-24 Repeat Problem 15-23 when R; and R2 are each reduced by a factor of 10.
664
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Section 15-5 15-25 Determine the load capacitance that might cause instability in the circuit in
Fig. 15-10a with C; removed, if the circuit cutoff frequency is 600 kHz and fo = 100 0.
.
15-26 An inverting amplifier (as in Fig. 15-19) uses an op-amp with a 300 ©, output resistance,
and
has
R; = 220
kM
and
Rz=2.2
MQ.
Calculate
the load
capacitance that might make the circuit unstable. 15-27 Calculate the Miller-effect capacitor value required to compensate fora 0.1 pF load capacitance in the circuit of Fig. 15-10a if f, = 600 kHz. 15-28 Calculate the Miller-effect capacitor value required to compensate for the load capacitance in Problem 15-26.
a
a
15-29 Determine the load capacitance that might cause instability in the circuit in Fig. 15-22a if the cutoff frequency is 400 kHz, and the op-amp has an r, of 150 ©.
.
.
15-30 The circuit in Problem 15-29 is rearranged as in Fig. 15-22b with R, = 107.. Calculate the required C2 value to compensate for a 5000 pF load capacitance.
Practice Problem Answers 15-1.1 15-2.1
45°, 90°, 90° —48.5°, 415°
15-2.2
82pF
15-3.1 15-3.2 15-3.3
50 kHz 27 kHz, 1.13 MHz 296 kHz
15-4.2
0.5 pF
15-4.1
15-5.1 15-5.2
,
0.05 pF, 34.5 pF 995 pF, 2 pF 6000 pF
CHAPTER 16 Signal Generators Objectives You will be able to:
1 Draw the following types of sine wave oscillator circuits and explain the operation of each:
Analyze square and triangular waveform generators to determine the amplitude and
phase-shift, Colpitts, Hartley,
frequency of the output
and Wein bridge. 2 ceoaly2e
an a the above
ciara boten .
8 Design square and triangular
oscillator circuits to determine the oscillation frequency.
waveform generators to
3 Design each of the above
produce a specified output
oscillator circuits to produce a
amplitude and frequency.
specified output frequency. 4 Sketch oscillator amplitude stabilization circuits and explain their operation.
Design circuits to limit oscillator outputs to a specified amplitude. Draw square-wave and triangular-wave generator circuits. Sketch the circuit waveforms, and explain the operation of each circuit.
9 Analyze and design pulse generator circuits using 555 IC timers. 10 Explain piezoelectric crystals
and sketch the crystal equivalent circuit and the crystal impedance/frequency graph. 1
Show how crystals may be used for oscillator frequency stabilization, and design crystalcontrolled oscillators.
INTRODUCTION A sinusoidal oscillator usually consists of an amplifier and a phase-shifting network. The amplifier receives the output from the network, amplifies it, phase-shifts it by 180°, and applies it to the network input. The network
phase shifts the amplifier output by a further 180° and attenuates it before feeding it back to the amplifier input. When the amplifier gain equals the inverse of the network attenuation, and the amplifier phase shift equals the
network phase shift, the circuit is amplifying an input to produce an output
666
Electronic Devices and Circuits
which is attenuated to become the input. The circuit is generating its own
input signal, and a state of oscillation exists. Some signal generators produce square or triangular waveforms. These normally use non-linear circuits and resistor-capacitor charging circuits.
16-1
PHASE SHIFT OSCILLATORS
Op-Amp Phase Shift Oscillator Figure 16-1 shows the circuit of a phase shift oscillator, which consists of an inverting amplifier and an RC phase-shifting network. The amplifier phaseshifts its input by —180°, and the RC phase-lead network phase-shifts the amplifier output by a +180°, giving a total loop phase shift of zero. The attenuated feedback signal (at the amplifier input) is amplified to reproduce
the output. In this condition the circuit is generating its own input signal; consequently, it is oscillating. The output and feedback voltage waveforms in Fig. 16-1 illustrate the circuit operation.
For a state of oscillation to be sustained in any sinusoidal oscillator circuit, certain conditions, known as the Barkhausen criteria, must be fulfilled:
The loop gain must be equal to (or greater than) one.
The loop phase shift must be zero. The RC phase-lead network in Fig. 16-1 consists of three equal-value resistors and three equal-value capacitors. Resistor R; functions as the last feioaa
ee
|
Inverting
| amplifier
pss |
ie
Ry
I
Hy if
|
| L
| |
_
!
|
|
! |
!
|
SS
7
| (Rs |
Le
| | om
ee
ee
Se
z
~=4--4__ U%
Output voltage
fYols
"0 —
=
U¢
_tI__
a
ag
NX voltage
oo, I | | | | |
Figure 16-1
A phase shift oscillator consists of an inverting amplifier and an RC phase
shifting feedback network. The RC network attenuates the output and phase-shifts it by
180°. The amplifier amplifies the network output and phase-shifts it through a further 180°.
Chapter 16 _— Signal Generators
667
resistor in the RC network and as the amplifier input resistor. A phase-lag network would give a total loop phase shift of —360°, and so it would work
just as well as the phase-lead network. The frequency of the oscillator output depends upon the component values in the RC network. The circuit can be analyzed to show that the phase shift is 180° when Xc
=
V6R
This gives an oscillation frequency: f
—
(16-1)
Pee Se
QaRCV6
As well as phase-shifting the amplifier output, the RC network attenuates the output. It can be shown that, when the required 180° phase shift is
produced, the feedback factor (B) is always 1/29. This means that the amplifier must have a closed-loop voltage gain (Acz) of at least 29 to give a loop gain (BAc_) of one; otherwise the circuit will not oscillate. For example,
if the amplifier output voltage is 10 V, the feedback voltage is vg = Buy = 10 V/29 To reproduce the 10 V output, v; must be amplified by 29: Vo = Ac Ug = 29 X (10 V/29)
=10V
If the amplifier voltage gain is much greater than 29, the output waveform
will be distorted. When the gain is slightly greater than 29, a reasonably pure sine wave output can be expected. The gain is usually designed to be just over 29 to ensure that the circuit oscillates. The output voltage amplitude normally
peaks
at +(Vcc — 1 V) unless a
rail-to-rail op-amp
is used
(see
Section 14-9).
Op-Amp Phase Shift Oscillator Design Design of a phase shift oscillator begins with design of the amplifier to have a closed-loop gain just greater than 29. The resistor values for the RC network are then selected to be equal to the amplifier input resistor (R,), and the capacitor values are calculated from Eq. 16-1. In some cases, this procedure might produce
capacitor values not much larger than stray capacitance. So,
alternatively, the design might start with selection of convenient capacitor
values. Equation 16-1 is then used to calculate the resistance of R (and Rj). Finally, Rz is calculated to give the required amplifier gain.
668
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Example 16-1 Using a 741 op-amp witha +10 V supply, design the phase shift oscillator in
Fig. 16-2 to produce a 1 kHz output frequency.
B 180 ka Vec
5:6 kO
R3
Ver
180 kO
-10V
0.01 pF 0.01 pF 0.01 pF
‘Figure 16-2
Ex. 16-1.
Phase shift oscillator circuit for
Solution
Select
I, © 100 X Ipinaxy = 100 X 500 nA = 50 pA
Up ®H(Vec — 1 V)¥4(10V - 1 V) ~wt9V me
Y%
'
Ac
_
+9V
29
= 40.31 V _%
031V
11,
50pA
= 6.2 kO, (use 5.6 kO standard value) '
IRo = AcuRy = 29 X 5.6kO,
& 162: kO (use 180 kQ. to give Ac; > 29)
Rg = Ro = 180 kQ, (the de path through R, is interrupted by C) R=R, =5.6kQ
Chapter 16 —‘ Signal Generators
From Eq. 16-1:
C=
1
2aRFV6
669
1
_
2a x 5.6kO X 1kHz x V6
0.01 wF (standard value) Although the 741 op-amp used in Ex. 16-1 is likely to be quite suitable for the particular circuit, some care should always be taken when selecting an operational amplifier. It should be recalled (from Chapter 15) that when a
large output voltage swing is required, the op-amp full-power bandwidth is involved. This must be considered when selecting an operational amplifier
for an oscillator circuit.
A phase shift oscillator using a single BJT amplifier is shown in Fig. 16-3. Once again, the amplifier and phase shift network each produce 180° of phase shift, the BJT amplifies the network output, and the network attenuates the amplifier output. First thoughts about this circuit (in comparison to the op-amp phase shift oscillator) would suggest that a BJT amplifier with a voltage gain of 29 is required. An attempt to design such a
circuit reveals that in many cases the
amplifier output is overloaded by the phase shift network, or else the network output is overloaded by the amplifier input. The problem can be solved by including an emitter follower in the circuit. However, the circuit Sry | Inverting | amplifier, |
| a
Output voltage
%
et
ae Seete
pag Nea #> tee aaeestninee prepasted
LE maith
merge > Xc)).
a 40 kHz
output
frequency. Use a 100 mH inductor and an op-amp with a +10 V supply. R
2
270 kO AM\+10V
Ry 27 kO
, R3
27ko
> Z, of the amplifier Sen =
1
_
2afC,
1 2a X 40 kHz
x 1500 pF
= 2.65 kO,
Ri >
Xca
Ry = 10Xq = 10 X 2.65 kO,
Select
= 26.5 kO (use 27 kO standard value)
From Eq. 16-6,
C,
1500 pF
Aci(min) = CG
180 pF
= 8.33
Rp = ActRi = 8.33 X 27 kO
= 225 kQ, (use 270 kO standard value)
Rg = Ry||Ro = 27 kO||270 kO = 24.5 kQ (use 27 kO standard value) when The op-amp full-power bandwidth (fp) must be a minimum of 40 kHz
0% 49 V and Act = 8.33.
From Eq. 15-2,
fr = Aci
fo = 8.33 X 40 kHz
= 333 kHz
674
Electronic Devices and Circuits
From Eq. 15-3,
SR = 2nfpUp = 20 X 40 kHz X 8V =2V/yus
BJT Colpitts Oscillator A Colpitts oscillator using a single BJT amplifier is shown in Fig. 16-6a. This
is the basic circuit, and its similarity to the op-amp Colpitts oscillator is fairly obvious. A more complex version of the circuit is shown in Fig. 16-6b. Components
Qi, Ri, Rz, Rg, and Cg in (b) are unchanged
from
collector resistor Rc is replaced with inductor L;. A radio frequency
(a), but choke
(RFC) is included in series with Vcc and L;. This allows dc collector current
(Ic) to pass but offers a very high impedance at the oscillating frequency, so that the top of L; is ac isolated from Vcc and ground. The output of the LC network (L;, Cy, C2) is coupled via Cc to the amplifier input. The circuit
output voltage (v,) is derived from a secondary winding (Lz) coupled to L;. As in the case of the BJT phase shift oscillator, the transistor current gain is
important. Circuit analysis gives Eq. 16-4 for frequency. For current gain, Kein e(min) =
ov.
amplifier
"ma
f—-— a —a—ar
Inverting
(16-7)
BS Re
Ve e
R,
RFC
Ce
— FI
se
Ly Ts. -4----------
(a) Basic circuit Figure 16-6 network.
Ci Cs
4
Q;
(b) Practical circuit
Colpitts oscillator using an inverting BUT amplifier and an LC feedback
675
Chapter 16 —_ Signal Generators
Practice Problems 16-2.1 Design a Colpitts oscillator circuit to produce a 12 kHz, +10 V output.
Use a 741 op-amp.
—
6 V p-to-p 16-22 Design the oscillator in Fig. 16-6a to produce a 20 kHz, output. Use.a10 mH inductor and assume that the BJT has hp» ~ 26 0
and hie ¥ 1.5 kQ.
16-3 HARTLEY OSCILLATORS Op-Amp Hartley Oscillator
The Hartley oscillator circuit is similar to the Colpitts oscillator, except that the feedback network consists of two inductors and a capacitor instead of two capacitors and an inductor. Figure 16-7a shows the Hartley oscillator circuit,
and Fig. 16-7b illustrates the fact that L; and L, may be wound on a
single
core so that there is mutual inductance (M) between the two windings. In this
case, the total inductance is Ly = L} + L, + 2M
(16-8)
Oscillation occurs at the feedback network resonance frequency: 1
* LVS
| Inverting
eS
(16-9)
2a V (CyL7) F?.C~*~=C—s=sSN
| amplifier
Cy UE
bf (b) L; and L, wound (a) Oscillator circuit
“igure 16-7
ona single core
Hartley oscillator circuit using an op-amp inverting amplifier and an LC
feedback network.
676
Electronic Devices and Circuits
The attenuation of the feedback network is
ax
Xi — Xc1 It can be shown that the required 180° phase shift occurs when
Xia = Xn — Xa The loop gain must be a minimum of one, giving L AcL(min) = ies
(16-10)
Design procedure for a Hartley oscillator circuit
is similar
to
that
for
a Colpitts
oscillator.
Example 16-3
a
Design the Hartley oscillator in Fig. 16-8 to
i eO
produce a 100 kHz output frequency with
an amplitude of approximately +8 V. For
Rs
simplicity, assume that there is no mutual inductance between L; and Ly».
=
Solution Vec®Up +1V =4H(8V+1V) Zt9V X12 >> Z, of the amplifier
Figure 16-8
Hartley oscillator
circuit for Ex. 16-3.
Select
Xr %1kO I,
= Xr2
a
1kQO
Qf
2a X 100 kHz
= 1.59 mH (use 1.5 mH standard value) Ly
Select
Ly
=
10
1.5 mH
=
10
= 150 wH (standard value)
Ly = Ly + Lz = 1.5mH + 150 pH (assuminMg = 0) = 165mH
Chapter 16 _ Signal Generators
Cy ae
From Eq. 16-9,
677
1
4m’ f?Ly
4a? x (100 kHz)? x 1.65 mH
= 1535 pF (use 1500 pF with additional parallel
capacitance, if necessary)
C; >> stray capacitance
Xi = 2afLy = 2m X 100 kHz X 150 pH = 94.20, Ry > Xiu
Select
R,; = 1 kQ (standard value)
From Eq. 16-10,
fee
2 _ 1.5mH 1
150 pH
= 10
R2 = ActRi= 10 X 1 kO, = 10 kO (standard value)
Rg = Ry||Rp = 1kQ|[10kO = 909 © (use 1 kO standard value) The op-amp full-power bandwidth when U, © +8 V and Ac, = 10. From Eq. 15-2,
(fp) must be a minimum
of 100 kHz
fox = Act X f = 10 X 100 kHz = 1 MHz
From Eq. 15-3,
SR = 2mfpvp = 2m X 100 kHz X 8V =5V/ps
BJT Hartley Oscillator Figure 16-9 shows the circuit of a Hartley oscillator using a BJT amplifier. The basic circuit in Fig. 16-9a is similar to the op-amp Hartley oscillator, and its
operation is explained in the same way as for the op-amp circuit. Note that coupling capacitors Cc and Cy are required in order to avoid dc-grounding the transistor base and collector terminals through L; and Ly». In the practical BJT Hartley oscillator circuit shown in Fig. 16-9b Ly, Lz, and C; constitute the phase shift network. In this case, the inductors are directly connected in place of the transistor collector resistor (Rc). The circuit
output is derived from the additional inductor winding (L3). The radio
678
Electronic Devices and Circuits
(a) Basic circuit
Figure 16-9
(b) Practical circuit
Hartley oscillator consisting of a BUT inverting amplifier and an LC feedback
network.
frequency choke (RFC) passes the direct collector current, but ac isolates the upper terminal of L; from the power supply. Capacitor C2 couples the output of the feedback network back to the amplifier input. Capacitor C4 at the BJT
collector in Fig. 16-9a is not needed in Fig. 16-9b, because L» is connected directly to the collector terminal. The junction of L; and L2 must now be capacitor-coupled to ground (via C3) instead of being direct-coupled.
Practice Problems
=
16-3.1 A Hartley oscillator circuit using a 741 op-amp is to produce a 7 kHz,
+10 V output. Determine suitable component values. 16-3.2 Analyze the BJT Hartley oscillator in Fig. 16-9b to determine the oscillating frequency. The important component values are: yer ack = Ly = 47 mH, C; = 600 pE, and C2 = C3 = 0.03 pF. The mutual
_. inductance between Ly and L3 is 100 wH.
16-4 WEIN BRIDGE OSCILLATOR The Wein bridge is an ac bridge that balances only at a particular supply frequency. In the Wein bridge oscillator (Fig. 16-10), a Wein bridge circuit is used as a feedback network between the amplifier output and input. The bridge
is made
up of all of the resistors
and
capacitors.
The
operational
Chapter 16 _
679
Signal Generators
a Vo
Output voltage
Feedback volta ge
Figure 16-10
Wein bridge oscillator circuit uses an operational amplifier and a Wein
bridge that balances at a particular frequency.
amplifier
together
with
Ry, constitute
R3; and
resistors
a non-inverting
amplifier. The feedback network from the amplifier output to its noninverting input terminal is made up of components Cj, Ri, C2, and Ra. At the balance frequency of the Wein bridge, the feedback voltage is in
phase with the amplifier output. This (in-phase) voltage is amplified
to
reproduce the output. At all other frequencies, the bridge is off balance; that
is, the feedback and output voltages do not have the correct phase relationship to sustain oscillations. The Barkhausen requirement for zero loop phase shift is fulfilled in this circuit by the amplifier and feedback network both having zero phase shift at the oscillation frequency. Analysis of the bridge circuit shows that balance is obtained when two equations are fulfilled:
R3
a
and
20f
f
=
Rh
eG
G
1
(RyCyRoC2)
(16-11)
16-12)
If RiC, = R2C2, Eq. 16-12 yields ee
1
27R\Cy
(16-13)
680
Electronic Devices and Circuits
For simplicity, the components are often selected as R; = R2 and causing Eq. 16-11 to give
C, = C,,
Ry ='2R4
(16-14)
In this case, the amplifier closed-loop gain is Ac = 3. Sometimes it is preferable to have an amplifier voltage gain substantially
greater than 3; then the relationship between
the component
values js
determined by Egs 16-11 and 16-12. Design of a Wein bridge oscillator can be started by selecting a current level for each arm of the bridge. This should be much larger than the op-amp input bias current. Resistors R; and Ry can
then
be calculated
from the
estimated output voltage and the closed-loop gain. After that, the other component values can be determined from Eqs 16-11 to 16-14. An alternative design approach is to start by choosing a convenient value for the smallest capacitor in the circuit. The other component values are then calculated from the equations.
Example 16-4 Design the Wein bridge oscillator in Fig. 16-11 to produce a 100 kHz, +9 V output. Design the amplifier to have a closed-loop gain of 3.
Figure 16-11 Wein bridge oscillator circuit for Ex. 16-4.
Solution
Vec® Vy +1V) =+9V + 1V) =+10V
For Act = 3,
R, = Rpand C; = Cy
Also,
R3=2R,
Select
C; = 1000 pF (standard value)
Chapter 16
Signal Generators
681
C2 = C; = 1000 pF
q
]
1
1
2nfC,
2m X 100 kHz x 1000 pF
= 1.59 kQ (use 1.5 kO standard value)
Rz = Ry = 1.5k0 Select
Ry = Ro = 1.5kQ (standard value) Rg = 2Ry = 2 X1.5k0 = 3 kO (use 3.3 kO standard value)
The op-amp must have a minimum when 0, ~ £9 V and Ac, = 3. From Eq. 15-2,
full-power bandwidth
(fp) of 100 kHz
fp = Aci X f= 3 X 100 kHz
= 300 kHz From Eq. 15-3,
SR= 2m)
=27 X 100kHz x9 V
=5,.7V/ps
Practice Problems 16-4.1
Resistors R; and Ro in Fig. 16-11 are switched to (a) 15 kO and (b) 5.6 k®.
Calculate the new oscillating frequency in each case. 16-4.2 A Wein bridge oscillator using an op-amp is to produce a 15 kHz, +14 V output. Design the circuit with the amplifier having Ac, = 11.
16-5 OSCILLATOR AMPLITUDE STABILIZATION Output Amplitude For all of the oscillator circuits discussed, the output voltage amplitude
is
determined by the amplifier maximum output swing. The output waveform may also be distorted by the output saturation limitations. To minimize distortion and reduce the output voltage to an acceptable level, amplitude stabilization circuitry must be employed. Amplitude stabilization operates by ensuring that oscillation is not sustained if the output exceeds a predetermined level.
Diode Stabilization Circuit for a Phase Shift Oscillator The phase shift oscillator discussed in Section 16-1 must have a minimum
amplifier gain of 29 for the circuit to oscillate. Consider the oscillator circuit in Fig. 16-12a that has part of resistor R, bypassed by series-parallel connected
diodes.
When
the output amplitude is low, the diodes do not
682
Electronic Devices and Circuits
(a) Phase shift oscillator with
(b) Use of adjustable resistor
amplitude stabilization
for distortion control
Figure 16-12 The output amplitude of a phase shift oscillator can be limited by using diodes to modify the amplifier gain.
become forward biased, and so they have no effect on the circuit. At this time, the amplifier voltage gain is Ac. = R2 /R;. As always for a phase shift oscillator, Ac, is designed to exceed the critical value of 29. When the output amplitude becomes large enough to forward bias either D; and D3, or D3 and
Du, resistor Rg is short-circuited and the amplifier gain becomes R5/R,. This is designed to be too small to sustain oscillations. So, this circuit cannot oscillate with a high-amplitude output; however it can (and does) oscillate with a low-amplitude output. In the design of the amplitude stabilization circuit, the inverting amplifier is designed in the usual manner with one important difference. The current (I) used in calculating the resistor values must be large enough to forward bias the diodes into the near-linear region of their characteristics. This usually requires a minimum current around 1 mA. The resistor values are
calculated as follows:
Ro 1
V_/29
a
Ro = 29R,
(16-15)
(16-16)
Chapter 16 _
683
Signal Generators
The diodes should become forward biased just when the output voltage is at the desired maximum level. At this time, I; produces a voltage drop of 2V; across Rg. Therefore
Ry © =
and
Rs
=
Rp
—
(16-17)
1 Rg
The resulting component values should give (Ry + Rs)/R; slightly greater than 29, and Rs5/R; less than 29. Some distortion of the waveform can occur if (Rq + Rs)/Ri is much larger
than 29; however, attempts to make the gain close to 29 can cause the circuit to stop oscillating. Making a portion of Rs adjustable, as illustrated in Fig. 16-12b,
provides for gain adjustment to give the best possible output waveform.
Usually Rg should be approximately 40% of the calculated value of Rs, and R7
should be 80% of Rs. This gives a +20% adjustment of Rs. The diodes should be low-current switching devices. The diode reverse
breakdown maximum
voltage
should
exceed
the circuit supply
voltage,
and
the
reverse recovery time (ty(max)) Should be about one-tenth of the
time period of the oscillation frequency: rT trr(max) = 70
(16-18)
Example 16-5 Design the phase shift oscillator in Fig. 16-13 to produce a 5 kHz, +5 V output waveform.
Rp ——— Rg
Re
Rz
Figure 16-13 Amplitude-controlled phase shift oscillator circuit for
Ex. 16-5.
684
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Solution
Select
Eq. 16-15:
q
I, ~1 mA when Uoipeak) = 5 V
Vo/29.
5 V/29
==
AT
mA
= 170 0 (use 150 2) Eq. 16-16:
Ry = 29R; = 29 X 1500 744k0
Fq
. 16-17:
2V,
R,=—t = |
2x07V 1mA
= 1.4k0 (use 1.5 kO standard value) Rs = Ry — Ry = 4.4kQ— 1.5kO = 2.9k0 Re = 0.4Rs = 0.4 X 2.9kO = 1.16 0 (use 1 kO adjustable) R7 = 0.8Rs5 = 0.8 X 2.9 kO = 2.32 kO (use 2.7 kD standard value) R3® Ry = 4.4 kO (use 4.7 kO standard value) R=R,= 1500 From Eq. 16-1,
c=
,
2aRfFV6
=
:
a
2a X 1502 X 5kHz x V6
= 0.087 F (use 0.082 wF standard value)
Diode Stabilization Circuit for a Wein Bridge Oscillator Figures 16-14 and 16-15 show two output amplitude stabilization methods that can be used with a Wein bridge oscillator. These can also be applied to other oscillator circuits because they all operate by limiting the amplifier
voltage gain. The circuit in Fig. 16-14 uses diodes and operates in the same way as the amplitude control for the phase shift oscillator. Resistor Rg becomes shorted by the diodes when the output amplitude exceeds the design level, thus rendering the amplifier gain too low to sustain oscillations.
FET Stabilization Circuit for a Wein Bridge Oscillator The circuit in Fig. 16-15 is slightly more complex
than
the diode circuit:
however, like other circuits, it stabilizes the oscillator Output amplitude by controlling the amplifier gain. The channel resistance (rps) of the p-channel
Chapter 16 —
Signal Generators
685
Figure 16-14 Wein bridge oscillator with its output amplitude stabilized by a diode circuit that modifies the amplifier gain.
Figure 16-15
Wein bridge oscillator with the output amplitude stabilized by a FET
voltage-controlled resistance circuit.
FET (Q)) is in parallel with resistor Ry. Capacitor C3 ensures that Q; has no effect on the amplifier dc conditions. The amplifier voltage gain is
_ Rs + Rallros a
>
Rallrps
: 16-19)
The FET gate-source bias voltage is derived from the amplifier ac output. The output voltage is divided across resistors Rs and Ry and rectified by diode D,. Capacitor C4 smooths the rectified waveform to give the FET dc bias voltage (Vcs). The polarity shown on the circuit diagram reverse-biases
the gate-source of the p-channel device. When the output amplitude is low,
686
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Vgs is low and this keeps the FET drain-source resistance (rps) low. When the
output gets larger, Vos is increased, causing rps to increase. The increase
in rps reduces Ac,, thus preventing the circuit from oscillating with a high output voltage. It is seen that the FET is behaving as a voltage variable resistance (VVR).
Design of a FET Stabilization Circuit To design the FET amplitude stabilization circuit, knowledge of a possibly
suitable FET is required; in particular, the channel resistance at various gatesource voltages must be known. Suppose the circuit is to oscillate when rps = 6 kN. at Vcs = 1 V, and that the peak output is to be Voipk) = 6 V. Resistors Rs and Rg should be selected to give Vcs = 1 V when Vopk) = 6 V, allowing for Vy across the diode. Capacitor
C4 smooths the half-wave rectified waveform and discharges via Rg during the time interval between peaks of the output waveform. The capacitance of C4 is calculated to allow perhaps a 10% discharge during the time period of the oscillating frequency. The voltage-divider current (I5) should be a minimum of about 100 A for satisfactory diode operation. C3 is a coupling capacitor; its impedance at the oscillating frequency should be much smaller than the 7ps of the FET.
Resistors
R3 and Ry are
calculated from Eq. 16-19 to give the required amplifier voltage gain when rps =
6 kQ.
Example 16-6 Design the FET output amplitude stabilization circuit in Fig. 16-16 to limit the output amplitude of the Wein bridge oscillator in Ex. 16-4 to +6 V. Assume that the rg; = 600 9 at Ves = 1 V, and 800 2 at Ves = 3 V.
C,
1000 pF T.
Figure 16-16
Wein bridge oscillator circuit for Ex. 16-6.
Chapter 16
Signal Generators 687
Solution Select
R4* rpg at Veg = 1 V = 600 2 (use 560 2)
Ral|ros = 560 0||600.0 290 2, For Aci = 3,
R3 = 2 (R,||rps) = 2 X 290.0
= 580 2 (use 680 2) Select
I5 + 200 A when Vopeak) = 6 V R, = VSS
6
_
Is
1V
200 pA
= 5 kO (use 4.7 k) Voipeak) — (Vcs + Voi) Rs
=
Is
6V — (1V + 0.7V) 7
200 pA
= 21.5 kO (use 22 kD)
C4 discharge voltage: AVc = 0.1
Ve5
= 0.1
X1V=0.1V
C4 discharge time:
She
1
P= | = 100 KHz = 10us
Ic =
V Re
8 & Is = 200 pA _ 200 pA
= IcT
&,
4
AVe
X 10 ps
0.1V
= 0.02 wF (standard value) Xo3 = a
at the oscillating frequency
1
_
1
C3 = 27 f rps/10 ~ 2m X 100 kHz Xx 500 2/10
= 0.032 pF (use 0.03 LF) D, should be a low-current switching diode with a ty,
(17-26)
Chapter 17 _ Active Filters
737
R, =2QX at f,
(17-27)
2 _ Rit Ry 2Ry
(17-28)
Modified Figure 17-20 stage band-pass filter. addition of resistor R4 circuit to be designed
singleThe allows the for a
narrow-band A,/f response.
Design of the circuit is approached in the usual way by first selecting a suitable resistance value for R2 (considering the op-amp input bias current), and then calculating C. As always, if this produces a capacitance value that
might be affected by stray capacitance, then a suitable value for C is first selected, and R» is determined from C. Other determined from the appropriate equations.
components
are
then
Example 17-10 Calculate the centre frequency and bandwidth of the band-pass filter
in Fig. 17-20. Solution
Be
. 17-28:
liae
F rom Eq.17-27, 72,
Eq. 17-23:
Ri + Ry 60.4k0 + 1.21k0 Q 2R4 = 2X 121kO = 25,46 Q = V25.46 = 5.05 —
Q 5.05 = = fo = FoR, a X 0.012 pF X 121kQ = 1.1kHz pw ae = tt kHe “Q 5.05
738
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Practice Problems 17-6.1 A single-stage band-pass filter, as in Fig. 17-16, has the following component values: R; = Rz = 7.5 kQ, R3 = 6.8 kQ,, Ci = 8200 pF, and
C) = 750 pF. Determine the circuit bandwidth, centre frequency, and Q factor. 17-6.2 The band-pass circuit in Fig. 17-20 is to have a 1 kHz centre frequency and a 200 Hz bandwidth. Using a 741 op-amp, determine the required component values.
17-7
NOTCH
FILTERS
A notch filter is the inverse of a band-pass filter; its function is to block a band of signal frequencies. Other names are band-stop and band-reject filter. Figure 17-21a shows how a notch filter can be constructed
by the use of
low-pass and high-pass filters. The circuit inputs are connected in parallel, __|
Low-pass filter
| Summing
O
circuit
v;
ee
High-pass filter
:
:) vo
wie
ook (a) Low-pass and high-pass filters combined to produce a notch response
(dB)
Low-pass band
Stop band Ld
é 0
| |
High-pass band —
!
|
a
=
\
A, —i0
ny
—
i
| / |
f— f
(10 kHz)
,
f
hh
(100 kHz)
(b) Notch gain/frequency response Figure 17-21 A notch filter can be constructed by parallel-connecting the inputs of lowpass and high-pass filters, and summing the outputs.
Chapter 17
Active Filters
739
and the outputs are applied to a summing circuit (see Section 14-6). The summing circuit is necessary because the filters would overload each other if
the outputs were directly connected in parallel. Suppose that the low-pass circuit has a cutoff frequency of 10 kHz and that the cutoff frequency of the high-pass circuit is 100 kHz. The low-pass circuit will attenuate signal frequencies above 10 kHz, while the high-pass circuit will attenuate
frequencies below 100 kHz. The result is a stop band of 10 kHz to 100 kHz, as shown in Fig. 17-21b. Note that the frequency limits of the stop band are those frequencies at which the signal is —3 dB from its normal output level. The low-pass and high-pass filters can be first-order, second-order, or higher, for any desired roll-off rate of the notch frequency response. Another method of creating a notch filter is to sum the output of a bandpass filter with its own input signal, as shown in Fig. 17-22. In this case, the band-pass filter must have a voltage gain of 1, and it must invert the input
signal (or else an inverting amplifier must be included). During the pass band of the band-pass circuit, its output Upp equals —v;, and so the two inputs to the summing circuit cancel each other, giving zero output voltage. Above
and below the pass band of the band-pass circuit, vgp is very much smaller than v;. This causes the summing circuit output to equal v;, and the combination has a notch frequency response. Band-pass filter
v BP
|
Figure 17-22
tL
Anotch
filter can be
Summing circuit
constructed by Io a
summing the input and output of a band-pass filter. The notch filter
cutoff frequencies are the same as those of
|
LT
the band-pass filter.
The band-pass filter circuit in Fig. 17-18 (designed in Ex. 17-8) can be converted into a single-stage notch filter by the addition of resistor Ry, as shown in Fig. 17-23. R4 should be chosen to be equal to Rj and R2, and resistor R3 should also be made precisely equal to Rz (instead of approximately
equal). The circuit now functions as a difference amplifier (see Section 14-7) with only one input (0). For signal frequencies between f, and fs, the input
voltage (applied to both R; and Ry) produces positive-going and negativegoing equal outputs that cancel each other. For signals above and below the cutoff frequencies, input voltages applied via R; are attenuated, and those
applied via Ry are passed to the output. Thus, the circuit functions as a notch filter.
740
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Cy YI T
1000 P pF
Ry 5.36 kO
R
+Vec
WV
,
°
+=
5.36 kQ
Cy
R
0.1 pF
VT
+
Figure
4
7
AM 5.36 kO,
a
ie R; 5.36 kQ-
% EE ah =
LL
17-23
A single-
stage notch filter can be constructed by the addition of a resistor (R4) to a single-stage band-pass filter.
Practice Problem 17-7.1
A single-stage notch filter, as in Fig. 17-23, is to be designed to havea stop band
ranging from
200 Hz
to 20
kHz.
Determine
suitable
component values for the circuit.
17-8 ALL-PASS FILTERS Phase-Lag Circuit An all-pass filter is a circuit that will pass all frequencies without attenuation but with phase shifts that vary with the signal frequency. A phase lag can also
be termed a phase delay, so an all-pass phase-lag circuit is also known as a delay filter. Figure 17-24a shows an all-pass circuit, and Fig. 17-24b shows its phase/frequency response graph. The circuit is similar to a difference amplifier (see Section 14-7) except that capacitor C; replaces a resistor. Also,
the two input terminals are connected together so that v; is applied to both. The procedure used in the analysis of the difference amplifier can be used to investigate the all-pass filter. With the inputs separated, terminal 2 grounded, and _v; applied to terminal 1: Vo1
With
Ry = Rz
_=
_&
Ri
XK 0;
V1 = Uj
With terminal 1 grounded, and 9; applied to terminal 2, Ry + Ry
Yon = a With R; = Ro,
Vo2 = 2Uc1
1
* UI
Chapter 17__
Active Filters
7441
Figure 17-24 An all-pass phase-lag circuit passes the input signals with no attenuation but with a phase lag
dependent on the signal
frequency.
(b) Phase/ frequency response
%c1 =
and
anhlchgives
0j(-jXe1)
R3 — jXc1_ Vo = Voi — Vo2
_ =
;
Uj
1 + j(R3/Xc1)
Yo = [2 tan (Ry/ Xe)
(17-29)
It is seen that the output voltage amplitude is always equal to the input,
regardless of the signal frequency. Also, the output lags behind the input by an angle of
o = —2 tan* (R3/Xc1) When Xc; = R3,
ob = —90°
At high signal frequencies, when Xc1 > Rs,
x0?
(17-30)
742
Electronic Devices and Circuits
The above quantities are illustrated by the #/f response graph in Fig. 17-24b. An all-pass circuit is designed by first choosing suitable values for resistors R, and R» as for an inverting amplifier with a gain of 1. This requires R; = Ro. Resistor R3 is then selected to be approximately equal to Ry | Ro, and C
is calculated to give Xci = R3 at the desired 90° frequency. If
an uncompensated op-amp is used, it should inverting amplifier with a gain of 1.
be
compensated
as an
Example 17-11 Using a 741 op-amp, design an all-pass filter to have a phase lag adjustable from 80° to 100°. The signal amplitude is 1 V and its frequency is 5 kHz. Solution
See Fig. 17-25, ly > Ipmax) Select
i, =50 pA
= 7 ~ 5 3 = 20 kO (use 20 kN. + 1% standard value)
Ro = Ry = 20kO
R3*R,|| Ro = 10kO For a 90° phase shift,
Xci = Rs or
Cy
:
~ QnfR3
A
2X 7 X 5kHz X 10kO
= 3183 pF (use 3300 pF standard value)
-
” kQ
Ro¥
6.8kO
=al a
Figure 17-25 All-pass phase-lag circuit designed in Ex. 17-11.
Chapter 17
Active Filters
743
For an 80° phase shift,
Eq. 17-30:
d@ = —2 arctan (R3/Xc1)
.
Ry = 2/2) 2afC;
tang80"/2) 2X + X 5kHz X 3300 pF
~ 8.1 kO For a 100° phase shift, Ry = tan(p/2) _
QnfC;
tan(1 00°/2)
|
2X a X 5kHz X 3300 pF
= 11.5kO0 For R3, use a 6.8 k) fixed value +10% resistor in series with a 5 kQ variable
resistor to give a total resistance adjustable from 6.8 kO to 11.8 k.
Phase-Lead Circuit The phase-lead circuit in Fig. 17-26 is similar to the phase-lag circuit, except that R3 and C, are interchanged. This has the effect of causing the output to Ry
Ry Oo—¢ \] Vt
Uj
Up
Gi
R3
a 180°
[
-
=
t
150°
120°
$ 90°}
—_ _ ;—_ _ _ {}_ _ Peng
60°
—_f—$—————_
a
fe) LL
0°
Figure 17-26
An all-pass
phase-lead circuit
ai
Passes the input signals {
—_—
Xcy = Ry (b) Phase/ frequency response
with no attenuation but
with a phase lead dependent on the signal frequency.
744
Electronic Devices and Circuits
lead the input by a phase angle dependent on the relationship between Xc;
and R3. The design procedure for this circuit is similar to that for the phase-lag circuit.
Practice Problem 17-8.1 An all-pass filter using a BIFET op-amp is to have a phase lead adjustable from 75° to 90°. The input signal has 1 V amplitude and a frequency of 1 kHz. Determine suitable component values for the circuit.
17-9 STATE-VARIABLE FILTERS The circuit shown in Fig. 17-27, known as a state-variable filter, consists of amplifier A; and two integrators, Az and A3. Another arrangement of the
Figure 17-27 State-variable filter circuit consisting of amplifier stage A; and integrator stages Az and As. The circuit functions as a band-pass filter when the output is taken from Ap.
circuit is named a biquad filter. Both are termed universal filters because they
can function as low-pass, high-pass, band-pass, all-pass, or notch filters. The circuit in Fig. 17-27 is intended to operate as a band-pass filter with the output taken from Ap. Amplifier A, together with resistors Ry, Rz, R3, and R,, functions as a difference amplifier. (In a slightly different circuit configuration, Aj is
connected as a summing amplifier.) A. and A3 and their associated components are integrators, which introduce 90° phase shifts. The input to A, is applied via R, to its non-inverting terminal, but A, output is inverted by Az and fed back to Aj via resistor Ro. Consequently, A; and A» together with R, and R; constitute an inverting amplifier, which is effective only for signal
frequencies close to the filter centre frequency.
Chapter 17
Active Filters
745
At low frequencies, capacitors C; and C, have high impedances compared to the resistances of Rs and Rg, and so the stage gains of A2 and A3 are very large. In this case, the negative feedback from A3 to R, tends to reduce the A and A» outputs to nearly zero. At high-signal frequencies, the impedances of C, and C2 are small compared to Rs and Rg, so that the Ay and A3 gains are very small (an attenuation). In this condition, the output from Az is again quite small. At the centre frequency, or critical frequency (fo), for the circuit, Xci = Rs
and Xc2 = Re. The Az and A; stages each have a voltage gain of 1 at f,, as well as a 90° phase shift. So, the voltage fed from A3 to Ry is equal to, and in antiphase with, the output of A;. Thus, A; has a very large gain from its non-
inverting input terminal to its output, Az has a gain of 1, and resistors Rz and R; become effective as a feedback network. The voltage gain from 0; to v,2 at the centre of the pass band is then R2/R:.
Analysis of the equation for Q:
state-variable
filter circuit produces
——
which gives
Because
a very
R, + Ro OR,
17-3 (17-31)
Ry = R,(2Q — 1)
the circuit is designed
simple
(17-32)
so that at the centre frequency
of the
bandwidth (fo), Xc1 = Xc2 = Rs = Ro,
1 fo = 27 CRs Designing
this
circuit
begins
with
the
(17-33)
selection
of
a
convenient
capacitance value for C; and Cj. Then Rs and Rg are calculated from Eq. 17-33. Resistors R3 and R4 should give an A; stage gain of 1. So R3 equals Ry, and these can also be made equal to Rs and R¢. Furthermore, R; can be made equal to the common value of the other resistors, leaving R2 to be determined from Eq. 17-32. Only Rs and Re need to have precise resistance values in relation to C; and C> (to set fo). The design procedure is seen to consist of only three steps: (1) select a
convenient capacitance value for C; and C;, (2) use Eq. 17-33 to determine the common value for all resistors except Rz, (3) calculate R2 from Eq. 17-32.
Example 17-12 Design a state-variable band-pass filter to have f, = 10.3 kHz and f, =10.9 kHz.
746
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Solution
Select
C, = C) = 1000 pF
Eq. 17-24:
fo= (Af) = J10.3 kHz x 10.9 kHz = 10.6 kHz
Eq. 17-33:
Rs
1
~ DafyC,
1
2X m7 X 10.6kHz X 1000 pF
= 15.01 kO (use 15 kO +1% standard value)
Ry = Rg = Rg = Rs = Re = 15 kO.
From Eqs 17-22 and 17-23, Q=
fo
10.6 kHz
fo-fi
10.9kHz — 10.3 kHz
= 17.7 Eq. 17-32:
= Ry = R,(2Q — 1) = 15 kQ[(2 x 17.7) —1] = 515 kO, (use 301 kO and 215 kO +1% in series)
Practice Problem 17-9.1
A state-variable band-pass filter (as in Fig. 17-27) has the following components: Ry = R3 = Rg = Rs = Re = 12 kO, Ro = 180 kQO, and
C; = Cp = 1500 pF. Determine the centre frequency and bandwidth for the circuit.
17-10
IC SWITCHED-CAPACITOR
FILTERS
Switched-Capacitor Resistor Simulation A major problem with constructing filters in integrated circuit form is that size restrictions allow only very small capacitance values to be fabricated: a
maximum of approximately 100 pF. Small-value capacitances require relatively large-value resistors for the critical frequencies in filters. For example, a critical frequency of 1 kHz with a 100 pF capacitance requires a 1.59 MO, resistor. Here again there is a problem
because
such
resistance
values require more space than is available on an IC chip. The difficulties are overcome by the use of small-value capacitors and MOSFET
switches, which
are easily fabricated in IC form. The combination of capacitor and switch can
be employed to simulate a resistor. Figure 17-28a shows an integrator stage as used in a state-variable filter circuit. In Fig.17-28b, the integrator resistor (R2) is replaced with a capacitor (C1) and a switch (S;) that alternately connects C, to the input voltage (vj) at terminal 1 and to the junction of C; and the op-amp inverting input at
terminal 2. When S, is set to terminal 1, capacitor Cy charges to v;. When 5; is
Chapter 17
Active Filters
747
eo C,
el.
= (a) Integrator circuit
—, >
5 1 \
eh
Tt
2
=
[|
=
Li
(c) Clock switching waveform
(b) Integrator with a switched
capacitor substituted for R A resistor can be simulated by a switched capacitor, which passes charge Figure 17-28 at the same rate as the resistor. Switched capacitors are more easily fabricated than resistors in integrated circuits.
switched from terminal 1 to terminal 2, C; passes its charge to C2. Now assume that S; is controlled by the clock waveform shown in Fig. 17-28c. The charge passed during one cycle of the clock is
or
Q
=
Cy;
1 Tx
=
C10;
.
a
5 which gives
i=
Cy0;
Tek
Referring to Fig. 17-28a again, the current passed to C) is
ee i= Ro For equal input current levels via Ry and via S; and Cy, Tk
Ro = C,
Oo Tr
R
qe
|
Fea
= (17-34)
It is seen that resistance R» is simulated by C; and switch S;. The resistance
value depends upon the capacitance of C; and upon the switching (clock) frequency (fcx). Increasing fcx reduces the simulated resistance; reducing fex
748
Electronic Devices and Circuits
increases the resistance. A clock frequency acitance simulate a resistance value of
1
of 50 kHz
and
a 100 pF cap-
1
Ra= faeC1
50 kHz X 100 pF
= 200kO Recall from Section 17-9 that the critical frequency of the filter occurs when the integrator resistors equal the capacitive impedance:
1
fo = QarCoR> Substituting for Ro, Fa
fo= OmCs
(17-35)
Equation 17-35 shows that the critical frequency now depends upon the ratio of capacitors C, and C2 as well as on the clock frequency. Although integrated circuit capacitors cannot be fabricated with very accurate absolute values, they can be created with accurate capacitance ratios (usually + 0.1%), and
this is good for f, accuracy. Also, because f, is directly proportional to fy, the
critical frequency can be altered by variation of f-x.
IC Filter Circuits Integrated circuit switched-capacitor filters generally use the state-variable (universal)
filter
circuit
configuration
(see
Section
17-9),
because
the
connections can easily be arranged to give all five filter functions (low-pass, high-pass,
band-pass,
all-pass, and
capacitive component values are not the clock frequency determines the the filter critical frequency is set connections are usually provided:
notch).
internal
IC
resistive and
listed on a data sheet. Instead, because (switched-capacitor) resistance values, by the clock frequency. Two clock one for f. = f./50, and the other for
fo = fex/100. So, for fo = 1 kHz, for example,
100 kHz might be used. The critical frequency for a given highest signal frequency. An these are readily available in
The
a clock of either 50 kHz or
clock frequency must be much higher than the filter design, and it should be at least twice the external clock source is normally required, and IC form.
The MF10 is an integrated circuit containing two switched-capacitor statevariable filter sections which can be operated independently as two secondorder filters, or cascaded to make one fourth-order filter. One-half of the MF10
block diagram is shown in Fig. 17-29. The
amplifier, a summing
circuit, and
two
circuit is made
integrators.
An
external
up of an
clock is
Active Filters
Chapter 17
N/AP/HP, = Sla
3
INV, (-——_—_—_
01
2
Integrator
Summer
4
LPs
BP 4
5
749
Integrator
15 AGND (}
CLK,
| LEVEL [NON OVERL
apigemeee T |e
CLOCK
SHIFT |
a 12
50/100/CL (+
CONTROL
LIA Sa,
9 Lea tce——— Figure 17-29
Block diagram of one-half of an MF10 switched-capacitor IC filter.
(Reprinted with permission of National Semiconductor Corporation. Not authorized for
use as Critical components in a life support system.)
required, and with only two to four external resistors, any filter function can be performed. The connecting pins shown are identified as follows:
LSh 50/100/CL
Shifts the dc level of the clock input Sets the ratio of fex/fo
CLKa
Clock input
AGND
Analog ground terminal
INVa
N/AP/HP,
Op-amp inverting input terminal
Notch, all-pass, and high-pass output, and summer non-inverting input
Sla BPs LP,
Summer inverting input Band-pass output Low-pass output
SAB
Sets the internal switch to an inverting input of the summer stage
The f-./fo ratio is 50/1 when the 50/100/CL pin is connected to the positive supply, and 100/1 when it is connected to ground. When Sag is connected to the positive supply, the switch is set to the right to connect the second integrator output (LP, output) to the summing stage. With Sap connected to
the negative supply, the summing stage inverting input is grounded. Figure 17-30 shows one-half of an MF10 connected in Mode 1 to function as a notch, band-pass, or low-pass filter. The design equations are also
shown. Six possible modes of operation are listed on the manufacturer’s
750
Electronic Devices and Circuits BP, L] 2
LPs 1
Oj
Sap
6
15
&
ke
=O
=
7
Rg
+
v
fc
Mode 1
fe =
ts ™~ 1400 or “50
B®a
Q=
Footch = fo
Hop
__R = Ry
RB Hopp
Ry asfy —~ Hon = "R,
=
R,
Oand as f, —~
fox >
Figure 17-30 One-half of an MF10 connected in Mode 7 to function as a notch, bandpass, or low-pass filter. (Reprinted with permission of National Semiconductor Corporation. Not authorized for use as critical components in a life support system.)
data sheet, some subdivided into A and B. The Ho equations refer to the
voltage gains at the critical frequency (f,) from the input to each of the outputs. For example, Hopp refers to the gain from v; to the band-pass output terminal (BP,).
Example 17-13 Determine the required resistance values to operate one-half of an MF10asa
band-pass filter with f; = 10.3 kHz, fp = 10.9 kHz, and a voltage gain of 34. (Note that this is the same frequency limit as for Ex. 17-12.) Solution
Eq. 17-24:
fo = (fifa) V = V0.3 kHz x 10.9 kHz) = 10.6 kHz
Equations 17-22 and 17-23:
o-—__ fo- fi
10.6 kHz 10.9kHz — 10.3 kHz
=177 Select
R3* 120 kQ (use 121 kN. +1% standard value)
Chapter 17
Active Filters
754
From the MF10 design equations, —2=—R3
=
Q
121 kO
177
= 6.83 kO, (use 6.81 kQ +1% standard value) and
Rk,
R;
=
121k
= 3.6 kO (use 3.57 kOQ +1% standard value)
fx = 50 X fy = 50 X 10.6 kHz = 530 kHz Practice Problem 17-10.1
A notch filter using one-half of an MF10 is to have fi = 1.7 kHz, fo = 2.35 kHz, and a voltage gain of 10. Determine suitable component
values and select an appropriate clock frequency.
17-11
FILTER TESTING AND TROUBLESHOOTING
The common errors listed in Section 5-6 should be referred to once again. They apply to filter circuits constructed on a laboratory breadboard, just as they do to all circuits. The discussion in Section 14-11 concerning op-amp circuit testing is applicable to active filters, and the op-amp circuit stability treatment in Section 15-6 is very important. Once
it is determined
that the circuit is not oscillating and that the dc
voltage levels are acceptable, testing for A,/f and $/f responses can begin. The amplifier ac testing procedure in Section 12-11 can be followed. The first
signal frequency should be well within the filter-pass band; then fairly large frequency steps can be made while the response is flat. The frequency should be changed in small steps around the cutoff frequencies, to obtain sufficient readings for accurately plotting the graphs. Because of component tolerances, filter cutoff frequencies are unlikely to be precisely as calculated.
If a measured
cutoff frequency is far from the expected frequency, the
component values should be rechecked, especially the color-coded resistor values. A common mistake is the selection of a resistor in error by a factor of 10. When filter falloff rates are less than expected, one possibility is that the feedback portion of the circuit is not functioning correctly. For example, suppose
the
two-pole
filter in Fig. 17-9 behaves
like a single-pole
filter
(20 dB/decade falloff rate instead of 40 db/ decade). In this case it is most likely that the feedback capacitor (C2) is not correctly connected, or perhaps that the
capacitance value is much smaller than required.
752
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Higher-order
filters
consisting
of
several
sections
may
need
to be
separated into individual sections for testing if the overall circuit does not
perform as expected. The same remarks apply to band-pass and notch filters that contain low-pass and high-pass sections. Review
Questions
Section 17-1 17-1
Sketch ideal and practical gain/ frequency response graphs for low-pass, highpass, band-pass, and notch filters. Explain the function of each type of filter,
17-2 17-3
Sketch the circuit of a basic RC low-pass filter and explain its operation. Sketch typical gain/frequency and phase/frequency response graphs for a low-pass filter. Identify the cutoff frequency, and
17-4
explain
the shape of the
graphs. Define cutoff frequency, bandwidth, pass band, stop band, attenuation band, transition band, insertion loss, and transfer function.
Section 17-2 17-5
Sketch the circuit of a first-order active low-pass filter, and explain how the
circuit operates. Discuss the function of the operational amplifier. 17-6
Sketch the circuit of a first-order active high-pass filter, and explain how the
circuit operates. 17-7
Sketch typical gain/frequency and phase/frequency
response graphs for a
first-order active high-pass filter, and explain the shape of the graphs. Section 17-3 17-8
Define single-pole, two-pole,
17-9
formances of each. Identify the major types of filter circuit design, and discuss the differences in their gain/ frequency and phase/frequency response graphs.
17-10 Sketch
and
three-pole
the circuit of a second-order
low-pass
filters, and
active
describe
filter, and
the per-
explain
its
operation.
17-11 Sketch typical A,/f and ¢/f response graphs for a second-order low-pass active filter. Discuss the shape of the graphs. Section 17-4 17-12 Sketch the circuit of a second-order high-pass active filter, and explain its operation. | 17-13 Sketch typical A,/f and $/f response graphs for a second-order high-pass
active filter. Discuss the shape of the graphs. Section 17-5 17-14 Sketch
a circuit
for
a third-order
low-pass
active
filter,
and
explain
its
explain
its
operation. Discuss the required cutoff frequency for each stage. 17-15 Sketch a circuit for a third-order high-pass active filter, and operation. Discuss the required cutoff frequency for each stage.
Chapter 17 _ Active Filters
753
17-16 Sketch typical A./f and /f response graphs for third-order low-pass and high-pass active filters. Discuss the shape of the graphs.
Section 17-6 17-17 Show how a band-pass filter can be constructed by the use of a low-pass and a
high-pass filter. Sketch the expected A,/f response graph and explain the filter operation. 17-18 Sketch the circuit of a single-stage band-pass active filter. Explain the circuit operation.
17-19 Sketch typical A,/f response graphs for wide-band and narrow-band bandpass filters, and discuss the differences between them. Write equations for bandwidth, Q factor, and centre frequency.
17-20 Show how the circuit of a single-stage wide-band band-pass filter can be modified for narrow-band operation. Briefly explain.
Section 17-7 17-21 Sketch a block diagram to show how a notch filter can be constructed using a low-pass and a high-pass filter. Sketch the expected A,/f response graph and explain the filter operation. 17-22 Explain by the use of a block diagram how a band-pass filter and a summing circuit can be used as a notch filter. Sketch the expected A,/f response graph.
17-23 The band-pass circuit in Fig. 17-16 can be modified to convert it to a notch filter. Show the modification and explain how the notch response is obtained.
Section 17-8 17-24 Draw a circuit diagram for an all-pass phase-lag filter. Sketch the typical phase/ frequency response and explain the circuit operation. 17-25 Write the input/output equation for an all-pass phase-lag circuit. Explain how the phase lag may be made adjustable. 17-26 Draw a
circuit diagram for an all-pass phase-lead filter. Sketch the typical
phase /frequency response and explain the circuit operation.
Section 17-9 17-27 Draw the circuit of a state-variable filter. Briefly explain the circuit operation and write equations for Q and fo.
Section 17-10 17-28 Show how a
switched capacitor can be used to simulate a resistor, and discuss
the advantages of this process in integrated circuit applications. 17-29 Explain how the critical frequency of an integrator with a switched-capacitor
simulated resistor can be controlled by a clock. 17-30 Sketch the basic block diagram for one-half of an MF10 integrated circuit filter. Identify the components and briefly explain the function of each. Show how
external resistors may be connected to have the IC function as a band-pass filter.
754
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Section 17-11 17-31 Prepare a point-form list of items to be checked before testing a laboratoryconstructed filter circuit. 17-32 Prepare a point-form list of the procedure for testing a filter circuit to
determine its A,/fand ¢/f responses.
Problems Section 17-1 17-1 Calculate the cutoff frequency for a basic RC low-pass filter with R; = 18 kQ) and C; = 1000 pF. Determine the circuit bandwidth,
and
estimate
the signal
attenuation at f ~ 35.4 kHz. 17-2
A basic
low-pass
filter with
C; = 0.015
pF
is
to
attenuate
20
kHz
signal
frequencies by approximately 23 dB. Determine the required cutoff frequency, and calculate a suitable resistance value for Rj. 17-3
Calculate the new cutoff frequency and insertion loss for the filter in Problem
17-4
Abasic low-pass filter with C; = 0.01 uF has R; consisting of a 3.3 kQ resistor
17-2 when a 60 kQ load resistance is connected to the output. in series with a 1 kQ variable resistor. Calculate the maximum
and minimum
cutoff frequency. 17-5
Calculate the insertion loss for the filter in Problem 17-1 when a 100 kQ load resistance is connected to the output. Determine the effect of the load on the
circuit cutoff frequency. Section 17-2 17-6 A first-order active low-pass filter is to have a cutoff frequency of 3 kHz. First, design
17-7
the circuit with
a bipolar
op-amp,
then
redesign
op-amp. Modify each of the circuits designed for Problem
it with
17-6 to make
a BIFET
the cutoff
frequency adjustable from 2 kHz to 4 kHz. 17-8
17-9 A
Using a BIFET op-amp, design a first-order active high-pass filter to have a 15 kHz cutoff frequency. Determine the circuit bandwidth if the op-amp has a
1.2 MHz unity gain frequency. first-order active high-pass filter has Rj = 56 kQ and C; = 600 pF. If the circuit uses a 741 op-amp, determine the cutoff frequency and the highest signal frequency that can be passed.
Section 17-3 17-10 Using a 741 op-amp, design a second-order active low-pass
filter to have a
5 kHz cutoff frequency with a Butterworth response. 17-11 Redesign the filter in Problem 17-10 to use a 108 op-amp.
17-12 A second-order active low-pass Butterworth filter has the following component values: Ri = Rz = 56k, Rs = 120 kQ,, C; = 600 pE, and C2 = 1200 pk Calculate the circuit cutoff frequency.
Chapter 17 _
Active Filters
755
17-13 A second-order active low-pass filter is to attenuate 7 kHz signals by 15 dB. Design the circuit to use a BIFET op-amp and to have a Butterworth response.
Section 17-4 17-14 Design
cutoff
a second-order
frequency.
Use
active high-pass
a 353
op-amp
Butterworth
and
a 7 kHz
filter to have
determine
the
highest
has
the
signal
frequency that can be passed. 17-15 A
second-order
active
high-pass
Butterworth
filter
following
component values: R; = 28 kOQ, Ro = 56 kN, and C; = C2 = 1000 pF. Calculate the circuit cutoff frequency. 17-16 A second-order active high-pass filter is to attenuate signal frequencies below 1.2 kHz by a minimum of 15 dB. Design the circuit to use a 741 op-amp and to have a Butterworth response. Calculate the circuit bandwidth.
17-17 Redesign the filter in Problem 17-16 to use a BIFET op-amp.
Section 17-5 17-18 A third-order active low-pass filter is to attenuate all signals above 9 kHz by a minimum
of 21 dB. Design the circuit to use BIFET op-amps and to have a
Butterworth response. 17-19 Using 741 op-amps, design a third-order Butterworth active low-pass filter to have an 18 kHz cutoff frequency. 17-20 A third-order Butterworth active high-pass filter is to pass all signal frequencies above 8 kHz. Design the circuit to use 108 op-amps.
17-21 Determine the bandwidth of the circuit designed for Problem 17-20. Estimate the attenuation of a 2 kHz signal.
Section 17-6 17-22 A bandpass filter using low-pass and high-pass circuits (as in Fig. 17-15) is to have a bandwidth extending from 400 Hz to 30 kHz. Using 741 op-amps,
design suitable second-order stages. 17-23 Design a single-stage band-pass filter to have cutoff frequencies of 1 kHz and
50 kHz and a voltage gain of 1. 17-24 A single-stage band-pass filter (as in Fig. 17-16) has the following component values: R; = R2 = R3 = 3.9 kO, Cy = 0.12 pF, and C2 = 600 pE. Calculate the
circuit cutoff frequencies. 17-25 A single-stage narrow-band band-pass filter (as in Fig. 17-20) is to be designed
to use an op-amp with 1A input bias current. The centre frequency is to be 3.3 kHz with a bandwidth of approximately 500 kHz. Determine suitable component values. 17-26 Redesign the filter in Problem 17-25 to use a BIFET op-amp. Section 17-7 17-27 The notch filter in Fig. 17-21 is to have a stop band from 10 kHz to 100 kHz. The signal amplitude is 1 V. Design the complete circuit to use first-order high-pass
and low-pass filters. 17-28 The notch filter in Fig. 17-22 is to be used to attenuate an unwanted 120 Hz input. Design the circuit to have a bandwidth of 20 Hz.
756
Electronic Devices and Circuits
17-29 Design a single-stage notch filter (as in Fig. 17-23) to have f; = 1.3 kHz and fz = 54 kHz.
Section 17-8 17-30 An all-pass filter circuit is to have a phase lag adjustable from 70° to 100°. The 3.3 kHz input voltage has a3 V amplitude. Design the circuit using a BIFET op-
amp. 17-31 An all-pass phase-lead circuit with a 2.V, 1.5 kHz input is to have a phase lead adjustable from 90° to 130°. Design the circuit to use a bipolar op-amp.
Section 17-9 17-32 A state-variable band-pass filter (as in Fig. 17-27) has the following component
values: Ry = 12 kQ, Ry = 560 kQ, R3 = Rq = 27 kO, Rs = Ro = 33 kQ, and C, = C2 = 1200 pF. Calculate the width of the pass-band. 17-33 A band-pass filter is to pass 2 kHz to 2.5 kHz signal frequencies. Design a suitable state-variable circuit. 17-34 A state-variable band-pass filter is to have f. = 3.3 kHz and BW ~ 200 Hz. Design the circuit using a BIFET op-amp.
Section 17-10 17-35
A band-pass filter with a voltage gain of 20, f, = 3 kHz, and/; = 4 kHz is to be
constructed using an MF10. Determine suitable resistance values and clock frequency. 17-36 Determine suitable resistance values and clock frequency for an MF10 notch
filter which is to have a voltage gain of 15, f, = 2 kHz and fy = 2.9 kHz.
Practice Problem Answers 17-1.1 17-1.2
19.65 kHz, 23 dB 1.1 dB, 22.29 kHz
17-2.1
1000 pF, 10.5 kQ
17-2.2
752 kHz
17-3.1 17-3.2
1000 pF, 2000 pF, 75 kQ, 75 kQ, 150 kQ, 1.5 kHz 1000 pF, 2000 pF, 18.7 kO, 18.7 kO, 39 kQ, 6.02 kHz
17-4.1
3000 pF, 3000 pF, 60.4 kQ, 121 kQ, 120 kQ, 621 Hz
17-5.1 17-5.2
1000 pF, 10.2 kQ, 10 kO; 1000 pF, 2000 pF, 9.09 kQ, 9.09 kQ, 18 kO 1000 pF, 37.4kQ, 39 kQ; 1000 pF, 1000 pF, 21 k®, 42.2 kQ2, 39 kA
17-6.1
25.7 kHz, 8.56 kHz, 0.33
17-6.2
60.4k0, 121 kO, 120 kO, 1.21 kO, 0.012 wF, 0.012 wF
17-4.2
1000 pE, 1000 pF, (3.01 kO. + 1.5 kQ), 9.09 kQ, 10 kO
17-7.1
9100 pF, 1000 pF, (4 x 26.1 kQ)
17-8.1 17-9.1 17-10.1
243 kO, 243 kO, (120 kO fixed +50 kO variable), 1000 pF 8.84 kHz, 1.1 kHz 3,92 kO, 40.2 kO, 121 kQ, 100 kHz
CHAPTER
18
Linear and Switching Voltage Regulators Objectives You will be able to:
i Sketch transistor series
regulator circuits and explain their operation. Show how regulator circuits may
be improved by the use of error amplifiers, additional series-pass transistors, preregulation, etc., and how the output voltage may be adjusted. Design transistor series regulator circuits to fulfill a given specification. Analyze transistor series
Sketch and explain the basic circuit of a 723 IC voltage regulator, and design circuits
using 723 ICs.
Sketch IC regulator block diagrams and determine external component values for various applications.
Sketch the block diagram and waveforms for a switching regulator and explain its operation. 10 Sketch circuits and waveforms
effect, load effect, line
for step-down, step-up, and inverting converters, and
regulation, load regulation, and
explain their operation.
regulators to determine source
ripple reduction.
Sketch operational amplifier series regulator circuits and explain their operation. Design op-amp series regulator
11 Design LC filter circuits for various switching converters. 2 Show how an IC controller circuit is used with switching
converters, and calculate values
circuits to fulfill a given
for the externally connected
specification.
components.
INTRODUCTION Almost all electronic circuits require a direct voltage supply. This is usually
derived from the standard industrial or domestic ac supply by transformation, rectification, and filtering. The resultant raw dc is not stable
758
Electronic Devices and Circuits
enough for most purposes, and it usually contains an unacceptably large ac ripple waveform. Voltage regulator circuits are employed to render the
voltage more constant and to attenuate the ripple. Unregulated power supplies and Zener diode regulators are discussed in
Chapter 3. Zener diode regulators are normally used only where the load current does not exceed 25 mA. A transistor operating as an emitter follower circuit may be connected to a Zener diode regulator to supply larger load currents. The regulator circuit performance is tremendously improved when an error amplifier is included, to detect and amplify the difference between the output and the voltage reference source, and to provide feedback to correct the difference. A variety of voltage regulator circuits are available in integrated circuit form.
18-1
TRANSISTOR SERIES REGULATOR
Basic Circuit When a low-power Zener diode is used in the simple regulator circuit described in Section 3-7, the load current is limited by the maximum diode current. A high-power Zener used in such a circuit can supply higher levels of load current, but much power is wasted when the load is light. The emitter
follower regulator shown in Fig. 18-1 is an improvement on the simple regulator circuit because it draws a large current from the supply only when required by the load. In Fig. 18-1a, the circuit is drawn in the form of the common collector amplifier (emitter follower) discussed in Section 6-6. In
Fig. 18-1b, the circuit is shown in the form usually referred to as a series regulator. Transistor Q is termed a series-pass transistor. The output voltage V, from the series regulator in Fig. 18-1 is Vz — Veg,
and the maximum load current IL(max) can be the maximum emitter current
>V,
“O
(a) Emitter follower voltage regulator
Figure 18-1
~)
(b) Series voltage regulator circuit
To supply a large output current from a Zener diode voltage regulator, a transistor
(Q,) is connected as an emitter follower. This converts the circuit into a series voltage regulator.
Chapter 18
Linear and Switching Voltage Regulators
759
that Q; is capable of passing. For a 2N3055 transistor (specification in data sheet A-8 in Appendix A), I, could approach 15 A. When I, is zero, the current drawn from the supply is approximately Iz + Ic(min), where Ic(min) is the minimum collector current to keep Q; operational. The Zener diode
circuit (R; and D;) has to supply only the base current of the transistor. The series voltage regulator is, therefore, much more efficient than a simple Zener
diode regulator.
Regulator with Error Amplifier A series regulator using an additional transistor as an error amplifier is shown in Fig. 18-2. The error amplifier improves the line and load regulation of the circuit (see Section 3-6). The amplifier also makes it possible to have an output voltage greater than the Zener diode voltage. Resistor Rzand diode D, are the Zener diode reference source. Transistor Q» and its associated components
constitute the error amplifier, which controls the series-pass transistor Q). The output voltage is divided by resistors R3and Ry and is compared to the Zener voltage level (Vz). C; is a large-value capacitor, usually 50 wF to 100 wF, which is connected at the output to suppress any tendency of the regulator to
oscillate. Tey
(+0
Q:
—
°
Oo +)
rvs,
~)
L=-©
Figure 18-2
Series voltage regulator circuit with an error
amplifier. The error amplifier improves the regulator line and load regulation and gives an output voltage greater
than the Zener diode voltage.
When the circuit output voltage changes, the change is amplified by transistor Q) and fed back to the base of Q; to correct the output voltage level. Suppose that the circuit is designed for a V, of 12 V and that the supply
voltage is Vs = 18 V. In this case a suitable Zener diode voltage might be Vz=6 V. For this Vz level, the base voltage of Q, must be Va2 = Vz + Vopr = 6.7 V. So resistors R3 and Ryare selected to give Vp) = 6.7 V and
V, = 12 V. The voltage at the base of Q; is Vgi = Vo + Vpp) = 12.7 V.
Also, Va; = Vs — Vp = 5.3 V. The current through R; is largely the collector current of Qo.
760
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Now suppose the output voltage drops slightly for some reason. When Vo
decreases, Vp decreases. Because the emitter voltage of Q> is held at Vz, any decrease in Vp appears across the base-emitter of Qo. A reduction in Ver
causes Ic) to be reduced. When Ic: falls, Vri is reduced, and the voltage at the
base of Q; rises (Vpi = Vs — Vri) causing the output voltage to increase. Thus, a decrease in V, produces a feedback effect which causes V, to increase
back toward its normal level. Similarly, a rise in V. above its normal level produces a feedback effect that pushes V, down again toward its normal
level.
When the input voltage changes, the voltage across resistor R, changes in order to keep the output constant. This change in Vp; is produced by a change in Ic2, which itself is produced by a small change in V4. Therefore, a
supply voltage change (AVs) produces a small output voltage chan ge (AV,).
The relationship between AVs and AV, depends upon the amplification of
the error amplifier. Similarly, when the load current (J;,) changes, Ip; alters as necessary to increase or decrease Ip. The Ip; variation is produced by a
change in Ico, which, once again, is the result of an output volta ge variation AV,.
Series Regulator Performance The performance of a series regulator without an error amplifier (Fig. 18-1) is
similar to that of a Zener diode regulator (see Section 3-7), except in the case
of the load effect. The series-pass transistor tends to improve the regulator
load effect by a factor equal to the transistor /ipp.
The error amplifier in the regulator in Fig 18-3 (reproduced from Fig. 18-2) improves all aspects of the circuit performance by anamount directly related to
the amplifier voltage gain (A,). When Vs changes by AVg, the output change is Me
i=
AV,
(18-1)
~
Figure 18-3
Voltage
variations at the input of
a regulator with an error amplifier are reduced by
a factor equal to the ©
amplifier voltage gain.
Chapter 18
Linear and Switching Voltage Regulators
761
If AVs is produced by a variation in the ac supply voltage, the power supply source effect is reduced by a factor of Ay. AVs might also be the result of an increase or decrease in load current that causes a change in the average
level of the dc supply voltage. Thus, the load effect of the power supply is reduced by a factor of Ay.
Now
consider the effect of supply voltage ripple on the circuit in
Fig. 18-3. The ripple waveform appears at the collector of transistor Qi. If there were no negative feedback, it would also be present at Q: base and at the regulator output. However, like supply voltage changes, the input ripple is reduced by a factor of A, when it appears at the output. The ripple rejection ratio is calculated as the decibel ratio of the input and output ripple voltages.
Example 18-1
The supply voltage for the regulator in Fig. 18-3 has Vs = 21 V on no load, and Vs = 20 V when It(maxy = 40 mA. The output voltage is Vo = 12 V, and the regulator has an error amplifier with a gain of 100. Calculate the source effect, load effect, line regulation, and load regulation for the complete power supply. Also determine the ripple rejection ratio in decibels. Solution
Eq. 3-25: :
—
wi:
Source effect = AV, (for AVs = 10%) AV,
°
=
AVs
Ay
—
10% of 21 V
100
= 21mV
Eq. 3-27:
Eq. 18-1: :
Load effect = AVo for Altimax)
20V 21V-—20V = AVs _ stv
AV. °
100
Ay
=10mV
Eq. 3-26:
S = ) xx 100%of, e ffect) Line regulation = (Source oO
_ 2 mV 12Vx 100% = 0.175%
Eq. 3-28:
eff Load Load regulation = Cond ae) * 100% oO
_ 10mV
x 100% 12V
%,
762
Electronic Devices and Circuits
= 0.08% Ripple rejection = 20 log (1/Ay) = 20 log (1/100) = —40 dB
Regulator Design To design a series regulator circuit (as in Fig. 18-3), the Zener diode is selected to have Vz less than the output voltage. A Zener diode Voltage approximately equal to 0.75 V, is usually suitable. Appropriate current levels
are chosen for each resistor, and the resistor values are calculated using Ohm’s law. Transistor Q, is selected to pass the required load current and to survive
the necessary power dissipation. A heat sink (see Section 8-8) is normally
required for the series-pass transistor in a regulator that supplies large load currents. As has been explained, a large capacitor is usually connected across the output to ensure amplifier ac stability (C; in Fig. 18-3).
The difference between the regulator input and output voltages is the collector-emitter voltage of the series-pass transistor (Q;), and this voltage must be large enough to keep the transistor operational. The minimum level
of Vcr (known as the dropout voltage) occurs at the lowest point in the ripple waveform of raw dc input (rectified and filtered). If Veg) is too small for correct operation at this point, a large-amplitude ripple waveform appears at
the regulator output. Example 18-2 Design the voltage regulator circuit in Fig. 18-4 to produce V, = 12 V and Timax) = 40 mA. The supply voltage is Vs = 20 V.
Figure 18-4 Voltage regulator circuit for
Ex. 18-2.
Solution Select
Vz~0.75 V, =0.75 X 12 V
=9V
For D,, use a 1N757 Zener diode with Vz = 9.1 V (see data sheet A-4 in Appendix A)
Linear and Switching Voltage Regulators
Chapter 18
763
For minimum D, current, select Tro
=
Ry =
10
mA
Vo-Vz
=
12V-91V
TR
10 mA
= 290 0 (use 270 0 standard value)
Te1max) © IL(max) + Ir2 = 40 mA + 10 mA =50mA
Specification for Qi: VcE1(max) oe Vs
=20V =50mA
leagmax) ~ Ftd
Ppanax)
Vo) X TEa(max)
—
= (Vs
=
-
(20V
12 V)
= 400 mW Assuming
hegimin) = 50 I
_
ana
TE1 (max)
HEE 1 (min)
_
50 mA
50
=l1mA leo > TBi(max)
Select
Io = 5 mA
Ve—Veaq
Ry
~ Teo + Ip
20V
—-G2V
+0.7¥)
5mA +1mA
= 1.21 kO (use 1.2 kO standard value)
Iz = Ik. + IR2=5mA+10mA =15mA
I, >> Ipi(max) Select
Ig=1mA
R=
Vz + Ver _ 9.1V + 0.7V
‘
I4
1lmA
= 9.8 kQ (use 10 kO standard value) 7
a
Vo — Vra
&
_ 2V-98V
1mA
= 2.2 kO (standard value)
X
50mA
764
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Practice Problems 18-1.1
A 12 V de power supply has an 18 V filter circuit. There is a 1 V drop in Vs regulator has an error amplifier with effect; load effect, line regulation, and
input (Vs) from a rectifier and from no load to full load. If the A, = 70, calculate the source load regulation.
18-1.2 A voltage regulator circuit as in Fig. 18-4 has Vs = 25 V, and is to produce
V, = 15 V with Kmax)
= 60 mA.
Design
the circuit and
specify the series transistor. Assume /tpei(min) = 100.
18-2 IMPROVING REGULATOR PERFORMANCE Error Amplifier Gain The performance of a regulator is dependent on the voltage gain of the error amplifier (see Eq. 18-1). A higher-gain amplifier gives better line and load regulation. So anything that improves the amplifier voltage gain will improve the regulator performance. Two possibilities for increasing A, are: use a transistor with a high hpg value for Qo, and use the highest possible
resistance value for Rj.
Output Voltage Adjustment Regulator circuits such as the one designed in Ex. 18-2 are unlikely to have Vo exactly as specified. This is because of component tolerances,
as well
as, perhaps,
not
finding
standard values close to the calculated values. Hence, some form of adjustment is required to
enable the output voltage to be set to the desired level. In Fig. 18-5, the potentiometer (Rs) connected between
provides output adjustment. The maximum output
voltage
level
oO —)
resistors R3 and Ry,
is produced
when
the
potentiometer moving contact is at the bottom
Figure 18-5
Use ofa
Pelenuemeter to provide regulator output voltage
adjustment.
of Rs:
Kae
Rai + Ry + Rs
Ry
xX Veo
(18-2)
Minimum V, occurs when the moving contact is at the top of Rs:
Vopnin) =
R3 + Rg + Rs
Ra eR,
VB
(18-3)
Chapter 18
Example
Linear and Switching Voltage Regulators
765
18-3
Modify the voltage regulator circuit in Ex. 18-2 (as in Fig. 18-6) to make V,
adjustable from 11 V to 13 V.
rVe
V54
Figure 18-6 Adjustable output regulator circuit for Ex. 18-2.
Solution Select
I4qnin) = 1 mA
For Vo = 11 V (moving contact at top of Rs),
_Vo- Vm _ UV -98V
Re
= :
T4(min)
lmA
= 1.2 kO (standard value) Rg
+
Rs
V
=
9.8V
Bs
T4(min)
7
imA
= 9.8kO
For V, = 13 V (moving contact at bottom of Rs), ok fs = Vo _ 13 V 4 becomes 4 Rg + Ra+ Rs 1.2k0+98k0
=1.18mA Veo 98V emA Ig =1.18
hy =
= 8.3 kO (use 8.2 kQO standard value)
Rs = (Ra+ Rs) — Ra= 9.8 kO — 8.2 kO, = 2.6 kO (use 2.5 kO standard value potentiometer)
766
Electronic Devices and Circuits
High-Output-Current Circuit For the circuit in Fig. 18-6 to function correctly, the collector current of Q2 must be larger than the maximum base current flowing into Q). In regulators that supply a large output current, Ip; can be too large for Ic2 to control. In this case, an additional transistor (Q3) should be connected at the base of Q; to forma Darlington circuit (or Darlington pair), as in Fig. 18-7. Transistor Q; is
usually a high-power BJT requiring a heat sink (see Section 8-8), and Q; is a low-power device. The Q; base current is
Tp
= +Ty
3
(18-4)
Neer X pes
The current gain for the Darlington is Mpg, X hpg3, and Ip3 is low enough that Ic2 may easily be made much greater than Ip3. In Fig. 18-7 note resistor Rg, which is included to provide a suitable minimum Q; operating current when
I, is very low. Darlington
ges
Ry S
pair
oy Q
on YS
Tey
I,
Ia|
| Ip3
Q,
7
Figure 18-7
.
An additional
transistor (Q3) connected at the base of Q; to constitute a
D;
Re
:
Ry
Darlington circuit allows a voltage regulator to supply a
=
O-——
,
me
higher output current.
Darlington transistors consisting of a pair of BJTs (low-power and high-
power) fabricated together and packaged as a single device are available. These are usually referred to as power Darlingtons. The 2N6039 is an npn
power Darlington with an hg specified as 750 minimum, 18 000 maximum. Resistor Rg in Fig. 18-7 is not required when a power Darlington is used.
Example 18-4 Modify the voltage regulator circuit in Ex. 18-2 to change the load current to 200 mA. Use a Darlington circuit (as in Fig. 18-7), and assume that /ipg1 = 20 and that hgg3 = 50. Specify transistor Q).
Chapter 18
Linear and Switching Voltage Regulators
767
Solution
Te1(max) © Tmax) + Io = 200 mA + 10mA = 210 mA
—
Te1(max) _ 210 mA hep
20
= 10.5mA
Frovesauy = Te1(max) _ 10.5 mA Nps
50
= 0.21 mA
Ic2 > Tp3qmax) Select
Ico = 1 mA
_ Ve-Vg3 _ 20V-(12V+07V+0.7V) Tetlps mA +021mA = 5.45 k© (use 5.6 kQ standard value) Select
Ig = 0.5 mA
_Vo+ Vpn
12V+07V
og
(5 mA
= 25.4 kQ (use 22 kO standard value) Specification for Q::
Veei(max) ¥ Vs = 20 V Te1qmax) © Te1¢max) = 210 mA
Ppimax) = (Vs — Vo) X Teiqmax) = (20 V — 12 V) X 210 mA = 1.68 W
Preregulation Refer to Fig. 18-8, which is a partial reproduction of Fig. 18-2. Note that resistor Rj is supplied from the regulator input, and consider what happens
when the supply voltage drops by 1 V. If Ic does not change, the voltage across R; remains constant, and the 1 V drop also occurs at the base of Q,; and
at the output of the regulator. This does not happen, of course. Instead, Ic2
changes to reduce the voltage across R; and thus keep the output voltage close to its normal level. The change in Ic: is produced by a small change in the output voltage. If Ry is connected to a constant-voltage source instead of
the input, the change in Ic. would not be required when Vs changes, and consequently the output voltage change would not occur.
768
Electronic Devices and Circuits
o~
Figure 18-8 A change in a regulator supply voltage (AVs) produces an output change (AV, = AVs/A\).
6
Now look at Fig. 18-9a where R; is shown connected
to another Zener
diode voltage source (R7 and D2). This arrangement is called a pre-regulator, When
Vs changes, the change in Vz2 is negligible compared
to AVs. Thus,
virtually no change is required in Icz and V,. A preregulator substantially
connected
across transistor Q;. This gives an R; supply
voltage of V;
lly
improves the line and the load regulation of a regulator circuit. The minimum voltage drop across R; should typically be 3 V. (Small values of R; give low amplifier voltage gain.) A minimum of perhaps 6 V is also required across R7 to keep a reasonably constant current level through D>. Figure 18-9b shows another preregulator circuit that has R7 and D,
(Vo + Vz2).
Preregulator
Qa
ES
o—
aeMES Ls
(a) Preregulator at the input Figure 18-9
(b) Preregulator connected between input and output
A preregulator circuit improves the performance of a voltage regulator.
Chapter 18
Linear and Switching Voltage Regulators
769
Example 18-5 Determine suitable component values for a preregulator circuit as in Fig. 18-9a for the voltage regulator modified in Ex. 18-4. Solution Select
Vrimin) = 3 V
R,
= _Vri :
~~ 3V
Ico + Ign
= 1 mA
+ 0.21 mA
= 2.5 kO (use 2.7 kO, standard value) Vz2=
Vo + Vee + Ver3 + Vai
=12V+07V+07V4+3V
= 16.4 V (use a IN966A with Vz = 16 V. Alternatively, use a 1N753 and a 1N758 connected in series.
See data sheet A-4 in Appendix A). Ir7 >> I, and Iz2 > (Izx for Zener diode D2) Select
Ir7=5mA
Vs—-Vz Ro
=
;
20V-—16V =
I R77
5mA
= 800 2 (use 820 0 standard value)
Constant-Current Source The constant-current source shown in Fig. 18-10 may be used in place of resistor R; as an alternative to a preregulator circuit. This arrangement passes all the required current to Q3 base and Q) collector, but it behaves as a very
°
Constant-current source
we
Qi
ne
|
Q,
Ry ¢
od
Figure 18-10 A constant-current source can be used as an alternative to a
preregulator circuit to improve regulator performance.
770
Electronic Devices and Circuits
high resistance (1/hoe4) at the collector of transistor Qo. Consequently, it increases
the
error
amplifier
voltage
gain
and
results
in
a
substantial
improvement in the regulator performance. To design the constant-current source,
Vcg4 should
typically be a minimum
of 3 V. The
various voltage
drops and current levels are then easily determined for component selection,
Differential Amplifier Figure 18-11 shows a regulator that uses a differential amplifier or difference amplifier (see Section 12-8). In this circuit, Zener diode Dy is the voltage reference source, and D, is used only to provide an appropriate voltage level Q
—O
+
\ pL I
(+ o-
L—o Figure 18-11
Use of a differential amplifier (Qs and Q¢) improves the regulator
performance by improving the gain of the error amplifier and by using D2 as a stable voltage reference source.
at the emitter of transistor Q2. Vo is divided to provide Vx¢, which is compared to Vz. Any difference in these two voltages is amplified by Qs, Q., Q., and the associated components, and is then applied to the base of Q; to
change the output in the required direction. The performance of the regulator is improved
by the increased voltage
gain of the error amplifier. However, the performance is also improved in
another way. In the regulator circuit in Figs 18-2 and 18-7, when Ic; changes,
the current through D, is also changed (Iz; = Ir2 + Iz). This causes the Zener
voltage to change by a small amount, and this change in Vz; produces a change in output voltage. In the circuit in Fig. 18-11, the current through the reference diode (D2) remains substantially constant because it is supplied from the regulator output. Therefore, there is no change in output voltage
due to a change in the reference voltage. Example 18-6 Design the differential amplifier stage for the regulator in Fig. 18-11. Use the
Q:, Qo, Q3 stage already designed in Examples 18-2 and 18-4. The output voltage is to be adjustable from 10 V to 12 V. (See Fig. 18-12.)
Chapter 18
—_Linear and Switching Voltage Regulators
771
| Tro
Ro
3.3kQ
Ry
ue
Differential amplifier Figure 18-12 circuit for Ex. 18-6.
5.6kQ
+—_—©o
Solution Vos
Select
=
Voces
Veo
=
9.8
V
—
Vers =9.8V-3V
=3V
Vro
=
Vos
= 6.8 V Vzo =
Vro + Vegs = 6.8V+0.7V
= 7.5 V (use a 1N755 Zener diode)
Ic5 >> Ip Select
Ickg =1mA
R=
Vi Veo _ DY, - 98V los
ImA
= 2.2 kQO (standard value) Ipgp ¥2
X Ic¢g = 2mA
Vero Rg
=
OO
68V Ss
Trg
2mA
= 3.4 kO, (use 3.3 kO standard value) Iz >> Ips and Iz2 > (Izx for the Zener diode)
Select
Iz2 = 10mA R=
V.— Vz
7
Iz
_ IV
=75V
10 mA
= 450 2 (use 470 2 standard value) I, >
Ip
772 = Electronic Devices and Circuits
Select
-
I4j= 1 mA V6
=
Vz
=7.5V
When V, = 11 V (moving contact at the top of Ks), Vo~ Vege TV - 7BV Rg
SOS
[4
1mA
= 3.5 kO (use 3.3 kQ standard value)
I, becomes
I4
_Vo~ Ves _ UV3.3 ~75V 7 Rg mA = 1.06 mA
Veg
7.5 V
Ra + Rs = & ~ 1.06 mA = 7.07 kO, When V, = 13 V (moving contact at the bottom of Ks),
I, becomes
I,
Vo ~ Ry + Ry + Rs
-
13V 3.3k0 + 7.07kO
=1.25mA R4
=
Ves ‘Ty
7.5V 1.25mA
= 6.25 kO (use 5.6 kQ standard value) Rs = (Rq + Rs) — Rg = 7.07 kO — 5.6 kO. = 1.47 kO (use 1.5 kO standard value potentiometer)
Practice Problems 18-2.1
A voltage regulator circuit as in Fig. 18-6 uses a 6.2 V Zener diode. Determine suitable resistor values for R3, R4, and Rs to produce an
output adjustable from 9 V to 12 V. 18-2.2 A voltage regulator has an 18 V supply, a 10 V output, and a 150 mA
load current. The circuit uses Darlington connected transistors, as in Fig. 18-7. Calculate suitable resistor values, and specify transistor Q). Assume that fe; = 20 and Mp3 = 50.
18-2.3 Determine’ suitable components for the constant-current circuit in Fig. 18-10. Assume that the supply voltage is 20 V, the output is 12 V, and that Ip3 is 100 wA.
18-3
CURRENT LIMITING
Short-Circuit Protection Power supplies used in laboratories are subject to overloads and short circuits. Short-circuit protection by means of current-limiting circuits is
Chapter 18
Linear and Switching Voltage Regulators
773
necessary in such equipment to prevent the destruction of components when an overload occurs. Transistor Q7 and resistor Rig in Fig. 18-13a constitute a current-limiting circuit. When the load current ([,) flowing through resistor Rio is below the maximum design level, the voltage drop Vaio is not large enough to forward-bias the base-emitter junction of Qy. In this case, Q7 has
no effect on the regulator performance. When the load current reaches the selected maximum (I,(max)), Vaio biases Q, on. Current Ic7 then produces a voltage drop across resistor R, that drives
the output voltage down to nearly zero. The voltage/current characteristic of the regulator is shown in Fig. 18-13b. It is seen that output voltage remains constant as the load current increases up to IL(max). Beyond It(max), Vo drops to zero, and a short-circuit current (Isc) slightly greater than It(max) flows at the output. Under these circumstances, series-pass transistor Q; is carrying all of the short-circuit current and has
R 10
—>
Thpax)
Isc
(b) V,/I, characteristic of current-limiting circuit Figure 18-13
Regulator overload protection circuit. When I, increases to a maximum
pulls Q; base down, causing V, to be design level, Vaio causes Q; to conduct, and this
reduced to almost zero.
774
Electronic Devices and Circuits
virtually all of the supply voltage developed across its terminals. So the power dissipation in Q; is
Obviously, a Q; must be selected to survive this power dissipation.
Design
of the current-limiting
circuit
in Fig.
18-13
is very
|
simple.
Assuming that Q; is a silicon transistor, it should begin to conduct when Vrio ¥ 0.5 V. Therefore, Rio is calculated as
Rio ©
0.5 V
(18-6)
TL max)
Fold-Back Current Limiting A problem with the simple short-circuit protection method just discussed is that there is a large amount of power dissipation in the series-pass transistor while the regulator remains short-circuited. The fold-back current-limiting circuit in Fig. 18-14a minimizes this transistor power dissipation. The graph
(a) Fold-back current-limiting circuit
Normal V, —
| 4
oO
hse Isc
I L(max)
(b) Characteristic of fold-back current-limiting circuit
Figure 18-14
Fold-back current limiting. The short-circuit current (Isc) is less than Imax:
and thus the power dissipation in Q; is minimized.
Chapter 18
Linear and Switching Voltage Regulators
775
of Vo/IL in Fig. 18-14b shows that the regulator output voltage remains constant until IL(max) is approached. Then the current reduces (or folds back) to a lower short-circuit current level (Isc). The lower level of Isc produces a
lower power dissipation in Q,. To understand how the circuit in Fig. 18-14 operates, first note that when the output is shorted, V, equals zero. Consequently, the voltage drop across resistor Ry is almost zero. The voltage across Rio is Isc X Rio, and (as in the simple short-circuit protection circuit) this is designed to just keep transistor
Q, biased on. When the regulator is operating normally with J, less than Iumax), the voltage drop across Ry; is
Vriu ©
Vo
X
Run
Ry + Rig
To turn Q; on, the voltage drop across R1y must become larger than Vai; by
enough to forward-bias the base-emitter junction of Q7. Using Vpg7 ~ 0.5 V and making Vai ~ 0.5 V gives Fi anax) Rio
=05V+
0.5 V=1
V
With IscRip = 0.5 V, TLimax) © 2 Isc (See Fig. 18-14 b)
If Vex is selected as 1 V,
Tmax Rip = 05V+1V=15V and
Tuqmax) © 31Isc The fold-back current-limiting circuit is designed by first calculating Ry
to give the desired level of Isc. Then, the voltage-divider resistors (Ri, and
Ri) are calculated to provide the necessary voltage drop across Ry for the required relationship between Isc and It (max):
Example 18-7 Design a fold-back current-limiting circuit for a voltage regulator with a 12 V output. The maximum output current is to be 200 mA, and the short-circuit
current is to be 100 mA. (See Fig. 18-15.) Solution Isc
Select
=
100mA
Vrio © 0.5 V at short circuit Verio
0.5 V
Rio = F50 SC ~ 100mA = 5 Q (use 4.7 © standard value)
776
Electronic Devices and Circuits
4.70
Rio
Wz
” Ven
>
I,
=)
4 R10
$
Ry
4700 Hin
r Vo
Ry
Figure 18-15 _|
At Ih(maxy
Fold-back curreni-limiting
circuit for Ex. 18-7.
Vrio = Iugmax) X Rio = 200mA
X 4.7 O
= 0.94 V
Vani = (It(maxyRio) — 0.5 V = 0.44 V Ty, >> [pz Select
Iy =1mA
Ry =
Ven
044V
Ty
1mA
= 440 2 (use 470 © standard value)
p,, = vot Ve - Ven _ 12V + 0.94V — 044V bi 1mA = 12.5 kO (use 12 kO standard value)
Practice Problems 18-3.1 A short-circuit protection circuit, as in Fig. 18-13, is to be designed to limit the output of a 15.V regulator to 400 mA. Select a suitable value for Rip and specify Qi. Assume that Vs = 25 V.
18-3.2 Modify the circuit designed for Problem 18-3.1 to convert it to a foldback current-limiting circuit with a 150 mA short-circuit current.
18-4 OP-AMP VOLTAGE REGULATORS Voltage-Follower Regulator Refer once again to the voltage regulator circuit in Fig. 18-11. The complete error amplifier has two input terminals at the bases of Qs and Qg and one output at the collector of Q). Transistor Qs base is an inverting input, and Q: base is a non-inverting input. The error amplifier circuit is essentially an
Chapter 18
Linear and Switching Voltage Regulators
777
operational amplifier. Thus, IC operational amplifiers with their extremely
high open-loop voltage gain are ideal for use as error amplifiers in dc voltage regulator circuits. Normally, an internally compensated op-amp (such as the 741) is quite suitable for most voltage regulator applications. A simple voltage-follower regulator circuit is illustrated in Fig. 18-16. In
this circuit, the op-amp output voltage always follows the voltage at the noninverting terminal; consequently, V, remains constant at Vz. The only design calculations are those required for the design of the Zener diode voltage reference circuit (RK; and D,) and for the specification of Qi. +0
Vs
—0O
Figure 18-16 Operational amplifier connected as a voltagefollower regulator. The output voltage is held constant at V2.
Adjustable Output Regulator The circuit in Fig. 18-17 is that of a variable-output, highly stable dc voltage regulator. As in the transistor circuit in Fig. 18-11, the reference diode in
Fig. 18-17 is connected at the amplifier non-inverting input, and the output voltage is divided and applied to the inverting input. The operational amplifier positive supply terminal has to be connected to the regulator supply voltage. If it were connected to the regulator output, the op-amp output voltage
(at Qo base) would have to be approximately
than its positive supply terminal, and this is impossible.
YS
—-oO
— | -2—O
Highly stable, adjustable-output voltage Figure 18-17 regulator using an operational amplifier.
1.4 V higher
778
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Design of the regulator circuit in Fig. 18-17 involves selecting R; and Dj, design of the voltage-divider network (Ks, R4, and Rs), and specification of
transistors Q; and Q>. Clearly, an op-amp voltage regulator is more easily designed than a purely transistor regulator circuit. Example 18-8 Design the voltage regulator circuit in Fig. 18-18 to give an output voltage
adjustable from 12 V to 15 V. The maximum output current is to be 250 mA, and
the supply voltage is 20 V. Assuming
that hrm,
=
20 and
Mp
estimate the op-amp maximum output current.
Figure 18-18
Op-amp voltage regulator for Ex. 18-8.
Solution Vz * 0.75 Vorminy = 0.75 X 12'V =9V Use a 1N757 diode with Vz = 9.1 V Iz >> (op-amp Ipmmax)) and Iz > (Izx for the diode) Select
Iz=10mA
Vowmin) R,
Vz _ 12V—-9.1V
= Iz
10 mA
= 290 Q (use 270 © standard value)
I3¢@min) => (Op-amp Ip(max)) Select
I3(mnin) =1mA
When V, = 12 V (moving contact at top of Rs)
R, = oz _ BV-91V 3
Ts¢nin)
1mA
= 50,
_Linear and Switching Voltage Regulators
Chapter 18
779
= 2.9 kO, (use 2.7 kO standard value)
= 21V
2
Ry+ Rp=
I3¢min)
1 mA
=91kO
When V, = 15 V (moving contact at bottom of Rs), I; becomes
15 V
I; = —Vo
R3+ Rat Rs
2.7kQ + 9.1k2
= 1.27mA Rg
=
Vz
91V
I;
1.27mA
= 7.16 kO (use 6.8 kO standard value)
Rs = (Rg+ Rs) — Rg= 9.1k0 — 6.8 kD. = 2.3 kO (use 2.5 kO potentiometer) Select
Ir6 = 0.5mA
Re
_ vo _ WV Tre
0.5
mA
= 24 kQ (use 22 kO standard value)
Op-amp output current:
me. =
oe
Tu@max)
_ 250mA
lie te | 2K BO = 0.25 mA
Current Limiting with an Op-amp Regulator When a large output current is to be supplied by an operational amplifier voltage regulator, one of the current-limiting circuits described in Section 18-3 may be used with one important modification. Figure 18-19 shows the
modification. A resistor (R13) must be connected between the op-amp output terminal and the junction of Qog and Q7c. When an overload causes the regulator output voltage to go to zero, the op-amp output goes high (close to Vs) as it attempts to return V, to its normal level. Consequently, because the
op-amp normally has a very low output resistance, Rj3 is necessary to allow Ic7 to drop the voltage at Q. base to near ground level. The additional resistor at the op-amp output is calculated as R13 ~ Vs/Ic7. Resistor R13 must not be so large that there is an excessive voltage drop across it when the regulator is supposed to be operating normally.
780
Electronic Devices and Circuits
rn a os
ee
WA Rio
L
ON
|
\— OFigure 18-19 When current limiting is used with an op-amp regulator, a resistor (R;3) must be included in series with the op-amp output.
Practice Problems 18-4.1
Design
an
op-amp
voltage-regulator
circuit
as
in
Fig.
18-17 to
produce an output adjustable from 15 V to 18 V, with a 300 mA maximum load current. The supply voltage is 25 V.
18-4.2 Design
a fold-back current-limiting
circuit
for
the
regulator in
Problem 18-4.1, to give IL(maxy = 300 mA and Isc = 200 mA when [a
15.
18-5
IC LINEAR VOLTAGE REGULATORS
723 IC Regulator The basic circuit of a 723 IC voltage regulator in a dual-in-line package is
shown in Fig. 18-20. This IC has a voltage reference source (Dj), an error amplifier (Aj), a series pass transistor (Q:), and a current-limiting transistor (Q2), all contained in one small package. An additional Zener diode (D)) is 14
13 mM
+Vec 12 4
Ve 11 I
Output 10 ry
9
8 m
Figure 18-20 The 7231C voltage regulator contains a reference diode (D,), an error amplifier (A;), a seriespass transistor (Q;), a
current-limiting transistor
(Qa), and a voltage-dropping diode (D2).
Chapter 18
Linear and Switching Voltage Regulators
784
included for voltage dropping in some applications. The IC can be connected
to function as a positive or negative voltage regulator with an output voltage
ranging from 2 V to 37 V and output current levels up to 150 mA. The maximum supply voltage is 40 V, and the line and load regulations are each specified as 0.01%. A partial specification for the 723 regulator is given in
data sheet A-16 in Appendix A. Figure 18-21 shows a 723 connected to function as a positive voltage regulator. The complete arrangement (including the internal circuitry
shown in Fig. 18-20) is similar to the op-amp regulator circuit in Fig. 18-17.
One difference between
the two circuits is the 100 pF capacitor
(Ci)
connected to the error amplifier output and its inverting input terminal.
This capacitor is used instead of a large capacitor at the output terminals to prevent the regulator from oscillating. (Sometimes both capacitors are required.) By appropriate selection of resistors R; and R in Fig. 15-21, the
regulator output can be set to any level between 7.15 V (the reference
voltage) and 37 V. A potentiometer can be included between Ky and R2 to
make the output voltage adjustable.
re
wlllls Go
V.
s
4
723 14
—-
Rs Wr
Tt 1 f
4
1
1
!
|
I
|
|
=
|2
! Sh
!
I
I
I
_ ference
o-
Figure 18-21
!
!I
| LIZ
|
|
|
—o +)
|
|
Li
°
1 S* T_.~*
Voltage regulator circuit using a 723 IC regulator. The
output voltage range is 7 V to 37 V.
The dashed lines (in Fig. 18-21) show connections for simple (non-foldback) current limiting. Fold-back current limiting can also be used with the
723. It is important to note that, as for all linear regulator circuits, the supply voltage at the lowest point on the ripple waveform should be at least 3 V
greater than the regulator output; otherwise a high-amplitude output ripple might occur. The total power dissipation in the regulator should be calculated to ensure that it does not exceed the specified maximum.
The
specification lists 1.25 W as the maximum power dissipation at a free air
782
Electronic Devices and Circuits
temperature of 25°C for a DIP package. This must be derated at 10 mW/°C for higher temperatures. For a metal can package, Ppymax) = 1 W at 25°C free air temperature, and the derating factor is 6.6 mW /°C. An external series-
pass transistor may be Darlington-connected to (internal transistor) Q; to enable a 723 regulator to handle a larger load current. This is illustrated in
Fig. 18-22.
100 pF
a
+ a
Figure 18-22 An external series-pass transistor may be added to a 723 IC voltage regulator to supply higher load currents than the 723 can normally handle.
A regulator output voltage less than the 7.15 V reference level can be obtained by using a voltage divider across the reference source (terminals 6 and 7 in Fig. 18-20). Terminal 5 is connected to the reduced reference voltage,
instead of to terminal 6. Example 18-9 The regulator circuit in Fig. 18-23 is to have an output of 10 V. Calculate resistor values for R; and R2, select a suitable input voltage, and determine the maximum load current that may be supplied if Ppgmax) = 1000 mW.
Solution Ip > Select
(error amplifier input bias current)
Ih=1mA
Vro = Vrep = 7.15 V
p= 2"
bb
et
EY
ImA
= 7.15 kQ (use 6.8 kO standard value, and recalculate I»)
Chapter 18
Linear and Switching Voltage Regulators *
(+0
Ry 7 2.7kO
15V
/
=(10V
its Tr
uF Figure 18-23
Ilbecomes
e
[,
|
2
=
Veeg —= Ro
Regulator circuit for Ex. 18-9.
7.15V -6.8kO
= ——
= 1.05mA
a,
8 :
Veep _ 10V — 7.15V h 1.05 mA
= 2.85 kO, (use 2.7 kO standard value) For satisfactory operation of the series pass transistor,
Select
Vs—V,=5V
V5 =Vo+5V=10Vt5V =15V The internal circuit current is
SeenON
erste
aoa
Istandby) + ret © 25 mA
The 723 internal power dissipation on no-load is
P, = Vg X (Iistandby) + Jret) = 15 V X 25 mA = 375 mW Maximum power dissipated in the (internal) series-pass transistor:
Pp = (specified Ppimax)) — Pi = 1000 mW
eck Be satan
ee
= 625 mW Maximum load current: Pp TL(max) = Vs—Vo =125mA
_ 625mW ~ 5V
— 375 mW
783
784
Electronic Devices and Circuits
LM317 and LM337 IC Regulators The LM317
and LM337
IC regulators are three-terminal
devices
that are
extremely easy to use. The 317 is a positive voltage regulator (Fig. 18-24a), and
the 337 is a negative voltage regulator (Fig. 18-24b). In each case, input and output terminals are provided for supply and regulated output voltage, and an adjustment terminal (ADJ) is included for output voltage selection. The
output voltage range is 1.2 V to 37 V, and the maximum load current ranges from 300 mA to 2 A, depending on the type of device package. Typical line and load regulations are specified as 0.01% /(volt of V,), and 0.3%/(volt of Vo),
respectively. The internal reference voltage for the 317 and 337 regulators is typically 1.25 V, and Viet appears across the ADJ and output terminals. Consequently, the regulator output voltage is
Vo
=
2
x
VREF
(18-7)
LM337
O +
O— (a) LM317 positive voltage regulator
Figure 18-24
_
In
Out
Coal
9
O—)
|
+0 (b) LM337 negative voltage regulator
Application of the LM317 and LM337 integrated circuit voltage regulators.
The internal reference voltage appears across resistor Rj.
To determine suitable values for R; and R2 for a desired output voltage,
first choose a voltage-divider current (I;) that is much larger than the current that flows in the ADJ terminal of the device. This is specified as 100 pA maximum
on the device data sheet. The resistors are calculated from the
relationship in Eq. 18-7. Note the capacitors included in the regulator circuits. Capacitor Cin is
necessary only when the regulator is not located close to the power supply
filter circuit. Cj, eliminates the oscillatory tendencies that can occur with long connecting leads between the filter and regulator. Capacitor C, improves the transient response of the regulator and ensures ac stability, and Cau; improves the ripple rejection ratio.
Chapter 18
Linear and Switching Voltage Regulators
785
Figure 18-25 shows the terminal connections for
ae.
Mae
LM317 and LM337 regulators in 221 A-type packages.
cMat?
LM337
O
O
Example 18-10 An LM317 regulator is to provide a 6 V output from a 15 V supply. The load current is 200 mA.
|
Determine suitable resistance values for R, and R2 (Fig. 18-24), and calculate the regulator power dissipation. Solution
Figure 18-25
Vin Vo
AD!
connections
I, >> Iapy
Terminal for
LM317 and LM337 IC
regulators contained
b=1mA
Select
ALY
ry ADT Vom Vin
in 221A packages.
Ri =
1.25 V pop es
Viet
I;
1mA
= 1.25 kO (use 1.2 kO standard value) Va R»
—
Ve¢ —
I,
6V—-135V 1mA
= 4,75 kO (use 4.7 kO standard value)
Pp = (Vs — Vo) X ILimaxy = (15 V — 6 V) X 200 mA =1.8W
LM340 Regulators LM340 devices are three-terminal positive voltage regulators with fixed output voltages ranging from a low of 5 V toa high of 23 V. The regulator is selected for the desired output voltage and then simply provided with a voltage (Vs) from a power supply filter circuit, as illustrated in Fig. 18-26. Here again, capacitor C, is required only when the regulator is not close to the
filter. The LM340
data sheet specifies the regulator performance for an output
current of 1 A. The tolerance on the output voltage is + 2%, the line regulation is 0.01% per output volt, and the load regulation is 0.3% per amp of load current.
LM340
|
Gnd Cy
Vo
Figure 18-26
«= O36
_
:
The LM3840 is a fixed output
IC voltage regulator with an output selectable from 5 V to 23 V.
786
Electronic Devices and Circuits
The IC includes current limiting and a thermal shutdown circuit that protects
against excessive internal power dissipation. As with all series regulators, a heat sink must be used when high power dissipation is involved.
Practice Problems 18-5.1 Design the regulator circuit in Fig. 18-22 to have an 18 V, 200 mA output. Include short-circuit protection, and specify Q>.
18-5.2
Using an LM317, design a 9 V, 150 mA voltage regulator. Select a
supply voltage, and calculate the regulator power dissipation.
18-6
SWITCHING
REGULATOR
BASICS
Switching Regulator Operation A switching regulator can be thought of as similar to a linear regulator but with the series-pass transistor operating as a switch that is either off or switched on (in a saturated state). The output voltage from the switch is a pulse waveform which is smoothed into a dc voltage by the action of an LC filter. Switching regulators can be classified as ¢ step-down converter (output voltage lower than input); e step-up converter (output higher than input); or ¢ inverting converter (output polarity opposite to input).
The basic block diagram of a step-down switching regulator in Fig. 18-27 consists of a BJT switch (Q:) (also termed a power switch), an oscillator, a voltage
comparator, a voltage reference source, a diode (D;), and a filter. The switch, oscillator, comparator, and reference source are all usually contained within Integrated circuit controller
Switch (+
Oo—
Ss
Input
Oscillator
V; : 4
A +)
Filter
=
Sy
Voltage comparator
Ry
U4
| Output
Sh
f
Va
—_ A D,
7
Ry
0
Reference voltage EO
Figure 18-27
oO
=,
A switching regulator has a switch (contained in an IC controller), a
filter,
and a diode. The switch converts the dc input into a pulse waveform, and the filter smooths the pulse wave into a direct voltage with a ripple waveform.
Chapter 18
Linear and Switching Voltage Regulators
an integrated circuit controller, as illustrated. The filter usually consists of an inductor and capacitor. The operation of the regulator is as
787
Input voltage yj
follows: e
Oscillator output
Refer to the waveforms in Fig. 18-28. The de
input voltage (Vj) is converted into a pulse FL waveform
(Va) by the action of the switch
!
(Qi) turning on and off. ¢
]
The oscillator switches Q; on, causing current to flow to the filter and the output
voltage to rise. e The voltage comparator
|
output
[|
VA |
compares
the
al
output voltage (divided by R; and R2) to the
En
t—
4
|
reference voltage, and it holds Q; on until Vro equals Vier. Then, Q; is turned off again. e A pulse waveform (Va) is produced at the
input of the filter by Q; turning on and off. a dc output voltage (V.) with a
ripple waveform (V;,).
lott —~1
Output
| os
| | | | | |
ace
te fa bene pH
Vo! Po
Figure 18-28
e The filter smooths the pulse waveform to produce
Switch
: "s
Switching
ae ee
per oa aa tiee
output is a de voltage with a
e The ripple waveform is the result of the filter capacitor charging via the inductor
ripple.
during fon, and then discharging to the load during fog via Dy. (Thise is explained further in Section 18-7.)
In the operation described above, the controller can be thought of as a pulse width modulator; the on time of Q; (pulse width of its output) is increased or decreased as necessary to supply the output current required. Other systems involve control of the switch off time.
Comparison of Linear and Switching Regulators The power
dissipated in the series-pass transistor in a linear regulator is
wasted power. This is not very important when the load current is lower than 500
mA.
With
high
current
levels,
the
regulator
efficiency
becomes
important, and there can also be serious heat dissipation problems.
In a switching regulator, the power dissipation in the switching transistor (whether it is on or off) is very much smaller than in the series-pass transistor of a linear regulator with a similar output voltage and load current. Thus, a switching regulator is more efficient than a linear regulator.
The approximate efficiency of a linear regulator can be calculated by
assuming that the only wasted power (Pp) is that dissipated in the seriespass transistor (see Fig. 18-29a).
788
Electronic Devices and Circuits Vor
Vcr (sat)
a
ath I,
4)
Ger tos)
‘
x
oT
9
Q;
Filter
D Amplifier
Vj
Vv,
reference
V;
o-
[
circuit with
Load
source
V,,
reference
1
source
low
O Pp
Vcr
5
x I,
Pp ce
(a) Linear regulator Figure 18-29
i Vy
Control
and
/-
0 = P__OR, (43.vP_ 21000 =1W
Design Procedure The amplifier in Fig. 19-44 uses four diodes to forward-bias the base-emitter junctions
of the Darlington
output
exactly the same as in Fig. 19-43.
transistors. Otherwise,
the circuit is
856
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Darlington
is Darlington
Ts . Figure 19-44 and 19-17.
—Veg
Power amplifier circuit for Examples 19-16
As always, the peak output voltage and current are calculated from the specified output power and load resistance. The supply voltage is determined using Eq. 19-22, and the emitter resistors for the output stage are typically selected as 0.1R,. The bias network current (J4) should be larger than the peak base current for Q; and Q>. The resistance of R4 (which equals
Rg + Ro) is calculated from I, and the circuit dc voltage drops. Rg should typically be selected as 0.5 Rg, and then Ro, Rio, and Ry, are all equal to Rg.
R, and R3 are equal-value resistors that bias the op-amp input terminals. R> is calculated from R3 to give the required voltage gain. C2 is selected to
have its impedance equal to R; at the desired lower cutoff frequency (f;). The bootstrapping capacitors are calculated in terms of the resistance in series with them: Xc3 = Xc4 = 0.1(Rg||Ro) at fi. The op-amp must have a suitable full power bandwidth (see Section 15-3) to produce the peak output voltage
at the desired upper cutoff frequency for the amplifier.
Example 19-16 The circuit in Fig. 19-44 uses a BIFET op-amp. Ry = 8 2, P, is to be 6 W, and v, = +0.1 V. Q; and Qzare Darlingtons with hpggminy = 1000 and Vex(sat) = 2 V. Determine a suitable supply voltage and resistor values. Also, calculate the
minimum op-amp slew rate to give fz = 50 kHz.
Power Amplifiers
Chapter 19
Solution
From Eq. 19-8,
Vp = V2Rz, Po) =
V2 X 80
X 6W)
=98V
1, =P _ 98V PR,
80
=12A Select
Re
= Ry® 0.1Ry,
=0.1
x 80
20.8 0 Eq, 19-22:
Vec = +[V, + IpnRg + Verxsat)]
=+[98V + (12AX 0.80) +2 V] ~+12.8 V (use £13 V)
1
_/p _12A
Bl(peak)
"ee;
1000
=12mA
I > Ip3(peak) Select
If=2mA
R,
= Vee —Vn—
*
Ym
13V-07V
Li
-07V
2mA
= 5.8kO Rg
= Ro
=
Rio =
Ru
=
0.5 Rg
= 0.5 X 5.8kO = 2.9 kO (use 2.7 kO standard value) Acq
= U9 _ 9.8 V (peak) cL
v,
0.1 V (peak)
= 98
Srdect
R, = R3 = 100 kQ (See BIFET in Section 14-2) R3 Ry = ——
100 kO =
= 1.03 kO (use 1 kQ) Eq. 15-3:
SR = 2nf2Vp = 27 X 50 kHz X 9 V = 2.8 V/ps
857
858
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Example 19-17 Calculate capacitor values for the circuit in Ex. 19-16. The lower cutoff frequency is to be 50 Hz.
Solution Xci
=
0.1R,
C
at fy
1 2arf,XO1R,
—
= 0.318 uF Xoo
=—
1 27X50Hzx0.1X100kO
(use 0.33 F)
= Ro at fi
1
C=
_
QafiRo = 3.18 pF
1
=
2a X 50Hz X 1kO
(use 3.3 wF)
Xc3 = Xcq = 0.1(Rgl|Ro) at fj = 0.1 (2.7 kO||2.7 kQ)
= 1352
1
1
* 2af,Xc, 2mX50Hz 13500 = 23.6 wF (use 25 wF)
Practice Problems 19-8.1 Calculate V,(ouy and P, for the circuit in Fig. 19-39 when Vin = +£0.54 V. Also, determine f; when a 741 op-amp is used. 19-8.2 Calculate the supply voltage for an amplifier as in Fig. 19-44 to deliver 3 W to a 12 © load. Assume that hppqnin)= 1500 and VE (at) = 2 V for Q, and Q>. Determine the op-amp minimum
give fp = 65 kHz.
slew rate to
)
19-9 MOSFET POWER AMPLIFIER WITH OP-AMP DRIVER STAGE Basic Circuit Operation The class AB power amplifier circuit in Fig. 19-45a consists of an operational amplifier (A;), two MOSFETs (Q3 and Q,), and several resistors. The op-amp, together with resistors Ra, Rs, and R¢ and capacitor C2 constitutes a noninverting amplifier. The two MOSFETs are a complementary common-source output stage, like the output stage for the circuit discussed in Section 19-7.
Chapter 19
Power Amplifiers
859
Ri
—O
— VEE
- Ver
(b) Op-amp
(a) Basic circuit of common-source
amplifier
output stage controls
Ves3 and Vegas
Figure 19-45 Complementary common-source power amplifier using an opamp driver stage and a MOSFET output stage.
The gate-source bias voltages for Q3 and Q, are provided by the voltage
drops across resistors R7 and Rs, which are in series with the op-amp supply
terminals. So the op-amp supply currents (Isi+) and Isi-)) determine the levels of Voes3 and
Vesa:
Ves3
and
= Is¢+)
xX Rz
(19-23)
Vesa = Is(-) X Rg
(19-24)
Suitable gate-source threshold voltages (Vestn) to bias the output transistors for class AB operation, and typical op-amp supply currents (Is) can be determined from the device data sheets. Figure 19-45b shows that the op-amp supply currents are largely the collector currents in the op-amp output stage BJTs (Qs and Qe). Thus, R7 and Rs are collector resistors for Qs and Qs. When the base voltage for Qs and Q, is in-
creased in a positive direction, Qs collector current (Is,.)) increases, causing Vcs3 to increase and thus increasing the MOSFET drain current Ip3. At the same time, the Q, collector current (Is-)) decreases, reducing Vggy and drain current Ips. The resulting Ip3 flows through R,, producing a positive output voltage swing (+V,). Note that the op-amp output voltage is also positive at this time.
When
the base voltage at Qs and Qs is negative-going, Ig;_) increases,
causing an increase in Vgsa and in Ip4. During this time, Is;+) decreases, re-
ducing Voss and Ip3. Thus, Ips flows through R,, producing a negative output voltage swing (—V.). The op-amp output voltage is also going negative while Q, is creating the negative output voltage across R,.
860
Electronic Devices and Circuits
It is seen that BJTs Qs and Q, operate as common-emitter amplifier and that MOSFETs Q3 and Q, function as common-source circuits. Both produce voltage gain, which should. be multiplied with the op-amp loop gain to determine the total open-loop gain for the circuit. If typical tities are used, the overall open-loop gain can be shown to be around 4
stages stages openquanx 10°.
Returning to Fig. 19-45a, the complete (basic) circuit operates as a non-
inverting amplifier with a closed-loop voltage gain:
Aq. = —
(19-25)
Example 19-18 Determine the MOSFET gate-source bias voltages for the complementary common-source power amplifier in Fig. 19-46. Calculate the peak output voltage, peak output current, and output power if the ac input is +100 m’V. es Vec
O15
V
-15V —Vep
Figure 19-46 Power amplifier circuit for Ex. 19-18.
Solution From the LF351 op-amp data sheet:
Supply current:
Is =1.8mAto3.4mA
Ves3 = Vesa = Is X R7 Vos(min) = Is(min) X R7 = 1.8 mA
X 820 O
215V
Vostmax) = Istmax) X Ry = 3.4 mA X 820 0 2.9 V
Eq. 19-25:
Act _ Rst+ Re _ 3900 + 18kO Rs
~ 47.2
390 O
Chapter 19
Power Amplifiers
861
Vp = Act, X V; = 47.2 X 100 mV =472V
Vplp — 4.72V x 472mA =
T
EEE
=
P,=-—
Bias Control As previously explained, the bias current in the output transistors of a power amplifier should be adjustable. Control over the bias current flowing in transistor Q3 in Fig. 19-47a can be effected by using a variable resistor for R7, as illustrated. This allows Ip3 to be adjusted by varying Voss. When Ip3 is increased and the additional drain current flows through Ri, the dc feedback
(via Re in Fig. 19-46) keeps the V, equal to zero. The feedback produces the necessary change in Vesa to make Ip, closely follow Ip3. Thus, adjustment of resistor R7 controls the level of Ins as well as Ips.
A disadvantage of using R7 to adjust the bias current is that the voltage gains produced by Qs and Qs become unequal when Rz and Rg have different
resistances. This can be overcome by the negative feedback; however, the bias resistors can be kept equal by using the variable current source shown in
Fig. 19-47b. In the variable current source, transistor Q; is biased from the emitter of Q>, and the Q, base is connected to the collector of Q;. The collector-emitter
voltage of Q; is Vce1 = Ver + Vee2 = 2V pe Assuming that Ipz < Ici, the Q, collector current is
_ Vec ~ 2 Ver
Ri
fe =
(19-26)
With Ip;
Vy Ry
_
Vrpion))
Maximum undistorted output
-
Rg
jv
=
(Vez — Vrpon))
—O —Vip
(b) Voltage divider Ry and Ryo allows the output swing to go to +(Vee - Verpwon))
Figure 19-49
The common-source amplifier circuit can be modified to produce an out-
put swing larger than the op-amp maximum output.
Chapter 19
Power Amplifiers
865
Rg and Ro also provide negative feedback that controls the gain of the stage made
up of the op-amp
output BJTs and the common-source
MOS-
FETs. This is illustrated in Fig. 19-50. A further function of Ro and Rig is that
they can be selected to limit the op-amp output current in the event that R is short-circuited.
Feedback voltage
Figure 19-50
Negative feedback to the emit-
ters of Qs and Qg controls the gain of the
O-Ver
(Qs — Qe) — (Q3 — Qa) stage.
Example 19-20 The circuit in Fig. 19-51 has MOSFETs with gs, = 2.5 S and Rpwon) = 0.5 ©.
Determine the maximum peak output voltage, the minimum supply voltage at op-amp terminals, and the op-amp peak output voltage when the circuit is producing maximum output power. 4
t Vcc
“© aV Ry 820 0
— Qs Is
2mA
|!
Ryo Ay
4
S-
{} 2mA
Hol
Rg
1kQ
Ry
1kQ
109 aa (Fe
"=
Rg 820 2
—Ver -12V
Figure 19-51
Circuit for Ex. 19-20.
866
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Solution
Eg.19-31:
V
Vec
X Ry,
_
P Rowen + RL
12V
x
100
052+100
= 11.43V
7 =e 2 14sV PRL
100
=114A Eq. 19-29:
Ip
114A
AVgs = _ =e = 0.46 V
Verdc) = Is X Ry = 2 mA X 8200 =1.64V Eq. 19-30:
Vsqniny = +(Vcc — Verde) — AVos) = +(12 V — 1.64 V — 0.46 V) =+9.9V
The op-amp peak output voltage is
_VpX Ro
11.43 V X 1kO
Ro +R
1k0+1kO
Complete Amplifier Circuit The complete circuit of the common-source power amplifier is shown in Fig. 19-52. Note the inclusion of resistors Ry, and Riz and capacitors C3 and C4. Resistors Ry, and Riz are typically 100 0. They have no effect on the circuit dc conditions, but they help to reduce the possibility of oscillations in the
output stage. The additional stage of voltage gain constituted by the MOSFETs and the op-amp (common-emitter) output transistors increases the pos-
sibility of circuit instability. Capacitor C3 helps to ensure frequency stability by acting with resistor Ro to introduce a phase lead in the output stage feedback loop (see Section 15-2). The phase lead cancels some of the phase lag in the overall circuit. The additional stage of amplification extends the high cutoff frequency of
the amplifier above the cutoff frequency of the op-amp operating alone. If the op-amp (full-power) upper cutoff frequency for an overall voltage gain of 20 (or 26 dB) is 200 kHz, and the additional stage has a gain of 2 (or 6 dB), the circuit cutoff frequency is 400 kHz. For audio applications, it is normal to in-
clude capacitor C, (see Fig. 19-52), which is usually selected to set the amplifier upper cutoff frequency around 50 kHz or lower.
Chapter 19
Power Amplifiers
867
~—0 +Vec
Figure 19-52
Complete circuit of class AB common-source power amplifier.
Example 19-21 Analyze the circuit in Fig. 19-53 to determine the op-amp minimum supply voltage (Vs(dcimin)) and the MOSFET maximum gate-source voltage
(Ves(max)). The op-amp supply current is 0.5 mA. +Vecc
2 BY Ry
15kO Ry 1009
\IEXQ
5
sf
C3
Rg 1000 15kO Common-source power amplifier circuit for Figure 19-53 Examples 19-21 and 19-22.
868
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Solution From Eq. 19-27,
V, Ic2¢max) = RB
0.7 V = 700
~1.5mA Icoqmin) =
VBE. R, +R;
ca : 47004+1k0
= 476 pA Eg. 19-28:
Vos max) = Us(max) + Ic2qnax)] R7 = (0.5 mA
+ 1.5 mA)
X 15kQ
=3V Vs(dey(min) = (Vcc — Vr7) = +(15 V — 3 V) =+12V Example 19-22 Analyze the circuit in Fig. 19-53 to determine Poimax, Act, fi, and fy. The
op-amp supply current is 0.5 mA, and the MOSFETs have Rpjon) = 0.3 ©. Solution Power output:
Eq. 19-31:
_ Vcc X Ry "Ro ah
_ 15V x 150 ~~ 030+150 =14.7V Vp _147V
RR 150 = 980 mA Volp Pounax)
=
2
14.7V xX 980mA =
9
=7.2W Voltage gain:
Ay
_ Rs t+Ro _ 2.2kO + 33k0 Rs 2.2 kO = 16
Chapter 19
Power Amplifiers
869
Cutoff frequencies:
f-—1_InCoRg
1 27 X 3.9 pF X 2.2kO
= 18.5 Hz
fr
1 ~
27C4Re
1 ~
In
X 100 pF X 33kQ
= 48.2 kHz
Practice Problems 19-9.1 A complementary common-source power amplifier is to deliver 5 W to a 12 © load. The available MOSFETs have Rpn) = 0.6 2, Vin = 1.2 V,
and gf, = 3S. The op-amp to be used has 1 mA supply currents and a
maximum output of 20 mA. Design the output stage of the circuit as shown in Fig. 19-51. 19-9.2 Design a BJT current source bias control circuit for the amplifier in Problem 19-9.1 to adjust the Ves of Q3 and Qs by +20%.
19-9.3 The amplifier in Problem 19-9.1 is to have fj = 20 Hz and f. = 40 kHz. If the ac input is +600 mV, determine suitable values for Ry, Rs, Re, C1, Co, and C4 (see Fig. 19-52). Use a BIFET op-amp.
19-10
INTEGRATED
CIRCUIT POWER AMPLIFIERS
IC Power Amplifier Driver The LM391 integrated circuit audio power driver contains amplification ver stages for controlling an externally connected class AB output stage ing 10 W to 100 W. The voltage gain and bandwidth are set by additional nents. Internal circuitry is included for overload and thermal protection
and dridelivercompoand for
protection of the (externally connected) amplifier output transistors. The circuit is designed for very low distortion, so that it can be used for high-fidelity amplifiers. Figure 19-54 illustrates the use of the device as an audio amplifier. The output stage in Fig. 19-54 is seen to be a complementary emitter fol-
lower with the low-power and high-power
transistor pairs connected
in
quasi-complementary form. The IC output at terminal 9 is connected to the amplifier output, and the output stage transistors are controlled from current
source terminal 8 and current sink terminal 5. The circuit uses a plus-minus supply, and the non-inverting input terminal of the IC is biased to ground.
The inverting input terminal receives feedback from the output, so that the complete circuit operates as a non-inverting amplifier. Resistors Ra and Kp are connected to an internal transistor (via terminals 5, 6, and 7) to constitute a Vee multiplier for controlling the bias voltage to the
870
Electronic Devices and Circuits
amplifier output stage (see Fig. 19-55a). Capacitor Cap by-passes the Vpz multiplier circuit to improve the amplifier high-frequency response. Capaci-
tor Cr helps to reject power supply ripple, and Cc is a compensation capaci-
tor for frequency stability. Components Ro, Co, Lxand R, are included for load compensation (see Section 19-5).
The LM3391 has an internal transistor that can shut the circuit down when turned on by a thermal switch (Fig. 19-55b). This allows the device to be pro-
LM391 14 33 kO Thermal
switch (a) Vgp multiplier Figure 19-55
20 WF T
(b) Thermal shut-down
Bias control and shut-down circuits for the LM391.
(c) Soft turn-on
Chapter 19
Power Amplifiers
874
tected from the overheating that might occur with an excessive load current demand. This same transistor can be employed for soft turn-on of the circuit (Fig. 19-55c). If the amplifier supply voltage is switched on at the instant that
a peak input signal is applied, a high-level output is passed to the speaker, causing a sharp unpleasant noise. Soft turn-on causes the output to increase
slowly, thus eliminating the speaker noise. The circuit in Fig. 19-55c holds the amplifier in a shut-down condition until the capacitor charges. Overload protection transistors are included
in the LM391, as shown in Fig. 19-56. These transistors turn on when excessive voltage drops occur across the emitter resistors (Rp3 and Regs) in
the output stage (see Section 19-5). The output stage components in Fig. 19-54 are selected in the same way as for other directcoupled class AB amplifiers. The minimum supply voltages are calculated by adding 5 V to the peak output voltage.
Vec = +(Vp + 5V)
(19-32)
The input resistance at terminal
LM391
1 of the
is extremely high and so the circuit
input resistance is set by resistor Rin, which is
typically selected as 100 kQ. Feedback resistors Rr and Rp set the amplifier closed-loop voltage
gain. The
feedback network components
are
determined in exactly the same way as for
Figure 19-56
Overload pro-
tection for the LM391.
other feedback amplifiers. Rr is made equal to Rin to minimize output offset, and Ry is calculated from Rp to give the desired voltage gain. Capacitor C; is determined in terms of Ry, to set the low
cutoff frequency.
Example 19-23 Determine the maximum output power, the voltage gain, and the low cutoff frequency for the circuit shown in Fig. 19-54, if the supply is +23 V. Solution From Eq. 19-32,
Vp = Vcc — 5V=2V=5V =18V
> = Vp _ (sv)? °
2R,
2x80
872
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Rg
Ac =
+ Re
_
100 kQ
RS
+ 5.6kO
5.6ka = 18.9
Bt fi = QnC;Ry 2X
1 a7 X 1 pF X 5.6k0
= 28 Hz
250 mW IC Power Amplifier The LM386 is a complete power amplifier circuit capable of delivering 250 mW to an 8 © load without any additional components. The supply
voltage range is 5 V to 18 V, and the (inverting and non-inverting) input terminals are biased to ground or to a negative supply via internal 50 kO resistors. The output is automatically centred at half the supply voltage. Feedback resistors are also provided internally to set the voltage gain to 20. The pin connections for the LM386 are shown in Fig. 19-57a, and the circuit
connections for functioning as an amplifier with a gain of 20 are illustrated in
part b. Figure 19-57c shows how a capacitor and resistor can be connected at pins 1 and 8
to achieve a larger voltage gain. With the 10 wF capacitor alone,
a maximum gain of 200 is obtained. The resistor in series with the capacitor allows the voltage gain to be set anywhere between 20 and 200.
(b) Amplifier with Ac, = 20
(a) LM386 pin connections
Vcc
10pF
12k
(c) Amplifier with Ac, = 50 Figure 19-57 The LM386 IC power amplifier can be connected to have a closed-loop gain from 20 to 200.
Chapter 19
Power Amplifiers
873
single-ended
(SE),
Bridge-Tied Load Amplifier All
the power
amplifiers
already
discussed
have
been
meaning that they provide power to a load that has one terminal grounded
and the other terminal connected to the amplifier output. These amplifiers either use a plus-minus supply with directly-coupled loads or have a capacitorcoupled load and a single-polarity supply. A bridge-tied load (BTL) amplifier uses a single-polarity supply and a direct-coupled load. Figure 19-58a shows the basic circuit of a BTL amplifier. The two op-amps
are connected to function as inverting amplifiers, but note from the resistor values that A; has a voltage gain of 10 and that Az has a gain of 1. Each am-
plifier has a single-polarity supply (Vcc), and a voltage divider (Rs and Re) provides a bias voltage of 0.5Vcc to the op-amp non-inverting input terminals. The load resistor (R1) is connected from the output of A, to the output
of Ao. This is the bridge-tied load configuration. Amplifier A,
Amplifier A»
Ry
100 kQ
10kO
+Vec
Gy
%F-WA+Vec
ok
22 V
-
Y
Rs 100 kO.
Rot 100 kQ
+1V
+21V
10k
9
Yy
tL
~
+11V
Led V l
5
20 V Vo 20 V
ae (a) BTL amplifier circuit
Figure 19-58
ileal
R,
22V
x ph —$WWv— '
10 kQO
+1V
+21 V
x
+Vce
22V
Ry
Y; |
Ry
(b) Circuit waveforms
A bridge-tied load (BTL) amplifier uses two op-amp Circuits with their out-
puts connected to opposite ends of the load.
When no ac signal is applied, the de voltage at the load terminals (X and Y) is
0.5 Vcc, in this case, 11 V for a 22 V supply. As illustrated by the waveforms in Fig. 19-58b, a +1 V ac input to Ai produces a —10 V change at load terminal X. This (—10 V) is also applied to the input of A», resulting ina +10 V change at load terminal Y. Thus, a peak of 20 V, negative at X and positive at Y, is developed across the load. When the ac input goes to —1 V, a 20 V peak load voltage
is again produced but with the load polarity reversed. So, although a singlepolarity +22 V supply is used, the output is 40 V peak-to-peak, and no load-coupling capacitor is required. A (similar performance) single-ended amplifier producing a 40 V peak-to-peak output would require either a +22 V supply for a direct-coupled load ora +44.V supply for a capacitor-coupled load.
874
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Figure 19-59 shows the pin connections and typical application of a TPA4861, 1 W integrated circuit BTL audio power amplifier. The load is connected across the two output terminals (5 and 8), external resistors R; and Rp
set the voltage gain, and the signal is coupled to R; via C;. The supply volt-
age (Vpp) is internally divided to bias the op-amp non-inverting terminals to 0.5Vpp. The bias point is externally accessible so that it can be bypassed
to
ground (via Cg) for soft start-up and to minimize noise. A TPA4861 using a +5 V supply can dissipate 1 W in an 8 ( load. The overall voltage gain for the (BTL) amplifier is twice the gain of the inverting
amplifier stage: Act,
_2Ry
(19-33)
m
Because the signal is applied to an inverting amplifier, the input resistance is set by resistor R;. The IC manufacturer recommends that R; should be selected in the range of 5 kO to 20 kQ. Also, if Rp exceeds 50 kQ,, a small capacitor (Cp = 5 pF) should be connected in parallel with it for ac stability. The input capacitor (C1) sets the circuit low cutoff frequency. So, Xc, = Ry at fy
(19-34)
The internal voltage-divider resistance (50 kQ||50 kQ) is connected in series with the bypass capacitor (Cg). The impedance of Cg should usually be onetenth of the series resistance: XcB
=
2.5kQ
at fi
(19-35)
|e, 15kQ ww "4 a — 50kQ | 50k0 4 sHw—+4 a eels fl
6
1
5.6kO
pa SEN
|
3
ate
46 kQ.
WV
ne
80
—VWA\—
a
46 kO,
Speaker
—+
1
fc, Figure 19-59
V
TPA4861 bridge-tied load IC amplifier.
8
Bias
control.
Z
|
|
Chapter 19
Audio Power Amplifiers
875
Example 19-24 Analyze the circuit in Fig. 19-59 to determine the load power dissipation when a +0.5 V signal is applied at the input. Solution
15k Ac. = 2ReRy = 2X5.6k0,
Eq, 19-33;
Z5A
Vo = Aci X Vs = £5.4 X 0.5V =12.7V
i Vp _ @7vP ©
2R;
2X80
=~ 0.46 W
7 W IC Power Amplifier The LM383 can deliver 7 W to a 4 2 load. No additional output transistors are required because the amplifier can produce a 3.5 A peak output current.
Ae
Overload protection circuitry is included, and internal bias is provided for
(a) LM383 five-lead TO-220 package Figure 19-60
(b) Connection for amplifier with Pg = 7 W
LM383 IC power amplifier connected to dissipate 7 W in a 4 Q load.
876
Electronic Devices and Circuits
the input terminals. The single-polarity supply voltage ranges from 5 V to 20 V. Amplifier voltage gain can be programmed by means of external components. The circuit bandwidth is 30 kHz at a gain of 40 dB. Figure 19-60 shows an LM383
(in a 5-pin TO-220 package) connected to
function as a non-inverting audio amplifier. Capacitors C; and C4 couple the
signal and load. Resistors R, and R» are feedback components that set the circuit voltage gain, and capacitor C2 couples the feedback voltage to the inverting input terminal. Other components provide circuit stability. Note that
the resistance of Rp is 2.2 0. This is because the inverting input terminal is connected
(internally)
to a transistor emitter terminal
that has
an input
resistance of about 20 ©. Capacitor Cz must be very large to couple the feedback voltage to the low-resistance inverting input. The circuit functions as a non-inverting amplifier.
68 W IC Power Amplifier Figure 19-61 shows a power amplifier circuit using an LM3886 IC audio amplifier. The LM3886 can deliver 68 W to a 4 2 load using a +28 V supply. Alternatively, it can be used to dissipate 38 W in an 8 2 load, again using a +28 V supply. The circuit operates as a non-inverting amplifier with the
closed-loop gain set by resistors R3 and R4 and the low cutoff frequency set by capacitor C;. Potentiometer R; allows the signal amplitude to be adjusted.
Switch S; is a mute control.
t +Vcc
T Ni45
Laseas!8
LM3886
R3
rs
20Ryka
Cy 10 pF
Figure 19-61
M3886, 68 W audio power amplifier.
L, 0.7 pH
WW
R, 109
Chapter 19
Audio Power Amplifiers
877
Practice Problems 19-10.1 A power amplifier using an LM391 driver (as in Fig. 19-54) has a
+20 V supply, a 50 © load, and power Darlington output BJTs with hge = 600. Calculate the maximum output power and the peak output current from the integrated circuit. 19-10.2
Calculate the efficiency of the circuit in Fig. 19-59 when delivering
1 W to the speaker. The quiescent current for the TPA4861 is speci-
fied as 2.5 mA. 19-10.3
Determine the signal amplitude for the circuit in Fig. 19-60 to dissipate 7 W in the load. Calculate the low cutoff frequency.
19-11 CLASS C AMPLIFIER Class C Circuit and Waveforms In the basic class C amplifier circuit shown in Fig. 19-62a the BJT base is biased to a negative voltage level (— Vg) via inductor L) to keep the device in _a normally off state. The circuit waveforms in Fig. 19-62b show that Qi conducts when the signal voltage (v,) becomes sufficiently positive to drive ¥ SNE
po Vec :
I
L
L
‘
, ¥,
iH
—-
C,
4
(a) Class C power amplifier circuit
(b) Circuit waveforms
Figure 19-62 Basic class C amplifier circuit and waveforms. Tank circuit components C2 off.and pulsed on briefly and L» resonate at the signal frequency. Transistor Q, is biased
tank circuit. during each signal time period to recharge the
878
Electronic Devices and Circuits
the transistor base above the level of the grounded emitter terminal. The base
and collector currents flow only during a portion of the entire cycle of the signal waveform. The tank circuit (LzC2) connected to the collector is tuned to
resonate at the signal frequency, and because the waveform across a resonant circuit is sinusoidal, the circuit output voltage (vo) is a sine wave despite the
pulsed condition of the transistor.
Some of the energy stored in the tank circuit is dissipated in the load, and is replaced by the current pulse each time the transistor switches on. The process is sometimes referred to as the flywheel effect. A flywheel that gets a kick to keep it turning once in every cycle will rotate indefinitely. Similarly, a tank circuit that receives a (large enough) current pulse once a cycle will oscillate indefinitely. The tank circuit can be tuned to resonate at a harmonic of the signal frequency, instead of being tuned to the fundamental frequency. In this case, the output frequency is the selected harmonic frequency, and the circuit functions as a frequency multiplier. The circuit peak-to-peak output voltage (vp) is shown as 2Vcc in Fig. 19-62b. This effect (also discussed in Section 12-10) is due to the inductor opposing
any change in current flow. Figure 19-63a shows that when Q; is saturated, the voltage across Lz and C) is
Vp = Voc — Vee¢at) The polatrity of V, is positive (+) at the top of Lz and negative (—) at the bottom. When Q,; is off, as in Fig. 19-63b, the inductor voltage reverses to keep I, flowing, and V, is now: negative (—) at the top of Lz and positive (+) at the bottom. (The presence of C2 in parallel with Lz prevents any sudden
switch in the inductor voltage polarity.) So, the circuit peak-to-peak output +
ot Vic
———9+Vic we
V,
=
Voc
reversed polarity ~ Vegat)
Voc +V, ¥2V,
(a)Q, onin saturation
(b) QO, off
Figure 19-63 When Q; is on, the output voltage is —V, = (Voc — Veejeat)). When Q; switches off, the output oscillates up to +V, = (Vcc — Vce(say). This gives a peak-to-peak output amplitude of approximately 2Vec.
Chapter 19
Audio Power Amplifiers
879
voltage is 2V,. However, because Vcxisat) is very much smaller than Vcc,
Vovp-p) is taken as approximately 2Vcc. This also means that the BJT collectoremitter voltage can approach 2Vcc.
The output voltage amplitude from a class C circuit is not linearly related to the input amplitude, so the circuit cannot be employed as a linear amplifier. A class C circuit is normally used to amplify a high-frequency signal to the maximum possible output amplitude. Inductor L; in Fig. 19-62a has a high impedance at the signal frequency. This avoids loading the signal source, and isolates the bias voltage source from signal frequency currents. The winding resistance of L; is likely to be less than 20 ©, so the dc bias at the QQ; base is securely held at — Vz.
Efficiency When no signal is applied to a class C amplifier, the transistor is off. Also, when on, the device is driven into saturation and conducts only for a portion of the positive half-cycle of the signal waveform. Thus, the transistor power dissipation is a minimum, and the only other wasted power is a very smal] power dissipation in the inductor winding resistance. This gives the class C amplifier a very high efficiency. The maximum ac power delivered to the load is, P, =
giving
Po =
(Vins)
Rk
_ (V, / V2)’
&
(Vp 2R,
(19-36)
The dc voltage applied to the tank circuit when Q; is on is Vp, as already discussed. If this voltage was applied continuously to deliver P, to the tank circuit, the average direct current would be
The dc input power can be calculated from
P; = Voc X lac and the circuit efficiency is (from Eq. 19.4)
n= Fo x 100% P.
1
To determine the peak current supplied by the transistor, consider the pulse waveform illustrated in Fig. 19-64. This is represented as having a rec-
tangular wave shape for calculation simplicity. To produce the average current I4,a pulse amplitude of
880
Electronic Devices and Circuits
T lp = Igo X
7
(19-37)
is required where T is the time period of the signal frequency and ft is the device on time. The transistor on time can also be expressed as a conduction angle (8): t
6= — X 360°
(19-38)
=
Figure 19-64 Approximate representation of the repetitive current pulse that charges the tank circuit in a class
T
C amplifier.
The power that must be supplied to the tank circuit equals the output
power (Po), which can be expressed as
Py = (Ip X Vp) X 7
(19-39)
Example 19-25 The basic class C amplifier circuit in Fig. 19-65 has Vcc = 10 V, Ry = 1 kQ, f=3MHz, Ip = 25 mA, Vexat) = 0.3 V. Calculate the ac output power, dc input
power, conduction angle, and efficiency. t+Vec
10V C,
28 nH
=
L
2
1000 pF
~
= =
Figure 19-65 Class C amplifier circuit analyzed in Ex. 19-25.
Solution Vp= Vec — Ver¢at) = 10 V — 0.3 V
=9.7V
Chapter 19
2
Eq. 19-36:
881
2
p,= “e) _ @7V) 2R,
Audio Power Amplifiers
2x1kO
=~ 47 mW
T= 1/f=1/(3 MHz) = 0.33 ps From Eq.
19-39:
_
F
x
_ 47 mW
[, XV,
x 0.33 [wS
25 mA
x 9.7 V
= 64 ns
Eq. 19-38:
oo tx 360° = OFS 300_ z
1/(3MHz)
=~ 70° P|
lac =
V,
47mW
a
«9.7V
=485mA P;=
Vec X Ige= 10 V
X 4.85 mA
= 48.5 mW EP
Eq. 19-4:
47 mW
= — x 100% =————-_ x 100%
.
a”
48.5 mW
= 96.9%
The calculation of efficiency in Ex. 19-9 does not take into account the power dissipated in the inductor. This can be determined from the inductor rms current (I,) and the winding resistance (Ry): V I
and
SS
0.707 V. P
Py = Ty? Rw
Bandwidth The equations relating to the bandwidth for the small-signal tuned amplifier (Eqs 12-30 through 12-35) also apply to the class C circuit. Recall that the
bandwidth is determined from Eq. a 12-35: where Q, is given by
f B= Q, =*
882
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Eq. 12-33:
Qp= FeriR o™p
Remember that Eq. 12-33 is correct only when Q;, >> Qp.
Component Selection The transistor used in a class C amplifier must be able to survive 2Vcc, as discussed. It must also be able to provide the necessary pulse of collector current to the tank circuit, and its switching times must be much smaller than
the required on time (t). Because the transistor is off for most of the signal time period, the tank circuit in a class C amplifier operates as a power source for the load. So, the energy stored in the tank circuit should be many times the output energy provided to the load during each cycle. If the components are too small, the
tank circuit will be incapable of supplying the required output power. The inductance and capacitance values can be determined in terms of the energy stored. However, suitable values can also be calculated by simply selecting
the impedance of L and C as very much smaller than the load resistance. Example 19-26 demonstrates this.
Example 19-26 The class C amplifier in Fig. 19-66 has a 1 MHz signal frequency. Determine suitable tank circuit component values. Also, calculate the required transistor peak current if the conduction angle is 100°. Assume Vcr (at) = 0.5 V. ot Vec 30 V
Figure 19-66 Class C 19-26 and 19-27.
Solution Xc= XL
K
‘Cathode 6 K
(a) SCR 4-layer construction
Figure 20-1
OK
(b) SCR circuit
(c) Two-transistor
symbol
construction
(d) Two-transistor equivalent circuit
The silicon-controlled rectifier (SCR) is a four-layer device that can be
explained in terms of a two-transistor equivalent circuit.
Chapter 20
Thyristors
895
possible to think of pi, Ma, Poa as a pnp transistor, and 1p, P2b, M2 as an npn
transistor. Replacing the transistor block representations in Fig. 20-lc with the pnp and npn BJT circuit symbols gives the two-transistor equivalent circuit in Fig. 20-1d. It is seen that the Q, collector is connected to the Q2 base, and
the Q» collector is commoned with the Q; base. The Q; emitter is the SCR anode terminal, the Q2 emitter is the cathode, and the junction of the Q;
collector and the Q> base is the SCR gate terminal. To forward-bias an SCR, a voltage (Vax) is applied positive on the anode (A) and negative on the cathode (K), as shown in Fig. 20-2a. If the gate (G) is
left unconnected, only small leakage currents (Ico) flow, and both transistors remain off. Figure 20-1a shows that the leakage currents are the result of junction Jz being reverse biased when A is positive and K is negative.
When
a negative gate-cathode voltage (—Vc) is applied, the Q2 base-
emitter junction is reverse biased, and only small leakage currents continue to flow, so both Q; and Q» remain off. A positive gate-cathode voltage
forward-biases the Q, base-emitter junction, causing a gate current (Ic = [p2) collector current (Ic). (See Fig. 20-2b.) Because Ic;
to flow and producing a Q
is the same as Ipi, Q; also switches on and Ic; starts to flow, providing base
current Ip. Each collector current provides much more base current than needed by the transistors, and even when Ic is switched off, the transistors remain on, conducting heavily with only a small anode-to-cathode voltage
drop. The ability of the removed is referred to as To switch the SCR on, switched on, the gate has
SCR to remain on when the triggering current is latching. only a brief pulse of gate current is required. Once no further control and the device remains on until
Vax is reduced to near zero.
+
y
of
Hie
Ico G om
7 Vax
7 Q
J K
(a) Leakage current when the gate is open-circuited
(b) Gate current triggers the SCR on
Figure 20-2 When the SCR gate current is zero, the device normally remains off. The flow of gate current (Ig) triggers the SCR on.
g96
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Consider Fig. 20-la again. With a forward (anode-to-cathode) bias, junctions J, and J3 are forward-biased, while Jz is reverse biased. When Vx is
made large enough, J2 will break down and the resulting current flow across the junction constitutes collector current in each transistor. Each collector
current flows into the base of the other transistor, causing both transistors to switch on. Thus, the SCR can be triggered on with the gate open-circuited.
SCR Characteristics and Parameters Figure 20-3a shows an SCR with a reverse-bias anode-to-cathode voltage (—Vax) (negative on A, positive on K). Note that the gate terminal is opencircuited. Figure 20-3b shows that the reverse bias voltage causes junction J> to be forward biased and J; and J3 to be reverse -biased. When — Vax is small, a reverse leakage current (Ipx) flows. This is plotted as the reverse characteristic
(—Vax versus Ip) on Fig. 20-3c. IRx is typically around 100 pA, and is sometimes referred to as the reverse blocking current. When —Vax is increased, Ipx remains approximately constant until the reverse breakdown voltage is reached. At this point the reverse-biased junctions (J; and J3) break down and the reverse current (Ip) increases very rapidly. If Ip is not limited (by additional circuit components), the device will
be destroyed by excessive current flow. The region of the reverse characteristics before breakdown is termed the reverse blocking region. An SCR with a forward-bias anode-to-cathode voltage (positive on A,
negative on K) is shown in Fig. 20-4a. Here again, the gate terminal is opencircuited. As illustrated in Fig. 20-4b, +Vax forward-biases J, and J3 and
reverse-biases J2. With low levels of +Vax, a small forward leakage current (Ipx) flows. This is actually the reverse leakage current at junction Jz, and so (like Ipx), it is typically around 100 pA. Also like Ipx, zx remains substantially Reverse breakdown
voltage AQ-
—Vax
““+— Jy forwardbiased
=|
.~—J3 reversebiased
(a) Reverse-bias
(b) Junction bias polarity
(c) SCR reverse characteristic
Figure 20-3. When Vax is negative, Jz is forward biased, and J, and Js are reverse biased. A small reverse leakage current flows while —Vax is less than the breakdown voltage.
Chapter 20
_—iThyristors
897
. Py
4:
ees)
mt; A
Gor
pr
+—J, forward-
|
+——
biased Jo reverse-
biased _~—J3 forward-
. No
y
biased
K
(a) Forward-bias
Figure 20-4
FX
VE Ko-
4
f
;
+
+Vax
=
G
+— +
_
|
—_(b) Junction bias polarity
Forward breakover voltage
(c) SCR forward characteristic
When Vax is positive, J. is reverse-biased and J, and Jz are forward-biased.
A small forward leakage current flows while +Vax is less than the forward breakover
voltage.
constant until +Vax is made large enough to cause (reverse biased) Jz to break down. The applied voltage at this point is termed the forward breakover voltage (Vp@o)). This is illustrated by the forward characteristics (Ip versus +Vax) in Fig. 20-4c. When Vygo) is reached, the component transistors (Q; and Q)) are immediately switched on into saturation as already explained, and the anode-to-cathode voltage falls rapidly to the
forward conduction voltage Vg. The device is now into the forward conduction region, and Ip must be limited to protect the SCR from excessive current levels. So far, the SCR forward characteristics have been discussed only for the case of Ig = 0. Now consider the effect of Ig levels greater than zero
(Fig. 20-5a). As already shown, when + Vax is less than Veo) and Ig is zero,
a small leakage current flows. This current is too small to have any effect on the level of +V,x that causes SCR switch on. When Ic is made just slightly larger than the junction leakage currents, it still has a negligible effect on the level of +Vx for switch-on. Now consider the opposite extreme. When Ic is made larger than the minimum base current required to switch Q, on, the SCR switches on when + Vax forward-biases the base-emitter junctions of Q; and Q» (Figs 20-5b and 20-6).
The complete forward characteristics for an SCR are shown in Fig. 20-6.
Note that when Ig = Ica, switch-on occurs with + Vax at a relatively low level (V4). Gate currents between Ico and Ica permit device switch on at voltages
greater than V4 and less than Vrgo). The region of the forward characteristics
g98
Electronic Devices and Circuits
(a) SCR with gate current Figure 20-5
(b) SCR voltage drops when on
A gate current (Ig) can cause the SCR to switch on at a low Vax level. Forward
conduction region
pee
eg
A
faa pad Soop eg
be
i
To
’
ese aa
|
ly Wy |
a
Forward blocking region
|
+Vax
—_—_—>
f
f |
v;
VE(Bo) Figure 20-6
Forward characteristics for an SCR. Higher levels of gate current (Ig) cause
the SCR to conduct at lower anode-to-cathode voltages (+Vax). before switch-on is known as the forward blocking region, and the region after switch-on is termed the forward conduction region, as illustrated. In the forward conduction region, the SCR behaves as a forward-biased rectifier. The forward (anode-to-cathode) voltage (Vp) when the device is on is
typically 1.7 V. To switch an SCR off, the forward current (Ip) must be reduced below the holding current (I;3) (see Fig. 20-6). The holding current is the minimum level of Iz that maintains SCR ‘conduction: If'a gate current greater than zero is maintained while the SCR is on, lower levels of holding current (I¢41, [y2, etc.)
are possible.
Chapter 20
__siThyristors
899
SCR Specification As in the case of most electronic devices, the SCR maximum
voltage and
current are important for any given application. The forward breakover voltage and reverse breakdown voltage have already been discussed. The maximum forward voltage that may be applied without causing the SCR to
conduct is termed the forward blocking voltage (Vprm). Similarly, the maximum reverse voltage that may be applied is the reverse blocking voltage (Vrrm)-
The maximum SCR current is variously specified as the average current (Iqcavy), the rms current (Iq¢amsy), and the peak non-repetitive surge current (Its). The first two of these need no explanation. The third is a relatively large
current that can normally be permitted to flow for a maximum of a half-cycle of a 60 Hz sine wave. The circuit fusing rating (/’t) is another parameter that defines the maximum non-repetitive forward current. This can be used to
calculate the maximum duration of a given forward current surge. In many circuit applications the SCR current is limited by a series-connected load, so
there is usually no need to consider surge-current levels, except in the case of capacitive loads. Some of the range of available SCRs is illustrated by the partial specifications and packages shown in Fig. 20-7. With 800 mA rms current and 2N5060
2N6396
30 V
200 V
960 V
0.8A
12A
35 A
Forward on voltage (Vm)
1.7V
L7'V
2V
Holding current (I) Gate trigger current (Icr)
5mA 200 pA
6mA 12mA
100 mA 6mA
0.8 V
0.9 V
3V
5V
5V
5V
' Peak forward and reverse voltage
C35N
- (Vprm and Ver) “Maximum rms current (It(Rms))
Gate trigger voltage (Vcr) Gate reverse voltage (Vcrm)
2N6396 (TO-220)
2N5060 (TO-92)
Figure 20-7
Partial specifications and packages for three SCRs for different voltage and
current levels.
gG0
Electronic Devices and Circuits
30 V forward and reverse blocking voltage, the 2N5060 is a relatively low-
current, low-voltage device. This is packaged in the typical plastic TO-92 transistor-type enclosure. Note that the peak reverse gate voltage (VcrM) is 5 V. The 2N6396 SCR is capable of handling a maximum rms current of 12 A, and has forward and reverse blocking voltage of 200 V. The package is a TO-220 plastic enclosure with a metal tab for mounting on a heat sink. For the C35N, the peak forward and reverse voltage is 960 V, and maximum rms current is
35 A. The device package is designed for bolt-mounting to a heat sink.
Section 20-1 Review 20-1. 1 Sketch the four-layer construction of an SCR and the two-transistor equivalent circuit. Explain the device operation. 20-1.2 Sketch SCR forward and reverse characteristics. Briefly explain.
20-2
SCR CONTROL CIRCUITS
Pulse Control The simplest of SCR control circuits is shown in Fig. 20-8a. If SCR; were an ordinary rectifier, the ac supply voltage would be half-wave-rectified and only the positive half-cycles would appear across the load (R,). The same would be true if the SCR gate had a continuous bias voltage to keep it on when the anode-cathode voltage goes positive. A trigger pulse applied to the gate can switch the device on at any time during the positive half-cycle of the supply voltage. The SCR continues to conduct during the rest of the positive half-cycle, and then it switches off when the instantaneous level of the supply approaches zero. The resulting load waveform is a portion of the positive half-cycle starting at the instant that the SCR is triggered (Fig. 20-8b).
| | )
even
Trigger pulse
| |
|
I
| _ Load waveform
|
| ihe
Trigger | |
on
Vo
pulse
off
jon
lake Fe eon
angle (a) SCR pulse control circuit Figure 20-8
(b) Circuit waveforms
An SCR can be triggered on by a pulse applied to the gate. Once triggered,
the device remains on until the load current falls below the holding current.
Chapter 20‘
Resistor Rg holds the gate-cathode voltage at zero when no trigger input is present. Load
waveforms
being switched
that result from
0° 90°180°
Thyristors
901
—0”_-90°180°
rrr ott tt
the SCR
on at different points
in the
positive half-cycle of the supply voltage are shown in Fig. 20-9. It is seen that the average load
current
is
determined
by
the
SCR
conduction angle. Thus, the load power dissipation can be varied by adjusting the SCR switch-on point. It should be noted that the
ee
ee
SCR cannot be triggered precisely at the 0° Ns rneili 5th thea y controlling point in the waveform because the anode-toconduction angle. cathode voltage must be at least equal to the forward on voltage (V7) for the device. Also, the SCR will switch off before the 180° point when the load current falls below the holding current. The instantaneous level of the load voltage is the instantaneous supply
voltage (és) minus the SCR forward voltage (V7): Vi
= Ge =
Vu
(20-1)
The load current (I,) can be calculated from V;, and R,, and the SCR anode current (Ia) is, of course, the same as the load current. At the instant of triggering, the device cathode current (Ix) is actually the sum of the gate current (Ic) and the anode current. However, Ic is very much smaller than Ia, so the SCR anode and cathode currents can be assumed to be the same quantity, just as in the case of a diode. The instantaneous supply voltage (¢.(0)) that causes the SCR to switch off
can be determined from Vry, Rt, and the holding current: eso) = Vim + UpRt)
(20-2)
For any given application, the SCR selected must have forward and reverse blocking voltages greater than the peak supply voltage. Its specified
maximum rms current must also be greater than the rms load current. When
designing the circuit, the gate current used should be at least three times the Ig specified for the device. Note that the required triggering current (I7) for
the circuit in Fig. 20-8 is the sum of Ig and the resistor current Ipc, as
illustrated.
go02
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Example 20-1 Select a suitable SCR for the circuit in Fig. 20-8a if the rms supply voltage is 24 V and the load resistance is 25 ©. Calculate the instantaneous supply voltage that causes the SCR to switch off.
Solution Peak supply voltage:
Vapk) = 1.414 X V, = 1.414 x 25V = 33.9 V SCR forward and reverse blocking voltage: Vprm & Vero > 33.9 V Reference to the partial specification for the 2N5060 to 2N5064 range of SCRs in Fig. 20-10 shows that the 2N5060 has Vprm = 30 V and the 2N5061 has Vprm = 60 V. So the 2N5060 would
not be suitable, whereas
the 2N5061
would seem to be a suitable device.
Vspk) — Vim
33.9V -1.7V
Tip) = Ri = 4.29.4 i ENED
~
te ANOS
ie
\
/2N5061 “-2N5062 ~
TD
I
" Maximum mms curren
OO
‘\Forward-on voltage Vand)
a ae
Holding current (In)
ae
ee a Figure 20-10
ST”.
agus)
2N5063. IN5004
200 V
lke oe
17V
ai
“5mA Pedecalbyers
For a half-wave rectified sinusoidal waveform,
So, the 2N5061 is a suitable SCR.
150 V
0.8A
Partial specification for 2N5060 to 2N5064 SCRs.
The 2N5061 has Iryms) = 0.8 A.
~
ee
BS
= 0.64A
60V 00'V
bo Bape
ae
Tams) = 0.5 Tip)
30 V
ont060 "|"
vee
7
25 0
= 0.5
129A
200 pA
Chapter 20
903
_‘Thyristors
Switch-off voltage:
From Eq. 20-2,
eso) = Vim + (In X Rt)
=17V+(5mA X25) 1.8V
90° Phase Control In the 90° phase-control circuit shown in Fig. 20-11, the gate triggering voltage is derived from the ac supply via resistors R,, R2, and R3. When the moving contact is set to the top of R2, the SCR can be triggered on almost immediately
at the beginning of the positive half-cycle of the input. When the moving contact is set to the bottom of R», the SCR might not switch on until the peak of the positive half-cycle. Between these two extremes, the device can be
switched on somewhere between the zero level and the peak of the positive half-cycle (between 0° and 90°). If the triggering voltage (Vr) is not large
enough to trigger the SCR at 90°, then the device will not trigger on at all, because Vr is greatest at the supply voltage peak and falls off past the peak. Diode D, in Fig. 20-11 is included in the circuit to protect the SCR gate from the negative voltage that would otherwise be applied to it during the negative half-cycle of the ac supply. The load for an SCR phase-control circuit could be a permanent magnet motor, so that the circuit controls the motor speed. Or the load may be a heater or a light, and in this case the circuit controls the heater temperature or the light intensity. The voltage divider (R; R R3) in Fig. 20-11 is designed in the usual way for
the required range of adjustment of Vr. The voltage-divider current (Ij) is selected much larger than the SCR gate current. The instantaneous triggering voltage at switch-on is , Vr
a
Vo1
2
Ve
(20-3)
ac voltage @ source
= (a) 90° phase-control circuit Figure 20-11
be
Control
Control
range
range
(b) Circuit waveforms
SCR 90° phase-control circuit. The SCR can be triggered on anywhere
between 0° and 90°.
g04
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Figure 20-12 shows a 90° phase-control circuit with its ac voltage source full-wave-rectified. This gives a larger maximum
power dissipation in the
load than a non-rectified source. Diode D; in Fig. 20-11 is not required in
Fig. 20-12 because the SCR gate does not become reverse-biased. Ry
SCR,
0°
90°
II
Ro
Z|T |
|
Ry
Ry
0° a
90°
!
|
yf
0°
mr ! | bw |
90° |
I \
a Control
| (a) 90° phase-control circuit with
range (b) Circuit waveforms
full-wave-rectified supply Figure 20-12
SCR 90° phase-control circuit with a full-wave-rectified supply.
In the circuit in Fig. 20-13a, the two SCRs are connected in inverse parallel and they operate independently as 90° phase-control circuits. SCR; controls the load current during the positive half-cycle of the supply voltage, and SCR, controls the current during the negative half-cycle. The triggering voltage for each SCR is set by the voltage divider network R; to Rg and adjusted by variable resistor R3. Diodes D; and D2 protect the gate terminals
of each SCR from excessive reverse voltage. During the supply voltage positive half-cycle, D2 is forward-biased and current flows through R2, Rs, and Ry. The voltage drop across Ry, triggers SCR; at the desired point in the positive half-cycle. When triggered, the SCR forward voltage switches to a low level and remains there until the instantaneous supply voltage approaches zero. During the supply negative half-cycle, D; is forward-biased to produce current flow through Ri, R2, and R3. With R, equal to Ry, the voltage drop across R; triggers SCR; at the same 0°
90°
180° 270° 360° |
voltage
(a) 90° full-wave phase-control circuit
Figure.20-13 SCRs.
(b) Load current waveform
90° full-wave phase-control circuit using two inverse-parallel connected
Chapter 20
point
in
the
negative
half-cycle
as
SCR;
in
the
Thyristors
positive
905
half-cycle.
The resulting 90° full-wave phase-controlled load waveform is shown in
Fig. 20-13b.
Example 20-2 The SCR in Fig. 20-14 is to be triggered on between 5° and 90° during the positive half-cycle of the 30 V supply. The gate triggering current and voltage
are 200 A and 0.8 V. Determine suitable resistance values for Ri, Rz, and Rs.
Ry 30 V Ay)
fh
SCR,
Ry
Figure 20-14
Rs
SCR 90° phase-control
circuit for Ex. 20-2.
Solution Peak supply voltage:
Veipk) = 1.414 X V, = 1.414 x 30 V =424V At5®,
es = Vek) Sin 5° = 42.4 V sin 5° =3.7V
At 90°, Eq.
20-3:
és = Vr
V s(pk) = 42.4V
= Vpi
+
Vg
= 0.7V
+ 0.8 V
=15V
To trigger at e, = 3.7 V, the Rz moving contact is at the top. So and
Vro + Vrx3 = Vr = 15 Vv Va
=@-
VrRa3s7V-15V
=22V Timin) =
Select
(Ig = 200 pA)
Timin) = 1 mA
906
Electronic Devices and Circuits
= 2.2 kO, (standard value)
Rp + Ry == = 190 1
1mA
= 15kO
To trigger at e, = 42.4 V, the R2 moving contact is at the bottom. So
Vre3 = Vr =15V
anil
i, =
é, R,
_
+ Ro
+ Rg
4A24V 2.2kQ0
4+ 1.5kO,
¥11.5mA
|
Vr
LSV
I;
11.5 mA
= 1300
(use 120 0 standard value)
Rp= (Ro + R3) — R3= 1.5kO — 120 © = 138k
(use 1.5 kO, standard value potentiometer)
Example 20-3 Analyze the circuit designed in Ex. 20-2 to determine the SCR anode-cathode
voltage at the instant of switch-on when the moving contact of potentiometer R is set to (a) its centre position and (b) its zero (bottom) position. Solution (a) With R2 contact at centre: ' The SCR will trigger when Vy = 1.5 V.
y= Vr (Rit Rp +Rs) _ 15 V2.2 kO+1.5k0 + 120 0) AK R3 + 0.5Ry 8700 =6.6V (a) With R2 contact at zero:
vy,
- Va (Ri+Ro+Rs) _ 1.5 V(2.2kO +1.5k0 + 120 0) = R, 1200 = 47.85 V
Because the peak supply voltage is 42.4 V, the SCR will not trigger with Rz at the zero position.
Chapter 20 0°
)
0°
| range ja
:
180°
‘Control |
| Control
SCR, R
180°
907
Thyristors
!
range |
|
voltage source
(b) Circuit waveforms
(a) 180° phase-control circuit
Figure 20-15
SCR 180° phase-control circuit. R; adjustment allows the SCR triggering
point to be set anywhere between 0° and 180” in the positive half-cycle of the ac supply
voltage.
180° Phase Control In the circuit shown in Fig. 20-15, resistor R, and capacitor C; determine the point in the supply voltage cycle where the SCR switches on. During the negative half-cycle of the supply, C; is charged via diode D; to the negative
peak of the supply voltage. When the negative peak is passed, Dj is reversebiased because its anode (connected to C;) is more negative than its cathode. With D; reversed, C; begins to discharge via R;. While C; voltage remains
negative, D2 is reverse-biased and the gate voltage cannot go positive to trigger the SCR on. Depending on the values of C; and R;, the capacitor might
be completely discharged at the beginning of the positive half-cycle of the supply, allowing SCR, to switch on. Alternatively, C; might retain some negative charge past the end of positive half-cycle, keeping SCR; off. Resistor Ro is included in the circuit to restrict the level of the gate current.
Designing the 180° phase-control circuit can begin with selection of a capacitor much larger than stray capacitance. A maximum resistance for R; should then be calculated to discharge the capacitor voltage to zero during the time from the negative peak of the supply voltage to the 180°
point
in
the
positive
half-cycle.
The
capacitor voltage does not decrease linearly as Fig. 20-16 implies. However, the maximum resistance for R; can be most easily calculated
by assuming a linear discharge. The average value
of the discharging voltage
(E) is first
determined. Figure 20-16 shows that E is —0.636V 4px) for 0.25T, and +0.636Vs(pk) for 0.5T, which averages out to approximately 0.2V.(px) for the total discharge time of 0.75T.
Kigame 20-46 ‘Diech times and Sotteoe ate the circuit in Fig. 20-15.
on
908
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Now the equation for discharge of a capacitor to zero volts via a resistor may
be applied:
t = RC In [(E — Eo)/E] Substituting the appropriate quantities into the equation gives
Kw OEE PUT ERG
(20-4)
Practice Problems’ 20-2-1 ‘The 90° phase-control circuit in Fig. 20-11 has a 115 V, 60 Hz supply, arid Ry = 50'(. Specify the required SCR, and calculate suitable resiStor values for switch on between 7° and 90°.
20-2.2 The 180° phase-control circuit in Fig. 20-15 has a 50 V, 60 Hz supply, and the SCR has Ve.= 0.5 V and Ig= 100 pA. Determine suitable _ values for Ry and C. Calculate a resistance for R2 to limit the gate
current to a maximum of 50. mA. 20-3
MORE
SCR APPLICATIONS
SCR Circuit Stability: An SCR circuit is stable when it operates correctly, switching on and off only
at the desired instants. Unwanted triggering (also called false triggering) can be produced by noise voltages at the gate, transient voltages at the anode terminal, or very fast voltage changes at the anode (termed dv/dt triggering). Obviously, gate noise voltages may be large enough to forward-bias the gate-cathode junction and cause false triggering. Anode voltage transients (produced by other devices connected to the same ac supply) can exceed the SCR breakover voltage and thus trigger it into conduction. The dv/dt effect
occurs when the anode voltage changes instantaneously, such as when the supply is switched on at its peak voltage level. The SCR capacitance is charged very quickly, and the charging current is sufficient to trigger the device. Gate noise problems can be minimized by keeping the gate connecting
leads short and by the use of a gate bias resistor (Rg in Fig. 20-17a). This should be connected as closely as possible to the SCR gate-cathode terminals, because conductors connected between Rg and the device could pick up noise that may cause triggering. Biasing the gate negative with respect to the
cathode can also be effective in combating noise. Capacitor C; in Fig. 20-17b can be used to short-circuit gate noise voltages. C, also operates in conjunction with the anode-gate capacitance as a voltage divider that
Thyristors
Chapter 20
r)
10 kQ
0.1 wF
|
C | 0.1 LF
¥)
309
Cy
ge
i
r “S (a) Gate resistor
Figure 20-17
Ry = (b) Gate capacitor
Ry (c) Snubber circuit
Unwanted gate noise triggering can be prevented by Rg or C; at the gate-
cathode terminals. The use of a snubber circuit prevents triggering by transients at ihe anode terminal.
reduces the possibility of dv/dt triggering. C; is usually in the 0.01 LF to 0.1 pF range, a. d like Rg, it should be connected close to the SCR terminals.
An RC snubber circuit can be used to prevent triggering by anode terminal transients (Fig. 20-17c). A snubber is usually necessary for inductive loads
and may also be required for resistive loads. With an ac supply, there is a phase difference between an inductive load current and the supply voltage, and this can cause loss of SCR control. Also, the current through an inductor
with a de supply will not go to zero immediately when the SCR switches off. A snubber circuit is necessary in both cases.
Zero-Point Triggering When an SCR is switched on while the instantaneous level of the supply voltage is greater than zero, surge currents occur that generate electromagnetic interference (EMI). The EMI can interfere with other nearby circuits and equipment, and the switching transients can affect control of the SCR. Circuits can be designed to trigger an SCR on at the instant the ac supply is crossing the zero voltage point from the negative half-cycle to the positive half-cycle. This is called zero-point triggering, and it effectively eliminates the
EMI and the switching transients. The zero-point triggering circuit in Fig. 20-18a shows two inverse-parallel connected SCRs that each have RC triggering circuits: C, and R, for SCR, and Cy and R>2 for SCR2. SCR; is held off while switch S; is closed, and because
capacitor C2 is uncharged, SCR: remains off. With S; open, positive triggering current (Ic1) begins to flow when the supply voltage begins to go positive. As illustrated, Ig; flows via C; and R; to the gate of SCR),
triggering it into
conduction at the zero-crossing point. SCR; provides a path for (positive) load current (i, +).
910.
Electronic Devices and Circuits
circuit
(a) Zero-point —
. AD AD D DA NA CA WYODOODGUSGGSG \
GS
|
SCRs on S; open
|
1D »
» >
|Load waveform |
SCRs off 5S; closed
SCRs on S; open
SCRs off S, closed
(b) Circuit waveforms Figure 20-18
In.an SCR zero-point triggering circuit the devices
are switched on only when the supply waveform crosses the zero-voltage point.
With SCR; on, capacitor C2 charges (with the polarity shown) almost to the
peak of the supply voltage. When the supply voltage crosses zero from the positive half-cycle to the negative half-cycle, SCR; switches off. D; becomes reverse-biased,
and
the charge
on
C; provides
triggering
current
(Ic)
to
SCR2. Thus, SCR, is switched on at the start of the supply negative half-cycle, providing a path for (negative) load current (i,-). Both SCRs continue to switch on and off at the zero-crossing points while
S; remains open, and both stay off when S; is closed. SCR cannot switch on unless
SCR,
has
first been
on,
and
because
of this
the
arrangement
is
sometimes termed a master-slave circuit, SCR; being the master and SCR; the
slave. The waveforms in Fig. 20-18b show that power is supplied to the load for several cycles of the supply
while
S; is open,
dissipation occurs for several cycles while S; remains
and
no
closed.
load power The
switch
might be controlled by a temperature sensor or other device.
Crowbar Circuit A crowbar circuit (also known as an overvoltage protection circuit) is illustrated in Fig. 20-19. This circuit protects a sensitive load against an excessive dc
supply voltage. When the supply (Vs) is at its normal voltage level, it is too
Chapter 20
Thyristors
9114
Currentlimited
Load
sees source
Figure 20-19
An SCR crowbar
circuit (or overvoltage protection circuit) short-circuits the load when the supply voltage exceeds a pre-determined level.
—
low to cause the Zener diode (Dj) to conduct. Consequently, there is no current through the gate bias resistor (R;) and no voltage drop across R;. The gate voltage (Vg) remains equal to zero, and the SCR remains off. When
the
supply voltage exceeds Vz, D; conducts, and the resultant voltage drop across R; triggers the SCR into conduction. The voltage across the load is
now reduced to the SCR forward voltage drop. The voltage across Vz and R, is also reduced to the SCR forward voltage, and the dc voltage source is
short-circuited by the SCR. The voltage source must have a current-limiting circuit to protect the source and to minimize SCR power dissipation. The supply must be switched off for the SCR to cease conducting.
Example 20-4 The de voltage source in the SCR crowbar circuit in Fig. 20-19 has Vs = 5 V and Itmnax) = 300 mA. The load voltage is not to exceed 7 V. Select suitable
components for D; and Rj, and specify the SCR. Assume that Vc = 0.8 V. Solution Vz = Vigmaxy — Vo = 7 V — 0.8V =62V For Dy, select a 1N753 with Vz = 6.2 V
Select
Iz7(min) = 1 mA
a = WGIz = O8V 1mA = 800 © (use 820 © standard value)
SCR specification: Vorm > 7 V, Itjav) > 300 mA
Heater Control Circuit The circuit in Fig. 20-20 uses a temperature-sensitive control element (R2).
The resistance of R2 decreases when the temperature increases, and increases
912
Electronic Devices and-Circuits
Heater =
Temperature sensitive device
3
4 ey,
SCR,
Figure 20-20
SCR heater
control circuit. The SCR is triggered on when the temperature is below a specified level and held off
2
when the temperature is satisfactory.
when
the temperature falls. Diode D; keeps capacitor C; charged
to the
supply voltage peak, and C; together with resistor R; behaves as a constanteurrent source for Ro. When R; is raised to the desired temperature, Vg drops
to a level that keeps the SCR from triggering. When the temperature drops, the resistance of R2 increases, causing Vg to increase to the SCR triggering
level. The result is that the load power is turned off when
the desired
temperature is reached, and turned on again when the temperature falls to a
predetermined level. Rectifier D. might be included, as illustrated, to pass the negative half-cycle of the supply waveform to the load.
Practice Problem 20-3.1 The SCRin the circuit in Fig. 20-20 triggers when Vg is 0.8 V or higher, but..will not trigger when Vg is 0.6 V. The temperature-sensing -element (R>) has a resistance of 400 0 at 95°C and 300 © at 100°C.
. Determine suitable values for R; and C; that will trigger the SCR at
95°C and leave it untriggered at 100°C. 20-4
TRIAC AND DIAC
TRIAC Operation and Characteristics The basic construction, equivalent circuit, and graphic symbol for a TRIAC are shown in Fig. 20-21. The TRIAC behaves as two inverse-parallel connected SCRs with a single gate terminal. Sections 11, p2, 13, and p3 in Fig.
20-21a form one SCR that can be represented by transistors Q; and Q> in Fig. 20-21b. Similarly,
Pir Ny Pr, and
n4 form
another
SCR
with
the transistor
equivalent circuit Q3 and Qy. Layer p2, common to the two SCRs, functions as a gate for both sections of the device. The two outer terminals cannot be identified as anode and cathode; instead they are designated main terminal 1 (MT1) and main terminal 2 (MT2), as illustrated. The TRIAC circuit symbol is composed of two inverse-parallel connected SCR symbols (Fig. 20-21c). When MT2 is positive with respect to MT1, transistors Q3 and Q, can be triggered on (Fig. 20-21b), In this case the current flow is from MT2 to MT1.
Thyristors
Chapter 20
913
MT2
MT1
O
O
MT1
MT]
(a) Basic TRIAC construction
Figure 20-21
(b) Equivalent circuit
(c) Circuit symbol
Basic construction, equivalent circuit, and graphic symbol for a TRIAC.
When MT1 is positive with respect to MT2, Q; and Q2 can be switched on. Now current flow is from MT1 to MT2. It is seen that the TRIAC can be made
to conduct in either direction. Regardless of the MT2/MT1 voltage polarity, the characteristics for the TRIAC are those of a forward-biased SCR. This is
illustrated by the typical TRIAC characteristics shown in Fig. 20-22.
Figure 20-22 TRIAC characteristics. These are similar to the characteristics of two inverse-parallel connected SCRs.
914
Electronic Devices and Circuits
TRIAC Triggering
The characteristics and circuit symbol in Fig. 20-22 show that when MT2 is positive with respect to MT1, the TRIAC can be triggered on by application of a positive gate voltage. Similarly, when MT2 is negative with respect to MT1, a negative gate voltage triggers the device into conduction. However, a negative gate voltage can also trigger the TRIAC when MT72 is positive, and
a positive gate voltage can trigger the device when MT72 is negative. Figure 20-23 shows the triggering conditions for a 2N6346, 8 A, 200 V TRIAC. The voltage polarity for MT2 is identified as MT2(+) or MT2(— ), and the gate polarity is listed as G(+) or G(—). From the first line of the specifications, it is seen that with MT2
positive, the device
gate triggering
voltage is +0.9 V minimum and +2 V maximum. From the second line, still
with MT2 positive, triggering can be produced by a negative gate voltage: —0.9 V to —2.5 V. The third line shows MT2 negative and the gate trigger voltage as —1.1 V to —2 V. Also, with MT2 negative (fourth line), triggering
can be effected by a positive gate voltage: +1.4 V to +2.5 V. 2N6346 TRIAC
Ver Min
Max
MT2(+), G(+)
0.9-V
MT2(+), G(—)
0.9V
2.5V
MT2(—), G(-)
PTY
2V
14V
25V
MT2(—), G(+)
“
2
;
Figure 20-23
.
Partial
specification showing the
triggering conditions fora
2N6346 TRIAC.
The TRIAC triggering conditions are further illustrated by the diagram in Fig. 20-24. The vertical line identifies MT2 as positive or negative, and the horizontal line shows the gate voltage as positive or negative. The TRIAC is
defined as operating in one of the four quadrants: I, II, III, or IV. In quadrant I, MT2 is positive, the gate voltage is positive, and current flow is from MT2
to MT1, as shown. When MT2 is positive and the device is triggered by a negative gate voltage, the TRIAC is operating in quadrant II. In this case, current flow is still from MT2 to MT1. Quadrant III operation occurs when
MT2
is negative and the gate voltage is negative. Current flow is now from
MT1 to MT2. In quadrant IV, MT2 is again negative, the gate voltage is positive, and current flow is from MT1 to MT2. Normally, a TRIAC is operated in either quadrant I or quadrant III. When this is the desired condition, it may be necessary to design the circuit to avoid quadrant II or quadrant IV triggering.
Chapter 20
_siThyristors
915
+
+
MT2 MT2
|r G
=
Ic -
6mm G
Quadrant II | Quadrant I
G
+
Quadrant III | Quadrant IV
© MT2
© MT2
(
oe
Ig
l
G
v i .
cout MT2
teen
Figure 20-24
Quadrant
diagram illustrating the
TRIAG four-quadrant
operating conditions.
The DIAC A DIAC is simply a low-current TRIAC without a gate terminal. Switch-on is effected by raising the applied voltage to the breakover voltage. Two different DIAC symbols in general use are shown in Fig. 20-25a, and typical DIAC characteristics are illustrated in Fig. 20-25b. Note that the terminals are
Ay
A2
(a) Two DIAC symbols
Figure 20-25
(b) DIAC characteristics
The DIAC is essentially a low-current TRIAC without a gate terminal.
916
Electronic Devices and Circuits
_ DIACs
a
Ws
|
Min
HS-10 |
ew
123
56V
Figure 20-26
labelled
|
Pp
Max
Tg
HS-60
Igmax)
400pA |
70 V
250mW
50 pA
250 mW
Partial specifications for two DIACs.
anode
2
(Az)
and
anode
1
(A,).
Figure
20-26
shows
partial
specifications for two DIACs. The HS-10 has a switching voltage that ranges from a minimum
of 8 V to a maximum
of 12 V. Switching current is a
maximum of 400 A. The HS-60 switching voltage is 56 V to 70 V, and maximum switching current is 50 wA. Both devices have a 250 mW power dissipation, and each is contained in a cylindrical low-current diode- type package. DIACs are most often applied in triggering circuits for SCRs and TRIACs.
Section 20-4 Review 20-4.1 Sketch the construction and transistor equivalent circuit of a TRIAC.
Explain the device operation.
20-4. 2. Sketch TRIAC characteristics. Briefly explain.
20-5 TRIAC CONTROL CIRCUITS TRIAC Phase-Control Circuit
A TRIAC circuit that allows approximately 180° of phase control is shown in Fig. 20-27a. The waveforms in Fig. 20-27b illustrate the circuit operation. With the TRIAC (Q)) off at the beginning of the supply voltage positive half-cycle, 0°
180°
0°
180°
| k
ey
ea .Qy conduction
~t
off
\
|
ton
|
angle
| \
(a) Phase-control circuit
(b) Circuit waveforms
Figure 20-27 TRIAC phase-control circuit and circuit waveforms. Q, is switched on when the capacitor charges to D; breakover voltage.
Chapter 20
Thyristors
917
capacitor C; is charged positively via resistors R; and Rz, as shown. When Vey reaches the DIAC switching voltage plus the Q, gate triggering voltage, D, conducts passing gate current to trigger Q, on. C; discharges until the
discharge current falls below the D; holding current level. The TRIAC switches off at the end of the supply positive half-cycle, and then the process is repeated during the supply negative half-cycle. The rate of charge of C; is set by variable resistor R,, so that the Q; conduction angle is controlled by
adjustment of Rj. Example 20-5 Estimate the smallest conduction angle for Q; for the circuit in Fig. 20-27a. The supply is 115 V, 60 Hz, and the components are R; = 25 KO, Ro = 2.7 kQ,
and C; = 3 pF. The D, breakover voltage is 8 V and Vg = 0.8 V for Qi. Solution At Q; switch-on,
Va
= Vp
+ Vo =8V
+08 V
= 8.8V Assume the average charging voltage is
E = 0.636 X Vacpk) = 0.636 X 1.414 x 115 V ~103 V
Average charging current,
_—
Ic ~
Ry + Rp
25kQO
ae
+ 2.7kO
3.7 mA tr =
Charging time:
a e
—
V
= 7.1ms
T=
Q; switch-on point:
; = aE
= 16.7 ms
t X 360°
7.1ms X 360°
aes
a
= 153° Gorduetion angle:
a=
180° —
= 180° — 153°
= 27°
TRIAC Zero-Point Switching Circuit The
TRIAC
zero-point switching circuit in Fig. 20-28a
produces
a load
waveform similar to that for the SCR zero-point circuit in Fig. 20-18. The load
918
Electronic Devices and Circuits
@
ac voltage source
D,
(b) With Q, on, Q, is held off Figure 20-28
Dz
(c) Ig flows when Q, is off
(d) Vc, triggers Q,
Zero-point switching circuit for a TRIAC. While Q; is on, Q2 cannot switch
on. With Q; off, Q2 starts to conduct at the beginning of the supply positive half-cycle.
power dissipation is controlled by switching the TRIAC on for several cycles of the supply voltage and off for several cycles, with switch-on occurring only at the negative-to-positive zero crossing point of the supply waveform, and switch-off taking place at the positive-to-negative zero point. Q, is a low-
current SCR that controls the switching point of Qo. With switch S; closed, Q, is on, and the Q, forward voltage drop is below the level required for triggering Q) (Va2 + Vp + Vp2) (see Fig. 20-28b). Thus, no gate current flows to Q2, and no conduction occurs. Q; switches off when Si is opened, so that Ic flows to Q2 gate via C1, Rx, Dy, and D> to trigger Q> into conduction (Fig. 20-28c). With Q, conducting, capacitor C2 is charged via D3
almost to the positive peak of the load voltage (Fig. 20-28d). The TRIAC switches off at the end of the positive half-cycle. Then, the charge on C2
(applied to the gate via D2) triggers Qo on again just after the zero-crossing point into the negative half-cycle. (It should be noted this is quadrant IV
triggering.)
Chapter 20
__‘Thyristors
919
The initial Q; switch-on occurs only at the beginning of the positive halfcycle of the supply voltage. If S, is opened during the supply positive halfcycle, Q; continues to conduct until the end of the half-cycle, thus keeping Q> off. With Qs off, C2 remains uncharged, and so it cannot trigger Q» on during the supply negative half-cycle. Q, triggering now occurs at the beginning of
the next positive cycle. If S; is opened during the supply negative half-cycle, Q2 cannot be triggered into conduction, again because of the lack of charge on Cp. It is seen that Q2 conduction can start only at the beginning of the positive half-cycle of the supply voltage. Once triggered, Q2 conduction continues until the end of
the cycle. To design the circuit in Fig. 20-28, the TRIAC is first selected to pass the
required load current and to survive the peak supply voltage. Resistor Rp is a low-resistance component calculated to limit the peak surge current to the Q> gate in the event that the peak supply voltage is applied to the circuit without
Q; being on. Capacitor C; has to supply triggering current (Ic) to Q2 at the zero crossing point of the supply waveform when Q; is off. Usually Ic2 is
chosen to be about three times the specified Ic¢¢max) for Qz, and C; is then calculated from the simple equation for capacitor charge: C = (J x #)/AV. In this case AV /t can be replaced by the rate of change of the supply voltage at the zero crossing point, which is 27 fV,. So the C; equation is
Cc,
Igo
=-=— Z 27fV>
(20-5)
Resistor R; can now be determined by using the selected gate current for Q» (Ig2) as the peak anode current for Q;: Ri = V,/Ic2. The Qi gate resistor (R3) is calculated from the Q; triggering current and the voltage of the dc source:
Ry
=
(E =
Vo1)/Ici.
The Q, gate current is again used in the calculation of Ry and C). To trigger
Q, at the start of the supply negative half-cycle, Ig. must flow from C) into the Q» gate; so Ry © V,p/Ic2. A suitable capacitance for Cz is now calculated by again using the simple capacitance equation C2 = (Ic2 X t)/AV. In this case, time t is selected much larger than the Q) turn-on time, and AV is
approximately 0.1 Vp. SCR Q; must pass the selected anode current (Ig2) and survive the peak supply voltage. The diodes must each survive the peak supply voltage and
pass the Q, triggering current.
The IC Zero Voltage Switch The functional block diagram for a typical integrated circuit TRIAC driver,
known as a zero voltage switch, is shown in Fig. 20-29. The device contains a voltage limiter and a dc power supply, so that it operates directly from the ac
920
Electronic Devices and Circuits
a
Wenger.
[
Bower
| limiter
| ‘supply
1
O°
|
Zero crossing detector
ac, source
TRIAC drive stage
7
On-off sensing
_jamplifier,
Figure 20-29
Functional block diagram for an integrated circuit zero voltage switch, or
TRIAG driver.
supply
to the load to be controlled. There is also a zero crossing detector
(see Section 14-9) that provides an output pulse each time the supply waveform crosses the zero level. The zero crossing detector output is fed to an AND gate (see Section 3-11), and the AND gate output goes to the TRIAC drive stage that produces the current pulse to the TRIAC
sensing amplifier is used
to sense the voltage level from
gate. An
on-off
an externally
connected transducer; for example, a temperature-sensing transducer would
be, used if the load is a heater. When the temperature drops to a predetermined level, the on-off sensing amplifier provides an input to the AND gate. The gate triggering pulse from the TRIAC drive stage occurs at the
supply zero-crossing points only when the temperature is below the desired level. The circuit load waveforms are similar to those shown in Fig. 20-18.
Practice Problem 20-5, A, Determine ‘suitable components for the TRIAC zero-point switching _. circuit in Fig. 20-28, given the following parameters: for Q,, Ig =
200 pA, Vr = 2 V; for Qo, Ic. = 30 mA, Icom = 1A, ton = 100 ps; E = 4... 6N;and ac source= 115 V,.60. Hz.
20-6
SUS, SBS, GTO, AND SIDAC
The SUS The silicon unilateral switch (SUS), also known as a four-layer diode and as % a Schokley diode, can be treated as a low-current SCR without a gate terminal.
Chapter 20
___Thyristors
921
SUS circuit symbol and Figure 20-30 forward characteristics.
Vs
20-30
Figure
the
shows
circuit
SUS
symbol
typical
and
forward
characteristics. The device tri ggers into conduction when a forward switching
voltage (Vs) is applied. At this point a minimum switching current (Is) must flow. The voltage falls to a forward conduction voltage (Vp) at switch-on, and conduction continues until the current level falls below the /iolding current
(Iq). The 2N4988 SUS has Vs ranging from 7.5 V to 9 V, Is = 150 pA, and ly
=
0.5 mA.
characteristics:
SUS a
reverse
very
small
characteristics reverse
are
current
similar flows
to SCR
reverse
the
reverse
until
breakdown voltage is reached.
The SBS It is convenient to think of a silicon bilateral switch (SBS) as two SUS with a
gate terminal, or as a low-current TRIAC. However, the SBS is not simply another four-layer device. Silicon bilateral switches are actually integrated circuits
constructed
of
matched
transistors,
diodes,
and
resistors.
This
produces better parameter stability than is possible with four-layer devices.
The SBS equivalent circuit in Fig. 20-31a is similar to the TRIAC equivalent circuit with the addition of resistors Ry and R2 and Zener diodes D; and D>.
The device circuit symbol in Fig. 20-31b is seen to be composed of inverseparallel connected SUS symbols with a gate terminal added. Note that the terminals are referred to as anode 1 (A1), anode 2 (Az), and gate (G). The typical
SBS characteristics shown in Fig. 20-31c are essentially the same shape as TRIAC characteristics. Returning to the equivalent circuit, the SBS switches on when a positive AjA: voltage is large enough to cause D2 to break down. This produces base current in Qy;, resulting ina Qi collector current that switches Q> on. Similarly,
a negative A;A2 voltage causes D, to break down, producing base current in Q, that turns Qs and Qs on. The switching voltage is the sum of the Zener diode voltage and the transistor base-emitter voltage (Vs = Vz + Vpr). The
922
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Ay
G
OA,
As
(a) Equivalent circuit
(b) Symbol
+I
Vig
—s| Ten
Vso
——-v nee
Fie
—_—
7 _
ih. ae p--L_j- ta
Jv wr
T
Dinas
~hL
Igo
[oo
|
apseb
+V—>-
T
t
>
I
Vs
Vp2
=]
’ (c) Characteristics
Figure 20-31 Equivalent circuit, symbol, and characteristics for the silicon bilateral switch (SBS).
Zener diode has a positive temperature coefficient (TC) and the transistor base-
emitter voltage has a negative TC. This results in a very small TC for the SBS switching voltage.
The partial specification for a MBS4991 SBS in Fig. 20-32 shows a switching voltage that ranges from 6 V to 10 V. Note also that the switching
Chapter 20 MBS4991
Switching voltage (Vs)
Min
Typ
Max
6V
8V
10 V
175 pA 0.3 V
500 pA 0.5 V
14V
100 pA 100 pA 1.7V
Switching current differential Gate trigger current (Icp) Forward-on voltage (Vp) Partial specification for the MBS4991
silicon bilateral switch.
voltage differential (the difference between the switching voltages in opposite directions) (Vs; — Vs2), is 0.5 V maximum. The maximum switching current is a 500 wA, and the differential (Is, — Isz) is 100 pA.
923
SBS
Switching current (Is) Switching voltage differential
Figure 20-32
_Thyristors
switching
current
SBS devices are frequently used with the gate
D
open-circuited, so that they simply break down to
the forward voltage drop when the applied voltage increases
to
the
switching
voltage
level.
The
switching voltage can be reduced by connecting Zener diodes with Vz lower than 6.8 V between the gate and the anodes, as shown in Fig. 20-33a. The
(a) Vg modification by external Zeners
new switching voltage is approximately (Vz + 0.7 V).
The switching voltage can also be modified by the use of external
resistors
(Fig. 20-33b).
Taking the
gate current into account, it can be shown that the two 22 kO resistors reduce Vs to approximately
D
3.6 V. The use of an SBS in a TRIAC phase-control circuit is illustrated in Fig. 20-34. This is essentially the same as the circuit using a DIAC in Fig. 20-27.
The SBS turns on and triggers the TRIAC when the capacitor voltage equals the SBS switching voltage plus the TRIAC gate triggering voltage.
For an SBS to switch on, the total resistance
(b) Vs modification by external resistors
Figure 20-33 The switching voltage for an SBS can be modified by externally connected Zener diodes or
resistors. in series with it must have a maximum value that allows the switching current to flow. If the resistance is so large that it restricts the current to a level below the SBS
switching current, the device will not switch on. The series resistance must
not be so small that it allows the holding current to flow when the SBS is supposed to switch off. These restrictions also apply to SCRs, TRIACs,
924
@)
Electronic Devices and Circuits
ac voltage
Ry
source
R, Figure 20-34
Use of an SBS in a TRIAC phase-
control circuit. The TRIAC
oe
is triggered by the
current surge when the SBS switches on.
DIACs, and other similar switching devices. Switch-off is usually no problem in thyristor circuits with ac supplies, because the devices normally switch off when the instantaneous supply voltage reduces to zero. With de supplies, more care must be taken with resistor sizes. Figure 20-35 shows a simple circuit that requires careful design to ensure
that the SBS switches on and off as required. The circuit is a relaxation oscillator that produces an exponential output waveform, as illustrated. Capacitor C, is charged via resistor R,; from the de supply voltage (E). When the capacitor voltage (Vc) reaches the SBS switching voltage (Vs), D, switches on and rapidly discharges the capacitor to the D; forward voltage (Vp). Then D,
_switches off, and the capacitor begins to.charge again. The SBS will not switch off if the D, holding current (Jj) continues to flow through R; when Vc equals
Vp. SBS switch-on will normally occur when Vc equals Vs regardless of the R, resistance, because the capacitor discharge should provide the switching current (Is). However, it is best to select Rj small enough to allow Is to flow at D, switch-on.
cecil
Port C, charge | time
(a) Relaxation oscillator circuit
Figure 20-35
C, discharge time
(b) Circuit waveforms
SBS relaxation oscillator. C, charges via R, to the
‘SBS switching voltage. D; switches on-at that point and rapidly
discharges C;.
F
Chapter 20
Thyristors
The approximate oscillation frequency can be determined
925
from the
capacitor charging time (f), and the equation for t is derived from the RC charging equation.
t=
CR in|
E-—Vp
Y, ———-
(20-6)
|
Example 20-6 The SBS in the circuit in Fig. 20-35 has the following parameters: V>=10V, Ve = 1.7 V, Is = 500 pA, and [yy = 1.5 mA. Calculate the maximum and minimum
resistances
for R;
for correct
circuit
operation
when
E
=
30 V.
Determine the capacitor charging time when Ry = 27 kQ. and C; = 0.5 pF. Solution
Ruma) =
B=
%0v=—10V
= 500 nA
= 40 kO _E-Vp Ra(min) = ly
30V-17V 15mA
= 18.9kO
Eq. 20-6:
t= CRIn
E-Vr E—Ve
= 0.5 pF X 27kQ In
30V — ae 30V
-— 10V
= 4.7 ms
The GTO When an SCR is triggered into conduction by application of a gate current, the
gate loses control and the device continues to conduct until the forward current falls below
the holding current. A gate turn-off (GTO)
device
is
essentially an SCR designed to be switched on and off by an applied gate signal. The circuit symbol for a GTO is shown in Figs 20-36a, and the two-
transistor equivalent circuit for the device is illustrated in Fig 20-36b and c. Note that at switch-on, the gate current has got to be just large enough to supply base current to transistor Qo. However, at switch-off, the Q; collector current has to be diverted through the gate terminal in order to turn Q> off.
Consequently, for device turn-off, relative large levels of gate current are
involved, approaching half the GTO forward current. The SIDAC The
SIDAC
is a two-terminal
thyristor designed
mainly
for use in over-
voltage protection situations. As a bilateral device with no gate terminal, it
926
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Anode
Gate
| | Turn-on
Cathode
Turn-off
pulse
(a) Symbol
pulse
(b) Switch-on
(c) Switch-off
Figure 20-36 The gate turn-off device GTO is effectively an SCR that can be switched off by a voltage applied to the gate.
simply breaks down to its forward voltage drop when the applied terminal
voltage (of either polarity) rises to the breakover voltage level. Like other
thyristors, there is a minimum current that must flow to latch the SIDAC into
an on state. When it is switched on, conduction continues until the current falls below a holding current level. The circuit symbol and typical characteristics for a SIDAC are shown in Fig. 20-37. Available devices have breakover voltages ranging from 110 V to 280 V. Usually, on state voltage is 1.1 V, rms current is 1 A, and
holding
current is 100 mA.
Eh J
Tiny
4—-y'
Laks
=
Ss
4 ~~ IBo
Ly =e
\
MT1
Vio)
Pp
|
ff
MT2 (a) Symbol Figure 20-37
(b) Characteristics Circuit symbol and characteristics for a SIDAC.
Chapter 20
__—iThyristors
927
Figure 20-38 shows a SIDAC used to protect a de power supply from ac line transients. Normally, the SIDAC will behave as an open-circuit. A voltage transient on the ac line will cause it to break down to its forward voltage level, so that it essentially short-circuits the transformer output. This
will cause a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to trip, thus interrupting the ac
supply.
e# Ot
Voltage regulator
Figure 20-38 SIDAC used for protecting a dc power supply against transients on the supply line.
Practice Problem 20-6.1
The SBS in the circuit in Fig. 20-34 has Vs ~ 4 V, Is = 500 pA, and
In(max) = 200 mA. The ac supply is 115 V, and R3 = Ry = 22 kO. Determine suitable resistances for R, and Ro.
20-7
UNIJUNCTION TRANSISTOR (UJT)
UJT Operation The unijunction transistor (UJT) consists of a bar of lightly doped n-type silicon with a block of p-type material on one side (see Fig. 20-39a). The end terminals of the bar are identified as Base 1 (B,) and Base 2 (Bz), and the p-type
block is named the emitter (E).
B, E
By (a) Basic construction
Figure 20-39
(b) Equivalent circuit
(c) Circuit symbol
A unijunction transistor (UJT) is made up of a p-type emitter joined to a bar
of n-type semiconductor.
928
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Figure 20-39b shows
the UJT equivalent circuit. The resistance of the n-
type silicon bar is represented as two resistors, rp; from By; to point C, and rp, from Bz to C,.as illustrated. The sum of rg and and rpz is called Rgp. The p-
type emitter forms a pn-junction with the n-type silicon bar, and this junction
is shown as a diode (D;) in the equivalent circuit.
With a voltage Vgipo applied as illustrated, the voltage at the junction point C is
Vi = Veip2 X
os
BB
Note that V; is also the voltage at the cathode of the diode in the equivalent circuit. With the emitter terminal open-circuited, the resistor current is
Ipo =
VB1B2 Rpp
(20-7)
If the emitter terminal is grounded, the pn-junction is reverse-biased and there
is a small emitter reverse current (Ix). Now consider what happens when the emitter voltage (Vegpi) is slowly increased from zero. When
Vp: equals V1, the emitter current is zero. (With
equal voltage levels on each side of the diode, neither reverse nor forward current flows.) A further increase in Vgpi forward-biases the pn-junction and causes a forward current (Ig) to flow from the p-type emitter into the s-type silicon bar. When this occurs, charge carriers are injected into the rg; region.
Since the resistance of the semiconductor material is dependent on doping, the
additional
charge
carriers
cause
the
resistance
of
the
rs;
region
to
decrease rapidly. The decrease in resistance reduces the voltage drop across rei, and so the pn-junction is more heavily forward-biased. This in turn results in a greater emitter current and more charge carriers that further
reduce the resistance of the rgi region. (The process is termed regenerative.) The input voltage is pulled down, and the emitter current (Ig) is increased to a
limit determined by the V¢pi source resistance. The device remains in this on condition until the emitter input is open-circuited, or until Ig is reduced to a
very low level. The circuit symbol for a UJT is shown in Fig. 20-39c. As always, the
arrowhead points in the conventional current direction for a forward-biased junction. In this case it points from the p-type emitter to the n-type bar.
UJT Characteristics A plot of emitter voltage Vegi versus emitter current I; gives the UJT emitter characteristics. Refer to the UJT terminal voltages and currents shown
in
Fig. 20-40a and to the equivalent circuit in Fig. 20-39b. Note that when
__iThyristors
Chapter 20 Cutoff region
‘(a)'UJT voltages and currents
Negative resistance region
929
Saturation region
6
Vest (sat) ——. Vy
aw
0
~" of
1
2
3
4 (mA)
Point1 P
(V) desc 1
| |
dat 14 fr \ i”
12}44
1}
“AL
coral ,V
ye
= 20V
Vpip2 7 15'V
|
Vpip2 = 10 vo
(c) Family of UJT characteristics Figure 20-40
The UJT characteristics show that the device triggers on at various levels
of emitter voltage Veg1, depending upon the level of supply voltage Vpip2.
Veip2 = 0, Ipo = Oand V; = 0. If Vegi is now increased from zero, the resultant plot of Vgp; and Ig is simply the characteristic of a forward-biased diode with some series resistance. This is the characteristic for Iz = 0 in Fig. 20-40b. When Vpip2 is 20 V, the level of V; (Fig. 20-39b) might be around 15 V, depending on the resistances of rg; and ’p2. With Vgip2 = 20 V and Vgpi = 0, the emitter junction is reverse-biased and the emitter reverse current Igo
flows, as shown at point 1 on the Vgip2 = 20 V characteristic in Fig. 20-40b.
930
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Increasing Vgpi until it equals V; gives Iz = 0; point 2 on the characteristic. A further increase in Vgpi forward-biases the emitter junction, and this gives the peak point on the characteristic (point 3). At the peak point, Vgp) is identified as the peak voltage (Vp) and Ig is termed the peak current (Ip). Up until the peak point, the UJT is said to be operating in the cutoff region of its characteristics. When
Vp
arrives at the peak voltage, charge carriers
are injected from the emitter to decrease the resistance of rpi, as already explained. The device enters the negative resistance region, rp falls rapidly to a saturation resistance (rs), and Vxp; falls to the valley voltage (Vy), (point 4 on the characteristic in Fig. 20-40b). Ip also increases to the valley current (Iy) at this time. A further increase in Ig causes the device to enter the saturation region, where V¢pi equals the sum of Vp and Ig X rs.
Starting with Vgip2 lower than 20 V gives a lower peak point voltage and a different characteristic. Thus, by using various levels of Vpip2, a family of
Vepi/Ig characteristics can be plotted for a given UJT, as shown in Fig. 20-40c.
UJT Packages Two
typical UJT
packages
with
the terminal
identified
are shown
in
Fig. 20-41. These are similar to low-power BJT packages.
B, EB,
E
B, Bottom view
By Bottom view
B, EB,
By p By
(a) Resin-encapsulated UJT
Figure 20-41
(b) UJT in a metal can
UJT packages
ane Nernlnate.
UJT Parameters Interbase Resistance (Rpg): This is the sum of rg; and rg2 when Ig is zero. Consider Fig. 20-42, which shows a portion of the manufacturer’s data sheet for 2N4949 UJT. Rgp is specified as 7 kO typical, 4 kO minimum, and 12 kO
maximum. The value of Rpp, together with the maximum power dissipation Pp, determines the maximum voltage Vg1p2 that may be used. When Iz = 0,
V51B2(max) = V (Rep Pp) , Like
all other
temperatures.
devices,
the
Pp
of the
UJT
must
(20-8) be
derated
for
higher
Chapter 20
Thyristors
931
2N4949 UJT
Min Interbase resistance (Rpp)
OD sci.DASE tt
4kO,
7kO
12 kQ 0.86
0.74
Intrinsic standoff ratio (7)
Emitter saturation voltage (Vepi (sat)
25V
3V
Peak point current (Ip)
0.6 pA
1pA
Valley point current (Iy) Figure 20-42
2mA
4mA
Partial specification for a 2N4949 UUT.
Example 20-7 AUJT has Rgpimin) = 4 kO, Pp = 360 mW at 25 °C, and a power derating factor
D = 2.4 mW/°C. Calculate the maximum temperature of 100°C.
Vgip2 that should be used at a
Solution Ppaoo) = Pps») — [D (T2 - 25°)|
Eq. 8-26:
= 360 mW
— [2.4mW/°C (100° — 25°)|
= 180 mW
Verpotmey = V(RppPp) = V4 «2 X 180 mW)
Eq. 20-8:
= 26.8 V
Intrinsic Standoff Ratio (): The intrinsic standoff ratio is simply the ratio of rgi to Rpg. The peak point voltage is determined
from
7, the supply
voltage, and the diode voltage drop: Vp
= Vp
+ nVpiB2
Emitter Saturation Voltage (Vepi(say)):
(20-9)
This is the emitter voltage when the
UJT is operating in the saturation region of its characteristics; the minimum Vzp level. Because it is affected by the emitter current and voltage, Vepiat) is specified for given Ig and V3ip2 levels.
the supply
Example 20-8 Determine UJT with
the maximum Vp1B2
=
and minimum
triggering voltages for a 2N4949
25V.
Solution
From Fig. 20-42,
= 0.74 minimum, 0.86 maximum
982
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Vptmax) = Vo + (max Vein2) = 0.7 V + (0.86 X 25 V) = 222
Eq, 20-9:
Vpcniny = Vo + (nmin Vere) = 0.7V + (0.74 X 25 V) =192V Peak Point Emitter Current (Ip): Ip is important as a lower limit to the
emitter current. If the emitter voltage source resistance is so high that Is is not greater than Ip, the UJT will simply not trigger into the on state. The maximum emitter voltage source resistance is
Regan) =
Vep — Vp Ip
(20-10)
where Vp is the circuit supply voltage.
Valley Point Current (Ty): ly is important in some circuits as an upper limit to the emitter current. If the emitter voltage source resistance is so low that Ip is equal to or greater than Ivy, the UJT will remain on once it is triggered; it will not switch off. So the minimum emitter voltage source resistance is
Vep 7 VEBisat) Reqmin)
7
(20-11)
Ivy
UJT Relaxation Oscillator The
relaxation
oscillator circuit
in Fig.
20-43a
consists
of
a UJT
and
a
capacitor (C;) charged via resistance Rg. When the capacitor voltage (Vc)
reaches Vp, the UJT fires and rapidly discharges Ci to Vepiyat. The device Slams
|
to the UJT firing voltage, and the SCR is triggered by the voltage drop across
R3. By adjusting R2, the charging rate of C; and the UJT firing time can be selected. The waveforms in Fig. 20-44b show that 180° of SCR phase control is possible. D,
0° Supply waveform
Ry
180° j
|
Load
waveform
I
T
Q,
rhb | end
|
angle
| l | |
Capacitor
waveform
i
a
t
f~
| | |
| |
; | | | |
1
R3 waveform 1—_+ i (a) UJT control circuit for SCR
|
ee a
conduction
180°
|
tay
off
0° 1
I | |
i —?,
| ! | |
=I
Vi
P| |
\ Vr3
(b) Circuit waveforms
Figure 20-44 UJT 180° phase-control circuit for an SCR. Resistor R2 controls the C; charging rate and the SCR firing point.
Practice Problems 20-7.1 A 2N4870 UJT
has the following parameters: Pp = 300 mW
at 25°C,
“D=3mW/°C, n = 0.56 to 0.75, Rep = 4kO to 9.1 kO, Vapieay = 2.5 V, Ip = 1 pAto 5 pA, and ly = 2mAto5 mA. Determine the maximum _ Vpip2 that may be used: at 75°C.
20-7.2. Calculate the Vpgmax) and Vpdmin) for a 2N4870 when Vpp = 30 V. 20-7.3 A 2N4870 is used in the circuit in Fig. 20-44. If D, has Vz = 30 V, determine the maximum and minimum resistance values for Ro.
Chapter 20
20-8
PROGRAMMABLE
Thyristors
935
UNIJUNCTION TRANSISTOR (PUT)
PUT Operation The programmable unijunction transistor (PUT) is actually an SCR-type device used to simulate a UJT. The interbase resistance (Rpg) and the intrinsic standoff ratio (n) can be programmed to any desired values by selecting two resistors.
This means that the device firing voltage (the peak voltage Vp) can also be
programmed. Consider
Fig.
20-45a,
which
shows
a four-layer device with its gate connected to the junction of resistors Ry and R2. Note that the gate terminal is close to the anode of the device, instead of the cathode as for an SCR. The
anode-gate junction becomes forward-biased when
the anode is positive
with respect to the gate. When this occurs, the device is triggered on. The anode-to-cathode voltage then drops to a low level, and the PUT conducts heavily until the current becomes too low to sustain conduction. To simulate
the UJT performance, the anode of the device acts as the UJT emitter, and R, Vp are and R2 operate as rp; and rp, respectively. Parameters Rpp, 7, and
programmed by the selection of Rj and R2. The four-layer block diagram is replaced with the PUT graphic symbol in Fig. 20-45b. Note that this is the same as the SCR symbol except that the gate terminal is at the anode.
PUT Characteristics The typical PUT characteristic (Vax plotted versus I4) shown in Fig. 20-46 is seen to be very similar to UJT characteristics. A small gate reverse current (Iago) flows while the anode-gate junction is reverse-biased. At this point the PUT is in the cutoff region of the characteristics. When the anode voltage is raised sufficiently above the gate voltage (Vc in Fig. 20-45), the PUT is triggered into the negative resistance region of its characteristics and the
(a) PUT four-layer construction
Figure 20-45
(b) PUT circuit
The programmable unijunction transistor (PUT) is an SCR-type device that
can be connected to function like a UJT.
936
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Cutoff
| Negative resistance
region,
region
Saturation region
Figure 20-46 The typical Vax/I, characteristics for a PUT are similar to UJT characteristics.
anode-cathode voltage falls rapidly to the valley voltage (Vy). A further increase in I, causes the device to operate in its saturation region. PUT Parameters The intrinsic standoff ratio for the PUT is
Ry
Re Be
(20-13)
Vo = 1Vep
(20-14)
Vp = Vp + 1V pp
(20-15)
The gate voltage is simply
and the peak voltage is
|
where Vp is the anode-gate junction voltage, typically 0.7 V. The gate source resistance (Rc) is an important quantity because it affects the peak current and valley current for the PUT. Rg is the resistance at the
junction of voltage divider R; and Rp (Fig. 20-45): Rg
= Rill Ry
(20-16)
Refer to the partial specification for a 2N6027 PUT in Fig. 20-47, and note the
typical quantities. With Rg = 1 MQ, Ip = 1.25 pA and Iy = 18 A; with Rc = 10 kO, Ip = 4 pA and Iy = 150 pA.
Chapter 20
937
i Thyristors
2N6027 PUT Peak current (Ip) Valley current (Iy) Forward voltage (Vp) Figure 20-47
Typ
Max
1 MQ) 10 kf) 1 MQ) 10 kQ)
1.25 pA 4A 18 pA 150 pA
2 pA 5A 50 pA -
(Ip = 50 mA)
0.8 V
(Rg (Rg (Ro (Rg
= = = =
15V
Partial specification for a programmable unijunction transistor.
PUT Applications A PUT can be applied in any circuit where a UJT might be used. Figure 20-48 shows
a PUT
relaxation
oscillator
used
to control
an SCR.
This
circuit
operates in essentially the same way as the UJT circuit in Fig. 20-44. It should be noted that there are upper and lower limits to the resistance that can be connected in series with the PUT anode for correct operation of the device. This is similar to the Re(min) and ReGnaxy Fequirement for the UJT.
Figure 20-48 SCR phase-conirol circuit using a PUT relaxation oscillator.
A battery charger circuit using a PUT (Q:) and an SCR (Q>) is shown in Fig. 20-49. The ac supply voltage is full-wave-rectified and applied via current-limiting resistor Rs to the anode of the SCR. The SCR is triggered into conduction by the PUT output coupled via transformer T;. The PUT gate voltage (Va) is set by the voltage divider (R3, Ry, and Rs). While Vc is lower than the Zener diode voltage (Vz), capacitor C; is charged via R; to the PUT
peak voltage. At this point the PUT fires and triggers the SCR on. As the battery charges, its voltage (Eg) increases, and thus Vg also increases. The increased Vg raises the Vp of the PUT and causes C; to take a longer time to charge. Consequently, the SCR is held off for a longer portion of
the ac supply half-cycle. This means that the average charging current is gradually reduced as the battery approaches full charge. When Eg is fully charged, Vc is raised to the Vz level, so that Dg conducts and stops the C; voltage from firing the PUT. Thus, the SCR remains off and battery charging stops. The circuit will not operate if the battery is connected with the wrong
polarity.
938
Electronic Devices and Circuits
(ye lis
NWN Rs
YS
r
Ry 1kO
\
Ry
Rg
100 kO
6.8 kO,
D 6
ac voltage
r
Ry
10 kA, +
source
i
pax 2
Ex
ls
ve
2)
1
*Ps
4
1N5240 |
+ o. Battery under charge
Rs
0.
33 kA
yh yd
Figure 20-49
SCR battery charger using a PUT control circuit.
Example 20-10 Calculate
Vpgmax) and
Vpimin) for the PUT
in the circuit in Fig. 20-49 when
Eg = 12 V. Determine the gate bias resistance Rc, and calculate the maximum and minimum resistances for R> if the PUT is a 2N6027. Solution
Eq. q 20-13:
11 (max)
=
R
° Rg+Rygt+R,
=
33k0,
6.8k0+10kN+33kO0,
= 0.86
Rs
“Neris) RZ+R,+R;
33k0,
68kK0+10kK0+33kO
= 0.66
Eq. 20-15: Vp(may = Vo + (mmax) Van) = 0.7 V + (0.86 X 12 V) =11V
Vpimin) = Vp + (max) Ves) = 0.7V + (0.66 X 12 V) = 8.6V Kq. 20-16:
Rg = (R3 + 0.5 Ra) II (Rs + 0.5 Ra) = (6.8 kO + 5) 11 (33 kO + 5 kQ) =9kO
_E—Vpmaxy _12V—11V = 250 kO
Chapter 20
Roqmin) =
ly
Thyristors
939
150 pA
= 740,
Practice Problems 20-8.1 The circuit in Fig. 20-48 has Vpp = 15 V, R2 = 12 kO, and R3 = 18 kQ.
The PUT has Ip = 10 wA, Iy = 100 pA, and Vz = 1 V. Calculate Rg, n, 20-8.2
Vp, and the maximum and minimum resistances for Ri. Determine the voltage that the battery will be charged to in Fig. 20-49
when the moving contact is at the middle point on Ry. Assume that the PUT will stop firing when Vac is reduced to 0.5 V.
Review Questions
Section 20-1 20-1
20-2
20-3
Sketch the construction of a silicon-controlled rectifier. Sketch the twotransistor equivalent circuit and show how it is derived from the SCR construction. Label all terminals and explain how the device operates. Sketch typical SCR forward and reverse characteristics. Identify all regions of the characteristics and all important current and voltage levels. Explain the shape of the characteristics in terms of the SCR twotransistor equivalent circuit. List the most important SCR parameters and state typical quantities for low-, medium-, and high-current devices.
Section 20-2 20-4 Draw the circuit diagram to show how an SCR can be triggered by the application of a pulse to the gate terminal. Sketch the circuit waveforms and explain its operation. 20-5 Sketch a 90° phase-control circuit for an SCR. Draw the load waveform and explain the operation of the circuit. Show the circuit and load waveforms when the ac supply is full-wave-rectified.
20-6
Draw the diagram for a 90° phase-control circuit using two SCRs for full-wave phase control. Draw the load waveforms and briefly explain the circuit operation.
20-7
Sketch a 180° phase conirol for an SCR. Draw the load waveform and
explain the circuit operation. Section 20-3 20-8 Briefly discuss SCR circuit stability and draw methods that can be used to improve stability.
diagrams
to show
940
20-9
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Draw the diagram for anSCR zero-point triggering circuit.
Ex plain the
circuit operation and advantages and draw the load waveform. 20-10 Sketch a circuit that uses an SCR to protect a load from excessive dc
supply voltage. Briefly explain. 20-11 Draw a diagram for an SCR heater control circuit using a temperature-
sensitive device. Explain the circuit operation. Section 20-4 20-12 Draw sketches to show the construction, equivalent circuit, and characteristics of a TRIAC. Identify all important voltage and current
levels on the characteristics and explain the operation of the device. 20-13 Using diagrams, explain the four quadrant operating conditions for a TRIAC. 20-14 Draw
the
typical
characteristics
for
a
DIAC.
Explain
the
DIAC
operation, and sketch the two circuit symbols used for the device.
Section 20-5 20-15 Draw the diagram for a TRIAC 180° phase-control circuit. Draw all
waveforms and explain the circuit operation.
20-16 Draw the diagram for an TRIAC zero-point triggering circuit and carefully explain its operation. 20-17 Sketch the functional block diagram for an IC zero voltage switch for TRIAC control. Discuss the components of the block diagram. Section 20-6 20-18 Using diagrams, briefly explain a silicon unilateral switch (SUS). Draw
the device circuit symbol. 20-19 Sketch the equivalent circuit and characteristics for a silicon bilateral switch (SBS). Explain how the device construction differs from that of other thyristors. Discuss the device operation, state typical parameters, and show how the switching voltage can be modified. 20-20 Sketch a relaxation oscillator circuit using an SBS. Draw the output
waveform, and explain the circuit operation. 20-21 Draw the circuit symbol and equivalent circuit for a gate turnoff device (GTO) and discuss its operation. 20-22 Draw
the circuit symbol
and
typical characteristics
for a SIDAC.
Discuss its operation and applications. Section 20-7 20-23 Draw sketches to show the basic construction and equivalent circuit of
a unijunction transistor (UJT). Briefly explain the device operation. 20-24 Sketch typical UJT Vepi /Tg characteristics for Ip, = 0, Vpip2 = 20 V, and
Veip2 = 10 V. Identify each region and all important points on the characteristics, and explain the shape of the characteristics.
Chapter 20
Thyristors
941
20-25 Define the following UJT parameters: intrinsic standoff ratio, interbase resistance, emitter saturation voltage, peak point current, and valley
point current. 20-26 Draw the circuit of a UJT
relaxation oscillator with
provision
for
frequency adjustment and spike waveform. Show all waveforms, and explain the circuit operation. 20-27 Sketch a UJT circuit for controlling an SCR. Draw all waveforms, and briefly explain how the circuit operates. Section 20-8 20-28 Draw the basic block diagram and basic circuit for a programmable unijunction transistor (PUT); explain the device operation. 20-29 Sketch typical PUT characteristics, explain how the intrinsic stand-off ratio may be programmed, and identify the most important PUT parameters.
20-30 Draw a basic PUT circuit for controlling an SCR; explain its operation. 20-31 Draw the circuit diagram of a battery charger using a PUT and an SCR. Explain the circuit operation.
Problems Section 20-1 20-1 Consult 2N6167
and 2N1595
SCR
specifications to determine
the
typical values for Vorm, Jt, Viw, In, Jor, and Ver.
Section 20-2 20-2 Choose a suitable SCR from Fig. 20-10 for a circuit with a 115 V ac supply. Calculate the minimum load resistance that can be supplied, and determine the instantaneous voltage level when the SCR switches
off. 20-3
A 33 ( resistor is supplied from an ac source with a 60 V peak level. Current to the load is to be switched on and off by an SCR. Select a
suitable device from the specifications in data sheet A-17 in Appendix A, and determine
the instantaneous supply voltage at which
the SCR
switches off. 20-4
An SCR with a 115 V ac supply controls the current through a 150 0 load resistor. A 90° phase-control circuit (as in Fig. 20-11) is employed
to trigger the SCR between 12° and 90°. The gate trigger current is 50 20-5
wA, and the trigger voltage is 0.5 V. Calculate suitable resistor values. The circuit in Fig. 20-12 has a 50 V ac supply and Ry,= 20 0. Determine suitable resistance values for Ri, R2, and R3 such that the SCR will be
triggered anywhere between 7.5° and 90°. The gate trigger current and
voltage are 500 pA and 0.6 V.
942
20-6
Electronic Devices and Circuits
The circuit in Problem 20-5 uses a 2N5170 SCR (see data sheet A-17 in Appendix A). Calculate the instantaneous supply voltage level when
the SCR switches off. 20-7 Design the circuit in Fig. 20-13 for 10° to 90° phase control; specify the SCRs. The ac supply is 115 V, R, = 12 0, and the SCRs have Vc = 0.6 V and Ig = 100 pA. 20-8 A180° phase-control circuit as in Fig. 20-15 has a 40 V, 400 Hz ac supply and
Ry = 22 Q.. The SCR has
Ve
= 0.5 V, Ig =
60 pA,
and
lcm
=
20 mA.
Determine suitable resistor and capacitor values, and specify the SCRs and the diodes. Section 20-3 20-9
An SCR crowbar circuit (as in Fig. 20-19) is connected to a 12 V de
supply with a 200 mA current limiter. Design the crowbar circuit to protect the load from voltage levels greater than 13.5 V. Assume that Vc = 0.7 V for the SCR.
20-10 A zero-point triggering circuit (as in Fig. 20-18) is to control the power dissipation in a 12 ©, load resistor with a 115 V, 60 Hz ac supply. Assuming
that
the
SCRs
have
Vg
=
0.5
V
and
Igmmin)
=
10
mA,
determine suitable capacitor and resistor values. 20-11 An SCR heater control circuit (as in Fig. 20-20) is to switch on at 68°C
and off at 71°C. The circuit is to operate from a 50 V, 60 Hz supply, and the available temperature-sensitive device has a resistance of 500 © at 68°C and 350 O at 71°C. The load resistance is Ry = 2.5 O and the SCR
has Vc = 0.6 V. Determine suitable component values, and calculate the SCR gate voltage at 71°C. 20-12 Specify the SCRs required for the circuits in Problems 20-9, 20-10, and 20-11 in terms of maximum anode-cathode voltage and maximum anode current. Section 20-4 20-13 Consult specifications for 2N6071
and 2N6343 TRIACs
to determine
the maximum supply voltage, maximum rms current, and the typical quadrant I gate triggering voltage. Section 20-5
20-14 A light dimmer uses a TRIAC 180° phase-control circuit, as in Fig. 2027. The ac supply is 220 V, 60 Hz, and the total load is 750 W. The TRIAC has triggering current Ig = 200 A, maximum gate current Ign
= 50 mA, and Vg = 0.7 V. The DIAC has Vs = 9.2 V and Is = 400 pA.
Determine suitable component values. 20-15 The TRIAC control circuit in Fig. 20-27 has the following components: Ry = 100 Q, Ry = 10 kQ, R2 = 500 0, C; = 3.9 wR The DIAC has Vz =
Chapter 20
Thyristors
943
7 V, and
the TRIAC has Vo = 1V. The ac supply is 60 V, 60 Hz. Determine the minimum conduction angle for the TRIAC. 20-16 Specify the TRIACs required for the circuits in Problems 20-14 and
20-15. 20-17 The TRIAC zero-point switching circuit in Fig. 20-28 uses an SCR with
Ig = 100 pA and Vz = 1.5 V. The TRIAC has Ig = 5 mA, Ic = 500 mA, and fon = 50 us. The control voltage is E = 5 V, the ac source is 60 V,
60 Hz, and the load is Rj = 15 Q. Determine suitable component values. Section 20-6 20-18 A relaxation oscillator (as in Fig. 20-35) uses an SBS with Vs = 8 V, Ve = 1 V, Is = 300 pA, and fy = 1 mA. The dc supply is E = 40 V. Calculate maximum and minimum R values for correct operation of
the circuit. 20-19 A relaxation oscillator (as in Fig. 20-35) has a 25 V supply, a 1 pF
capacitor, and a 12 kQ series resistor. The capacitor is to charge up to 15 V and then discharge to approximately 1 V. Specify the required SBS in terms of forward conduction voltage, switching voltage, switching
current, and holding current. 20-20 The phase-control circuit in Fig. 20-34 has the following components: Ry = 18 0, Ry = 12 kO, Rp = 470 0, and C; = 10 wF. Resistors R3 and R,
are replaced with 3.3 V Zener diodes, and the TRIAC triggering voltage is Vo = 1 V. The ac supply is 115 V, 60 Hz. Determine the TRIAC minimum conduction angle. Section 20-7 20-21 Determine the maximum
power dissipation for a 2N2647 UJT at an
ambient temperature of 70°C. Calculate the maximum V3}p2 that may be used at 70°C. Data sheet A-18 in Appendix A gives partial specification for the 2N2647.
20-22 Calculate the minimum and maximum Vp; triggering levels for a 2N2647 UJT when Vpip2 = 20 V. 20-23 A relaxation oscillator (as in Fig. 20-43) uses a 2N2647 UJT with Vpp = 25 V. Calculate the typical oscillation frequency if C, = 0.5 uF and Rg = 3.3 ki. 20-24 Calculate the maximum and minimum charging resistance values that can be used in the circuit of Problem 20-23. 20-25 The UJT phase-control circuit in Fig. 20-44 has a 115 V, 60 Hzac supply,
and an SCR with Vg = 1 V and Icgm = 25 mA. Design the circuit to use a 2N2647 UJT and a Zener diode with Vz ~ 15 V.
944
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Section 20-8 20-26 A PUT operating from a 25 V supply has Vp = 1.5 V and Ig = 50 pA. Determine values for R; and R2 program 7 to 0.75. Calculate Vp, Vy, Rgp,
and
Ro.
20-27 A PUT relaxation oscillator (as in Fig. 20-48) has a 0.68 wF capacitor. The PUT has Vg = 1 V and Ig = capacitor voltage is to be 5 V and the oscillating 300 Hz. Determine suitable resistor values. 20-28 The UJT in Problem 20-23 is to be replaced with
20 V supply and a 100 pA. The peak frequency is to be a PUT.
Determine
suitable resistance values for the gate bias voltage divider. 20-29 A PUT has a forward voltage of Vp = 0.9 V and Ig = 200 wA.
The
device is to be programmed to switch on at Vg = 15 V when operating from a 24 V supply. Determine values for R; and Ro, and calculate Vp, Vv, Rpg, and Rc.
Practice Problem Answers
20-2.1 20-2.2 20-3.1 20-51 20-6.1 20-71 20-7.2 20-7.3 20-8.1 20-8.2
163 V,1.6A, 18 kO, 1.5 kO; 180.0 10 kQ, 0.82 pF 1.5kO (68kQ + 12k), 4 uF 1k0,1800,5.6k0,1kO, 2.5 pF 1 pF 500kQ, 3200 24.5V 23.2V,17.5V 1.36 MO, 6.25 kO. 7.2 kQ, 0.6, 9.7 V, 530 kQ, 140 kO 13.4V
CHAPTER 21 Optoelectronic Devices Objectives You will be able to:
Explain solar cells, and design
1 Define important illumination
units and calculate illumination
solar cell battery charger circuits.
intensity at a given distance
from a source. Explain the fabrication and operation of a light-emitting
Explain the operation of a phototransistor, sketch phototransistor characteristics, and discuss its parameters.
diode (LED), discuss its
parameters, and design LED circuits.
Explain the operation of liquid crystal displays (LCDs), show how LCDs and LEDs are used in seven-segment numerical
Explain photodarlingtons and photo-FETs. 10 Design phototransistor circuits
for energizing relays, triggering SCRs, and so on.
Explain the construction and
displays, and calculate power dissipations in each type of display. Explain the construction and operation of a photoconductive cell, sketch the device
11
characteristics, and discuss its parameters.
different supply voltages. 13 Explain the construction and operation of a photomultiplier
Design photoconductive cell circuits to bias BJTs on or off,
energize relays, trigger Schmitt circuits, and so on. Explain the construction and operation of a photodiode, sketch photodiode characteristics, and discuss its parameters.
Design photodiodes into circuits where they operate as a photoconductive devices and as photovoltaic devices.
operation of optocouplers, and discuss optocoupler parameters. 12 Design optocoupler circuits for
coupling pulse-type and linear signals between systems with
tube, and discuss its
characteristics and parameters. Design voltage dividers for biasing photomultiplier tube
electrodes. 14 Explain the operation of a laser diode. Discuss the device characteristics and parameters.
Design and analyze laser diode control circuits.
946
Electronic Devices and Circuits
INTRODUCTION Optoelectronic devices emit light, modify light, have their resistance affected by light, or produce currents and voltages proportional to light intensity. Light-emitting diodes (LEDs) produce light and are generally used as indicating lamps and in numerical displays. Liquid crystal displays (LCDs), which modify light, are also used as numerical displays. Photoconductive cells have a resistance that depends upon illumination intensity. They are used in circuits designed to produce an output change when the light level changes. The current and voltage levels in photodiodes and phototransistors are affected by illumination. These devices are also used in circuits that have their conditions altered by changes in light levels. Illumination is converted into electrical energy by means of solar cells, and this energy is often used to charge storage batteries. Optocouplers combine LEDs and phototransistors to provide a means of coupling between circuits that have different supply
voltages while maintaining a high level of electrical insolation.
21-1
LIGHT UNITS
The total light energy output, or luminous flux (¢,), from a source can be measured in milliwatts (mW) or in lumens (lm), where 1 lm = 1.496 mW. The luminous intensity (E,) (also termed illuminance) of a light source is defined as
the luminous flux density per unit solid angle (or cone) emitting from the source (see Fig. 21-1a). This is measured in candelas (cd), where one candela
is equal to one lumen per unit solid angle (assuming a point source that emits light evenly in all directions).
E, = 5
(21-1)
The light intensity (Eq) on an area at a given distance from the source is
determined
from
the surface
area
of a sphere
surrounding
the source
Mer Né AWS Soe I. Point light
solid angle
source (a) Flux per unit solid angle Figure 21-1
area.
Point light
Unitarea
source (b) Flux per unit area
Light intensity can be expressed in flux per unit solid angle or in flux per unit
Chapter 21 _— Optoelectronic Devices
947
(Fig. 21-1b). At a distance of r metres, the luminous flux is spread over a
spherical area of 47r* square metres. Therefore, Eq = os
(21-2)
Agry*
When
the total flux is expressed in lumens, Eq. 21-2 gives the luminous
intensity in !umens per square meter (lm/ m7’), also termed /ux (Ix). Comparing Eq. 21-2 to Eq. 21-1, shows that the luminous intensity per unit area at any
distance r from a point source is determined by dividing the source intensity
by 7. Luminous intensity can also be measured in milliwatts per square centimetre (mW/cm?), or lumens per square foot (Im/ft?), also known as a foot candle (fc), where 1 fc = 10.764 Ix.
The light intensity of sunlight approximately 107 640 lx, or 161 lamp is approximately 4.8 X 10° At a distance of 2 m, this is 1.2 x
on the earth at noon on a clear day is W/m7?. The light intensity from a 100 W cd (allowing for a 90% lamp efficiency). 10° Ix. An indicating lamp with a 3 med
output can be clearly seen at a distance of several metres in normal room lighting conditions.
Example 21-1 Calculate the light intensity 3 m from a lamp that emits 25 W of light energy.
Determine the total luminous flux striking an area of 0.25 m’ at 3 m from the lamp. Solution
Eq. 21-2:
Ea =
25 W
Pe
Am ~~ dor X (3m)?
= 0.221 W/m?2 = 221 mW/m? Total flux = Ea X area = 221 mW/m?
X 0.25 m?
~55 mW
Example 21-2 Determine the light intensity at a distance of 2 m from a 10 mcd source. Solution
_ E, (ed) _ 10mcd A
2
= 2.5 mlx
72
948
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Light energy is electromagnetic radiation; that is, it is in the form of electromagnetic waves. Thus it can be defined in terms of frequency or
wavelength, as well as intensity. Wavelength, frequency, and velocity are
related by the equation
c= fA where
(21-3)
c = velocity = 3 x 10° m/s for electromagnetic waves f = frequency in Hz A = wavelength in metres
The wavelength of visible light ranges from violet at approximately 380 nm (nanometres) to red at 720 nm. From Eq. 21-3, the frequency extremes are f
_¢ violet
—
_3*x
10° m/s
Xr
380 nm
~8 x 10!* Hz
tyes ree
3 x 108 m/s
A
720 nm
4
Practice Problems 21-1.1 » » -21-1.2. 21-1.3
A lamp is required to produce a light intensity of 213 lx at a distance of 5 m. Calculate the total light energy output of the lamp in watts. Calculate the frequency of yellow light with a 585 nm wavelength. Determine the light intensity 3.3 m from an 8 mcd lamp, and the total
luminous flux striking a 4 cm? area at that location.
21-2
LIGHT-EMITTING DIODES (LED)
LED Operation and Construction _ Charge
carrier recombination
occurs
at a forward-biased
pn-junction
as
electrons cross from the n-side and recombine with holes on the p-side. Free
electrons have a higher energy level than holes, and some of this energy is dissipated in the form of heat and light when recombination takes place. If the semiconductor material is translucent, the light is emitted and the junction
becomes a light source, that is, a light-emitting diode (LED). A cross-sectional view of an LED junction is shown
semiconductor
material
is gallium
arsenide
(GaAs),
in Fig. 21-2a. The
gallium
arsenide
phosphide (GaAsP), or gallium phosphide (GaP). An n-type epitaxial layer is grown upon a substrate, and the p-region is created by diffusion. Since charge carrier recombinations occur in the p-region, the p-region is kept uppermost to allow the light to escape. The metal film anode connection is
Chapter 21
Optoelectronic Devices
949
Solid plastic |
gr
Light
Light
canted
emitted
.
\\
Anode
pn-junction
// Charge carrier recombination
\ O+0+0+0+0+0+
-
|
AN
|+—
7
Reflector
p-type
|= type
Anode
sg
Cathode
of
Cathode
(a) LED junction
(b) Typical construction
(c) Graphic symbol
Figure 21-2 A light-emitting diode (LED) produces energy in the form of light when charge carrier recombination occurs at the pn-junction.
patterned to allow most of the light to be emitted. A gold film is applied to the bottom of the substrate to reflect as much light as possible toward the surface of the device and to provide a cathode connection. LEDs made from GaAs emit infrared (invisible) radiation. GaAsP material produces either red
light or yellow light, while red or green light can be created by using GaP. Through the use of various materials, LEDs can be manufactured to produce
light of virtually any color. Figure 21-2b shows the typical construction of a LED. The pn-junction is
mounted on a cup-shaped reflector, wires are provided for anode and cathode connection, and the device is encapsulated in an epoxy lens. The lens can be colorless or colored, and (when not energized), the lens color
identifies the LED light color. The color of the light emitted by the energized LED is determined solely by the pn-junction material. Some LEDs have glass particles embedded in the epoxy lens to diffuse the emitted light and
increase the viewing angle of the device. The LED circuit symbol is shown in Fig. 21-2c. Note that the arrow directions indicate emitted light.
Characteristics and Parameters LED characteristics are similar to those of other semiconductor diodes, except that (as shown in the partial specification in Fig. 21-3) the typical forward
voltage drop is 1.6 V. Note also that the reverse breakdown voltage can be as low as 3 V. Insome circuits it is necessary to include a diode with a high reverse breakdown voltage in series with a LED. The forward current used with a LED is usually in the 10 mA to 20 mA range, but (depending on the particular
device) the peak current can be as high as 90 mA. LED luminous intensity depends on the forward current level; it is usually specified at 20 mA. The peak wavelength of the light output is also normally listed on the specification.
950.
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Typical LED Specification
Min
Typ
Luminous intensity (Iy at 20 mA)
4 med
8 mcd
Forward voltage (Vx)
14V
1.6 V
Reverse breakdown voltage (Vgpr) | 3 V
10 V
Peak forward current (Izmax))
90 mA
Average forward current (Ip(av))
20 mA
Power dissipation (Pp)
20 '¥
100 mW
Response speed (ts)
90 ns
Peak wavelength (Ap) Figure 21-3
Max
:
660 nm
Partial specification for a typical light-emitting diode.
LED Circuits
As explained, an LED is a semiconductor diode that emits light when a forward current is passed through the device. A single LED might be employed simply as a supply voltage on/off indicator, as illustrated in Fig. 21-4a. A series-connected resistor (Ri) must be included
to limit the
current to the desired level. Figure 21-4b shows an LED connected at the output of a comparator to indicate a high output voltage. As well as the current-limiting resistor (Ri), an ordinary semiconductor diode (D;) is connected in series with the LED to protect it from an excessive reverse
voltage when the comparator output is negative. + Vec
Comparator + Vee
(a) LED as on /off indicator Figure 21-4
(b) LED as high output voltage indicator
Light-emitting diode indicator circuits.
LEDs are often controlled by a BJT, as illustrated in Figs 21-5a and b. Transistor Q; in Fig. 21-5a is switched into saturation by the input voltage (Vp). Resistor R limits the transistor base current, and R limits the LED current. In Fig. 21-5b, the emitter resistor (R;) limits the LED current to (Vp — Vpr)/R1.
Chapter 21
Optoelectronic Devices
951
VE (sat)
(a) Rz controls Ip, Q, is saturated Figure 21-5
(b) R, controls Ig, Q, is not saturated
BUT control circuits for light-emitting diodes.
Example 21-3 The LED in Fig. 21-5a is to have a forward current of approximately 10 mA. The circuit voltages are Vcc = 9 V, Vg = 1.6 V, and Vg = 7 V; and Q, has
hrg(min) = 100. Calculate suitable resistance values for R; and Ro. Solution ee
= Veco — Vg — Vex (sat) _ 9V-16V-02V
a
Ie
10 mA
= 720 O (use 680 0 standard value) Ic becomes
= Veco — Ve ~ Vega) 9V-16V -—02V c~ Ry 680 2 =106mA In
=
8
Ic
_
hee¢nin)
10.6 mA
100
= 106 pA
Rp = —
te
106 pA
= 59 kQ (use 56 kQ standard value)
952
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Practice Problems 21-2.1
The LED in the circuit in Fig. 21-5b is to pass a 20 mA current. The circuit voltages are Vcc = 15 V, Vp = 1.9 V, and Vg = 5 V. Determine a
suitable resistance for Ry, and calculate Vcg for Q). 21-2.2
Determine suitable resistances for the circuits in Fig. 21-4 to give Ig = 15 mA. The LEDs have Vx = 1.8 V. Also, Vcc = 6 V in Fig 21-4a,
and in Fig. 21-4b the op-amp output is V, = +9 V. 21-3
SEVEN-SEGMENT
DISPLAYS
so
. Pull-up resistor R2 isnecessary to ensure that
the load terminal is held at the 5 V supply level when Qz; is off. tVecy od
24V 97
Ry
yal)
1D, \
+VeCee
5V
=
Load
:
=
Oo
SS
=
3
Figure 21-37
Octocoupler used for coupling a signal from a 24 V
system to a 5 V system.
Example 21-11 The optocoupler in Fig. 21-37 is required to sink a 2 mA load current when Q2 is in saturation and If; = 10 mA. The optocoupler has the specification in
Fig. 21-36. Determine suitable resistor values. Solution From the specification: Ic¢2 = 5 mA when Ipp; = 10 mA
Tro = Ie. - Ip =SmMA-—2mA =3mA Fine 2
Vcc2
— VcR(sat) Tro
eV
=02¥V 3 mA
= 1.6 kO (use 1.8 kO to ensure Q) saturation)
7 ,
Veci — Vepi — Vick at) _ 24V-15V-02V Trp1 10 mA = 2.23 kQ (use 2.2 kQ)
A linear application of an optocoupler is shown
in Fig. 21-38. The 5 V
supply provides a dc bias current to D, via Ro, and the ac signal coupled via C,; and R; increases and decreases the diode current. Transistor Q, is biased into an on state by the direct current through Dj, and its emitter current is
increased and decreased by the variation in light level produced by the alternating current in D,. An output voltage is developed across R3.
974
Electronic Devices, and Circuits
+Vec Ry
390.0
+ Ve
[Tea
IBV.
i
1
i ig "l
43
es ae
=
47kQ
4
| TE(de) Rg
2.2 kO
t i, |
Figure 21-38
Linear signal
coupling by means of an octocoupler.
Other Optocouplers Other types of optocouplers involve different types of output stage. The three types illustrated in Fig. 21-39 are (a) Darlington-output type, (b) SCRoutput, and (c) TRIAC-output. In (a), the photo-darlington output stage provides much higher CTR than a BJT phototransistor output stage
LO 5
2
3 Oe
301g
(a) Darlington output Figure 21-39
ptO4
(b) SCR output
Los
x
205
89 304—
Lo4
(c) TRIAC output
Octocouplers are available with various types of output stage.
(typically 500%), but it also has a slower response time. The output stages in
(b) and (c) are a light-activated SCR and a light-activated TRIAC, respectively. They are used with the kind of control circuits discussed in Chapter 20, where high electrical isolation between the triggering circuit and the control
device is an additional requirement. CTR does not apply to SCR and TRIAC
output stages; instead, the LED current needed to trigger the thyristor is of interest.
Optocoupler output Maximum
stages are not designed for high load currents.
current levels for Darlington outputs are about
150 mA,
and
300 mA is typical for SCR and TRIAC outputs. When high-load currents are
to be switched, the optocoupler output
high-power device.
stage is used as a trigger circuit for a
Optoelectronic Devices
Chapter 24
975
Practice Problems 21-7.1 An octocoupler with the specification in Fig. 21-36 is to control a 10 mA relay with a 30 V supply. The input stage is connected via a resistor (Ri) toa5 V supply. Calculate a suitable resistance for R.
21-7.2
Analyze
the circuit in Fig. 21-38 to determine
the dc bias current
through D; and the ac signal current peaks. Calculate the maximum and minimum de and ac output voltages. The octocoupler used has a diode with Vp = 1.5 V, and a CTR ranging from 20% to 70%.
21-8 PHOTOMULTIPLIER TUBE Operation Although many semiconductor photoelectric devices are currently available,
the photomultiplier tube is still widely used, essentially because it is an Figure
device.
ultra-fast
and
sensitive
extremely
21-40
illustrates
the
principle of the photomultiplier tube. It consists of an evacuated glass cylinder containing a photocathode, an anode, and several additional electrodes known as dynodes. Note that the anode and cathode are at opposite ends of the tube, and that the anode is at a very high positive voltage with respect to the cathode. The dynodes are biased to voltage levels distributed between the cathode and anode voltages. ; Incident
+100 V
+500 V
|
|
1 Dynode |
illumination %,
+300 V
D,
D;
4
+700 V
\\
/
4
WY, iji}
N
Emitted electron
Cathode
Secondary
I electrons OV
Figure 21-40
|
4
Dynode 2
+200 V
Figure 21-41 Typical photomultiplier tube t/voltage characteristics. The dark
curren ‘ current occurs when there is zero cathode
illumination, and the anode current increases
with increased illumination levels.
electrodes. The sensitivity and spectral response are largely dependant on the cathode material. The spectral responses available range from 200 nm to 800 nm. As well as being very sensitive, photomultiplier tubes respond in nanoseconds to illumination changes. Hence they are appropriate for the detection of very fast low-level occurrences.
Circuit Diagrams Figure 21-42a shows a circuit diagram employing a common photomultiplier
graphic symbol. Note that the cathode has a high negative voltage supply,
Chapter 21
and that
the dynode
voltages
Optoelectronic Devices
by a multi-resistor
are provided
977
voltage
divider connected between the cathode and ground. Thus, the dynodes are at progressively higher positive voltage levels moving from the cathode to
the anode. The anode is connected via a resistor to a level more positive than ground, and also to the input of an amplifier. The use of a negative cathode voltage enables the anode output to be relatively close to ground, which is convenient for connecting to an amplifier input or to measuring instruments. Another photomultiplier graphic symbol sometimes used in circuit diagrams is shown in Fig. 21-42b. EB PP +200 V
72
Cathode (K)
#
Dynode: aa7
Anode (P) 8
\
\
\
~
~ Amplifier
wr)
~
(a) Photomultiplier circuit
_— Dynodes
~~ Anode Cathode
(b) Alternative photomultiplier circuit symbol Figure 21-42
Photomultiplier circuit and alternative graphic symbol. In this circuit the
cathode is supplied from a —2 kV source and the anode has a +200 V supply. A voltage divider is used to bias the dynodes to levels between ground and —2 kV.
In some circumstances it might not be convenient to apply a negative high-voltage supply to the cathode (as shown in Fig. 21-42). For example, if a grounded light source is in direct physical contact with the glass at the cathode, the high voltage can produce a leakage current that affects the performance of the photomultiplier. In this situation it is preferable to ground the cathode and connect the anode to a positive high-voltage source, as shown in Fig. 21-43. The output from the anode is coupled via a high-
voltage capacitor (Ci) to subsequent measurement or amplification stages.
978
Electronic Devices and Circuits
D,
D,
=" _
i,t
D
= Lt
= Ll
rE =
R,
R,
R,
Vv, +2kV
Figure 21-43
Photomultiplier circuit with the cathode grounded and the anode supplied
by a +2 kV source. Because of the high anode voltage the output has to be capacitor
coupled. The dynodes have to supply the currents of electrons that pass from one dynode to another inside the tube. For dynode voltage stability, the voltage divider Current (/p) should be much larger than the maximum
anode current.
Voltage Divider The design of the voltage divider circuit for biasing the dynodes is a very
important part of the application of photomultipliers. Normally, the design process simply involves selecting a suitable current and then calculating each resistor value in terms of its voltage drop and the voltage divider current. However, the current that flows between successive dynodes in the form of incident and secondary electrons has to be supplied by the voltage divider, as illustrated in Fig. 21-43. If it is assumed that each incident electron
striking a dynode produces two secondary electrons, then the current levels in Fig. 21-43 would be progressively doubled between successive dynodes, (Iz = 2h, Iz = 2, etc.). Working backwards from D6, Ig ~ 2 I, /3, Is © Ix /3, I, = Iy/6 etc. In fact, the current ratio between successive dynodes could be
much greater than 2:1. However, it is clear that the dynodes closest to the
anode have the highest current levels, and the last dynode before the anode
has a higher current than the rest.
The best approach to voltage divider design would seem to be to select a resistor current very much larger than the anode current, so that the dynode
voltages remain substantially constant regardless of the anode current level. However, a high current can produce heating of the volta ge divider resistors, and because the resistors are likely to be located close to the photomultiplier
tube, the device performance can be affected by the heating; for example, the dark current will be increased. In practical circuit applications the volta ge divider current should be at least 20 times the maximum anode current, and for best performance the ratio should be 100. Example 21-12 demonstrat es
that high power dissipation resistors are required for a voltage divider.
Chapter 21
Optoelectronic Devices
979
O
42 kV (a) Zener diode stabilization of dynode voltages
TF +2 kV
(b) Capacitor stabilization of dynode voltages Figure 21-44
Dynode voltage stabilization using Zener diodes and parallel-connected
capacitors. The capacitors are most effective for a photomultiplier tube with a pulsed illumination input.
Example 21-12 Calculate suitable resistor values for the voltage divider illustrated in Fig. 21-43. Assume that the maximum anode current is 2 mA. Solution
Vaz Vak _2kV 7
7
= 285.7 V Select,
Ipn= 20 X Tacenax) =20X2mA
=40mA
R= VR_285.7V Ip
40mA
= 7.14 kQ (use 6.8 kO)
Pee (VR) _ (285.7 V)" RR
6.8 kO,
= 12 W (use 15 W) R, to R7 = 6.8 kQ, 15 W
980
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Two methods used for dynode voltage stabilization are shown in Fig. 21-44. The Zener diodes shown in Fig. 21-44a hold the voltages constant at the three dynodes closest to the anode. The Zener diodes should obviously be selected to have a breakdown voltage (Vz) equal to the calculated resistor voltage
drop, and the voltage divider current (Ip) must be large enough to keep the diodes operating during breakdown. An Ip level larger than the diode test current (It) is satisfactory. Also, Ip must not exceed the specified maximum Zener diode current (Iz).
Figure 21-44b shows capacitors connected in parallel with the three voltage divider resistors closest to the anode. This arrangement is suitable for photomultiplier tubes that are subject to pulse operation (illumination input
in the form of pulses). The capacitors supply the required dynode current pulses while holding the voltage levels nearly constant. The capacitance values are usually calculated by allowing no more than a 1% capacitor voltage change due to the dynode currents during the input pulse on time. Example 21-13 Determine suitable capacitance values to be connected resistors Rs, Re, and R7 in the voltage divider designed
in parallel
with
in Ex. 21-12, if the
light input has a pulse duration of 100 ps. Solution Assume that
Ig% In, 15~I4/2, and Ig I4/4 and allow that AVc7 ~ Vr/100
Cy=
I, Xt
2 2mAX100 ps AVoy 285.7V/100
= 0.07 pF (use 0.068 pF) /2)Xt_Cy C _ Uy a
= 0.034 pF (use 0.039 1F)
C
_ (In /4)Xt_Cy
"AV, = 0.017 pF (use 0.018 pF)
Note that all three capacitors have to survive approximately 300 V.
Example 21-14 Select suitable Zener diodes to replace resistors Rs, Rg, and Ry in the voltage divider designed in Ex. 21-12.
Optoelectronic Devices
Chapter 21
981
Solution
Vz = Van = Vz3 = 285.7 V Each diode can be made up of two series-connected 140 V Zener diodes. Izy
40 mA
Use 1N3010, 140 V, 10 W Zener diodes with Izp = 18 mA and Izy = 68 mA,
Practice Problems 21-8.1 Determine suitable resistor values to provide the electrode voltages shown in Fig. 21-40. Assume that the maximum anode current is 3 mA. 21-8.2A photomultiplier tube with six dynodes is to be biased as shown in Fig. 21-42a, with a —1400 V supply connected to the cathode and a +100 V anode supply. The maximum anode current is 1.5 mA.
Determine suitable voltage divider resistor values and specify the Zener diodes that could be used to replace Rg and Kz.
21-9 LASER DIODE Operation Laser is an acronym for light amplification by stimulated emission of radiation. A laser emits radiation with a single wavelength or a very narrow band of wavelengths.
This
means
that the
emitted
light
has
a single
color
(is
monochromatic). Laser light is referred to as coherent light, as opposed to light made up of a wide band of wavelengths, which is termed incoherent. A
unique property of light generated by a laser is that the emission is in the form of a very narrow beam; typically 1 ym
to 100 ym
in width. Some
applications of the laser beam are reading bar codes, playing music from a
compact disc, and fibre-optic communication. The operating principle of a laser diode is illustrated in Fig. 21-45. A pn junction of gallium arsenide (GaAs), or GaAs combined with other materials, is manufactured with a precisely defined length (L) related to the wavelength
of the light to be emitted. The ends of the junction are each polished to a mirror surface and usually have an additional reflective coating. One end is only partially reflective so that light can pass through when
lasing occurs.
Consider the effect of charge carriers entering (injected into) the depletion
region of the forward-biased junction, as illustrated in Fig. 21-45. The charge carriers excite the atoms they strike, causing random emission of photons of energy, as electrons are raised to a higher energy level and then fall back to a
lower level. Eventually several photons strike one of the reflective ends of the
junction perpendicularly so that they are reflected back along their original (incident) path. These reflected photons are then reflected back again from
982
Electronic Devices and Circuits
the other end of the junction. The reflection back and forth continues over and over again, and the photons
increase in number,
as they cause other
similar photons to be emitted from atoms. The process of reflection and generation of increasing numbers of photons leads to amplification of the initial reflected light photons. The beam of coherent light emerges from the partially reflective end of the junction. Because of its high-energy density, a laser beam can be quite dangerous. Eye protection must be worn when working with devices employing laser beams. — —
L
— =
Charge carriers Reflected photons Depletion region
Laser beam
Ri eflecti ve end
>
Semi-re j flectivj e end
Charge carriers
Figure 21-45 A
laser diode is basically a pn junction with reflective ends. Photons
reflected from end to end emerge as a narrow beam of coherent light.
Characteristics and Parameters A typical laser diode package is illustrated in Fig. 21-46a and the device characteristics are shown in Fig. 21-46b. The characteristics are a plot of optical power output (P.) versus diode forward current (Ip). Note that the output
power does not increase significantly until Ip exceeds the threshold current (In), which is the level of forward current at which lasing commences. The
output power increases approximately linearly with current increase above the threshold current. At current levels below the threshold, the laser diode
emits incoherent light, just like an LED. The maximum output of typical low-power laser diodes lies in the range
of 2 mW to 10 mW, with threshold currents ranging from 30 mA to 60 mA and operating currents (op) around 60 mA to 150 mA. The forward voltage drop, also termed the operating voltage (Vop), typically ranges from 1.2 V to 2.4 V and the maximum reverse voltage (Vaqpy) is around 2 V. The available
output wavelengths are currently 260 nm to 1800 nm.
Chapter 21
Optoelectronic Devices
983
5 mm
\
(a) Typical laser diode
40 \ 60
20
0
package
—
80
100mA
Threshold current
Ip —
(b) Output power versus forward current characteristic Figure 21-46 Laser diode package and characteristics. Significant power output does not occur until the diode forward current exceeds the threshold current at which lasing commences.
Drive Circuits As seen in Fig. 21-46b, laser diodes are very temperature sensitive. They are also subject to thermal runaway—current increase causing temperature increase, leading to further current increase—which can very rapidly destroy the device. Temperature increase can also cause the laser output wavelength
to jump to another wavelength, a phenomenon termed mode hopping or mode jumping. Consequently, it is very important to operate the device within its specified current range.
Two generally used laser diode drive methods are constant current drive and constant power drive. As the name implies, constant current drive uses a constant current source, such as the circuit illustrated in Fig. 21-47a. Operational amplifier A; has its non-inverting input terminal biased to an adjustable reference voltage (Vier). The output of A; provides the base current to transistor Q:, and the voltage at the emitter of Q: is stabilized at Vy.¢ by feedback diode
to the amplifier’s non-inverting
current
(Ip) substantially
equals
the
input Q;
terminal. emitter
Thus,
current,
the laser which
is
Vet /Rq. A constant power drive circuit, also known as automatic power control (APC), relies on a photodiode included inside many laser diode packages. The photodiode monitors the laser diode light output and produces a current
proportional to the laser output power. The APC circuit in Fig. 21-47b uses
984
Electronic Devices and Circuits
the photodiode current (Ip2) to provide negative feedback to the amplifier. Any increase in laser output power above the design level produces a photodiode current increase, which results in an increase in the voltage drop across Rs. This raises the voltage at the A; inverting input terminal and causes a decrease in the amplifier output. The decrease in A; output voltage reduces the Q; base voltage and results in a decrease in the laser diode current. The decreased level of Ip produces a reduced light output power, which brings Ip2 down to its original level. Thus, the laser diode power
output is stabilized at a constant level. +Vic
412V R
ot Mec
+V
+12'V
Hey diode
Laser
diode
(39 kO +39 kQ)
Laser
|r
R,
20 kO R, (47 kO + 3.3 kO)
(a) Laser diode with a constant current circuit
Figure 21-47
(b) Laser diode with automatic power control
A laser diode can be destroyed by excessive power dissipation. Two
methods of controlling the device forward current and power dissipation are, constant
current and automatic power control.
Modulation Figure 21-48 shows analog and digital modulation methods for laser diodes used in fibre-optic communication equipment. The analog input in
Fig. 21-48a is coupled via capacitor C; to circuit. Capacitor C2 short circuits the ac resistor Re offers a higher impedance otherwise be provided by the A; output.
the base of transistor Q; in an APC feedback from the photodiode, and to the input signal than would The circuit in Fig. 21-48b uses an on
biased switching transistor (Q.) to provide some direct current (Ic) through the laser diode. The required level of Ip is then the sum of Ic, and Ic. The current through Q; is adjusted to the desired level for a constant D, power
output by feedback from D2. The digital input via capacitor C; rapidly switches the Q» collector current between higher and lower levels, thus modulating the laser diode current and its light output power. Because Q> is not switched on and off, its switching speed is not limited by turn-on and turn-off times (see Section 8-5).
Chapter 21
—_ Optoelectronic Devices
985
tVq +12 V
Photo-
diode
Laser diode
\r,
ry
Digital signal
, 10kQ +
ey Analog signal
(a) Analog modulation of laser diode
(b) Digital modulation of laser diode
Output power
Figure 21-48
output power
For fibre-optic communication applications, laser diode power output levels
can be modulated by analog or digital inputs.
Example 21-15 Analyze the constant current circuit shown in Fig. 21-47a to determine the laser diode output power if Vyer is set at 4.9 V. Assume that D, has the P,/Ir
characteristics shown in Fig. 21-46b and that its temperature is 25°C. Solution V.
rR, =~ 60 mA
4.9V
820 \
From the P,/Ip characteristic at Ip = 60 mA, Po 5mW
Example 21-16 The photodiode shown in Fig. 21-47b produces a current of 0.5 mA when the laser diode output is 4 mW. Assuming that D) has the P,/Ig characteristics at 25°C shown in Fig. 21-46b, calculate the required level of Vier and determine the op-amp output voltage when D; is generating 4 mW. Solution Viet= Vrs =Ip2 X R5=0.5mAX 10kO =5V
986
Electronic Devices and Circuits
From the P,/Ig characteristic at P, = 4 mW, Ip= 55mA Vya1 = Vee + (Ip X Rg) = 0.7 V + (55 mA X 82 OD) m52V
Practice Problems | 21-9.1 If Vref is adjusted to 6 V in the circuit shown in Fig. 21-47a, calculate the required resistance for Ry to produce a 6 mW output from D;. Assume that the laser diode has the characteristics at 25°C shown in Fig. 21-46.
21-9.2 Calculate the amplitude of the analog input voltage that should be applied to the base of Q +1 mW
in the circuit shown in Fig. 21-48a to produce a
output from D). Assume that D; has the P,/Ip characteristics at
29°C shown in Fig. 21-46b.
Review Questions Section 21-1 21-1
State measurement
units for luminous
flux and
luminous
intensity.
Using
diagrams, explain flux per unit solid angle. 21-2
Define candela, lumen, and foot candle.
Section 21-2 21-3 21-4 21-5
Sketch diagrams to show the operation and construction of a LED. Briefly explain. For a LED, state typical values of forward current, forward voltage, and reverse breakdown voltage. Draw circuit diagrams showing LEDs used to indicate (a) a de supply voltage switched on and (b) a high output level from an op-amp. Explain each circuit.
21-6
The current level in a LED is to be controlled by the use of a BJT. Sketch two possible circuits, and explain the operation of each.
21-7
An op-amp is to be used to control the current level in a LED. Draw a suitable circuit diagram and explain its operation.
Section 21-3 21-8
Sketch a seven-segment LED display. Explain common-anode and commoncathode connections. Discuss total current numeral, seven-segment display.
21-9
requirements
for a LED
four-
Using illustrations, explain the operation of liquid crystal cells. Discuss the difference between reflective-type and transmittive-type cells.
21-10 Sketch a seven-segment LCD and show the waveforms involved in controlling the cells. Explain.
Chapter 21 _ Optoelectronic Devices
Section 21-4 21-11 Sketch the
typical
construction
and
illumination
characteristics
987
for
a
photoconductive cell. Explain its operation. 21-12 Draw circuit diagrams to show how a photoconductive cell can be used for (a) biasing a pnp transistor off when the cell is illuminated and (b) biasing an npn transistor on when the cell is illuminated. Explain how each circuit operates.
21-13 Draw circuit diagrams to show a photoconductive cell used for (a) triggering an op-amp Schmitt trigger circuit and (b) energizing a relay when the cell is illuminated. Explain the operation of each circuit.
Section 21-5 21-14 Sketch the cross-section of a typical photodiode and explain its operation. Sketch typical photodiode characteristics and discuss their shape.
21-15 For a photodiode, define dark current, light current, and sensitivity. State typical values for each quantity.
21-16 Explain how a solar cell differs from a photodiode. Sketch typical solar cel] characteristics, and discuss the best operating point on the characteristics. 21-17 Sketch the circuit diagram for an array of solar cells employed as a battery charger. Briefly explain.
Section 21-6 21-18 Sketch characteristics for a phototransistor, and
explain how
the device
operates.
21-19 Draw a circuit diagram to show how a phototransistor can be used to energize a relay when the incident illumination is increased to a given level. Explain the circuit operation.
21-20 Modify the circuit drawn for Question 21-19 to have the relay energized until the illumination is increased to a given level. Explain. 21-21 Draw a circuit diagram for phototransistor control of an SCR that triggers on
when the incident illumination falls to a low level. Explain how the circuit operates.
21-22 Sketch a circuit diagram for a photo-darlington. Compare the performance of
photo-darlingtons to phototransistors. 21-23 Sketch a circuit diagram to show the operation of a photo-FET circuit. Briefly
explain the principle of the device. Section 21-7 21-24 Draw the circuit diagram of an optocoupler with a BJT output stage. Sketch a cross-section to show the construction of an optocoupler. Explain the device
operation. 21-25 Discuss the most important parameters of optocouplers.
21-26 Draw a circuit diagram to show how an optocoupler can use a pulse signal from a low-voltage source to control a circuit with a high-voltage supply, or vice versa. Explain how the circuit operates. 21-27 Draw
a circuit diagram to show how
an optocoupler can be used to pass a
linear signal between two circuits with different supply Wolkapes the circuit operates.
Explain how
988
Electronic Devices and Circuits
21-28 Sketch circuit diagrams
for optocouplers with Darlington,
SCR, and TRIAC
outputs. Briefly discuss each optocoupler.
Section 21-8 21-29 Draw a sketch to show the operation of a photomultiplier tube. Briefly explain. 21-30 Define the following: photocathode, anode, dynode, secondary emission, and dark current. 21-31 Sketch and explain typical anode current/voltage characteristics for a photomultiplier tube. 21-32 Draw the circuit diagram of a photomultiplier tube with eight dynodes. Show the cathode biased to a high negative voltage and the anode grounded via a resistor. Explain the circuit operation. 21-33 Briefly discuss the factors involved in voltage divider design for a photomultiplier tube.
Section 21-9 21-34 Using a drawing of a pn junction, briefly describe the operation of a laser diode.
21-35 Sketch the typical P,/Ip characteristics for a laser diode and discuss their shape and the effect of temperature increase. 21-36 Draw a constant current drive circuit for a laser diode and explain its operation. 21-37 Draw an automatic power control circuit for a laser diode and explain its operation.
21-38 Show how a laser diode automatic power modulated. Explain the circuit operation. 21-39 Show how a
control circuit can be analog
digital input can be applied to modulate the output power of a
laser diode. Explain the circuit operation.
Problems Section 21-1 21-1
The total luminous flux striking a 4 cm? photocell at 7 m from a lamp is to be
80 mlm. Determine the required energy output from the lamp in watts. 21-2.
Calculate the total luminous flux striking the surface of a solar cell located 4.5 m
21-3
from a lamp with a 509 W output. The surface area of the solar cell is 5 cm?. Calculate the frequency of the light output from red, yellow, and green LEDs with the following peak wavelengths: 635 nm, 583 nm, 565 nm.
Section 21-2 21-4
An LED with Ip = 20 mA current and Vz = 1.4 V is to indicate when a 25 V supply is switched on. Sketch a suitable circuit and make all necessary calculations.
21-5
Two series-connected LEDs are to be controlled by a 2N3903 transistor with a
12 V supply and Vg = 5 V. The diode current is to be approximately 15 mA. Design a suitable circuit.
Chapter 21
21-6
Optoelectronic Devices
989
An op-amp Schmitt trigger circuit with Voc = +15 V is to have the state of its output indicated by LEDs. A green LED is to indicate high, and a red LED is to
indicate low. Design the circuit for 10 mA diode currents. Include reverse91-7
voltage protection diodes in series with each LED. The BJT-LED circuit in Fig. 21-5a has Vg = 5 V, Vcc = 20 V, and Mg min) = 40 for
Qs). Design the circuit to give a 20 mA LED current with Vp = 2 V.
Section 21-3 21-8
Calculate the maximum power used by a three-and-a-half digit seven-segment
LED display with a5 V supply and 10 mA LED currents. Determine the power dissipated in each LED series resistor if the LEDs have Vf = 1.4 V.
21-9
Determine the maximum power consumed by a three-and-a-half digit sevensegment LCD display with a 15 V peak square-wave supply and 1 ~A LCD segment currents.
Section 21-4 21-10 A
pnp
BJT
is
to
be
biased
on
when
the
level
of
illumination
on
a
photoconductive cell is greater than 100 Ix, and off when the cell is dark. A+5 V supply is to be used, and the BJT collector current is to be 10 mA when on. Design a suitable circuit to use a BJT with hpg = 50 and a photo-conductive cell
with the characteristics in Fig. 21-11. 21-11 An inverting Schmitt trigger circuit has Vec = +12 V and UTP/LTP = +5 V. The Schmitt output is to switch positively when the illumination level exceeds
30 Ix on a photo-conductive cell with the characteristics in Fig. 21-11. Design the
circuit,
and
estimate
the
light level
that
causes
the
output
to switch
negatively.
21-12 A photoconductive cell with the characteristics in Fig. 21-11 is connected in series with an 820 () resistor and a 12 V supply. Determine the illumination level when the circuit current is approximately 6.5 mA, and when it is 1.1 mA.
21-13 A photoconductive cell circuit for controlling the current in a LED (as in Fig. 21-16) has Vcc = 9 V, Ro = 3.3 kO, R3 = 270 Q. The photoconductive cell has a dark resistance of 100 kM, and Rc = 3 kO at 10 lx. Determine the LED current
at light levels of 3 lx and 30 Ix. 21-14 The circuit in Fig. 21-14a has Vcc = +5 V, Ri = 12 kQ, and a photoconductive cell with the specification in Fig. 21-12. Calculate the transistor maximum and
minimum base voltage at 10 lx.
Section 21-5 21-15 A photodiode with the illumination characteristics in Fig. 21-23 is connected in series with a resistance and a 1 V reverse-bias supply. The diode is to produce
a +0.2 V output when illuminated with 20 mW/cm?. Calculate the required series resistance value, and
determine
the device voltage
and current at a
15 mW/cm’ illumination level. 21-16 A photodiode with the characteristics in Fig. 21-23 is connected in series with a 1.2 V reverse-bias supply and a 100 1 resistance. Determine the resistance
offered by the photodiode 20 mW/cm?.
at illumination
levels
of 15
mW/cm?
and
$90
Electronic Devices and Circuits
21-17 Two photodiodes that each have a 100 2 series resistor are connected to a 0.5 V reverse-bias supply. A voltmeter is connected to measure the voltage difference between the diode cathodes. Assuming that each photodiode has the characteristics illustrated in Fig. 21-23, determine the voltmeter reading when the illumination level is 10 mW/cm?
on one diode and 15 mW/cm?
on
the other. 21-18 Six photodiodes with the characteristics in Fig. 21-23 are connected in series.
Determine the maximum output current and voltage at illumination levels of
15 mW/cm? and 12 mW/cm?. 21-19 A highway sign uses 6 V rechargeable batteries that supply an average current of 50 mA. The batteries are recharged from an array of solar cells, each with the characteristics in Fig. 21-25. The average level of sunshine is 50 mW/cm? for 10 hours of each 24-hour period. Calculate the number of solar cells required. 21-20 The roof of a house has an area of 200 m? and is covered with solar cells that are each 2cm X 2 cm. If the cells have the output characteristics shown in Fig. 21-25, determine how they should be connected to provide an output voltage of approximately 120 V. Take the average daytime level of illumination as 100 mW/cm7?. If the sun shines for an average of 12 hours in every 24 hours, calculate the energy in kilowatt-hours generated by the solar cells each day.
Section 21-6 21-21 The phototransistor circuit in Fig. 21-27b has a 25 V supply, and the device has the output characteristics in Fig. 21-29. Determine the collector resistance required to give Vcg = 10 V when the illumination level is 20 mW/cm?. 21-22 Estimate Vcg for the circuit in Problem 21-21 at a5 mW/cm’? illumination level.
If the phototransistor has the specification in Fig. 21-30, calculate the Vcr
variation produced by a +0.5 mW/cm? illumination change. 21-23 A phototransistor with the characteristics in Fig. 21-29 is connected in series with a 600 © relay coil. The coil current is to be 8 mA when the illumination level is 15 mW/cm7*. Determine the required supply voltage. Estimate the coil
current at 10 mW/cm?. 21-24 A phototransistor circuit for controlling an SCR (as in Fig. 21-32) is to be designed. The SCR has triggering conditions of Vg = 0.7 V and Ig = 50 pA, and the phototransistor
has
the specification in Fig. 21-30.
Calculate
suitable
resistor values if the SCR is to switch on when the light level drops to
5 mW/cm?. The supply voltage is Vcc = 12 V. Section 21-7 21-25 An optocoupler with the specification in Fig. 21-36 is to control a 12 mA load that has a 6 V supply. The input is a 10 V square wave connected via a resistor (R;). Determine a suitable resistance for Rj.
21-26 A25 V, 0.5 W lamp is to be switched on and off by an BJT circuit with Vec = 9 V and Ic = 6 mA. Design a suitable optocoupler circuit and estimate the required CTR. 21-27 An optocoupler circuit has its input connected via a 820 O resistor (Rj) to a pulse source. Its output transistor has a 5 V collector supply and a 470 0
Chapter 21
Optoelectronic Devices
991
emitter resistor (R2). The gate-cathode terminals of an SCR are connected
across R,. The SCR requires Vg = 1.1 V and Ic = 500 pA for triggering. If the
optocoupler has CTR = 40%, calculate the required
amplitude
of the pulse
input to trigger the SCR.
21-28 A optocoupler linear circuit, such as in Fig. 21-38, has Veci = 15 V, Vec2 = 25 V, vs = +0.1 V, Ri = 100 0, Rp = 1.2 kQ, R3 = 1.5 kM. Calculate the de and ac
output voltages and the overall voltage gain. The optocoupler has CTR = 30%. 21-29 An optocoupler switching circuit, as in Fig. 21-37, has Veci = 18 V, Vec2 = 3 V, Ri = 1.8 kO, Rp = 820 Q, and J, = 1 mA. Analyze the circuit to determine [f1, Ic, and CTR.
Section 21-8 21-30 A photomultiplier tube circuit as illustrated in Fig. 21-42a has the following components and voltage levels: R; through R7 = 4.7 kQ, Rg = 22 k0, cathode voltage Exx = ~—2.i kV, and anode supply voltage Epp = +100 V. Determine the suitable maximum
anode current, calculate the anode output
voltage, and determine the power dissipation in all resistors.
21-31 If the photomultiplier tube in Problem 21-30 is subject to 80 ps illumination pulses, determine suitable capacitor values for connecting in parallel with Rs,
R¢, and R; to stabilize the dynode voltages. 21-32 A photomultiplier tube with eight dynodes is to have its anode supplied with +1.5 kV and its cathode grounded. The dynodes are to be biased via a voltage divider connected between the anode supply and ground, and the anode is to be capacitor-coupled to the output. Draw
the circuit diagram
and calculate
suitable voltage divider resistor values if the maximum anode current is 3 mA. 21-33 The voltage divider designed for Problem 21-32 is to have the three resistors
closest to the anode replaced with Zener diodes. Specify suitable devices. 21-34 The circuit described in Problem 21-30 has capacitors connected in parallel with the three resistors closest to the anode. The capacitor values are Cs = 0.03 pF,
Co = 0.06 pF, and C7 = 0.12 pF If the input light level to the photomultiplier tube is pulsed, determine the maximum
pulse duration that should be used.
Section 21-9 21-35 Analyze the constant current circuit in Fig. 21-47a to determine the maximum and minimum laser diode output power. Assume that the device has the P,/Ir characteristics shown in Fig. 21-46b at 25°C. 21-36 A constant current circuit, as illustrated in Fig. 21-47a, is to be designed to
produce an output power adjustable from 4 mW to 6 mW. The diode has the P,/Ip characteristics shown in Fig. 21-46b and is operating at a temperature of
50°C. If the circuit has a 15 V supply, calculate suitable resistor values.
21-37 The laser diode constant power circuit in Fig 21-47b is to be used to stabilize the output power at 6 mW.
If the laser diode requires a forward current of
80 mA, and the photodiode current is 0.56 mA at P, = 6 mW, calculate the
required level of Vyet, and the amplifier output voltage.
992
Electronic Devices and Circuits
21-38 A constant power circuit, as illustrated in Fig. 21-47b, is to be designed to produce a5 mW output from a laser diode that requires Ip = 75 mA and has a 0.45 mA photodiode current at P, = 5 mW. The circuit is to operate from an 18 V supply. Select a suitable reference voltage and determine the required resistor values. 21-39 The circuit designed for Problem 21-38 is to be modulated by an analog input signal, as illustrated in Fig. 21-48a. Determine a suitable resistance for Rg, and
the required input voltage amplitude to modulate the laser diode forward current by +7.5 mA.
21-40 The automatic power control circuit analyzed in Ex. 21-16 is to be modified for digital modulation as shown
in Fig. 21-48b. If the collector current of Q> is
20 mA, calculate the change in Ip) to keep the output of D; stabilized at 4 mW. Assume that A; has an open-loop gain of 100 000.
Practice Problem 21-1.1
Answers
100W
21-1.2
5.13 x 10!4 Hz
21-1.3 21-2.1 21-2.2
0.73 mlx, 0.29 lm 2200,84V 2700,3900
21-3.1
1.84mW
21-4.2 21-4.3 21-5.1 21-5.2 21-6.1
33kQ04+2.2k0 301lx,151lx +0.19V 48 2.5 V,13.9V
21-4.1
21-6.2 21-7.1 21-7.2
422 A, 968 pA, 1.2mA
13mW/cm? 1500 9mA,+638mA,
(3.96 V to 13.9 V), (£0.27 V to £0.98 V)
21-81
7 xX (15kQ, 10 W)
21-8.2
(5.6 kQ, 10 W), (200 V, Izr < 30 mA < Iz)
21-9.1
920
21-9.2
+290 mV
CHAPTER 22 Miscellaneous
Devices
Objectives You will be able to:
1 Explain the construction and
operation of voltage-variable capacitor diodes (VVCs). Sketch
using thermistors for
temperature level detection. 5 Explain the construction and
typical VVC voltage/
operation of tunnel diodes.
capacitance characteristics, draw the equivalent circuits, and discuss typical VVC
Sketch typical forward and reverse characteristics for a tunnel diode, explain their shape, and identify the
parameters. 2 Design and analyze resonance circuits using VVCs for frequency tuning. 3 Discuss the construction and operation of thermistors, sketch
typical thermistor resistance/ temperature characteristics, and discuss typical thermistor parameters.
4 Calculate thermistor resistance
important points and regions of the characteristics. 6 Draw tunnel diode piecewise linear characteristics and analyze tunnel diode parallel
7 amplifier circuits. Explain the be: Seapine
characteristics, parameters, and applications of Schottky, PIN,
at various temperatures from the data sheet information.
and current-limiting diodes. Design and analyze circuits
Design and analyze circuits
involving these devices.
INTRODUCTION VVCs are pn-junction devices designed to produce a substantial change in junction capacitance when the reverse-bias voltage is adjusted. They can be applied to tune resonant circuits over a range of frequencies. The resistance of a thermistor changes significantly with change in temperature, so its major application is control of circuits that must respond to temperature change. The tunnel diode is a two-terminal negative-resistance device that can function as an oscillator, an amplifier, or a switch. Low forward voltage and fast turn-off time are features of the Schottky diode that make it suitable for preventing
994
Electronic Devices and Circuits
saturation in switching BJTs. The PIN diode behaves as a variable resistance at high frequencies, and the current-limiting diode is used in constant-current applications.
22-1
VOLTAGE-VARIABLE CAPACITOR DIODES
VVC Operation Voltage-variable capacitor diodes (VVCs) are also known as varicaps, varactors, and tuning diodes. Basically, a VVC is a reverse-biased diode, and its capacitance is the junction capacitance. Recall that the width of the depletion region at a pn-junction depends upon the reverse-bias voltage (Fig. 22-1). A large reverse-bias produces a wide depletion region, and a small reverse bias gives a narrow depletion region. The depletion region acts as a dielectric between two conducting plates; thus the junction behaves as a capacitor. The depletion layer capacitance (Cp,) is proportional to the junction area and inversely proportional to the width of the depletion region. Because the width of the depletion region is proportional to the reverse-bias voltage, C,, is inversely proportional to the reverse-bias voltage. This is not a direct proportionality; instead C,, is proportional to 1/V", where V is the reversebias voltage and n depends upon doping density. Depletion region width -— > Large reverse-bias Small reverse-bias
" Dielectric Conducting plates
Figure 22-1 A voltage variable capacitor diode (VVC) is essentially a . . . .
1 = VE
. . depletion region and reduces the
Reverse-bias
reverse-biased pn-junction. Increasing the reverse voltage widens the
capacitance.
Figure 22-2 shows the doping profiles for two types of VVC classified as abrupt junction and hyperabrupt junction devices. In the abrupt junction VVC, the semiconductor material is uniformly doped, and it changes abruptly
from. p-type to.n-type at the junction. The hyperabrupt junction device has the doping density increased. close to the junction. This increasing density produces a narrower depletion region, and so it results in a larger junction capacitance. It also causes the width of the depletion region to be more sensitive to bias, voltage variations; thus it produces the largest capacitance
Miscellaneous Devices
Chapter 22
Doping
995
Doping |
density | PtyPe
Fy | Devine
(————
"¥
densi a
Doping density
TEXY PE
density
(b) Hyperabrupt junction
(a) Abrupt junction
Doping profiles for abrupt junction and hyperabrupt junction
Figure 22-2 VCs.
change for a given voltage variation. VVCs are packaged just like ordinary low-current diodes. Equivalent Circuit The complete equivalent circuit for a VVC is shown in Fig. 22-3a, and a simplified version is given in Fig. 22-3b. In the complete circuit, the junction capacitance (Cj) is shunted by the junction reverse leakage resistance (Rj). The resistance of the semiconductor material is represented by Rs, the terminal inductance is Ls, and the capacitance of the terminals (or the device
package) is Cc. Because Ls is normally very small and ky is very large, the equivalent circuit can be simplified (Fig. 22-3b) to Rg in series with Cr, where Cr is the sum of the junction and terminal capacitances (Cr = Cy + Cc). The Q-factor for a VVC can be as high as 600 at a 50 MHz frequency. However,
since the Q-factor varies with bias voltage and frequency, it is used only as a figure of merit for comparing the performance of different VVCs. om
Ls
Rs
Cy
—O Rs
Ce
_\I }i-
Cr
Ry
(a) Complete equivalent circuit
(b) Simplified equivalent circuit
Figure 22-3 The complete equivalent circuit of a VVC has five components. The simplified circuit is made up of the semiconductor
resistance Rs and the total capacitance Cy.
Specification and Characteristics A wide selection of VVC capacitances is available, ranging approximately
from 6 pF to 700 pF. The capacitance tuning ratio (TR) is the ratio of Cy at a small
reverse
voltage to Cr at a large reverse voltage.
In the partial
specification for a VVC shown in Fig, 22-4, the tuning ratio is listed as C,/Cu1o. This is the ratio of the device capacitance at a 1 V reverse bias to that ata 10 V reverse bias. The 400 pF minimum capacitance (Cp) listed for a 1 V bias is
996)
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Typical VVC Specification
Cr Ve
=1V,f=1MHz
min
Ci /Ci9
max
400 pF
f=
1 MHz | Ve = 1
600 pF
Figure 22-4
QO
Vif = 1 MHz
14
200
Vmax)
TR¢max)
15V
100 nA | 200 mA
Teqnax)
Partial specification for a voltage-variable capacitor diode (VVC).
changed to 400 pF/14 when the bias is 10 V. The specification also lists the Qfactor, as well as maximum reverse voltage, reverse leakage current, and the
maximum forward current that can be passed when the device is forward biased. A typical graph of capacitance (Cr) versus reverse-bias voltage (VR) for a hyperabrupt junction VVC is reproduced in Fig. 22-5 together with the VVC circuit symbol. It is seen that Cr varies (approximately) from 500 pF to 25 pF when Vx is changed from 1 V to 10 V. It should be noted from the specification in Fig. 22-4 that the nominal capacitance has a large tolerance (400 pF to 600 pF), and this must be taken into account when the Cr/VR graphs are used. (pF)
1000 400 200
Cr
100
40 20
10 0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
(V)
Figure 22-5 Capacitance/voltage characteristic for a hyperabrupt junction VVC and VVC circuit symbol.
Applications The major application of VVCsis as tuning capacitors to adjust the frequency of
resonance circuits. An example of this is the circuit shown in Fig. 22-6, which is an amplifier with a tuned circuit load. The amplifier produces an output at the
resonance frequency
of the tuned
circuit. The VVC (D;) provides
the
capacitance (Cr) of the resonant circuit, and this can be altered by adjusting the diode (reverse) bias voltage (Vp). So the resonance frequency of the circuit can
Miscellaneous Devices
Chapter 22
Figure 22-6
997
Amplifier stage with an LC tank circuit load.
The resonance frequency of the LC circuit can be varied by adjusting the VVC reverse-bias voltage.
be varied. C; is a coupling capacitor with a capacitance much larger than that of the VVC, and R> limits the VVC forward current in the event that it becomes forward biased.
Example 22-1 Determine the maximum and minimum resonance frequency for the circuit in Fig. 22-6. Assume that D, has the Cr/ Vz characteristic in Fig. 22-5.
Solution
ye
=
VecX Re
_
9V Xx 4.7kO
Dimin) “" R3 + Rat Rs
47k04+5k0
+ 47kO
=2.9V
2
_ Vec(R3 + Ry) _ 9V X (4.7kO + 5kO) Dimax)"Rg + Ra tRs 47k04+5k0 + 47kO ~6.1V
From Fig. 22-5, at Vp = 2.9 V, Cr
1
Foie) = SAV EGR)
250 pF:
_
1
2m V (00 mH & 250 pF)
= 1 MHz From Fig. 22-5, at Vp = 6.1 V, Cr 1
f (min) = Qa V(LCt) =~ 1.9 MHz
70 pF: 1
24V(100 pH X 70 pF)
998
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Practice Problem
a
oo
22-1.1 A tuned amplifier circuit as in Fig. 22-6 is to have a resonance
frequency adjustable from
MHz to 2.5 MHz. A 12 supply is used, cana he inductor (Li) is 80 1.5 H, the VVC (D;) has the V charac teristics in Fig. 22-5 and the specification in Fig. 22-4. Determine suitab le resistance values for Rs, Ra, and Rs.
22-2 THERMISTORS Thermistor Operation The word thermistor is a combination of thermal and resistor. A thermistor is
a resistor with definite thermal characteristics. Most thermistors have a negative temperature coefficient (NTC), but positive temperature coefficient (PTC) devices are also available. Thermistors are widely applied for measurement
and control of temperature, liquid level, gas flow, and so on.
Silicon and germanium are not normally used for thermistor manufacture, because larger and more predictable temperature coefficients are available with metallic oxides. Various mixtures of manganese, nickel, cobalt, copper,
iron, and uranium are pressed into desired shapes and sintered (or baked) ata
high temperature to form thermistors. Electrical connections are made either by including fine wires during the shaping process or by silvering the surfaces after sintering (see Fig. 22-7a). Thermistors are made in the shape of beads, probes, discs, washers, and so on (Fig. 22-7b). Beads may be glass-coated or enclosed in evacuated or gas-filled glass envelopes for protection against corrosion.
Thermistor material
Contacts
Encapsulating material
Contact leads
(a) Thermistor construction
(b) Some thermistor shapes
Figure 22-7 Thermistors are resistors that are very sensitive to temperature.
Chapter 22
Miscellaneous Devices
999
Characteristics and Specifications The
typical
shows
thermistor
that
the
resistance/ temperature
device
resistance
characteristic in Fig. 22-8 decreases substantially when its
(R)
temperature is raised. At 0°C, R ~ 1.5 kQ; and at 60°C, R70 ©. Current flow
through a thermistor causes power dissipation that can raise its temperature and
change
its resistance.
This
could
introduce errors in the application, so device currents are normally kept to a minimum. 10 000
thermistor
-——~
4000 =~
2000 |. R(Q)
40
=
a
—40 T (°C) Figure 22-8
Typical resistance/temperature characteristics for a negative
temperature coefficient (NTC) thermistor.
Figure 22-9 shows partial specifications for two thermistors with widely different resistance values. Both devices have the resistance specified at 25°C
as the zero power resistance. This, of course, means that there must be zero power dissipation in the thermistor to give this resistance value. The dissipation
constant
is
the
device
power
dissipation
that
can
raise
its
temperature through 1°C. The dissipation constant in both cases is specified Typical Thermistor Specifications
Zero power | Resistance resistance ratio _Thermistor |
at25°C
B
Maximum working | Dissipation
| 25°C/125°C | (0 to 50°C) | temperature |
Batra _-44002A
300:
15.15
3118
° 100°C
"44008
30k
29.15
3810
50°
constant
1 mW/°C ait, 8 mW in/°C instill
"| Powis Hquia
Figure 22-9 Partial specifications for two thermistors, one with a 300 0 25°C resistance, and the other with a 30 kO 25°C resistance.
1000
Electronic Devices and Circuits
as 1 mW/°C in still air, and 8 mW/°C in moving liquid. Thus, a thermistor located in still air conditions could have its temperature increased by 1°C if its current produces 1 mW of power dissipation. An indication of how much the thermistor resistance changes is given by the resistance ratio at 25/125°C. Clearly, with this ratio specified as 15.15, the resistance at 25°C is divided by 15.15 to determine the resistance at 125°C. Note that maximum working temperatures are listed for both devices. The resistance change with temperature is also defined by the constant beta ({),
this time for the range 0°C to 50°C. This constant is used in an equation that relates resistance values at different temperatures: R OE ge Ro
(# id i) T, To
(22-1)
In Eq. 22-1, R; is the resistance at temperature T,, and Rz is the resistance T). It is important to note that T, and T> are absolute (or Kelvin) temperature values: (°C + 273) K.
Example 22-2 Calculate the resistance of the 300 9 thermistor specified in Fig. 22-9 at temperatures of 20°C and 30°C. Solution For T = 20°C, and
Ty = 25°C
+ 273 = 298K
To = 20°C
+ 273 = 293 K Ry
From Eq. 22-1,
300 2
Ry = pBA/TI=1/T2) — _,3118(1/298-1/293) = 358 0
For T = 30°C, and
From Eq. 22-1,
Ty = 25°C
+ 273 = 298K
To = 30°C
+ 273 = 303 K
Ry 300 2 Ry = (BU/TI-1/T2) — ,3118(1/298—-1/303) = 252 ©
Applications Figure 22-10 shows
a thermistor connected
as a feedback
resistor in an
inverting amplifier circuit. (Note the device circuit symbol.) In this case, the thermistor is supplied with a constant current determined by R; and V;j. The
output voltage is directly proportional to the thermistor resistance, and so V, varies with temperature change.
Miscellaneous Devices
Chapter 22
Figure 22-10
ah The
“Vg circuit in Fig.
22-11
Use of an inverting
amplifier to produce a constant current through a thermistor.
oO
illustrates
1001
how
a thermistor
can
be
used
for
triggering a Schmitt circuit at a predetermined temperature. This could be air temperature or the temperature of a liquid or perhaps the temperature of some type of heating appliance. When the thermistor resistance (Rr) is increased by the device temperature decrease, the Schmitt input voltage is raised to the upper trigger point, causing the output to switch negatively.
Example 22-3 Calculate Vj for the Schmitt circuit in Fig. 22-11 at 25°C and at 28°C if the
thermistor is the 300 © device specified in Fig. 22-9.
Figure 22-11 Schmitt trigger circuit using a thermistor input stage for temperature level detection.
Solution At.25°C,
Rr = 300 0,
V; = Veco X Rr _ R, + Rr
5 VX 3000 47kQ
= 31.7mV For T = 28°C,
Ti = 25°C + 273 = 298K
and
Tz = 28°C + 273 = 301K
+ 300 0
1002
Electronic Devices and Circuits
rom F tom
—
Eq. 22-1,
Rk
3009
Rp = pAUL/TI-1/T2) —_,3118(1/298—1/301) = 2700
y, -VecX Rr i>
Ri+ Rr
__5V x 2700 = 47k9
+2700
= 28.6 mV
_ Practice Problems _ 22-2.1 Calculate the output voltage from the circuit in Fig. 22-10 at 25°C and
' 28°C if the 30 kM thermistor specified in Fig. 22-9 is used. 22-2.2 If the Schmitt circuit in Fig. 22-11 has UTP = 1 V, calculate a suitable resistance value for Rj for the circuit to trigger at 18°C. The thermistor _ used is'the ot Q, device specified in Fig. 22-9.
22-3
TUNNEL DIODES
Tunnel Diode Operation A tunnel diode (sometimes called an Esaki diode
Depletion region
after its inventor, Leo Esaki) is a two-terminal
negative resistance device that can be employed as an amplifier, an oscillator, or a switch. Recall from Chapter 1 that the width of the depletion region at a pn-junction depends
upon the doping density of the semiconductor
oo dsped _ p-type
(@) 4 heavily oop ef ver
material. Lightly doped material has a wide depletion
region,
whereas
heavily
oka depletion cred
doped
material has a narrow region. A tunnel diode uses very heavily doped semiconductor material, so the depletion region is extremely narrow. This is illustrated in Fig. 22-12 along with three tunnel diode circuit symbols.
The
depletion
region
is an
cross
it only
(b) Tunnel diode circuit symbols
insulator
because it lacks charge carriers, and usually charge
carriers
can
when
the
5
55.49 A tunnel diode
has a heavily doped pn-
junction, which results in a
external bias is large enough to overcome the very narrow depletion region. barrier potential. However, because the depletion region in a tunnel diode is so narrow, it does not constitute a large barrier to electron flow. Consequently,
a small forward
or reverse
bias
(not large enough to overcome the barrier potential) can give charge carriers sufficient energy to cross the depletion region. When this occurs, the charge carriers are said to be tunnelling through the barrier.
Chapter 22
Miscellaneous Devices
1003
When a tunnel diode junction is reverse-biased (negative on the p-side, positive on the n-side), substantial current flow occurs because of the
tunnelling effect (electrons moving from the p-side to the n-side). Increasing levels of reverse-bias voltage produce more tunnelling and a greater reverse current. So, as shown in Fig. 22-13, the reverse characteristic of a tunnel diode is linear, just like that of a resistor. Negative resistance region
it bp eT
Tht
HA Jae
:
i
tr} |
|
Forward
iH _|
characteristi¢
Ip
Si Ep
4
Reverse | characteristic rt
Figure 22-13 Tunnel diode characteristics. The current increases to a peak level (Ip) as the forward bias is increased, and then falls off to a valley current (Jy) with
increasing bias voltage.
A forward-biased
tunnel diode initially behaves
like a reverse-biased
device. Electron tunnelling occurs from the n-side to the p-side, and the forward current (Ip) continues to increase with increasing levels of forward voltage (Ep). Eventually, a peak level of tunnelling is reached, and then further increase in Ep actually causes Ip to decrease. (See the forward
characteristic in Fig. 22-13.) The decrease in Ip with increasing E continues until the normal process of current flow across a forward-biased junction begins to take over when the bias voltage becomes large enough to overcome the barrier potential. Ip now starts to increase with increasing levels of Er, so that the final portion of the tunnel diode forward characteristics is similar to that for an ordinary pn-junction. The shape of the tunnel diode characteristics
can be explained in terms of energy band diagrams for the semiconductor material.
Characteristics and Parameters
Fig. 22-14. Consider the typical tunnel diode forward characteristics shown in
gnized on the The peak current (Ip) and valley current (Iy) are easily reco of [Ip before the s level and minimum forward characteristic as the maximum
peak voltage (Vp) is the level of junction is completely forward-biased. The
1004
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Negative resistance region
Figure 22-14 Typical forward characteristic for a tunnel diode. Note that the negative resistance region exists between forward-
bias voltages of approximately 50 mV and 325 mV.
forward bias voltage (Ep) corresponding to Ip, and the valley voltage (Vy) is the Ex level at Iy. Vz is the forward voltage drop when the device is completely forward-biased. The dashed line at the bottom of the forward characteristic shows the characteristic for an ordinary forward-biased diode. It is seen that this joins the tunnel diode characteristic as Vp is approached. When a voltage is applied to a resistance, the current normally increases as the applied voltage is increased. Between Ip and Iy on the tunnel diode characteristic, Ip actually decreases as Ey is increased. So this region of the characteristic is named the negative resistance region, and the negative resistance (Rp) of the tunnel diode is its most important property. The negative resistance value can be determined as the reciprocal of the slope of the characteristic in the negative resistance region. From Fig. 22-14, it can be seen that the negative resistance is Rp = AVy/Alg, and the negative
conductance is Gp = Alp/AVz. If Rp is measured at different points on the negative resistance portion of the characteristic, slightly different values will be obtained at each point because the slope is not constant. Therefore, Rp is usually specified at the centre of the negative resistance region. Figure 22-15 lists typical tunnel diode parameters. Typical Tunnel Diode Parameters
Ip(mA)
| Ve(mV) |
1to 100. | Figure 22-15
50 to 200
Iv (mA)
Vy (nV)
0.1 to 5
350. to.500
Ve (V)
Rp (Q)
Q,5to1 |. =10 te —200
Tunnel diode specification data showing the range of parameters.
Chapter 22 = Miscellaneous Devices
1005
It is shown in Chapter 2 that a straight-line approximation of diode characteristics can sometimes be conveniently employed. For a tunnel diode, the piecewise linear characteristics can usually be constructed from data
provided by the device manufacturer.
Example 22-4 Construct the piecewise linear characteristics and determine Rp for a 1N3712
tunnel diode from the following data: Ip = 1 mA, ly = 0.12 mA, Vp = 65 mV, Vy = 350 mV, and Vp = 500 mV at Ip = Ip.
Solution Refer to Fig. 22-16. Plot point 1 at
Ip=1mA
and
Vp=65mV
Plot point 2 at
Iyv=012mA
and
Vy = 350mV
(mA)
12}
—________—
0.8
5
htt
0.2 | vy —}--74--0 ! 0 100
(mV)
Vp Figure 22-16
Piecewise linear characteristics for a tunnel diode,
drawn from information provided on the device specification.
Draw the first portion of the characteristic from the zero point to point 1. Draw the negative resistance portion between points 1 and 2. Plot point 3 at
Ip=Ip
and
Vp=500mV
Draw the final portion of the characteristics at the same slope as the line
between point 0 and point 1. Draw the horizontal part of the characteristic from point 2 to the final portion.
AV,
350mV—65mV
KK
Rp= a7 > =GmA —0.12mA) = -3240
1006
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Parallel Amplifier For operation as an amplifier, a tunnel diode must be biased to the centre of
its negative resistance region. Figure 22-17a shows the basic circuit of a tunnel diode parallel amplifier. Load resistor Ry, is connected in parallel with diode D, and supplied with current from voltage source Eg and signal source e;. Figure 22-17b uses the tunnel diode piecewise linear characteristics to show the de conditions of the diode when the signal voltage is zero (e; = 0) and when e, = +100 mV. The operation of the circuit is explained by the analysis in Ex. 22-5, which also demonstrates that a parallel amplifier has current gain but no voltage gain.
Example 22-5 Assuming that Eg and e, have zero source resistance, calculate the current gain and voltage gain for the tunnel diode parallel amplifier in Fig. 22-17a. The device piecewise linear characteristics are given in Fig. 22-17b. IB
Eg
Ip 1
lL L
|
200 mV
R
ED goa +100
= @ mV
Eri
D, (a) Basic parallel amplifier circuit
0
0
100
Ep —>
200 {
300
400
> (mV)
Vig
(b) Circuit current and voltage levels
Figure 22-17
Abasic tunnel diode parallel amplifier has a load
resistance in parallel with the diode and the (seriesconnected) bias and signal sources applied directly to the
diode and load.
Miscellaneous Devices
Chapter 22
Solution
When e, = 0:
Epg = Eg = 200 mV (point Q on Fig. 22-17b) Ipg = 2mA
At the Q-point,
Erto = Ex = 200 mV a ERE _ 200mV re 800 RL. LO
Also,
=25mA
+ Ip = 2.5mA+ 2mA Iso = In. =45mA When
e, =
+100 mV:
Eg + es = 200 mV
+ 100 mV
= 300 mV
Ep = Era) = 300 mV (point A on Fig. 22-17b) Ipiay = 1 mA
and. Also,
I
Be)
Eryay
oo
=
OR
=
300mV
80 O
= 3.75 mA
Tpay = Iria) + Inia) = 3.75 mA + 1 mA = 4.75 mA When e; = —100 mV: Eg + e, = 200 mV — 100 mV = 100 mV
Ep = Erp) = 100 mV (point B on Fig. 22-17b) Ip)
and
Also,
I
=3mA =
RL) ~
Erte)
——
Ry
=
= 1.25mA
100 mV
80 2
‘
In) = Ire) + Inq) = 1.25 mA + 3mA = 4.25mA
Total load current change: Alet = Irwa) — Inve) = 3.75 mA — 1.25 mA =2.5mA
1007
1008
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Total signal current change: Alg = Ipca) — Ip) = 4.75 mA
— 4.25 mA
= 0.5mA Teak Aly _= 2.5mA Ay = Alp,
i Current gain:
=5 AE
= BY
Ap ekes
Voltage gain:
+100 mV
sd
The current gain equation for a tunnel diode parallel amplifier can be shown to be
A = >
(22-2)
Note that Rp is already taken as negative in Eq. 22-2, so that only the absolute value should be used in calculating Aj. For Rp= 100 0 and R;= 80 Q, as in Ex. 22-5, 100
“= T00-800~° From Eq. 22-2, it can be seen that when Ry, > Rp, Aj < 1; and when R;, = Rp, Aj = ©. A current gain of infinity means that the circuit is likely to oscillate. For maximum stable current gain, R, should be
selected to be just slightly less than Rp. Figure 22-18 shows the circuit of a practical tunnel diode parallel amplifier. The signal voltage e, and load resistor Ry are capacitor-coupled to the diode, while dc bias is provided by source voltage Ex and voltage divider
R, and Ry». Inductor L; and capacitor C; isolate the bias supply from ac signals.
Ry
we
—VWy— 2.2kO
Ez
>
Rvy
Ry
470
.
C3
1J
| Omi oc Pe
imi
0.3 pF
Goin vy.
.
Ry,
300 0
—
Figure 22-18
Ina practical sc
ail
amplifier circuit, the load and signal
source are capacitor-coupled to the tunnel diode.
e
°
Chapter 22 _— Miscellaneous Devices
1009
A tunnel diode series amplifier can be constructed. In this case the device
is connected in series with the load, and voltage amplification is obtained instead of current amplification. Oscillators and switching circuits can also be constructed with tunnel diodes.
Practice Problem 22-3.1 Draw the dc and ac equivalent circuits for the tunnel diode parallel amplifier in Fig. 22-18. Calculate the current gain.
22-4 SCHOTTKY, PIN, AND CURRENT-LIMITING
DIODES
The Schottky Diode The
Schottky
diode
(also known
as a hot-carrier
diode)
has
a metal-to-
semiconductor junction instead of a pn-junction. This gives the device a lower forward voltage drop and faster reverse recovery than a pn-junction diode. Figure 22-19a illustrates the basic structure of the device. An n-type epitaxial layer is created on a low-resistance n-type substrate (see Chapter 7), and
a metal
film
(the barrier metal)
is deposited
on
the epitaxial
layer.
Additional layers of metal are deposited on the outer surfaces for anode and cathode connections, as illustrated. The type of metal used at the junction affects the device performance. The metal side of the junction has an abundance of free electrons, and
there are no holes in either the metal or the n-type material. Thus there are no minority charge carriers and there is virtually no depletion region. This means that when the junction is switched from forward to reverse bias, there are no charge carriers to be withdrawn from a depletion region (see Section 2-6), and there is no charge carrier recombination. Consequently, the reverse recovery time is extremely small—on the order of picoseconds. The typical forward characteristic in Fig. 22-19b show a voltage drop (Vp) ranging from 0.2 V at a 10 mA forward current to about 0.4 V at 1 A. As illustrated, the reverse current is approximately 0.5 mA at 25 °C, which is substantially greater than for most pn-junction diodes. Another disadvantage
is that the 50 V typical reverse breakdown voltage is lower than for other types of diodes. The two important advantages of Schottky diodes over pn-junction diodes are the lower forward voltage drop and the much faster turn-off Figure 22-20 shows the use of a Schottky diode in an application where of these advantages are employed: clamping a switched BJT to keep it saturating. Without the diode, Q; saturation voltage would be Vexieaty¥
time. both from 0.2 V,
which gives Vac ¥ 0.5 V (Fig. 22-20a). If D, in Fig. 22-20b has Vr = 0.2 V, then
the collector is clamped to 0.2 V below the base voltage. Thus, the minimum
1010
Electronic Devices and Circuits
Anode terminal
metal Schottky
n-type
barrier
epitaxial ——" layer
metal n-type
—
substrate Cathode terminal metal
(a) Basic structure of a Schottky diode (mA) 1000 4 ee
|
100
Tp
6 @— OUTPUT
Q15
R10 50
017 a6
a10
OFFSET NULL
:
5_ OFFSET iy
. Ri 1K
020
Q22
ait
Qs 6S RS. : & 50K
SR2 S1K :
R4 5K
4 50K :
:
Ri1
50
=